-----BEGIN PRIVACY-ENHANCED MESSAGE----- Proc-Type: 2001,MIC-CLEAR Originator-Name: webmaster@www.sec.gov Originator-Key-Asymmetric: MFgwCgYEVQgBAQICAf8DSgAwRwJAW2sNKK9AVtBzYZmr6aGjlWyK3XmZv3dTINen TWSM7vrzLADbmYQaionwg5sDW3P6oaM5D3tdezXMm7z1T+B+twIDAQAB MIC-Info: RSA-MD5,RSA, Wh3mngjbCv2YKVH6/r1ctEDN/SMW3p8Cz4WL08l6IF3e6mma0NivhQdeyZB5x6Zp KcKcTi3Asy4wwDTUlnb3XA== 0000950123-08-011268.txt : 20080922 0000950123-08-011268.hdr.sgml : 20080922 20080922171108 ACCESSION NUMBER: 0000950123-08-011268 CONFORMED SUBMISSION TYPE: F-4 PUBLIC DOCUMENT COUNT: 18 FILED AS OF DATE: 20080922 DATE AS OF CHANGE: 20080922 FILER: COMPANY DATA: COMPANY CONFORMED NAME: ArcelorMittal CENTRAL INDEX KEY: 0001243429 STANDARD INDUSTRIAL CLASSIFICATION: STEEL WORKS, BLAST FURNACES ROLLING MILLS (COKE OVENS) [3312] IRS NUMBER: 000000000 FISCAL YEAR END: 1231 FILING VALUES: FORM TYPE: F-4 SEC ACT: 1933 Act SEC FILE NUMBER: 333-153624 FILM NUMBER: 081082908 BUSINESS ADDRESS: STREET 1: 19 AVE DE LA LIBERTE STREET 2: L-2930 LUXEMBOURG CITY: R.C.S. LUXEMBOURG STATE: N4 ZIP: 00000 BUSINESS PHONE: 35247922151 MAIL ADDRESS: STREET 1: 19 AVE DE LA LIBERTE STREET 2: L-2930 LUXEMBOURG CITY: R.C.S. LUXEMBOURG STATE: N4 ZIP: 00000 FORMER COMPANY: FORMER CONFORMED NAME: ARCELOR DATE OF NAME CHANGE: 20030618 F-4 1 u01974fv4.htm FORM F-4 F-4
Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on September 22, 2008
Registration No. 333-
 
 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
FORM F-4
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
ArcelorMittal
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
ArcelorMittal
(Translation of registrant’s name into English)
         
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg   5051   Not Applicable
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation
or organization)
(Primary Standard Industrial Classification Code   (I.R.S. Employer Identification Number)
    Number)    
19, Avenue de la Liberté
L-2930 Luxembourg
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
Telephone: (352) 4792-2414
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of Registrant’s principal executive offices)
Marc Jeske, Esq.
ArcelorMittal USA Inc.
1 South Dearborn Street, 19th Floor
Chicago, IL 60603-9888
United States
Telephone: 1-312-899-3400
(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)
Copies to:
Gamal M. Abouali, Esq.
Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP
12, rue de Tilsitt
75008 Paris
France
(33) 1 40 74 68 00
     Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale of the securities to the public: As soon as practicable after this registration statement becomes effective.
     If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering: o
     If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering: o
CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
     In accordance with Rule 457(p) under the Securities Act, the payment of the registration fee is offset against the filing fee paid in connection with the Registration Statement on form F-4 with File No. 333-152143 filed by ArcelorMittal on July 3, 2008.
                                             
 
                  Proposed Maximum     Proposed Maximum        
  Title of Each Class of     Amount to be     Offering     Aggregate     Amount of  
  Securities to be Registered     Registered     Price per Note     Offering Price     Registration Fee(1)  
 
U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes due 2013
    $ 1,500,000,000         100 %     $ 1,500,000,000       $ 58,950    
 
U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes due 2018
    $ 1,500,000,000         100 %     $ 1,500,000,000       $ 58,950    
 
(1)   The securities being registered are offered (i) in exchange for U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes due 2018 previously sold in transactions exempt from registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and (ii) upon certain resales of the notes by broker-dealers. The registration fee has been computed based on the face value of the notes, pursuant to Rule 457 under the Securities Act of 1933.
     The registrant hereby amends this registration statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this registration statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or until the registration statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.
 
 

 


Table of Contents

The information in this prospectus is not complete and may be changed. These securities may not be sold until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This prospectus is not an offer to sell nor does it seek an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

P R O S P E C T U S
(ARCELORMITTAL LOGO)
Offer to Exchange
the following series of notes:
U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes due 2013
and
U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes due 2018
of
ArcelorMittal
Material Terms of the Exchange Offer
 

  We are offering to exchange, commencing on      , 2008, the U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% notes due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% notes due 2018 we sold previously in private offerings (the “original notes”) for new registered exchange notes due 2013 and 2018, respectively (the “exchange notes”).
 
  The terms of the exchange notes are identical to the terms of the original notes, except for the transfer restrictions and registration rights relating to the original notes.
 
  We will exchange all original notes that are validly tendered and not validly withdrawn.
  The exchange offer will expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on      , 2008 unless we extend it.
 
  You may withdraw tenders of original notes at any time before 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the date of the expiration of the exchange offer.
 
  We will not receive any proceeds from the exchange offer.
 
  We will pay the expenses of the exchange offer.
 
  No dealer-manager is being used in connection with the exchange offer.
 
  The exchange of notes will not be a taxable exchange for U.S. federal income tax purposes.


 
     See “Risk Factors” beginning on page 9 of this prospectus for a discussion of certain factors that you should consider before participating in the exchange offer.
     Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission, or the “SEC,” nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the accuracy or adequacy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.
The date of this prospectus is     , 2008

 


 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
         
    Page  
  ii  
  ii  
  ii  
  iii  
  iii  
    v  
    1  
    9  
    23  
    24  
    31  
    31  
    32  
    33  
    42  
    56  
    59  
    63  
    64  
    64  
 EX-4.1: INDENTURE
 EX-4.2: FORM OF 2013 AND 2018 EXCHANGE NOTES
 EX-4.3: REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT
 EX-5.1: OPINION OF CLEARY GOTTLIEB STEEN & HAMILTON LLP
 EX-5.2: OPINION OF BONN SCHMITT STEICHEN
 EX-12: CALCULATION OF RATIOS OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES
 EX-23.3: CONSENT OF DELOITTE S.A.
 EX-23.4: CONSENT OF DELOITTE ACCOUNTANTS B.V
 EX-23.5: CONSENT OF KPMG AUDIT S.A.R.L.
 EX-25: FORM T-1
 EX-99.1: FORM OF LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL
 EX-99.2: FORM OF NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY
 EX-99.3: FORM OF LETTER TO REGISTERED HOLDERS
 EX-99.4: FORM OF INSTRUCTIONS TO REGISTERED HOLDER
 EX-99.5: FORM OF LETTER TO CLIENTS
 EX-99.6: FORM OF EXCHANGE AGENT AGREEMENT
i

 


Table of Contents

ABOUT THIS PROSPECTUS
     You should rely only on the information contained or incorporated by reference in this prospectus. No person has been authorized to provide you with different information. If anyone provides you with different or inconsistent information, you should not rely on it.
     We are not making the exchange offer in places where it is not permitted.
     You should not assume that the information contained in this prospectus is accurate as of any date other than the date on the front cover of this prospectus.
     As used in this prospectus, “ArcelorMittal,” “we,” “our,” “us” and “the Company” refer to ArcelorMittal and its consolidated subsidiaries, unless the context otherwise requires or unless otherwise specified.
INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE
     The SEC allows us to “incorporate by reference” the information we file with it, which means that we can disclose important information to you by referring you to those documents. The information incorporated by reference is considered to be part of this prospectus, and certain later information that we file with the SEC will automatically update and supersede this information. We incorporate by reference the following documents:
    our annual report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2007 (File No. 333-146371), which, excluding Item 5 and Item 18 thereof, we refer to as our “2007 Form 20-F”; and
 
    our reports on Form 6-K dated May 5, 2008 (Exhibit 99.1 only), May 14, 2008 (Exhibits 99.1, 99.2 and 99.3 only), June 9, 2008, June 11, 2008, June 16, 2008, June 30, 2008, July 1, 2008, August 4, 2008, August 7, 2008, August 13, 2008, August 14, 2008, August 20, 2008, September 3, 2008 (three reports), September 17, 2008 , September 19, 2008 and September 22, 2008.
     We also incorporate by reference into this prospectus any future filings made with the SEC under Sections 13(a), 13(c) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (which we refer to as the “Exchange Act”), before the 45th day following the consummation of the exchange offering, and, to the extent designated therein, reports on Form 6-K that we furnish to the SEC before the 45th day following the consummation of the exchange offering.
     Any statement contained in the 2007 Form 20-F or in the abovementioned Form 6-Ks filed or furnished before the date of this prospectus shall be deemed to be modified or superseded for purposes of this prospectus to the extent that a statement contained in this prospectus modifies or supersedes such statement. Any such statement so modified or superseded shall not be deemed, except as so modified or superseded, to constitute a part of this registration statement.
     You may request a copy of any and all of the information that has been incorporated by reference in this prospectus and that has not been delivered with this prospectus, at no cost, by writing or telephoning us at our address or telephone number set forth under the caption “Prospectus Summary—Corporate Information.” To obtain timely delivery, investors must request this information no later than five business days before the date they must make their investment decision.
WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION
     We file reports, including annual reports on Form 20-F, and other information with the SEC pursuant to the rules and regulations of the SEC that apply to foreign private issuers. You may read and copy any materials filed with the SEC at its Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. You may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. Any filings we make electronically will be available to the public over the Internet on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov and on
ii

 


Table of Contents

our web site at www.arcelormittal.com. The references above to our website and the website of the SEC are inactive textual references to the uniform resource locator (URL) and are for your reference only.
ENFORCEABILITY OF CIVIL LIABILITIES
     ArcelorMittal is organized under the laws of the Grand Duchy of Luxembourg with its principal executive offices and corporate seat in Luxembourg. The majority of ArcelorMittal’s directors and senior management are residents of jurisdictions outside the United States. The majority of ArcelorMittal’s assets and the assets of these persons are located outside the United States. As a result, investors may find it difficult to effect service of process within the United States upon ArcelorMittal or these persons or to enforce outside the United States judgments obtained against ArcelorMittal or these persons in U.S. courts, including actions predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the U.S. federal securities laws. Likewise, it may also be difficult for an investor to enforce in U.S. courts judgments obtained against ArcelorMittal or these persons in courts in jurisdictions outside the United States, including actions predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the U.S. federal securities laws. It may also be difficult for an investor to bring an original action in a Luxembourg court predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the U.S. federal securities laws against ArcelorMittal’s directors and senior management and non-U.S. experts named in this prospectus or the documents incorporated by reference herein.
FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
     This prospectus and the documents incorporated by reference herein contain forward-looking statements based on estimates and assumptions. Forward-looking statements include, among other things, statements concerning the business, future financial condition, results of operations and prospects of ArcelorMittal, including its acquired subsidiaries. These statements usually contain the words “believes,” “plans,” “expects,” “anticipates,” “intends,” “estimates” or other similar expressions. For each of these statements, you should be aware that forward-looking statements involve known and unknown risks and uncertainties. Although it is believed that the expectations reflected in these forward-looking statements are reasonable, there is no assurance that the actual results or developments anticipated will be realized or, even if realized, that they will have the expected effects on the business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects of ArcelorMittal.
     These forward-looking statements speak only as of the date on which the statements were made, and no obligation has been undertaken to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements made in this prospectus or elsewhere as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as required by applicable laws and regulations. In addition to other factors and matters contained or incorporated by reference in this prospectus, it is believed that the following factors, among others, could cause actual results to differ materially from those discussed in the forward-looking statements:
    ArcelorMittal’s ability to manage its growth;
 
    ArcelorMittal’s ability fully to realize anticipated cost savings, revenue enhancements and other benefits from the acquisition by Mittal Steel of Arcelor;
 
    Mr. Lakshmi N. Mittal’s ability to exercise significant influence over the outcome of shareholder voting;
 
    any loss or diminution in the services of Lakshmi N. Mittal, ArcelorMittal’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer;
 
    any downgrade of ArcelorMittal’s credit rating;
 
    ArcelorMittal’s ability to operate within the limitations imposed by its financing arrangements;
 
    ArcelorMittal’s ability to refinance existing debt and obtain new financing on acceptable terms to finance its growth;
iii

 


Table of Contents

    mining risks;
 
    the risk that non-fulfillment or breach of transitional arrangements may result in the restitution of aid granted to some of ArcelorMittal’s subsidiaries;
 
    ArcelorMittal’s ability to fund under-funded pension liabilities;
 
    increased cost of wages and the risk of labor disputes;
 
    general economic conditions, whether globally, nationally or in the markets in which ArcelorMittal conducts business;
 
    the risk of disruption or volatility in the economic, political or social environment in the countries in which ArcelorMittal conducts business;
 
    fluctuations in currency exchange rates, commodity prices, energy prices and interest rates;
 
    the risk of disruptions to ArcelorMittal’s operations;
 
    the risk of unfavorable changes to, or interpretations of, the tax laws and regulations in the countries in which ArcelorMittal operates;
 
    the risk that ArcelorMittal may not be able fully to utilize its deferred tax assets;
 
    damage to ArcelorMittal’s production facilities due to natural disasters;
 
    the risk that ArcelorMittal’s insurance policies may provide limited coverage;
 
    the risk of product liability claims adversely affecting ArcelorMittal’s operations;
 
    international trade actions or regulations;
 
    the risk that U.S. investors may have difficulty enforcing civil liabilities against ArcelorMittal and its directors and senior management;
 
    the risk that a downturn in global economic conditions may have an adverse effect on the results of ArcelorMittal;
 
    ArcelorMittal’s ability to operate successfully within a cyclical industry;
 
    the risk that changes in demand for and supply of steel products in China and other developing economies may result in falling steel prices;
 
    the risk of significant supply shortages and increasing costs of raw materials, energy and transportation;
 
    increased competition from substitute materials, such as aluminum; and
 
    legislative or regulatory changes, including those relating to protection of the environment and health and safety, and those resulting from international agreements and treaties related to trade, accession to the European Union (“EU”) or otherwise.
iv

 


Table of Contents

     Some of these factors are discussed in more detail in this prospectus, including under “Risk Factors,” and in the documents incorporated by reference herein.
PRESENTATION OF FINANCIAL INFORMATION
Definitions and Terminology
     Unless indicated otherwise, or the context otherwise requires, references herein to “ArcelorMittal,” “we,” “us,” “our” and “the Company” or similar terms are to ArcelorMittal, formerly known as Mittal Steel Company N.V. (“Mittal Steel”) or as Ispat International N.V., and its subsidiaries (which include LNM Holdings N.V. and its subsidiaries and International Steel Group Inc. and its subsidiaries).
     All references herein to “Arcelor” refer to Arcelor, a société anonyme incorporated under Luxembourg law, which was acquired by Mittal Steel on August 1, 2006, having its registered office at 19, avenue de la Liberté, L-2930 Luxembourg, Grand Duchy of Luxembourg, and, where the context requires, its consolidated subsidiaries. All references herein to “Arcelor Brasil” refer to the former Arcelor Brasil S.A. (the current ArcelorMittal Brasil S.A.), a majority-owned subsidiary of Arcelor. All references herein to “Sicartsa” refer to the operations of ArcelorMittal las Truchas S.A. de C.V. (formerly Siderurgia Lázaro Cárdenas las Truchas S.A. de C.V.) in Mexico, which was acquired by the Company on April 20, 2007. All references herein to “ArcelorMittal Kryviy Rih” refer to the operations of Kryvorizhstal in the Ukraine, which was acquired by the Company on November 25, 2005. “ISG” refers to International Steel Group Inc. and its subsidiaries as it existed prior to its acquisition by Mittal Steel on April 15, 2005. Following the acquisition of ISG by Mittal Steel, ISG’s name was changed to “Mittal Steel USA ISG Inc.,” the operations were merged with Ispat Inland on December 31, 2005 and the name of the surviving entity was changed to Mittal Steel USA Inc. and then to ArcelorMittal USA following Mittal Steel’s acquisition of Arcelor.
Financial Information
     The audited consolidated financial statements of ArcelorMittal (of which Mittal Steel is the predecessor) and its consolidated subsidiaries, including the consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2006 and 2007, and the consolidated statements of income, changes in equity and cash flows for each of the years ended December 31, 2005, 2006 and 2007 are contained in our report on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008 and have been incorporated by reference in this prospectus. The redefinition of the operating responsibilities of all members of the Group Management Board announced on April 21, 2008 resulted in a change in the composition of the reportable segments. ArcelorMittal has prepared the information required by Item 5 of Form 20-F for the three years ended December 31, 2007 and the ArcelorMittal consolidated financial statements for the three years ended December 31, 2007, retrospectively adjusted for the changes in the composition of the reportable segments. ArcelorMittal furnished this information to the SEC in a report of foreign private issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008. We refer to this report of foreign private issuer on Form 6-K as the "Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008'', and to the consolidated financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2006 and 2007 contained therein as the “ArcelorMittal Consolidated Financial Statements.” The unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements as of and for the six-month periods ended June 30, 2007 and 2008 have been incorporated by reference in this prospectus. The ArcelorMittal consolidated financial statements were prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IFRS”).
     Our results of operations and financial condition as of and for the years ended December 31, 2006 and 2007, and the comparability between them, have been significantly affected by our August 2006 acquisition of Arcelor. For purposes of comparing our 2006 and 2007 results, we have prepared unaudited pro forma financial information for the year ended December 31, 2006 that present our results of operations as if the acquisition had taken place on January 1, 2006, as described under “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects” in the Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008.
     The financial information and certain other information presented in a number of tables in this prospectus have been rounded to the nearest whole number or the nearest decimal. Therefore, the sum of the numbers in a column may not conform exactly to the total figure given for that column. In addition, certain percentages presented in the tables in this prospectus reflect calculations based upon the underlying information prior to rounding and, accordingly, may not conform exactly to the percentages that would be derived if the relevant calculations were based upon the rounded numbers.
v

 


Table of Contents

Market Information
     This prospectus and the documents incorporated by reference herein include industry data and projections about our markets obtained from industry surveys, market research, publicly available information and industry publications. Statements on ArcelorMittal’s competitive position contained in this prospectus and the documents incorporated by reference herein are based primarily on public sources including, but not limited to, publications of the International Iron and Steel Institute. Industry publications generally state that the information they contain has been obtained from sources believed to be reliable but that the accuracy and completeness of such information is not guaranteed and that the projections they contain are based on a number of significant assumptions. We have not independently verified this data or determined the reasonableness of such assumptions. In addition, in many cases we have made statements in this prospectus and the documents incorporated by reference herein regarding our industry and our position in the industry based on internal surveys, industry forecasts and market research, as well as our own experience. While these statements are believed to be reliable, they have not been independently verified, and we do not make any representation or warranty as to the accuracy or completeness of such information set forth in this prospectus or incorporated by reference herein.
vi

 


Table of Contents

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
     This summary highlights selected information from this prospectus and the documents incorporated by reference and does not contain all of the information that may be important to you. You should carefully read this entire prospectus and the documents incorporated by reference, including the risk factors and financial statements.
Overview
     ArcelorMittal is the world’s largest and most global steel producer. It results from the combination in 2006 of Mittal Steel and Arcelor, a société anonyme incorporated under Luxembourg law, which was acquired by Mittal Steel on August 1, 2006, at the time respectively the world’s largest and second largest steel companies by production volume.
     ArcelorMittal produces a broad range of high-quality finished, semi-finished carbon steel products and stainless steel products. Specifically, ArcelorMittal produces flat products, including sheet and plate, long products, including bars, rods and structural shapes, and stainless steel products. ArcelorMittal sells its products primarily in local markets and through its centralized marketing organization to a diverse range of customers in approximately 170 countries, including the automotive, appliance, engineering, construction and machinery industries.
     ArcelorMittal is the largest steel producer in the Americas, Africa, and Europe and the second largest producer in the Commonwealth of Independent States (the “CIS”), and it has a growing presence in Asia, particularly in China. ArcelorMittal has steelmaking operations in 20 countries on four continents, including 65 integrated, mini-mill and integrated mini-mill steelmaking facilities. As of June 30, 2008, ArcelorMittal had approximately 322,000 employees.
     ArcelorMittal operates its business in six reportable operating segments: Flat Carbon Americas; Flat Carbon Europe; Long Carbon Americas and Europe; Asia, Africa and CIS; Stainless Steel; and ArcelorMittal Steel Solutions and Services (trading and distribution). ArcelorMittal’s steelmaking operations have a high degree of geographic diversification. Approximately 35% of its steel is produced in the Americas, approximately 46% is produced in Europe and approximately 19% is produced in other countries, such as Kazakhstan, Algeria, Morocco and South Africa. In addition, ArcelorMittal’s sales are spread over both developed and developing markets, which have different consumption characteristics.
      ArcelorMittal had sales of approximately U.S.$67.6 billion for the six months ended June 30, 2008 and approximately U.S.$105.2 billion for the year ended December 31, 2007. ArcelorMittal had steel shipments of approximately 59.0 million tonnes and crude steel production of approximately 60 tonnes in the first six months of 2008 and approximately 109.7 million tonnes of steel shipments and approximately 116.4 million tonnes of crude steel production in 2007. “Tonnes” are metric tonnes and are used in measurements involving iron ore, iron ore pellets, direct reduced iron, hot metal, coke, coal, pig iron and scrap. A metric tonne is equal to 1,000 kilograms or 2,204.62 pounds. ArcelorMittal’s net income attributable to equity holders of the parent for the six months ended June 30, 2008 was U.S.$8.2 billion or U.S.$5.87 per share and, for the year ended December 31, 2007, was U.S.$10.4 billion, or U.S.$7.41 per share. As of June 30, 2008, ArcelorMittal had equity of U.S.$67.1 billion, total debt of U.S.$38.2 billion and cash and cash equivalents, including short-term investments and restricted cash, of U.S.$7.5 billion.
     ArcelorMittal’s shares are listed and traded on the New York Stock Exchange, or NYSE (symbol “MT”), are admitted to trading on the Luxembourg Stock Exchange’s regulated market and listed on the Official List of the Luxembourg Stock Exchange (symbol “MTL”), and are admitted to listing and trading on Euronext Amsterdam by NYSE Euronext (symbol “MT”), Euronext Brussels by NYSE Euronext (symbol “MTBL”), Euronext Paris by NYSE Euronext (symbol “MTP”) and the stock exchanges of Madrid, Barcelona, Bilbao and Valencia (symbol “MTS”).
Strategy
     ArcelorMittal’s success has been built on a consistent strategy that emphasizes size and scale, vertical integration, product diversity, continuous growth in higher value products and a strong customer focus. We intend to continue to play a leading role in the consolidation of the global steel industry and to be the global leader in this industry, in particular through the following:

1


Table of Contents

     Three-dimensional strategy for sustainability and growth. ArcelorMittal has unique geographical and product diversification coupled with upstream and downstream integration, which reduces exposure to risk and cyclicality. This strategy can be broken down into its three major elements:
Geography: ArcelorMittal is the largest producer of steel in Europe, North and South America and Africa and the second largest steel producer in the CIS region, with a growing presence in Asia, particularly in China. ArcelorMittal has steel-making operations in 20 countries on four continents, including 65 integrated, mini-mill and integrated mini-mill steel-making facilities. ArcelorMittal’s steel-making operations have a high degree of geographic diversification. ArcelorMittal is able to improve management and spread its risk by operating in six segments based on its geographical and product diversity.
Worldwide steel demand is driven by growth in developing economies, in particular in the BRICET countries (Brazil, Russia, India, China, Eastern Europe and Turkey). Our expansion strategy over recent years has given us a leading position in Africa, Central and Eastern Europe, South America and Central Asia. We are also building our presence in China and India. As these economies develop, local customers will require increasingly advanced steel products as market needs change.
Products: A global steel producer must be able to meet the needs of different markets. Steel consumption and product requirements clearly differ between mature economy markets and developing economy markets. Steel consumption in mature economies is weighted towards flat products and a higher value-added mix, while developing markets utilize a higher proportion of long products and commodity grades. To meet these diverse needs, we plan to maintain a high degree of product diversification. We also plan to seek opportunities to increase the proportion of our product mix consisting of higher value added products. We produce a broad range of high-quality finished, semi-finished carbon steel products and stainless steel products. With this highly diversified product portfolio, we are in a unique position to reduce exposure to volatile earnings.
Value Chain: ArcelorMittal plans to continue to develop its upstream and downstream integration. We intend to increase selectively our access to and ownership of low-cost raw material supplies, particularly in locations adjacent to or accessible from our steel plant operations. ArcelorMittal has access to high-quality and low cost raw material through its captive sources and long-term contracts.
Downstream integration is a key element of our strategy to build a global customer franchise. In high-value products, downstream integration allows steel companies to be closer to the customer and capture a greater share of value-added activities. As our key customers globalize, we intend to invest in value-added downstream operations, such as steel service centers and building and construction support unit services for the construction industry. In addition, we intend to continue to develop our distribution network in selected geographic regions. We believe that these downstream and distribution activities should allow us to benefit from better market intelligence and to better manage inventories in the supply chain to reduce volatility and improve working capital management. Furthermore, we will continue to expand our production of value-added products in developing markets, leveraging off our experience in developed markets.
     Growth Plan: ArcelorMittal has initiated a strategic plan designed for growth by increasing shipments to 130 million tonnes by 2012, a 20% increase over 2006 levels (including the output of Sicartsa for that year). This plan is based on projected world steel production growth of 3-5% per year, translating into an increase of 20-30% over the period. ArcelorMittal has based its growth plan on the low end of this projected world market growth in order to support a healthy global supply/demand situation. Should global demand grow at more than 3% per annum, we will adjust our growth target to meet demand.
     M&A/Greenfield growth: Mergers and acquisitions are a key pillar of our strategy to which we bring unique experience, particularly in terms of integration. While such mergers and acquisitions do not create new capacity on an industry-wide basis, they improve consolidation and offer synergies. ArcelorMittal has continued its predecessor companies’ policy of making strategic and substantial acquisitions and investments, with numerous transactions announced in 2007, and acquisitions and investments for a total value of U.S.$12.3 billion (including cash purchase price, assumed debt and shares issued at fair market value) completed in 2007.

2


Table of Contents

Recent Developments
     For a description of certain recent developments relating to ArcelorMittal, see “Recent Developments” in this prospectus.
Corporate Information
     ArcelorMittal is a public limited liability company (société anonyme) that was incorporated under the laws of Luxembourg on September 24, 2001. ArcelorMittal is registered at the Registre de Commerce et des Sociétés, Luxembourg under number B 82.454. The mailing address and telephone number of ArcelorMittal’s registered office are: ArcelorMittal, 19, Avenue de la Liberté, L-2930 Luxembourg, Grand Duchy of Luxembourg, +352 4792-2414.
Summary of the Exchange Offer
     
Background
  On May 27, 2008, we completed the private offering of U.S.$1,500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of our notes due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of our notes due 2018. In connection with that offering, we entered into a registration rights agreement with the initial purchasers of the original notes in which we agreed, among other things, to complete this exchange offer. Under the terms of the exchange offer, you are entitled to exchange the original notes for exchange notes evidencing the same indebtedness and with substantially similar terms. The exchange offer is intended to satisfy our obligations under the registration rights agreement. If the exchange offer is not completed within the time period specified in the registration rights agreement, we will be required to pay additional interest on the original notes. You should read the discussion under the heading “Description of Exchange Notes” for further information regarding the exchange notes.
 
   
The exchange offer
  We are offering to exchange up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 of our exchange notes due 2013 that have been registered under the Securities Act for up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 of our notes due 2013 that were issued on May 27, 2008; and up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 of our exchange notes due 2018 that have been registered under the Securities Act for up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 of our notes due 2018 that were issued on May 27, 2008.
 
   
 
  To participate in the exchange offer, you must follow the automatic tender offer program, or “ATOP,” procedures established by The Depository Trust Company, or “DTC,” for tendering notes held in book-entry form. The ATOP procedures require that the exchange agent receive, prior to the expiration date of the exchange offer, a computer-generated message known as an “agent’s message” that is transmitted through ATOP and that DTC confirm that:
     
 
 
     DTC has received instructions to exchange your notes; and
 
   
 
 
     you agree to be bound by the terms of the letter of transmittal.
     
 
  For more details, please read “The Exchange Offer—Terms of the Exchange Offer” and “The Exchange Offer—Procedures for Tendering.” Any holder electing to have original notes exchanged pursuant to this exchange offer must properly tender his or her original notes prior to the close of business on the expiration date. All original notes validly tendered and not properly withdrawn will be accepted for exchange. Original notes may be exchanged only in minimum

3


Table of Contents

     
 
  denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.
 
   
Resales of exchange notes
  We believe that the exchange notes may be offered for resale, resold or otherwise transferred by you (unless you are our “affiliate” within the meaning of Rule 405 of the Securities Act) without compliance with the registration and prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act, provided that:
     
 
 
     you acquire the exchange notes in the ordinary course of business; and
 
   
 
 
     you are not participating, do not intend to participate, and have no arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in the distribution of the exchange notes.
     
 
  If any of the foregoing is not true and you transfer any exchange note without delivering a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act and without an exemption of your exchange notes from such requirements, you may incur liability under the Securities Act. We do not assume or indemnify you against such liability.
 
   
 
  If you are a broker-dealer and receive exchange notes for your own account in exchange for original notes that were acquired as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities, you must represent to us that you will deliver a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale of the exchange notes.
 
   
Consequences of failure to exchange
  If we complete the exchange offer and you do not participate in it, then:
     
 
 
     your original notes will continue to be subject to the existing restrictions upon their transfer;
 
   
 
 
     we will have no further obligation to provide for the registration under the Securities Act of those original notes except under certain limited circumstances; and
 
   
 
 
     the liquidity of the market for your original notes could be adversely affected.
     
Expiration date
  This exchange offer will remain open for at least 20 full business days (as defined by Exchange Act Rule 14d-1(g)(3)) and will expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on     , 2008, or such later date and time to which we extend it (the “expiration date”).
 
   
Withdrawal of tenders
  You may withdraw your tender of original notes at any time prior to the expiration date. To withdraw, you must submit a notice of withdrawal to the exchange agent using ATOP procedures before 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the expiration date of the exchange offer. Please read “The Exchange Offer—Terms of the Exchange Offer—Withdrawal of Tenders.”
 
   
Conditions
  The exchange offer is subject to certain customary conditions. See “The Exchange Offer—Terms of the Exchange Offer—Conditions of the Exchange Offer.”
 
   
Certain income tax considerations
  This exchange of the original notes will not be a taxable exchange for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
 
   
Use of proceeds
  We will not receive any cash proceeds from the issuance of the exchange notes in this exchange offer.
 
   
Exchange agent
  HSBC Bank USA, National Association is serving as exchange agent in connection with the exchange offer.

4


Table of Contents

     
Information agent
  D.F. King & Co., Inc. is serving as information agent in connection with the exchange offer.

5


Table of Contents

Summary of the Exchange Notes
     The exchange notes have the same financial terms and covenants as the original notes, except that the exchange notes have been registered under the Securities Act and, therefore, will not bear legends restricting their transfer. The exchange notes will evidence the same debt as the original notes and will be entitled to the benefits of the indenture. The following summary contains basic information about the exchange notes and is not intended to be complete. It does not contain all the information that is important to you. For a more complete understanding of the exchange notes, please refer to the section of this prospectus entitled “Description of Exchange Notes.”
     
Issuer
  ArcelorMittal
     
Notes offered
 
     U.S.$1,500,000,000 in principal amount of 5.375% notes due 2013 (the “2013 exchange notes”)
 
   
 
 
     U.S.$1,500,000,000 in principal amount of 6.125% notes due 2018 (the “2018 exchange notes,” and together with the 2013 exchange notes, the “exchange notes” or “notes”)
 
   
Maturity
 
     2013 exchange notes: June 1, 2013
 
   
 
 
     2018 exchange notes: June 1, 2018
 
   
Interest rate
 
     The 2013 exchange notes will bear interest at the rate of 5.375% per annum, based upon a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months.
 
   
 
 
     The 2018 exchange notes will bear interest at the rate of 6.125% per annum, based upon a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months.
     
Interest payment dates
  Interest on the 2013 exchange notes will be payable semi-annually on June 1 and December 1 of each year, commencing on December 1, 2008.
 
   
 
  Interest on the 2018 exchange notes will be payable semi-annually on June 1 and December 1 of each year, commencing on December 1, 2008.
 
   
Ranking
  The notes will be our unsecured and unsubordinated obligations and will rank equally in right of payment with all of our other unsecured and unsubordinated debt. The notes will be effectively subordinated to all of our existing and future secured indebtedness and to all existing and future indebtedness of our subsidiaries with respect to the assets of those subsidiaries. The notes do not restrict our ability or the ability of our subsidiaries to incur additional indebtedness in the future. As of June 30, 2008, our total consolidated debt was approximately U.S.$38.2 billion, including U.S.$28.4 billion issued by our subsidiaries and guaranteed by us.

6


Table of Contents

     
Additional Amounts
  In the event that any withholding or deduction is required by the laws of a Relevant Jurisdiction, we will pay additional amounts so that the amount you receive after the withholding tax of a Relevant Jurisdiction will equal the amount that you would have received if no withholding tax had been applicable, subject to some exceptions as described under “Description of Exchange Notes — Additional Amounts” in this prospectus.
 
   
Covenants
  The indenture relating to the notes contains restrictions on our ability to pledge assets and merge or transfer assets. For a more complete description see “Description of Exchange Notes” in this prospectus.
 
   
Redemption Events
  We may redeem the notes, of any series, in whole or in part from time to time, at our option, on at least 30 days’ but no more than 60 days’ prior written notice given to the registered holders of such series of notes to be redeemed. Upon redemption of the notes, we will pay a redemption price equal to the greater of (1) 100% of the principal amount of the notes to be redeemed and (2) the sum of the present values of the Remaining Scheduled Payments of the notes to be redeemed, discounted to the date of redemption on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the Treasury Rate plus 40 basis points, in the case of the 2013 exchange notes, or 40 basis points, in the case of the 2018 exchange notes, in each case plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the redemption date. See “Description of Exchange Notes — Redemption, Exchange and Purchase — Redemption at the Option of the Company.”
 
   
 
  If, due to changes in tax treatment in a Relevant Jurisdiction occurring after May 27, 2008 (or after the date of succession), we would be required to pay additional amounts as described under “Description of Exchange Notes — Additional Amounts,” we may redeem the notes in whole but not in part upon giving not less than 30 days’ nor more than 60 days’ notice to the holders at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof, together with accrued and unpaid interest to the date fixed by the Issuer for redemption.
 
   
Offer to Purchase Upon a Change of
  Control
Upon the occurrence of certain change of control events, we may be required to make an offer to purchase all or a portion of each holder’s notes pursuant to a Change of Control Offer, at a purchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount tendered plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of purchase. See “Description of Exchange Notes — Redemption, Exchange and Purchase — Offer to Purchase Upon a Change of Control.”
 
   
Further issuances
  ArcelorMittal reserves the right, without the consent of the holders of the notes, to create and issue additional notes ranking equally with any series of the notes in all respects, so that such additional notes will be consolidated and form a single series with the relevant series of notes; provided that such additional notes will be issued with no more than de minimis original issue discount for U.S. federal income tax purposes or be part of a qualified reopening for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

7


Table of Contents

     
Use of proceeds
  We will not receive any cash proceeds from the issuance of the exchange notes in this exchange offer.
 
   
Listing
  The notes will not be listed.
 
   
Trustee, registrar, principal paying
  agent, transfer agent and exchange
  agent
HSBC Bank USA, National Association.
 
   
Rating
  The notes have been assigned a rating of “Baa2” by Moody’s Investor Services, Inc. (“Moody’s”), “BBB+” by Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services (“Standard & Poor’s”) and “BBB+” by Fitch Inc. (“Fitch”). Ratings are not a recommendation to purchase, hold or sell notes, inasmuch as the ratings do not comment as to market price or suitability for a particular investor. The ratings are based upon current information furnished to the rating agencies by ArcelorMittal and information obtained by the rating agencies from other sources. The ratings are only accurate as of the date thereof and may be changed, superseded or withdrawn as a result of changes in, or unavailability of, such information, and therefore a prospective purchaser should check the current ratings before purchasing the notes. Each rating should be evaluated independently of any other rating.
 
   
Governing law
  The indenture, the notes and the registration rights agreement will be governed by the laws of the State of New York.
 
   
Risk Factors
  See “Risk Factors” and the other information included or incorporated by reference in this prospectus for a discussion of the factors you should carefully consider before deciding to participate in the exchange offer.
         
Global Note Codes
  2013 exchange notes   2018 exchange notes
 
       
 
  CUSIP: 03938LAC8   CUSIP: 03938LAF1
 
  ISIN: US03938LAC81   ISIN: US03938LAF13

8


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS
     You should carefully consider the risks described below, as well as the other information included or incorporated by reference in this prospectus, before deciding to participate in the exchange offer.
Risks related to ArcelorMittal.
ArcelorMittal results from a recent merger of two companies and has continued to grow through acquisitions subsequently and expects to continue to do so. The failure to manage the company’s recent and expected future growth could significantly harm ArcelorMittal’s future results and require significant expenditures to address the additional operational and control requirements of this growth.
     ArcelorMittal results from Mittal Steel Company N.V.’s acquisition of Arcelor, a company of approximately equivalent size, in August 2006 and the subsequent merger of the two companies in 2007. The combined company has continued, as did its predecessor companies, to make numerous and substantial acquisitions, with numerous transactions announced in 2007 and the first half of 2008, and acquisitions and investments for a total value of U.S.$12.3 billion (including cash purchase price, assumed net debt and shares issued at fair market value) completed in 2007. ArcelorMittal’s growth strategy includes the acquisitions of complementary companies. Such growth entails significant investment and increased operating costs. Overall growth in ArcelorMittal’s business also requires greater allocation of management resources away from daily operations. In addition, managing this growth (including managing multiple operating assets) requires, among other things, the continued development of ArcelorMittal’s financial and management information control systems, the ability to integrate newly acquired assets with existing operations, the ability to attract and retain sufficient numbers of qualified management and other personnel, the continued training and supervision of such personnel and the ability to manage the risks and liabilities associated with the acquired businesses. Failure to manage such growth, while at the same time maintaining adequate focus on the existing assets of ArcelorMittal, could have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects.
The former Mittal Steel and Arcelor may not successfully integrate their business operations to the fullest extent, which could result in ArcelorMittal’s failure to realize anticipated cost savings, revenue enhancements and other benefits expected from the acquisition.
     Since the acquisition by Mittal Steel of Arcelor, the combined company has reached significant milestones in its operational integration process, having consolidated support functions, optimized its supply chain and procurement structure, and leveraged research and development services across a larger base, thereby achieving cost savings and revenue synergies, as well as other synergistic benefits. As of December 31, 2007, ArcelorMittal had realized U.S.$1.4 billion in synergies from the merger, as compared to the expected U.S.$1.6 billion in synergies to be achieved by the end of 2008 announced by Mittal Steel at the time of its acquisition of Arcelor. While the integration process has so far proceeded smoothly, further integration steps may not be achieved to the fullest extent or within the timeframe expected, which could have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s results of operations.
     In particular, ArcelorMittal is continuing to integrate manufacturing best practices and to standardize management information systems across the ArcelorMittal group. The integration of these functions could interfere with the activities of one or more of the businesses of ArcelorMittal and may divert management’s attention from the daily operations of ArcelorMittal’s core businesses. If the combined company is unable to continue to integrate effectively its operations, technologies and personnel in a timely and efficient manner, then it may not fully realize the benefits expected from the acquisition. In particular, if the continued integration is not successful, ArcelorMittal’s operating results may be harmed, it may lose key personnel and key customers, it may not be able to retain or expand its market position, and the market price of its shares may decline.
Mr. Lakshmi N. Mittal has the ability to exercise significant influence over the outcome of shareholder voting.
     As of December 31, 2007, Mr. Lakshmi N. Mittal owned 623,285,000 of ArcelorMittal’s outstanding common shares, representing approximately 44% of ArcelorMittal’s outstanding voting shares. Consequently, Mr. Lakshmi

9


Table of Contents

N. Mittal has the ability to influence significantly the decisions adopted at the ArcelorMittal general meetings of shareholders, including matters involving mergers or other business combinations, the acquisition or disposition of assets, issuances of equity and the incurrence of indebtedness. Mr. Lakshmi N. Mittal also has the ability to significantly influence a change of control of ArcelorMittal.
The loss or diminution of the services of the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of ArcelorMittal could have a material adverse effect on its business and prospects.
     The Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of ArcelorMittal has for over a quarter of a century contributed significantly to shaping and implementing the business strategy of Mittal Steel and subsequently ArcelorMittal. His strategic vision was instrumental in the creation of the world’s largest and most global steel group. The loss or any diminution of the services of the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer could have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s business and prospects. ArcelorMittal does not maintain key man life insurance on its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer.
ArcelorMittal has a substantial amount of indebtedness. Credit rating downgrades, which could result from, among other things, substantial debt-financed acquisitions or cyclical downturns in the steel industry, could significantly harm ArcelorMittal’s refinancing capacity and increase its cost of funding. ArcelorMittal’s level of indebtedness, including the consequential high financing costs and restrictive covenants, could also limit its flexibility in managing its business.
     As of June 30, 2008, ArcelorMittal had total debt outstanding of U.S.$38.2 billion, consisting of U.S.$10.3 billion of short-term indebtedness (including payables to banks and the current portion of long-tem debt) and U.S.$27.9 billion of long-term indebtedness. As of June 30, 2008, ArcelorMittal had U.S.$7.5 billion of cash and cash equivalents, including short-term investments and restricted cash, and, for the six months ended June 30, 2008, ArcelorMittal recorded operating income of U.S.$10.2 billion.
     Some of Mittal Steel’s credit ratings were put on ratings watch for possible downgrades following its acquisition of Arcelor in 2006. In late 2007 and early 2008, however, Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services raised its long-term corporate credit rating for ArcelorMittal to “BBB+” from “BBB” with a stable outlook, Fitch Ratings affirmed its rating of ArcelorMittal at “BBB” and Moody’s Investors Service upgraded its rating of ArcelorMittal from Baa3 to Baa2. On September 16, 2008, Fitch Ratings upgraded the Company’s “Long-term Issuer Default” (LT IDR) and senior unsecured ratings to “BBB+” from “BBB” and affirmed the “Company’s Short-term Issuer Default” rating at “F2”, with the outlook on the LT IDR now Stable.
     Future downgrades resulting from factors specific to ArcelorMittal could be experienced. Credit rating downgrades could also result from a cyclical downturn in the steel industry, as ArcelorMittal has experienced in the past. Any decline in its credit rating would increase ArcelorMittal’s cost of borrowing and could significantly harm its financial condition, results of operations and profitability, including its ability to refinance its existing indebtedness.
     ArcelorMittal’s principal financing facilities (that is, the U.S.$3.2 billion term and revolving credit facility, which was amended on February 6, 2007 (the “2005 Credit Facility”), the U.S.$800 million committed multi-currency letter of credit facility (the “Letter of Credit Facility”), the 17 billion (approximately U.S.$22 billion) term and revolving credit facility entered into on November 30, 2006 (the “17 Billion Facility”) and the U.S.$4 billion revolving credit facility entered into on May 13, 2008 (the “U.S.$4 billion Facility”)), contain provisions that limit encumbrances on the assets of ArcelorMittal and its subsidiaries and limit the ability of ArcelorMittal’s subsidiaries to incur debt. The Letter of Credit Facility requires compliance with a minimum interest coverage ratio. The 2005 Credit Facility, the 17 Billion Facility and the U.S.$4 Billion Facility require compliance with a maximum gearing ratio. Limitations arising from these credit facilities could adversely affect ArcelorMittal’s ability to maintain its dividend policy and make additional strategic acquisitions.
     The level of debt outstanding could have adverse consequences to ArcelorMittal, including impairing its ability to obtain additional financing for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions, general corporate purposes or other purposes, and limiting its flexibility to adjust to changing market conditions or withstand competitive pressures, resulting in greater vulnerability to a downturn in general economic conditions.

10


Table of Contents

     ArcelorMittal’s debt facilities and its guarantees have provisions whereby a default by any borrower within the ArcelorMittal group could, under certain circumstances, lead to defaults under other ArcelorMittal credit facilities. Any possible invocation of these cross-default clauses could cause some or all of the other guaranteed debt to accelerate, creating severe liquidity pressures.
     Furthermore, most of ArcelorMittal’s current borrowings are at variable rates of interest and thereby expose ArcelorMittal to interest rate risk. Generally, ArcelorMittal does not use financial instruments to hedge a significant portion of its interest rate exposure. If interest rates rise, ArcelorMittal’s debt service obligations on its variable rate indebtedness would increase even if the amount borrowed remained the same, resulting in higher interest costs.
     A substantial portion of ArcelorMittal’s debt is denominated in euro. Accordingly, ArcelorMittal is exposed to fluctuations in the exchange rates between the U.S. dollar and the euro. Any such fluctuations in the euro and, in particular, a further marked appreciation of the euro to the U.S. dollar would mechanically increase ArcelorMittal’s indebtedness.
Because ArcelorMittal is a holding company, it depends on the earnings and cash flows of its operating subsidiaries, which may not be sufficient to meet future needs.
     Because ArcelorMittal is a holding company, it is dependent on the earnings and cash flows of, and dividends and distributions from, its operating subsidiaries to pay expenses, meet its debt service obligations, and pay any cash dividends or distributions on its common shares. Some of these operating subsidiaries have debt outstanding or are subject to acquisition agreements that impose restrictions or prohibitions on such operating subsidiaries’ ability to pay dividends.
     Under the laws of Luxembourg, the combined company will be able to pay dividends or distributions only to the extent that it is entitled to receive cash dividend distributions from its subsidiaries, recognize gains from the sale of its assets or record share premium from the issuance of shares.
The significant capital expenditure and other commitments ArcelorMittal has made in connection with past acquisitions may limit its operational flexibility and add to its financing requirements.
     In connection with the acquisition of some of its operating subsidiaries, ArcelorMittal has made significant capital expenditure commitments and other commitments with various governmental bodies involving expenditures required to be made over the next few years. In the first half of 2008, capital expenditures amounted to U.S.$2.3 billion, and U.S.$5.4 billion in 2007. As of December 31, 2007, ArcelorMittal and its subsidiaries had capital commitments outstanding of approximately U.S.$1.9 billion under privatization and other major contracts. ArcelorMittal expects to fund these capital expenditure commitments and other commitments primarily through internal sources, but ArcelorMittal cannot assure you that it will be able to generate or obtain sufficient funds to meet these requirements or to complete these projects on a timely basis or at all. In addition, completion of these projects may be affected by factors that are beyond the control of ArcelorMittal. See “Item 5F — Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations” and Note 22 to the ArcelorMittal Consolidated Financial Statements in our Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008.
     ArcelorMittal has also made commitments relating to employees at some of its operating subsidiaries. It has agreed, in connection with the acquisition of interests in these subsidiaries, including the acquisition of Arcelor, that it will not make collective dismissals for certain periods. These periods generally extend several years following the date of acquisition. The inability to make such dismissals may affect ArcelorMittal’s ability to coordinate its workforce and efficiently manage its business in response to changing market conditions in the areas affected.
     ArcelorMittal may not be able to remain in compliance with some or all of these requirements in the future. Failure to remain in compliance may result in forfeiture of part of ArcelorMittal’s investment and/or the loss of tax and regulatory benefits.

11


Table of Contents

ArcelorMittal’s mining operations are subject to mining risks.
     ArcelorMittal has substantial mining operations and has recently increased their scope and intends to continue to do so. Mining operations are subject to hazards and risks normally associated with the exploration, development and production of natural resources, any of which could result in production shortfalls or damage to persons or property. In particular, hazards associated with open-pit mining operations include, among others:
    flooding of the open pit;
 
    collapse of the open-pit wall;
 
    accidents associated with the operation of large open-pit mining and rock transportation equipment;
 
    accidents associated with the preparation and ignition of large-scale open-pit blasting operations;
 
    production disruptions due to weather; and
 
    hazards associated with the disposal of mineralized waste water, such as groundwater and waterway contamination.
     Hazards associated with underground mining operations include, among others:
    underground fires and explosions, including those caused by flammable gas;
 
    cave-ins or falls of ground;
 
    discharges of gases and toxic chemicals;
 
    flooding;
 
    sinkhole formation and ground subsidence;
 
    other accidents and conditions resulting from drilling; and
 
    blasting and removing, and processing material from, an underground mine.
     ArcelorMittal is at risk of experiencing any or all of these hazards. For example, in September 2006, a methane gas explosion at ArcelorMittal’s Lenina mine in Kazakhstan resulted in 41 fatalities, and a production shutdown of two days to fully investigate the incident and in January 2008, a methane gas explosion at ArcelorMittal’s Abaiskaya mine in Kazakhstan resulted in 30 fatalities. A new face has been put into operations in June 2009 and normal operations at Abayskaya have been restored. On June 2, 2008 an accident caused by natural disaster took place at Tentekskaya Mine in Kazakhstan and took the lives of five miners. The mining face had to be closed and operations at a new face will commence in October 2009 only. The occurrence of any of these hazards could delay production, increase production costs and result in death or injury to persons, damage to property and liability for ArcelorMittal, some or all of which may not be covered by insurance.
Some of ArcelorMittal’s subsidiaries benefited from state aid granted prior to, or in connection with, their respective privatizations, the granting of which is subject to transitional arrangements under the respective treaties concerning the accession of these countries to the European Union. Non-fulfillment or breach of the transitional arrangements and related rules may result in the recovery of aid granted pursuant to the transitional arrangements.
     ArcelorMittal has acquired formerly state-owned companies in the Czech Republic, Poland and Romania, some of which benefited from state aid granted prior to, or in connection with, their respective privatization and restructuring. Moreover, the restructuring of the steel industries in each of the Czech Republic, Poland and Romania is subject to transitional arrangements and related rules that determine the legality of restructuring aid. The

12


Table of Contents

transitional arrangements form part of the respective treaties concerning the accession of the Czech Republic, Poland and Romania to the European Union. See “Item 4B — Information on the Company — Business Overview — Government Regulations — State Aid” in our 2007 Form 20-F. Non-fulfillment or breach of the transitional arrangements and related rules may nullify the effect of the transitional arrangements and may result in the recovery of aid granted pursuant to the transitional arrangements that have been breached.
Under-funding of pension and other post-retirement benefit plans at some of ArcelorMittal’s operating subsidiaries, and the possible need to make substantial cash contributions to pension plans or to pay for healthcare, which may increase in the future, may reduce the cash available for ArcelorMittal’s business.
     ArcelorMittal’s principal operating subsidiaries in Brazil, Canada, Europe, and the United States provide defined benefit pension plans to their employees. Some of these plans are currently under-funded. At December 31, 2007, the value of ArcelorMittal USA’s pension plan assets was U.S.$2,627 million, while the projected benefit obligation was U.S.$3,078 million, resulting in a deficit of U.S.$451 million. At December 31, 2007, the value of the pension plan assets of ArcelorMittal’s Canadian subsidiaries was U.S.$2,707 million, while the projected benefit obligation was U.S.$3,034 million, resulting in a deficit of U.S.$327 million. At December 31, 2007, the value of the pension plan assets of ArcelorMittal’s European subsidiaries was U.S.$623 million, while the projected benefit obligation was U.S.$2,486 million, resulting in a deficit of U.S.$1,863 million. ArcelorMittal USA also had an under-funded post-employment benefit obligation of U.S.$1,181 million relating to life insurance and medical benefits as of December 31, 2007. ArcelorMittal’s Canadian subsidiaries also had an under-funded post-employment benefit obligation of U.S.$983 million relating to life insurance and medical benefits as of December 31, 2007. ArcelorMittal’s European subsidiaries also had an under-funded post-employment benefit obligation of U.S.$507 million relating to life insurance and medical benefits as of December 31, 2007. See Note 18 to the ArcelorMittal Consolidated Financial Statements in our Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008.
     ArcelorMittal’s funding obligations depend upon future asset performance, the level of interest rates used to discount future liabilities, actuarial assumptions and experience, benefit plan changes and government regulation.
     Because of the large number of variables that determine pension funding requirements, which are difficult to predict, as well as any legislative action, future cash funding requirements for ArcelorMittal’s pension plans and other post-employment benefit plans could be significantly higher than currently estimated amounts. These funding requirements could have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects.
ArcelorMittal could experience labor disputes that could disrupt its operations and its relationships with its customers.
     A majority of the employees of ArcelorMittal and of its contractors are represented by labor unions and are covered by collective bargaining or similar agreements, which are subject to periodic renegotiation. Strikes or work stoppages could occur prior to, or during, the negotiations leading to new collective bargaining agreements, during wage and benefits negotiations or during other periods for other reasons. ArcelorMittal has experienced strikes and work stoppages at various facilities in recent years. Any such breakdown leading to work stoppage and disruption of operations could have an adverse effect on the operations and financial results of ArcelorMittal.
ArcelorMittal is subject to economic risks and uncertainties in the countries in which it operates or proposes to operate. Any deterioration or disruption of the economic environment in those countries may have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects.
     In recent years, many of the countries in which ArcelorMittal operates, or proposes to operate, have experienced economic growth and improved economic stability. For example, Eastern European countries, such as Poland, the Czech Republic and Romania, have initiated free-market economic reforms in connection with or in anticipation of their accession to the European Union. Others, such as Algeria, Argentina and South Africa, have attempted to reinforce political stability and improve economic performance after recent periods of political instability. Ukraine and Kazakhstan have implemented free-market economic reforms. ArcelorMittal’s business strategy was developed partly on the assumption that such economic growth and the modernization, restructuring and upgrading of the

13


Table of Contents

physical infrastructure in the developing countries in which it invested will continue, thus creating increased demand for ArcelorMittal’s steel products and maintaining a stable level of steel prices both in these countries and in other key product markets. While the demand in these countries for steel and steel products has gradually increased, this trend will not necessarily continue. In addition, the legal systems in some of the countries in which ArcelorMittal operates remain underdeveloped, particularly with respect to bankruptcy proceedings, and the prospect of widespread bankruptcy, mass unemployment and the deterioration of various sectors of these economies still exists. Reform policies may not continue to be implemented and, if implemented, may not be successful. In addition, these countries may not remain receptive to foreign trade and investment. Any slowdown in the development of these economies or any reduction in the investment budgets of governmental agencies and companies responsible for the modernization of such physical infrastructure could also have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects.
ArcelorMittal is subject to political, social and legal uncertainties in some of the developing countries in which it operates or proposes to operate. Any disruption or volatility in the political or social environment in those countries may have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects.
     ArcelorMittal operates, or proposes to operate, in a number of developing countries. Some of the countries in which it currently operates, such as Romania and the Ukraine, have been undergoing substantial political transformations from centrally controlled command economies to pluralist market-oriented democracies. Political and economic reforms necessary to complete such transformation may not continue. On occasion, ethnic, religious, historical and other divisions have given rise to tensions and, in certain cases, wide-scale civil disturbances and military conflict, as in Algeria, Bosnia and Herzegovina, China, India, Liberia, Russia, South Africa, Turkey and Venezuela. The political systems in these and other developing countries may be vulnerable to the populations’ dissatisfaction with reforms, social and ethnic unrest and changes in governmental policies, any of which could have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects and its ability to continue to do business in these countries.
     In addition, ArcelorMittal may encounter difficulties in enforcing court judgments or arbitral awards in some countries in which it operates because those countries may not be parties to treaties that recognize the mutual enforcement of court judgments.
     A current example of these risks is the situation in Kazakhstan, where the government has placed into question certain development deals negotiated in the early years of the country’s independence. Following the Abaiskaya mine accident in Kazakhstan, the second mine accident at ArcelorMittal Temirtau in two years, the government of Kazakhstan has threatened to remove ArcelorMittal Temirtau’s operating license. In addition, tax claims (amounting to U.S.$2.5 billion including administrative charges) have been brought against ArcelorMittal Temirtau, despite ArcelorMittal Temirtau’s tax obligations being capped under the privatization agreements under which it was acquired from the government of Kazakhstan. The revocation of the operating license of ArcelorMittal Temirtau could disrupt ArcelorMittal’s operations and final assessment of tax payments in the amounts claimed would have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s results of operations.
ArcelorMittal may experience currency fluctuations and become subject to exchange controls that could adversely affect its business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects.
     ArcelorMittal operates and sells products in a number of countries, and, as a result, its business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects could be adversely affected by fluctuations in exchange rates. Major changes in exchange rates, particularly changes in the value of the U.S. dollar against the currencies of the countries in which ArcelorMittal operates, could have an adverse effect on its business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects.
     Some operations involving the South African rand, Kazakh tenge, Brazilian real, Argentine peso, Algerian dinar and Ukrainian hryvnia are subject to limitations imposed by their respective central banks. The imposition of exchange controls or other similar restrictions on currency convertibility in the countries in which ArcelorMittal operates could adversely affect its business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects.

14


Table of Contents

Disruptions to ArcelorMittal’s manufacturing processes could adversely affect ArcelorMittal’s operations, customer service levels and financial results.
     Steel manufacturing processes are dependent on critical steel-making equipment, such as furnaces, continuous casters, rolling mills and electrical equipment (such as transformers), and such equipment may incur downtime as a result of unanticipated failures or other events, such as fires or furnace breakdowns. ArcelorMittal’s manufacturing plants have experienced, and may in the future experience, plant shutdowns or periods of reduced production as a result of such equipment failures or other events. To the extent that lost production as a result of such a disruption could not be compensated for by unaffected facilities, such disruptions could have an adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s operations, customer service levels and financial results.
Natural disasters could significantly damage ArcelorMittal’s production facilities.
     Natural disasters could significantly damage ArcelorMittal’s production facilities and general infrastructure. In particular, a new plant planned in Mozambique is in a natural flood zone. In addition, ArcelorMittal Lázaro Cárdenas’s production facilities are located in Lázaro Cárdenas, Michoacán, Mexico and ArcelorMittal Temirtau is located in the Karaganda region of the Republic of Kazakhstan, both of which are areas that have historically experienced earthquakes of varying magnitude. Extensive damage to these facilities, or any other major production complexes, whether as a result of a flood, earthquake, hurricanes, tsunami or other natural disaster, could, to the extent that lost production as a result of such a disaster could not be compensated for by unaffected facilities, severely affect ArcelorMittal’s ability to conduct its business operations and, as a result, reduce its future operating results.
ArcelorMittal’s insurance policies provide limited coverage, potentially leaving it uninsured against some business risks.
     The occurrence of an event that is uninsurable or not fully insured could have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects. ArcelorMittal maintains insurance on property and equipment in amounts believed to be consistent with industry practices but it may not be fully insured against some business risks. The ArcelorMittal insurance policies cover physical loss or damage to its property and equipment on a reinstatement basis arising from a number of specified risks and certain consequential losses, including business interruption arising from the occurrence of an insured event under the policies. Under these policies, damages and losses caused by certain natural disasters, such as earthquakes, floods and windstorms, are also covered. Each of the operating subsidiaries of ArcelorMittal also maintains various other types of insurance, such as workmen’s compensation insurance and marine insurance. Notwithstanding the insurance coverage that ArcelorMittal and its subsidiaries carry, the occurrence of an accident that causes losses in excess of limits specified under the relevant policy, or losses arising from events not covered by insurance policies, could materially harm ArcelorMittal’s financial condition and future operating results.
Product liability claims could adversely affect ArcelorMittal’s operations.
     ArcelorMittal sells products to major manufacturers who are engaged to sell a wide range of end products. Furthermore, ArcelorMittal’s products are also sold to, and used in, certain safety-critical applications. If ArcelorMittal were to sell steel that is inconsistent with the specifications of the order or the requirements of the application, significant disruptions to the customer’s production lines could result. There could also be significant consequential damages resulting from the use of such products. ArcelorMittal has a limited amount of product liability insurance coverage, and a major claim for damages related to products sold could leave ArcelorMittal uninsured against a portion or all of the award and, as a result, materially harm its financial condition and future operating results.

15


Table of Contents

International trade actions or regulations and trade-related legal proceedings could reduce or eliminate ArcelorMittal’s access to steel markets.
     ArcelorMittal has international operations and makes sales throughout the world, and, therefore, its businesses have significant exposure to the effects of trade actions and barriers. Various countries, including the United States and Canada, have in the past instituted, or are currently contemplating the institution of, trade actions and barriers.
     ArcelorMittal cannot predict the timing and nature of similar or other trade actions by the United States, Canada or any other country. Because of the international nature of ArcelorMittal’s operations, it may be affected by any trade actions or restrictions introduced by any country in which it sells, or has the potential to sell, its products. Any such trade actions could materially and adversely affect ArcelorMittal’s business by reducing or eliminating ArcelorMittal’s access to steel markets.
     In addition to the more general trade barriers described above, if ArcelorMittal were party to a regulatory or trade-related legal proceeding that was decided adversely to it, its business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects could be adversely affected.
     See “Item 4B — Information on the Company — Business Overview — Government Regulations” in our 2007 Form 20-F.
The income tax liability of ArcelorMittal may substantially increase if the tax laws and regulations in countries in which it operates change or become subject to adverse interpretations or inconsistent enforcement.
     Taxes payable by companies in many of the countries in which ArcelorMittal operates are substantial and include value-added tax, excise duties, profit taxes, payroll-related taxes, property taxes and other taxes. Tax laws and regulations in some of these countries may be subject to frequent change, varying interpretation and inconsistent enforcement. Ineffective tax collection systems and continuing budget requirements may increase the likelihood of the imposition of arbitrary or onerous taxes and penalties, which could have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s financial condition and results of operations. In addition to the usual tax burden imposed on taxpayers, these conditions create uncertainty as to the tax implications of various business decisions. This uncertainty could expose ArcelorMittal to significant fines and penalties and to enforcement measures despite its best efforts at compliance, and could result in a greater than expected tax burden. See Note 19 to the ArcelorMittal Consolidated Financial Statements in our Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008.
     In addition, many of the jurisdictions in which ArcelorMittal operates have adopted transfer pricing legislation. If tax authorities impose significant additional tax liabilities as a result of transfer pricing adjustments, it could have a material adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s financial condition and results of operations.
     It is possible that tax authorities in the countries in which ArcelorMittal operates will introduce additional revenue raising measures. The introduction of any such provisions may affect the overall tax efficiency of ArcelorMittal and may result in significant additional taxes becoming payable. Any such additional tax exposure could have a material adverse effect on its financial condition and results of operations.
     ArcelorMittal may face a significant increase in its income taxes if tax rates increase or the tax laws or regulations in the jurisdictions in which it operates, or treaties between those jurisdictions, are modified in an adverse manner. This may adversely affect ArcelorMittal’s cash flows, liquidity and ability to pay dividends.
If ArcelorMittal were unable to utilize fully its deferred tax assets, its profitability could be reduced.
     At December 31, 2007, ArcelorMittal had U.S.$1,629 million recorded as deferred tax assets on its balance sheet. These assets can be utilized only if, and only to the extent that, ArcelorMittal’s operating subsidiaries generate adequate levels of taxable income in future periods to offset the tax loss carry forwards and reverse the temporary differences prior to expiration.
     At December 31, 2007, the amount of future income required to recover ArcelorMittal’s deferred tax assets was approximately U.S.$5,072 million at certain operating subsidiaries. For each of the years ended December 31, 2006 and 2007, these operating subsidiaries generated approximately 43% and 29%, respectively, of ArcelorMittal’s consolidated income before tax of U.S.$7,228 million and U.S.$14,888 million respectively.

16


Table of Contents

     ArcelorMittal’s ability to generate taxable income is subject to general economic, financial, competitive, legislative, regulatory and other factors that are beyond its control. If ArcelorMittal generates lower taxable income than the amount it has assumed in determining its deferred tax assets, then the value of deferred tax assets will be reduced. See “Item 5A — Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Operating Results — Year Ended December 31, 2007 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2006 — Income Tax” in our Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008.
U.S. investors may have difficulty enforcing civil liabilities against ArcelorMittal and its directors and senior management.
     ArcelorMittal is organized under the laws of the Grand Duchy of Luxembourg with its principal executive offices and corporate seat in Luxembourg. The majority of ArcelorMittal’s directors and senior management are residents of jurisdictions outside the United States. The majority of ArcelorMittal’s assets and the assets of these persons are located outside the United States. As a result, U.S. investors may find it difficult to effect service of process within the United States upon ArcelorMittal or these persons or to enforce outside the United States judgments obtained against ArcelorMittal or these persons in U.S. courts, including actions predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the U.S. federal securities laws. Likewise, it may also be difficult for an investor to enforce in U.S. courts judgments obtained against ArcelorMittal or these persons in courts in jurisdictions outside the United States, including actions predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the U.S. federal securities laws. It may also be difficult for a U.S. investor to bring an original action in a Luxembourg court predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the U.S. federal securities laws against ArcelorMittal’s directors and senior management and non-U.S. experts named in this prospectus and the documents incorporated by reference herein.
ArcelorMittal’s inability to successfully centralize various corporate and management functions could adversely affect its productivity and profitability.
     ArcelorMittal is centralizing various corporate and management functions at its corporate headquarters in Luxembourg. These functions include the central sale of raw materials, purchase and sale of finished products, research and development functions as well as other functions. The process of centralizing these functions and of making changes to the Company’s existing operational business model may have various efficiency, organizational, operational and tax consequences. If ArcelorMittal is not able to centralize its functions successfully, this could adversely affect its productivity and profitability.
ArcelorMittal may not be able to realize the full book value of its assets held for sale.
     ArcelorMittal has assets held for sale. If ArcelorMittal cannot sell them at their full book value, this would negatively affect its cash flow and consequently could affect its financial results.
Risks related to the steel industry.
A downturn in global economic conditions may have a material adverse effect on the results of ArcelorMittal.
     ArcelorMittal’s activities and results are affected by international, national and regional economic conditions. In 2007, growing fears of an economic downturn affected consumer confidence and reduced the intensity of demand for steel products. If macroeconomic conditions worsen, the performance of steel producers could be affected. In particular, fears of a recession in the United States, sparked by uncertainty in the credit markets, have grown, as have concerns as to the effect a U.S. recession would have in Europe and elsewhere. Despite ArcelorMittal’s size and global breadth, regional declines in consumption caused by a recession in one or more major markets may have a material adverse effect on demand for its products and hence on its results.
ArcelorMittal is susceptible to the cyclicality of the steel industry, making ArcelorMittal’s results of operations unpredictable.
     The steel industry has historically been highly cyclical and is affected significantly by general economic conditions and other factors such as worldwide production capacity, fluctuations in steel imports/exports and tariffs. Steel prices are also sensitive to trends in cyclical industries, such as automotive, construction, appliance,

17


Table of Contents

machinery, equipment and transportation industries, which are the significant markets for ArcelorMittal’s products. Steel markets have been experiencing larger and more pronounced cyclical fluctuations, driven recently by the substantial increase in steel production and consumption in China. This trend, combined with the rising costs of key inputs, mainly metallics, energy, transportation and logistics, presents an increasing challenge for steel producers.
     The volatility and the length and nature of business cycles affecting the steel industry have historically been unpredictable, and the recurrence of another major downturn in the industry would negatively impact ArcelorMittal’s results of operations and profitability.
     See “Item 5 — Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Overview — Key Factors Affecting Results of Operations” and “— Consolidation in the Steel Industry” in our Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008.
Rapidly growing supply of steel products in China and other developing economies, which may increase faster than increases in demand, may result in additional excess worldwide capacity and falling steel prices.
     Over the last several years, steel consumption in China and other developing economies such as India has increased rapidly. Steel companies have responded by developing steel production capabilities in these countries. Steel production, especially in China, has been expanding significantly and China is now the largest worldwide steel producer by a significant margin. In 2006, China became a net exporter of steel, exerting downward pressure on steel prices in the European and American markets in that year. Chinese steel exports slowed in 2007 due to, among other things, rising input prices, Chinese government policies, growing internal demand and slowing worldwide economic growth. In the future, any significant excess Chinese capacity could have a major impact on world steel trade and prices if this excess production is exported to other markets.
Developments in the competitive environment in the steel industry could have an adverse effect on ArcelorMittal’s competitive position and hence its business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects.
     The markets in which steel companies conduct business are highly competitive. Competition could cause ArcelorMittal to lose market share, increase expenditures or reduce pricing, any one of which could have a material adverse effect on its business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects. The global steel industry has historically suffered from substantial over-capacity. This has led to substantial price decreases during periods of economic weakness that have not been offset by commensurate price increases during periods of economic strength. Excess capacity in some of the products sold by ArcelorMittal will intensify price competition for such products. This could require ArcelorMittal to reduce the price for its products and, as a result, may have a material adverse effect on its business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects.
ArcelorMittal may encounter increases in the cost and shortages in the supply of raw materials, energy and transportation.
     Steel production requires substantial amounts of raw materials and energy, including iron ore, coking coal, zinc, scrap, electricity, natural gas, coal and coke. Currently, there is a worldwide shortage of coke and coal, mainly as a result of the rapid growth in the demand for steel globally. In recent years, and particularly in 2006 and 2007, there was a sharp rise in the cost of a number of commodities essential for the process of steel-making. In particular, the prices of zinc and nickel fluctuated substantially, while the price of iron ore rose 65%, due among other things to dynamics of supply (including downstream concentration) and demand (including the surge in Chinese and Indian demand). The current concentration in the mining industry, as well as possible further consolidation (in particular the possible combination of BHP Billiton and Rio Tinto), has fostered and may also lead to further price increases in iron ore and other raw materials. The availability and prices of raw materials may be negatively affected by, among other factors, new laws or regulations; suppliers’ allocations to other purchasers; interruptions in production by suppliers; accidents or other similar events at suppliers’ premises or along the supply chain; wars, natural disasters and other similar events; changes in exchange rates; consolidation in steel-related industries; the bargaining power of raw material suppliers; worldwide price fluctuations; and the availability and cost of transportation. Any prolonged interruption in the supply of raw materials or energy, or substantial increases in their costs that steel

18


Table of Contents

companies are not able to pass on to customers, could adversely affect the business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects of steel companies.
     In addition, energy costs, including the cost of electricity and natural gas, make up a substantial portion of the cost of goods sold by steel companies. The price of energy has varied significantly in the past several years and may vary significantly in the future largely as a result of market conditions and other factors beyond the control of steel companies, including significant increases in oil prices. Because the production of direct reduced iron and the re-heating of steel involve the use of significant amounts of natural gas, steel companies are sensitive to the price of natural gas.
     ArcelorMittal will not necessarily be able to procure adequate supplies in the future. A portion of ArcelorMittal’s raw materials are obtained under contracts that are either short-term or are subject to periodic price negotiations. Any prolonged interruption, discontinuation or other disruption in the supply of raw materials or energy, or substantial increases in their costs, may harm ArcelorMittal’s business, financial condition, and results of operations or prospects.
Competition from other materials could significantly reduce market prices and demand for steel products and thereby reduce ArcelorMittal’s cash flow and profitability.
     In many applications, steel competes with other materials that may be used as steel substitutes, such as aluminum (particularly in the automobile industry), cement, composites, glass, plastic and wood. Additional substitutes for steel products could significantly reduce market prices and demand for steel products and thereby reduce ArcelorMittal’s cash flow and profitability.
ArcelorMittal is subject to stringent environmental and health and safety regulations that give rise to significant costs and liabilities, including those arising from environmental remediation programs.
     ArcelorMittal is subject to a broad range of environmental and health and safety laws and regulations in each of the jurisdictions in which it operates. These laws and regulations, as interpreted by relevant agencies and the courts, impose increasingly stringent environmental and health and safety protection standards regarding, among other things, air emissions, wastewater storage, treatment and discharges, the use and handling of hazardous or toxic materials, waste disposal practices, worker health and safety and the remediation of environmental contamination. The costs of complying with, and the imposition of liabilities pursuant to, environmental and health and safety laws and regulations could be significant, and failure to comply could result in the assessment of civil and criminal penalties, the suspension of permits or operations, and lawsuits by third parties.
     Compliance with environmental obligations may require additional capital expenditures or modifications in operating practices, particularly at steel companies operating in countries that have recently joined the European Union. For example, U.S. laws and regulations and EU Directives, as well as any new or additional environmental compliance requirements that may arise out of the implementation by different countries of the Kyoto Protocol (United Nations Framework on Climate Change, 1992) and future, more stringent greenhouse gas restrictions and emissions trading schemes, may require changes to the operations of steel facilities, further reductions in emissions, and the purchase of emission rights.
     ArcelorMittal also incurs costs and liabilities associated with the assessment and remediation of contaminated sites. In addition to the impact on current facilities and operations, environmental remediation obligations can give rise to substantial liabilities with respect to divested assets and past activities. ArcelorMittal could become subject to further remediation obligations in the future, as additional contamination is discovered or cleanup standards become more stringent.
     Under certain circumstances, authorities could require ArcelorMittal facilities to curtail or suspend operations based on environmental or health and safety concerns. For example, following accidents in 2006 and 2007 that resulted in numerous fatalities, the Kazakh government has threatened to revoke the operating license of ArcelorMittal Temirtau unless certain additional safety measures are implemented at its facilities. Similarly,

19


Table of Contents

exceedance of ambient air quality standards or other environmental limitations can lead to sanctions including imposition of penalties or operational restrictions, particularly where human health may be compromised.
     See “Item 4B — Information on the Company — Business Overview — Government Regulations — Environmental Laws and Regulations” in our 2007 Form 20-F and “Item 8A — Financial Information — Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information — Legal Proceedings” in our Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008.
Risks related to the exchange notes and exchange offer.
Since we conduct our operations through subsidiaries, your right to receive payments on the exchange notes is subordinated to the other liabilities of our subsidiaries.
     We carry on a significant portion of our operations through subsidiaries. Our subsidiaries are not guarantors of the exchange notes. Moreover, these subsidiaries are not required and may not be able to pay dividends to us. Our subsidiaries are not bound by our obligations under the indenture. Claims of the creditors of our subsidiaries have priority as to the assets of such subsidiaries over the claims of our creditors. Consequently, holders of the exchange notes are in effect structurally subordinated, on our insolvency, to the prior claims of the creditors of our subsidiaries.
Our ability to make debt service payments depends on our ability to transfer income and dividends from our subsidiaries.
     We are a holding company with no significant assets other than direct and indirect interests in the many subsidiaries through which we conduct operations. A number of our subsidiaries are located in countries that may impose regulations restricting the payment of dividends outside of the country through exchange control regulations.
     Furthermore, the continued transfer to us of dividends and other income from our subsidiaries are in some cases limited by various credit or other contractual arrangements and/or tax constraints, which could make such payments difficult or costly. If in the future these restrictions are increased or if we are otherwise unable to ensure the continued transfer of dividends and other income to us from these subsidiaries, our ability to pay dividends and/or make debt payments will be impaired.
     We have a significant level of debt. As of June 30, 2008, our total consolidated debt was approximately U.S.$38.2 billion, including U.S.$28.4 billion issued by our subsidiaries and guaranteed by us. The indenture governing the exchange notes does not restrict us or our subsidiaries from incurring additional debt or guaranteeing any debt of others in the future.
Since the exchange notes are unsecured and unsubordinated, your right to receive payments may be adversely affected.
     The exchange notes will be unsecured. The exchange notes are not subordinated to any of our other debt obligations, and therefore they will rank equally with all our other unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness. If we default on the exchange notes, or after bankruptcy, liquidation or reorganization, then, to the extent our parent company has granted security over its assets, the assets that secure that entity’s debts will be used to satisfy the obligations under that secured debt before we can make payment on the exchange notes. There may only be limited assets available to make payments on the exchange notes in the event of an acceleration of the exchange notes. If there is not enough collateral to satisfy the obligations of the secured debt, then the remaining amounts on the secured debt would share equally with all unsubordinated unsecured indebtedness.
A downgrade in our credit rating could adversely affect the trading price of the exchange notes.
     The trading prices for the exchange notes is directly affected by our credit rating. Credit rating agencies continually revise their ratings for companies that they follow, including us. Any ratings downgrade could adversely

20


Table of Contents

affect the trading price of the exchange notes or the trading market for the exchange notes to the extent a trading market for the exchange notes develops. The condition of the financial and credit markets and prevailing interest rates have fluctuated in the past and are likely to fluctuate in the future. Fluctuations in interest rates may give rise to arbitrage opportunities based upon changes in the relative value of the exchange notes. Any trading by arbitrageurs could, in turn, affect the trading prices of the exchange notes.
Luxembourg insolvency laws may adversely affect a recovery by the holders of the exchange notes.
     We are a Luxembourg company. Luxembourg insolvency laws may make it more difficult for holders of the exchange notes to effect a restructuring of our Company or to recover the amount they would have recovered in a liquidation or bankruptcy proceeding in other jurisdictions. There are a number of insolvency regimes under Luxembourg law. Bankruptcy proceedings (faillite) are primarily designed to liquidate and distribute the assets of a debtor to its creditors. Three formal corporate rescue procedures exist — controlled management (gestion contrôlée), which involves one or several commissioners (commissaires à la gestion contrôlée) preparing a plan of re-organization or a plan for the realization and distribution of the assets; moratorium (concordat préventif de la faillite), whereby a judge is appointed to oversee the negotiation of an agreement between the debtor and his creditors; and the suspension of payments (sursis de paiement), whereby one or more commissioners is/are appointed by the court to manage the company during the suspension of payments period. A judgment in bankruptcy proceedings has the effect of removing the power from a company to manage its assets and of stopping all attachment or garnishment proceedings brought by unsecured or non-privileged creditors. However, this type of judgment has no effect on creditors holding certain forms of security, such as pledges. A secured creditor holding a pledge can retain possession of the pledged assets or can enforce its security interest if an event of default has occurred under the security agreement. The ratification of the composition in composition proceedings will have no effect on creditors who, having secured claims, did not participate in the composition proceedings and did not, therefore, waive their rights or priority, their mortgages or pledges. These creditors may continue to act against the debtor in order to obtain payment of their claims and they may enforce their rights, obtain attachments and obtain the sale of the assets securing their claims. Equally, the procedure of suspension of payments has no effect on secured creditors.
     A recovery under Luxembourg law, therefore, could involve a sale of the assets of the debtor in a manner that does not reflect the going concern value of the debtor. Consequently, Luxembourg insolvency laws could preclude or inhibit the ability of the holders of the exchange notes to effect a restructuring of our Company and could reduce their recovery in a Luxembourg insolvency proceeding.
     In connection with Luxembourg bankruptcy proceedings, the assets of a debtor are generally liquidated and the proceeds distributed to the debtor’s creditors on the basis of the relative claims of those creditors, and certain parties (such as secured creditors) will have special rights that may adversely affect the interests of holders of the exchange notes. The claim of a creditor may be limited depending on the date the claim becomes due and payable in accordance with its terms. Each of these claims will have to be resubmitted to our receiver to be verified by the receiver. Any dispute as to the valuation of claims will be subject to court proceedings. These verification procedures could cause holders of the exchange notes to recover less than the principal amount of their exchange notes or less than they could recover in a liquidation governed by the laws of another jurisdiction. Such verification procedures could also cause payments to the holders of the exchange notes to be delayed compared with holders of undisputed claims.
There may not be a liquid trading market for the exchange notes.
     The exchange notes are new securities with no established trading market. As a result, we cannot assure you as to the liquidity of any trading market for the exchange notes. If an active market for the exchange notes does not develop, the price of the exchange notes and the ability of a holder of exchange notes to find a ready buyer will be adversely affected.

21


Table of Contents

We are not restricted in our ability to dispose of our assets by the terms of the exchange notes.
     The indenture governing the exchange notes contains a negative pledge that prohibits us and our material subsidiaries (as defined in the indenture) from pledging assets to secure other bonds or similar debt instruments, unless we make a similar pledge to secure the exchange notes issued under the indenture. However, we are generally permitted to sell or otherwise dispose of substantially all of our assets to another corporation or other entity under the terms of the exchange notes. We are also permitted to pledge assets as security for other bonds or similar debt instruments in certain circumstances (i.e., in the case of permitted security as defined in the indenture). If we decide to dispose of a large amount of our assets, you will not be entitled to declare an acceleration of the maturity of the exchange notes, and those assets will no longer be available to support payments on the exchange notes.
Your failure to tender original notes in the exchange offer may affect their marketability.
     If you do not exchange your original notes for exchange notes in the exchange offer, you will continue to be subject to the existing restrictions on transfers of the original notes. If the exchange offer is completed, we will have no further obligation to provide for registration of original notes except under limited circumstances described under “The Exchange Offer—Resale Registration Statement; Special Interest,” and those original notes will bear interest at the same rate as the exchange notes.
     Consequently, after we complete the exchange offer, if you continue to hold original notes and you seek to liquidate your investment, you will have to rely on an exemption from the registration requirements under applicable securities laws, including the Securities Act, regarding any sale or other disposition of original notes. Further, to the extent that original notes are tendered and accepted in the exchange offer, the trading market, if any, for the original notes could be adversely affected.

22


Table of Contents

SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
     The following tables present selected consolidated financial information of ArcelorMittal and, where relevant, of its predecessor company Mittal Steel, as of and for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2005, 2006 and 2007 and as of and for the six-month periods ended June 30, 2007 and 2008, prepared in accordance with IFRS. Mittal Steel did not prepare financial statements in accordance with IFRS in 2003. This selected consolidated financial information should be read in conjunction with the audited and unaudited consolidated financial statements incorporated by reference in this prospectus.
                                                 
        For the Six-Month Period
    For the Year Ended December 31,   Ended June 30,
    2004   2005   2006(5)   2007   2007   2008
    (Amounts in U.S.$ millions except percentages)   (unaudited)
Statement of Income Data
                                               
Sales(1)
  $ 20,612     $ 28,132     $ 58,870     $ 105,216     $ 51,699     $ 67,649  
Cost of sales (including depreciation and impairment)(2)(3)
    14,422       22,341       48,378       84,953       41,589       54,003  
Selling, general and administrative
    676       1,062       2,960       5,433       2,423       3,411  
Operating income
    5,514       4,729       7,532       14,830       7,687       10,235  
Operating income as percentage of Sales
    26.8 %     16.8 %     12.8 %     14.1 %     14.9 %     15.1 %
Other income — net
    1,143       214       49             83        
Income from equity method investments
    149       86       301       985       349       881  
Financing costs — net
    (214 )     (353 )     (654 )     (927 )     (192 )     (785 )
Income before taxes
    6,592       4,676       7,228       14,888       7,927       10,331  
Net income (including minority interest)
    5,625       3,795       6,106       11,850       5,906       8,802  
Net income attributable to equity holders of the parent
    5,210       3,301       5,247       10,368       4,973       8,210  
                                               
            As of December 31,   As of June 30,
            2004   2005   2006(5)   2007   2008
            (Amounts in U.S.$ millions)   (unaudited)
Balance Sheet Data
                                               
Cash and cash equivalents, including short-term investments and restricted cash
          $ 2,634     $ 2,149     $ 6,146     $ 8,105     $ 7,531  
Property, plant and equipment
            11,058       19,045       54,573       61,994       66,350  
Total assets
            21,692       33,867       112,681       133,625       156,264  
Short-term debt and current portion of long-term debt
            341       334       4,922       8,542       10,329  
Long-term debt, net of current portion
            1,639       7,974       21,645       22,085       27,920  
Net assets
            11,079       15,457       50,228       61,535       67,149  
                                                 
      For the Six-Month Period
    For the Year Ended December 31,   Ended June 30,
    2004   2005   2006(5)   2007   2007   2008
    (Amounts in U.S.$ millions except volume data)   (unaudited)
Other Data
                                               
Net cash provided by operating activities
  $ 4,300     $ 3,874     $ 7,122     $ 16,532     $ 6,382     $ 6,214  
Net cash (used in) investing activities
    (656 )     (7,512 )     (8,576 )     (11,909 )     (6,891 )     (7,983 )
Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities
    (2,118 )     3,349       5,445       (3,417 )     1,016       1,513  
Total production of crude steel (thousands of tonnes)
    39,362       48,916       85,620       116,415       59,021       60,014  
Total shipments of steel products (thousands of tonnes)(4)
    35,067       44,614       78,950       109,724       55,710       59,036  
 
(1)   Including U.S.$2,235 million, U.S.$2,339 million, U.S.$3,847 million and U.S.$4,767 million of sales to related parties for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2005, 2006 and 2007, respectively (see Note 12 to the ArcelorMittal Consolidated Financial Statements), and U.S.$1,144 million and U.S.$2,838 million of sales to related parties for the six-month periods ended June 30, 2007 and 2008, respectively.
 
(2)   Including U.S.$1,021 million, U.S.$914 million, U.S.$1,740 million and U.S.$2,408 million of purchases from related parties for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2005, 2006 and 2007, respectively, and U.S.$519 million and U.S.$418 million of purchases from related parties for the six-month periods ended June 30, 2007 and 2008, respectively.
 
(3)   Including depreciation and impairment of U.S.$734 million, U.S.$1,113 million, U.S.$2,324 million and U.S.$4,570 million for the years ended December 31, 2004, 2005, 2006 and 2007, respectively, and U.S.$1,985 million and U.S.$2,855 million for the six-month periods ended June 30, 2007 and 2008, respectively.
 
(4)   Shipment volumes of steel products for the operations of the Company include certain inter-company shipments.
 
(5)   As required by IFRS, the 2006 information has been adjusted retrospectively for the finalization of the allocation of purchase price of Arcelor (see Note 3 to the ArcelorMittal Consolidated Financial Statements).

23


Table of Contents

RECENT DEVELOPMENTS
Results for the three- and six-month periods ended June 30, 2008
     On July 30, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced results for the three- and six-month periods ended June 30, 2008.
Highlights for the six months ended June 30, 2008:
    Sales of $67.6 billion, up 31% compared with the six months ended June 30, 2007
 
    Operating income of $10.2 billion, up 33% compared with the six months ended June 30, 2007
 
    Net Income of $8.2 billion, up 65% as compared with the six months ended June 30, 2007
 
    Capital expenditure of $2.3 billion in the six months ended June 30, 2008
Highlights for the three months ended June 30, 2008:
    Sales of $37.8 billion, up 39% compared with the three months ended June 30, 2007
 
    Operating income of $6.6 billion, up 56% compared with the three months ended June 30, 2007
 
    Net Income of $5.8 billion, up 114% as compared with the three months ended June 30, 2007
 
    Capital expenditure of $1.4 billion in the three months ended June 30, 2008
Outlook
          The Company expects improved financial results in the third quarter 2008. Flat Carbon Americas’ results are expected to significantly improve due to operational improvements and a better operating environment. Asia, Africa and CIS results are expected to improve due to improved volumes and price increases. Long Carbon’s results are expected to improve. The results of ArcelorMittal Steel Solutions and Services are expected to remain flat. Flat Carbon Europe’s results are expected to decline following seasonal shutdowns and increased cost pressure, while the profitability of Stainless Steel is set to decline. Our full year effective tax rate is expected to be between 15-20%.
Other Key Events
Upstream Activities:
  On July 21, 2008 ArcelorMittal announced that it had signed an agreement to acquire the Concept Group (“Concept”). Concept, located in southern West Virginia and adjacent to the recently acquired Mid Vol Coal Group in the Central Appalachian Coal Basin, produced 0.8 million tonnes of metallurgical coking coal in 2007.

24


Table of Contents

  On July 16, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced it had acquired the remaining 60% of the shares in Rolanfer Recyclage S.A. (“Rolanfer”) that it did not previously own. Rolanfer is based in Yutz (France) near the border with the Grand Duchy of Luxembourg and operates a shredder at the port nearby.
  On June 29, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that it had increased its stake in Macarthur Coal Limited of Australia from 14.9% to 19.9%, following the acquisition of a further 5% stake (10,607,830 shares) from Talbot Group Holdings. The shares were purchased at 20 Australian dollars per share, bringing ArcelorMittal’s total investment in Macarthur Coal to $843 million Australian dollars (U.S.$810 million).
  On June 23, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that it had signed an agreement to acquire the Mid Vol Coal Group. Mid Vol, located in southern West Virginia and southwestern Virginia in the Central Appalachian Coal Basin, produced 1.5 million tonnes of metallurgical coking coal in 2007.
  On June 11, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced the allocation to it of a mining lease in respect of the Karampada iron ore deposit by the Governments of India and the Indian state of Jharkhand for its integrated steel plant to be based in Jharkhand. The Karampada iron ore deposit has estimated reserves of 65 million tonnes of iron ore.
  On June 9, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that it had signed an agreement to acquire Bakermet, a market leader in the scrap metal recycling industry in Eastern Ontario, Canada. Bakermet, which specializes in all types of ferrous and non-ferrous metal, processed approximately 130,000 short tons of ferrous and 40 million pounds of non-ferrous metals in 2007. The plant, located near Ottawa, will secure upstream self-sufficiency in shredded metal for ArcelorMittal’s Contrecoeur mill (ArcelorMittal Montreal).
  On April 23, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that it had reached an agreement with Coal of Africa Limited (“CoAL”), a coal development company operating in South Africa. ArcelorMittal will enter into an off-take agreement with CoAL relating to two coal mines. The first, Baobab, is 100% owned by CoAL and has an estimated yield of 2.45 million tonnes per annum. The second, Thuli, is 74 % owned by CoAL and has an estimated yield of 4.2 million tonnes per annum. Full production at both mines is expected to be achieved by 2011.
  On April 10, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced the acquisition of three coal mines and associated assets in Russia for a total consideration of $718 million.

25


Table of Contents

Steel Production Initiatives:
  On August 13, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that the Company signed a joint venture agreement for the production and sales of electrical (silicon) steel with Hunan Valin Steel Group Co., Ltd., following the Auto Sheet JV agreement signed by both parties in June (see below). The new JV, named Valin ArcelorMittal Electrical Steel Co., Ltd., has a registered capital of 2.6 billion RMB, each party retaining 50% of the shares. This JV plans to build cold rolling and processing facilities for the production of non-grain oriented (NGO) and grain oriented (GO) electrical steels. The total investment is estimated at 6.5 billion RMB, aiming for an annual production of 400,000 tons non-grain oriented and 200,000 tons grain oriented steel. ArcelorMittal will transfer its latest NGO and GO technologies to the joint venture. In addition, Valin Lian’gang, a subsidiary of Valin Steel Tube & Wire, signed a supply agreement with the JV and a Technology License Agreement with ArcelorMittal for the transfer of NGO and GO upstream technologies in order to supply high-quality hot-rolled substrate to the JV.
  On August 11, 2008, ArcelorMittal, announced that it had signed an agreement to acquire 49% of the share capital in MPP - Mineração Pirâmide Participações Ltda (“MPP”). MPP is a mining company located in Corumbá, in the State of Mato Grosso do Sul, Brazil. MPP’s activities are focused on the exploration and development of iron ore and manganese reserves in the region. The price to be paid by ArcelorMittal will be calculated based on the amount of iron ore and manganese reserves “in situ”, assessed according to the Code for the Reporting of Mineral Resources and Ore Reserves of the Australasian Joint Ore Reserves Committee (known as “JORC”).
  On August 7, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced new investments of U.S.$1.6 billion in its carbon steel operations in Brazil. The investments are in addition to the US$1.2 billion of investments slated for the expansion of the Monlevade plant in Minas Gerais. These investments, expected to be completed within 30 months, are intended to expand ArcelorMittal’s crude steel production capacity in the long carbon sector in Brazil by an additional 2.6 million tonnes, representing an increase from 3.9 million tonnes per year up to 6.5 million tonnes per year. The new investment program envisions the construction of all facilities with environmentally friendly and energy efficient technology and anticipates employing up to 6,000 people.
  On August 4, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that it plans to construct a new steel mill in Mexico for an investment of U.S.$600 million. The mill, designed to be energy-efficient and environmentally responsible, will produce carbon steel and bars including rebar, merchant bar quality and special bar quality products that will principally serve the construction and automotive sectors. The facility will be based on electrical steel making equipment with capacity of one million of metric tonnes of billets per year and a new bar rolling mill with a capacity of 500,000 metric tonnes. This additional production will be directed to the domestic Mexican market, mainly to produce high added value steel products but also to support the Government of Mexico’s National Infrastructure Plan and Housing Program. The commencement of construction will be subject to the receipt of appropriate regulatory approvals by the relevant local authorities.
  On July 22, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced a 76 million ($118 million) investment to expand electrical steel production capacity at its Saint Chély d’Apcher plant in Southern France, a move in line with the Group’s strategy to strengthen its position in high added value steel products and solutions that contribute to lower carbon dioxide emissions. The addition of a new 180,000 tonnes continuous annealing line will take Saint Chély d’Apcher’s capacity to 210,000 tonnes per year of mostly high end non-grain oriented electrical steels, which are used, among other things, in electric engines and wind turbines. The new line is scheduled to become operational during the second quarter of 2010.
  On July 3, 2008, ArcelorMittal and AREVA signed an agreement for a 70 million ($110 million) investment aimed at increasing production of certain products for the nuclear industry, at the steel plant of Industeel, a subsidiary of ArcelorMittal. The investment, which will be staggered between 2008 and 2010, is targeted to increase ingot production capacity significantly (from 35,000 tonnes to 50,000 tonnes per year). In addition, the two companies announced that they plan to implement a joint 3-year metallurgy research and development program that will be conducted at the Creusot Materials Research Center in France.
  On June 27, 2008, ArcelorMittal, Hunan Valin Group and Hunan Valin Steel Co. Ltd. announced a new development in their relationship with the launch of Valin ArcelorMittal Automotive Steel, an industrial and commercial automotive joint venture that will have an annual production capacity of 1.2 million tonnes of flat carbon steel, mainly for automotive applications. Products will include cold rolled steel, galvannealed steel and pure zinc galvanized steel. The establishment of this new joint venture remains subject to regulatory approval. Hunan Valin Steel Co., Ltd will own 34% of the new joint venture and ArcelorMittal and Hunan Valin Group will each have a 33% equity share. The new activity will be located in Hunan Province next to Hunan Valin Steel Co.’s subsidiary, Lianyuan Steel, which will supply hot rolled coil to the new joint venture.

26


Table of Contents

  On June 16, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that it had signed an agreement to acquire Bayou Steel, a producer of structural steel products with facilities in LaPlace, Louisiana, and Harriman, Tennessee, for $475 million. The transaction is subject to regulatory approval. Bayou Steel is an independent producer of medium and light structural steel and bar size products. Through its Mississippi River Recycling division, Bayou Steel operates an automobile shredder at the LaPlace facility, as well as barge wrecking and full-service scrap yards at LaPlace and its facility in Harvey, Louisiana. The company also has a deepwater dock and distribution network, including four stocking locations in the United States.
  On April 16, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that it would be expanding its joint venture partnership with Japan’s Nippon Steel Corporation by building a new continuous galvanising line at the I/N Kote facility in New Carlisle, Indiana. The new line will have an annual capacity of 480,000 metric tonnes and, upon completion, will double I/N Kote’s hot-dipped galvanised production capacity.  The new line will offer high-grade, high-quality coated sheets that promote improved safety and fuel efficiency in automobiles.
Downstream Activities
  On July 25, 2008, ArcelorMittal acquired a 70% share of Manchester Tubos e Perfilados S.A, a Brazilian steel processor and distributor located in Contagem, Minas Gerais, Brazil. This new acquisition will reinforce ArcelorMittal’s downstream position in Brazil, following the acquisition on April 3, 2008 of a 50% stake in Gonvarri Brasil (see below). With the acquisition of Manchester, and with its partnership with Gonvarri, ArcelorMittal will widen its product offering in the distribution segment in Brazil. The Group will now offer an extended range of flat products (coils and blanks), profiles, tubes and pipes.
 
  On July 14, 2008, ArcelorMittal and Primex (Germany) reached an agreement whereby ArcelorMittal Stainless International acquired the 35% stake in Uginox Sanayi ve Ticaret Limited Sirketi of Turkey which was owned by Primex.
 
  On July 1, 2008, ArcelorMittal acquired Astralloy Steel Products Inc. (“Astralloy”), a subsidiary of IMS International Metal Service. Astralloy operates three warehouses and employs 60 people in North America. Its 2007 revenues were $34 million.
 
  On June 30, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced its intention to acquire 60% of the entire issued share capital of Dubai Steel Trading Company LLC (“DSTC LLC”). DSTC LLC’s distributes approximately 120,000 tonnes of products per year out of Dubai, United Arab Emirates.
 
  On April 3, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced the acquisition of a 50% share of Gonvarri Brasil to form a Steel Service Centre joint venture. Gonvarri Brasil is one of the major players for servicing automotive, industry and distribution customers. The company is one of the leaders of flat steel processing in Brazil and its activities include pickling, slitting, blanking, and cutting to length, with a total processing capacity of around 1.3 million tonnes of steel.
Disposals:
  On May 7, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that the court-appointed trustee had completed the previously announced sale of ArcelorMittal’s Sparrows Point steel mill near Baltimore, Maryland to OAO Severstal of Russia for $810 million, net of debt.
Other key events
  On September 19, 2008, ArcelorMittal confirmed that it is currently contemplating a transaction involving the introduction of black economic empowerment into ArcelorMittal South Africa. There is no guarantee that the transaction will be forthcoming. ArcelorMittal indicated that it would update the market if and when appropriate. Black economic empowerment is a program launched by the South African government to redress the inequalities affecting previously disadvantaged groups in the country through promotion of their participation in the economy.
  On September 17, 2008, the Company announced a new “management gains” plan targeting a total cost savings of U.S.$4 billion over the next five years. The plan will target increasing employee productivity, reducing energy consumption and decreasing input costs to achieve a higher yield and improved product quality.
  On September 16, 2008, Fitch Ratings upgraded the Company’s “Long-term Issuer Default” (LT IDR) and senior unsecured ratings to “BBB+” from “BBB” and affirmed the “Company’s Short-term Issuer Default” rating at “F2”, with the outlook on the LT IDR now “Stable.”
  On September 12, 2008, Standard Iron Works filed a Class Action Complaint in U.S. district court against ArcelorMittal, ArcelorMittal USA Inc., and other steel manufacturers alleging that the defendants conspired since 2005 to restrict the output of steel products in order to fix, raise, stabilize and maintain prices at artificially high levels in violation of U.S. law. The Complaint has been served on ArcelorMittal USA Inc., but not yet on ArcelorMittal. It is too early in the proceedings for ArcelorMittal to determine the amount of its potential liability, if any. However, ArcelorMittal considers the allegations in the Complaint to be entirely unfounded.
  On September 3, 2008, ArcelorMittal and Kalagadi Manganese announced the unconditional participation of ArcelorMittal in Kalagadi Manganese, observing that all conditions precedent to the joint venture to develop Kalagadi’s manganese deposits have been satisfied and the subscription amount paid. The U.S.$432.5 million deal will result in the establishment and implementation of a joint venture between ArcelorMittal (owning 50%), Kalahari Resources, a majority black women-owned and controlled company (owning 40%), and Industrial Development Corporation Limited, the South African state-owned financier (owning 10%). The project, which is due to come on-line in 2010, includes plans for development in South Africa such as construction of a smelter complex in Coega, the establishment of a manganese ore mine and sinter plant expected to ultimately produce 2.4 million tonnes of sinter product per year, and the building of a 320,000 tonnes per annum ferromanganese alloy production facility.
  On August 20, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that the Company has agreed to acquire 100% of the issued share capital of London Mining South America Limited, an iron ore miner in the state of Minas Gerais, Brazil, from Oslo listed London Mining plc for approximately U.S.$764 million. The transaction also includes the assignment of inter-group loans from London Mining of approximately U.S.$46 million. The total consideration payable to London Mining will amount to approximately U.S.$810 million. Subject to further technical analyses, ArcelorMittal will consider investing up to U.S.$700 million to increase production in the medium term of iron ore concentrate and lump ore. ArcelorMittal has also reached an agreement (subject to contract) with Canadian based Adriana Resources Inc. for the development of an iron ore port facility in the State of Rio de Janeiro, Brazil and intends to use its share of the port’s capacity to export iron ore from the London Mining South America Limited mine to its steel facilities in the Atlantic basin.
  On August 4, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that it signed an agreement for the acquisition of Koppers’ Monessen Coke Plant from Koppers Inc. for U.S.$160 million. Koppers’ Monessen Coke Plant, located in Monessen, Pennsylvania produced 320,000 metric tonnes of metallurgical coke in 2007. The transaction is subject to receipt of relevant regulatory approvals.
  In connection with its acquisition of Kryvorizhstal, ArcelorMittal and the State Property Fund of Ukraine (the “SPF”) entered into a share purchase agreement dated October 28, 2005 (the “SPA”). The SPF and ArcelorMittal currently disagree with respect to the fulfillment of certain undertakings of ArcelorMittal under the SPA. In a letter dated August 1, 2008, the SPF claims that it considers ArcelorMittal to be in non-compliance with certain undertakings and that it is seeking ArcelorMittal’s agreement to terminate the SPA and return of shares sold thereunder to the Ukrainian State as represented by the SPF. The SPF states in the letter that it will refer the matter to arbitration if there is no resolution within thirty days following the formal receipt by ArcelorMittal of the SPF’s letter. The SPA provides for final resolution of disputes by arbitration before the International Commercial Arbitration Tribunal at the Chamber of Commerce and Industry of Ukraine in Kiev. ArcelorMittal has not yet formally received the August 1, 2008 letter from the SPF, and arbitration has not commenced. At this time, ArcelorMittal is unable to assess the outcome of any arbitration or the amount of ArcelorMittal’s potential liability, if any. On September 18, 2008, the special parliamentary commission in the Ukraine announced that it has not found any violation of the SPA by ArcelorMittal. The decision of the special parliamentary commission is a recommendation to SPF although not binding on the SPF.
  On July 11, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced the launch of a new clean technology venture capital fund (with an initial clean technology investment of $20 million in Miasolé).

27


Table of Contents

  In connection with the share buy-back program announced on December 12 and 18, 2007, for the repurchase of a maximum of 44 million shares over two years, as of the close of business on September 12, 2008, ArcelorMittal had repurchased a total of 43.9 million shares at an average price of U.S.$78.56 for a total amount of U.S.$3,449 million. The purchases were effected on Euronext Paris and off market.
In connection with the share buy-back program, on June 27, 2008, Frecolux, a Luxembourg subsidiary of ArcelorMittal, gave a share buy-back mandate to EXANE BNP Paris that commenced on July 2, 2009 and that effectively ended on July 11 when the number of shares acquired by EXANE BNP Paribas reached 10 million shares.
  On June 18, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that the principal borrowing vehicle of the Group would be ArcelorMittal, the ultimate holding company of the Group. As a result, future bonds are expected to be issued by ArcelorMittal. ArcelorMittal also announced that it expected to transfer a substantial portion of the debt from ArcelorMittal Finance to ArcelorMittal and that bonds currently issued under the name of ArcelorMittal Finance were expected to remain outstanding until their final maturity date.
  On June 16, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that following purchases of 11.31% on June 13, 2008, the Company now owns 24.99% of the Turkish steel company Erdemir.
  On June 10, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced its plan to expand the steelmaking capacity of its Kazakhstan plant in Temirtau from 5 to 10 million tonnes. The Company is collaborating closely with the Kazakh government for the planning and execution of the project that is expected to take 5 to 9 years to complete. The expansion project encompasses steel making, iron ore and coal extraction. For the steel plant, the plan is to modernize existing facilities with latest technologies and safety and environmental standards. The expansion project is expected to add 4 million tonnes of crude steel capacity. Recently developed technologies are expected to help upgrade the existing Atasu iron ore mine to underground mining to reach 10 million tonnes, increasing production to 16 million tonnes and making Temirtau entirely self-sufficient in iron ore. Finally, these investments are complemented by a $1.2 billion investment for continuous improvements in health and safety and the modernisation of existing coal mines. Combined with the development of new mines, production is therefore expected to reach approximately 17 million tonnes of mined coal by 2018. When completed, these projects will further increase self-sufficiency in coal supply for ArcelorMittal Termirtau. These investments are also expected to considerably reduce emissions and help achieve highest environmental standards.
  On June 3, 2008, ArcelorMittal and trade unions representing its employees across the globe signed a new agreement to further improve health and safety standards throughout the Group. The agreement, the first of its kind in the steel industry, recognises the vital role played by trade unions in improving health and safety. It sets out minimum standards in every site the Group operates in order to achieve world class performance. These standards include the commitment to form joint management/union health and safety committees as well as training and education programmes in order to make a meaningful impact on overall health and safety across the Group. Also included in the agreement is the creation of a joint management/union global health and safety committee that will target ArcelorMittal plants in order to help them to further improve their health and safety performance.  The agreement was signed on June 3, 2008 by ArcelorMittal, the European Metalworkers’ Federation, the United Steelworkers and the International Metalworkers’ Federation.

28


Table of Contents

  On June 2, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that an accident occurred at its Tentekskaya Mine in Kazakhstan. 100 people were working in the mine when the accident occurred at approximately 4 a.m. (Kazakhstan time). Although 95 persons were safely evacuated, 5 persons perished as a result of a coal and gas outburst underground. An independent government commission in its investigation report cites unpredictable geological failure in the roadway as the main cause of the accident. ArcelorMittal is presently reviewing the recommendations and developing an action plan in line with these.
  On May 13, 2008, ArcelorMittal signed a $4.0 billion revolving credit facility with a group of banks, further enhancing its liquidity position.
  On May 8, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that it filed suit against Esmark Inc., E2 Acquisition Corporation (Esmark/E2) in the Supreme Court of the State of New York. ArcelorMittal is seeking in excess of $540 million in connection with Esmark/E2’s breach of its August 1, 2007 contract to purchase the Sparrows Point steel manufacturing facility from ArcelorMittal for $1.35 billion. That contract was terminated on December 16, 2007, after Esmark/E2 failed to complete the transaction. As described above, Sparrows Point was sold to OAO Severstal for $810 million, net of debt, on May 7, 2008.
  On May 2, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced a series of measures which will restore a 25% free float in China Oriental Group Company (“China Oriental”) in compliance with the listing rules of the Hong Kong Stock Exchange (“HKSE”). At the time of the close of its tender offer on February 4, 2008 ArcelorMittal had reached a 47% shareholding in China Oriental. Given the 45.4% shareholding by the founding shareholders, this left a free float of 7.6% against a minimum HKSE listing requirement of 25%. The measures to restore the minimum free float have been achieved by means of sale of 17.4% stake to ING Bank and Deutsche Bank, together with put option agreements entered into with both banks. As a result of these measures ArcelorMittal’s shareholding has been reduced to 29.6%.
  On April 29, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that it had signed new long-term contracts with Companhia Vale do Rio Doce (“Vale”) to supply iron ore and pellets to its plants in Europe, Africa and the Americas. Under these long-term contracts, which are the largest ever signed between a steel company and an iron ore supplier, Vale will supply approximately 480 million tonnes of iron ore and pellets to ArcelorMittal plants over the next ten years (2007-2016).
  On April 21, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced new appointments to its Group Management Board. These appointments follow the announcement, on April 7, 2008, of the retirement of Mr. Malay Mukherjee. The appointments of Mr. Maheshwari, Mr. Cornier and Mr. Chugh are effective as of May 14, 2008.
  On April 14, 2008, ArcelorMittal announced that its Board of Directors unanimously approved amendments to certain aspects of the Memorandum of Understanding (“MOU”) that was entered into in November 2006, in the context of the offer of Mittal Steel for Arcelor, after the Board decided that certain of the provisions in the MOU were outdated or redundant.

29


Table of Contents

The amendments approved by the Board of Directors are summarized as follows:
  o   Replacement of the post of President with the new position of Lead Independent Director, whose principal duties and responsibilities include, among others, coordination of activities of the other independent directors, liaising between the Chairman of the Board of Directors and the other independent directors and calling meetings of the independent directors when necessary and appropriate;
 
  o   Permitting the CEO of ArcelorMittal to hold office as a Director;
 
  o   Reinforcement of the rules governing the composition of the Audit Committee and the Appointments and Remuneration Committee to ensure that each of these committees will be composed of at least three independent directors;
 
  o   Appointment of future members of the Company’s Group Management Board by the Board of Directors; and
 
  o   Amendment to provisions relating to the Company’s authorized share capital to reflect changes made to the Articles of Association.
  On April 4, 2008, ArcelorMittal acquired 30.0 million shares of ArcelorMittal Inox Brasil S.A. in a tender offer made to minority shareholders. This represents 40.33% of the total share capital of ArcelorMittal Inox Brasil S.A. and 94.81% of its free float, and increases ArcelorMittal’s stake in ArcelorMittal Inox Brasil S.A. from 57.34% to 97.67%. ArcelorMittal paid R$2.84 billion for the tendered shares, representing, at the current exchange rate, a total consideration of U.S.$1.66 billion. Between April 4 and April 26, 2008, the Company bought an additional 0.8 million shares, thereby increasing its stake to 99.5%. On April 26, 2008, ArcelorMittal Inox Brasil S.A. was delisted.
  ArcelorMittal has commenced a legal action in the Ontario Superior Court to require U.S. Steel Canada Inc. and Cleveland-Cliffs Inc. to respect their commitment and comply with the sale of their respective interests in the Wabush Mines joint venture to ArcelorMittal Dofasco. U.S. Steel Canada and Cleveland-Cliffs had agreed to sell their interests in the Wabush Mines joint venture to ArcelorMittal Dofasco in accordance with the terms of an agreement signed in August 2007.

30


Table of Contents

USE OF PROCEEDS
     We will not receive any proceeds from the exchange offer. In exchange for issuing the exchange notes as contemplated in this prospectus, we will receive original notes in like principal amount, the terms of which are identical in all material respects to the exchange notes. The original notes surrendered in exchange for the exchange notes will be retired and cancelled and cannot be reissued. Accordingly, the issuance of the exchange notes will not result in any increase in our indebtedness.
     We used the net proceeds from the sale of the original notes to repay existing indebtedness.
RATIO OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES
     ArcelorMittal’s unaudited ratio of earnings to fixed charges for the periods indicated below was as follows:
                                                 
        Six-month period
    2003   2004   2005   2006   2007   ended June 30, 2008
  (Unaudited)  
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges
    N/A       23.5x       9.0x       6.5x       8.0x     10.9x
     The ratio of earnings to fixed charges is computed by dividing earnings by fixed charges. Earnings represent consolidated net income before extraordinary charges, income allocable to minority interests in consolidated entities that incurred fixed charges, consolidated provision for income taxes, fixed charges less interest capitalized, and undistributed earnings of less-than-50% owned affiliates. Fixed charges include interest expensed and capitalized and the interest portion of rental obligations. Amounts were prepared in accordance with IFRS. The ratio for 2003 is not available because Mittal Steel’s financial statements were not prepared in accordance with IFRS for that year and doing so would involve a significant effort and expense.

31


Table of Contents

CAPITALIZATION
     The following table sets forth the unaudited consolidated capitalization and long-term indebtedness, as well as short-term indebtedness, of ArcelorMittal at June 30, 2008, on an actual basis. After the issuance, the capitalization of ArcelorMittal will be unchanged because ArcelorMittal will cancel existing indebtedness in an amount equal to the indebtedness with respect to the issued exchange notes. We prepared the following table on the basis of IFRS. You should read this table together with the ArcelorMittal audited and unaudited consolidated financial statements and the other financial data included elsewhere, or incorporated by reference, in this prospectus.
         
    As of
    June 30, 2008
    (In U.S.$
    millions)
    (Unaudited)
Short-term borrowings, including current portion of long-term debt
  $ 10,329  
Long-term borrowings, net of current portion
    27,920  
Total consolidated debt
    38,249  
Secured
    975  
Unsecured
    37,274  
Minority interests
    4,082  
Equity attributable to the equity holders of the parent
    63,067  
Total shareholders’ equity
    67,149  
Total capitalization (Total shareholder’s equity plus total consolidated debt)
    105,398  
     Except as disclosed herein, there have been no material changes in the consolidated capitalization, indebtedness and contingent liabilities of ArcelorMittal since June 30, 2008.

32


Table of Contents

THE EXCHANGE OFFER
     This section describes the exchange offer and the material provisions of the registration rights agreement, but it may not contain all of the information that is important to you. We refer you to the complete provisions of the registration rights agreement, which has been filed as an exhibit to the registration statement on Form F-4. See “Where You Can Find More Information” for instructions on how to obtain copies of this document.
     In this section and the section entitled “Description of Exchange Notes” and “Form of Notes, Clearing and Settlement,” references to “we,” “us,” “our” and “the Company” refer to ArcelorMittal only and do not include our subsidiaries or affiliates. References to the “notes” mean the U.S.$3,000,000,000 principal amount of original notes we previously sold in May 2008 and up to an equal principal amount of exchange notes we are offering hereby. References to “holders” mean those who have notes registered in their names on the books that we or the trustee maintain for this purpose, and not those who own beneficial interests in notes issued in book-entry form through The Depository Trust Company, or DTC, or in notes registered in street name. Owners of beneficial interests in the notes should read the subsections entitled “—Terms of the Exchange Offer—Procedures for Tendering” and “Form of Notes, Clearing and Settlement.”
Purpose and Effect of this Exchange Offer
General
     We sold the original notes to certain initial purchasers in May 2008 under the terms of a purchase agreement we reached with them. The initial purchasers resold the original notes to qualified institutional buyers in reliance on Rule 144A under the Securities Act and in offshore transactions in reliance on Regulation S under the Securities Act. In connection with the offering of the original notes, we also entered into a registration rights agreement with the initial purchasers, which governs our obligation to file a registration statement with the SEC and commence the exchange offer to exchange the exchange notes for the original notes. The exchange offer is intended to satisfy certain of our obligations under the registration rights agreement.
     The registration rights agreement further provides that if we do not complete the exchange offer within a certain period of time or under certain other circumstances, we will be obligated to pay additional interest, referred to as special interest, to holders of the original notes. Except as discussed below under “—Resale Registration Statement; Special Interest Premium,” upon the completion of the exchange offer we will have no further obligations to register your original notes or pay special interest.
Representations upon Tender of Original Notes
     To participate in the exchange offer, you must execute or agree to be bound by the letter of transmittal, through which you will represent to us, among other things, that:
    any exchange notes received by you will be, and the notes you are tendering in anticipation of receiving the exchange notes were, acquired in the ordinary course of business;
 
    you do not have any arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in, are not engaged in, and do not intend to engage in, the distribution (within the meaning of the Securities Act) of the exchange notes in violation of the provisions of the Securities Act;
 
    you are not an “affiliate” of ours, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act; and
 
    if you are a broker-dealer, (i) you will receive exchange notes for your own account in exchange for original notes that were acquired as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities and (ii) you will deliver a prospectus (or, to the extent permitted by law, make available a prospectus to purchasers) in connection with any resale of those exchange notes to the extent required by applicable law or regulation or SEC pronouncement.

33


Table of Contents

Resale of the Exchange Notes
     Based on existing interpretations of the SEC staff with respect to similar transactions, we believe that the exchange notes issued pursuant to this exchange offer in exchange for original notes may be offered for resale, resold and otherwise transferred by holders thereof without compliance with the registration and prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act if:
    such exchange notes are acquired in the ordinary course of the holder’s business;
 
    such holder is not engaged in, has no arrangement with any person to participate in, and does not intend to engage in, any public distribution of the exchange notes;
 
    such holder is not our “affiliate,” as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act; and
 
    if such holder is a broker-dealer that receives exchange notes for its own account in exchange for original notes that were acquired as a result of market-making activities, that it will deliver a prospectus, as required by law, in any resale of such exchange notes.
     Any holder who tenders in this exchange offer with the intention of participating in any manner in a distribution of the exchange notes:
    cannot rely on the position of the staff of the SEC set forth in “Exxon Capital Holdings Corporation” or similar interpretive letters; and
 
    must comply with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act in connection with a secondary resale transaction.
     This prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, may be used for an offer to resell or for other transfer of exchange notes only as specified in this prospectus. Participating broker-dealers may use this prospectus in connection with the resale of exchange notes for a period of up to 45 days from the last date on which the original notes are accepted for exchange. Only broker-dealers that acquired the original notes as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities may participate in this exchange offer. Each participating broker-dealer who receives exchange notes for its own account in exchange for original notes that were acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of market-making or other trading activities will be required to acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus (or, to the extent permitted by law, make available a prospectus to purchasers) in connection with any resale by it of exchange notes to the extent required by applicable law or regulation or SEC pronouncement. The letter of transmittal that accompanies this prospectus states that by acknowledging and delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act.
     This exchange offer is not being made to, nor will we accept tenders for exchange from, holders of original notes in any jurisdiction in which the exchange offer or the acceptance of it would not be in compliance with the securities or blue sky laws of such jurisdiction.
Consequences of Failure to Exchange
     Holders of original notes who do not exchange their original notes for exchange notes under this exchange offer will remain subject to the restrictions on transfer applicable in the original notes (i) as set forth in the legend printed on the original notes as a consequence of the issuance of the original notes pursuant to exemptions from, or in transactions not subject to, the registration requirements of the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws and (ii) otherwise as set forth in the prospectus distributed in connection with the private offering of the original notes.

34


Table of Contents

     Any original notes not tendered by their holders in exchange for exchange notes in this exchange offer will not retain any rights under the registration rights agreement (except in certain limited circumstances).
     In general, you may not offer or sell the original notes unless they are registered under the Securities Act or the offer or sale is exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws. We do not intend to register resales of the original notes under the Securities Act. Based on interpretations of the SEC staff, exchange notes issued pursuant to this exchange offer may be offered for resale, resold or otherwise transferred by their holders (other than any such holder that is our “affiliate” within the meaning of Rule 405 under the Securities Act) without compliance with the registration and prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act, provided that the holders acquired the exchange notes in the ordinary course of business and the holders are not engaged in, have no arrangement with any person to participate in, and do not intend to engage in, any public distribution of the exchange notes to be acquired in this exchange offer. Any holder who tenders in this exchange offer and is engaged in, has an arrangement with any person to participate in, or intends to engage in, any public distribution of the exchange notes (i) may not rely on the applicable interpretations of the SEC and (ii) must comply with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act in connection with a secondary resale transaction.
Terms of the Exchange Offer
     Upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this prospectus and in the accompanying letter of transmittal, we will accept for exchange any and all original notes validly tendered and not properly withdrawn prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the expiration date. The exchange offer will remain open for at least 20 full business days (as required by Exchange Act Rule 14e-1(a)) and will expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on      , 2008, or such later date and time to which we extend it (the “expiration date”). We will issue the exchange notes in denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof. Holders may tender some or all of their original notes pursuant to the exchange offer. However, original notes may be tendered only in denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof. The date of acceptance for exchange of the original notes, and completion of the exchange offer, will be the exchange date, which will be the first business day following the expiration date (unless such period is extended as described in this prospectus). The exchange notes issued in connection with this exchange offer will be delivered on the earliest practicable date following the exchange date.
     The form and terms of the exchange notes will be substantially the same as the form and terms of the original notes except that (i) the exchange notes will have been registered under the Securities Act and will not bear legends restricting the transfer thereof and (ii) the holders of the exchange notes will not be entitled to certain rights under the registration rights agreement, which rights will terminate when the exchange offer is terminated. The exchange notes will evidence the same debt as the original notes and will be entitled to the benefits of the same indenture that governs the original notes.
     As of the date of this prospectus, U.S.$3,000,000,000 principal amount of the original notes (of which U.S.$1,500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of our notes due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of our notes due 2018) are outstanding. This prospectus and the letter of transmittal are being sent to all registered holders of original notes.
     We intend to conduct this exchange offer in accordance with the provisions of the registration rights agreement, the applicable requirements of the Securities Act and the Exchange Act, and the rules and regulations of the SEC. Original notes that are not tendered for exchange in this exchange offer will remain outstanding and continue to accrue interest and holders of the original notes will be entitled to the rights and benefits of such holders under the indenture.
     We shall be deemed to have accepted validly tendered original notes when, as and if we have given oral or written notice thereof to the exchange agent. The exchange agent will act as agent for the tendering holders for the purpose of receiving the exchange notes from us and delivering the exchange notes to the tendering holders.

35


Table of Contents

     Holders who tender original notes in the exchange offer will not be required to pay brokerage commissions or fees or, subject to the instructions in the letter of transmittal, transfer taxes with respect to the exchange of original notes pursuant to the exchange offer. We will pay all charges and expenses, other than certain applicable taxes in certain circumstances, in connection with the exchange offer. See “—Fees and Expenses.”
     If any tendered original notes are not accepted for exchange because of an invalid tender, the occurrence of certain other events described in this prospectus or otherwise, we will return the original notes, without expense, to the tendering holder promptly after the expiration date.
Expiration Date; Extensions; Amendments; Termination
     The term “expiration date” means 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on      , 2008, unless we, in our sole discretion, extend the exchange offer, in which case the term “expiration date” means the latest date and time to which we extend the exchange offer. To extend the expiration date, we will notify the exchange agent of any extension by oral or written notice. We will notify holders of the original notes of any extension by press release or other public announcement.
     We reserve the right to amend the terms of the exchange offer in any manner. In addition, if we determine that any of the events set forth under “—Conditions of the Exchange Offer” has occurred, we also reserve the right, in our sole discretion, to:
    delay acceptance of any original notes;
 
    extend the exchange offer and retain all original notes tendered before the expiration date of the exchange offer, subject to the rights of the holders of tendered original notes to withdraw their tendered original notes;
 
    terminate the exchange offer and refuse to accept any original notes; or
 
    waive the termination event with respect to the exchange offer and accept all properly tendered original notes that have not been withdrawn.
     If we do so, we will give oral or written notice of this delay in acceptance, extension, termination or waiver to the exchange agent. If the amendment constitutes a material change to the exchange offer, we will promptly disclose such amendment in a manner reasonably calculated to inform holders of the original notes, including by providing public announcement or giving oral or written notice to such holders. We may extend the exchange offer for a period of time, depending upon the significance of the amendment and the manner of disclosure to the registered holders.
Interest on the Exchange Notes
     Each exchange note will bear interest from its date of original issuance. The original notes bear interest at 5.375% in the case of the notes due June 1, 2013 and 6.125% in the case of the notes due June 1, 2018 through the date preceding the date of the original issuance of the exchange notes. Such interest will be paid on the first interest payment date for the exchange notes. Interest on the original notes accepted for exchange and exchanged in the exchange offer will cease to accrue on the date preceding the date of original issuance of the exchange notes. The exchange notes will bear interest (as do the original notes) at a rate of 5.375% in the case of the notes due June 1, 2013 and 6.125% in the case of the notes due June 1, 2018, which interest will be payable semi-annually on June 1 and December 1 of each year.
Procedures for Tendering
     To participate in the exchange offer, you must properly tender your original notes to the exchange agent as described below. We will only issue exchange notes in exchange for original notes that you timely and properly

36


Table of Contents

tender. Therefore, you should allow sufficient time to ensure timely delivery of the original notes, and you should follow carefully the instructions on how to tender your original notes. It is your responsibility to properly tender your original notes. We have the right to waive any defects in your tender. However, we are not required to waive any defects, and neither we nor the exchange agent is required to notify you of defects in your tender.
     If you have any questions or need help in exchanging your original notes, please contact the exchange agent at the address or telephone number described below.
     All of the original notes were issued in book-entry form, and all of the original notes are currently represented by global certificates registered in the name of Cede & Co., the nominee of DTC. We have confirmed with DTC that the original notes may be tendered using ATOP. The exchange agent will establish an account with DTC for purposes of the exchange offer promptly after the commencement of the exchange offer, and DTC participants may electronically transmit their acceptance of the exchange offer by causing DTC to transfer their original notes to the exchange agent using the ATOP procedures. In connection with the transfer, DTC will send an “agent’s message” to the exchange agent. The agent’s message will state that DTC has received instructions from the participant to tender original notes and that the participant agrees to be bound by the terms of the letter of transmittal.
     By using the ATOP procedures to exchange original notes, you will not be required to deliver a letter of transmittal to the exchange agent. However, you will be bound by its terms just as if you had signed it.
     Determinations Under the Exchange Offer. We will determine in our sole discretion all questions as to the validity, form, eligibility, time of receipt, acceptance of tendered original notes and withdrawal of tendered original notes. Our determination will be final and binding. We reserve the absolute right to reject any original notes not properly tendered or any original notes our acceptance of which would, in the opinion of our counsel, be unlawful. We also reserve the right to waive any defects, irregularities or conditions of tender as to particular original notes. Our interpretation of the terms and conditions of the exchange offer, including the instructions in the letter of transmittal, will be final and binding on all parties. Unless waived, all defects or irregularities in connection with tenders of original notes must be cured within the time period we determine. Although we currently intend to notify holders of defects or irregularities with respect to tenders of original notes, neither we, the exchange agent nor any other person will incur any liability for failure to give such notification. Tenders of original notes will not be deemed made until such defects or irregularities have been cured or waived. Any original notes received by the exchange agent that are not properly tendered and as to which the defects or irregularities have not been cured or waived will be returned at no cost by the exchange agent to the tendering holder as soon as practicable following the expiration date of the exchange.
     When We Will Issue Exchange Notes. In all cases, we will issue exchange notes for original notes that we have accepted for exchange under the exchange offer only after the exchange agent receives, prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the expiration date:
    a book-entry confirmation of such original notes into the exchange agent’s account at DTC; and
 
    a properly transmitted agent’s message.
     Return of Outstanding Notes Not Accepted or Exchanged. If we do not accept any tendered original notes for exchange or if original notes are submitted for a greater principal amount than the holder desires to exchange, the unaccepted or non-exchanged original notes will be returned without expense to their tendering holder. Such unaccepted or non-exchanged original notes will be credited to an account maintained with DTC. These actions will occur as promptly as practicable after the expiration or termination of the exchange offer.
     Participating broker-dealers. Each broker-dealer that receives exchange notes for its own account in exchange for original notes, where those original notes were acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of market making activities or other trading activities, must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of those exchange notes. See “Plan of Distribution.”

37


Table of Contents

Guaranteed Delivery Procedures
     Holders who wish to tender their original notes and cannot complete the ATOP procedures for electronic tenders before expiration of the exchange offer may tender their original notes if:
    the tender is made through an eligible guarantor institution (as defined by Rule 17Ad-15 under the Exchange Act);
 
    before expiration of the exchange offer, DTC receives from the eligible institution a properly completed and duly executed notice of guaranteed delivery in the form available through the exchange agent, by facsimile transmission, mail or hand delivery, and the exchange agent receives from DTC an agent’s message in lieu of notice of guaranteed delivery:
  o   setting forth the name and address of the holder and the principal amount of original notes tendered;
 
  o   stating that the tender offer is being made by guaranteed delivery and confirming that the tender is subject to the terms of the letter of transmittal; and
 
  o   guaranteeing that, within three (3) New York Stock Exchange trading days after expiration of the exchange offer, tender of such original notes will made by book-entry delivery to the exchange agent’s DTC account; and
    the exchange agent receives book-entry confirmation of the transfer of the tendered original notes to the Exchange Agent’s DTC account within three (3) New York Stock Exchange trading days after expiration of the exchange offer.
     Upon request to the exchange agent, a notice of guaranteed delivery will be sent to holders who wish to tender their original notes according to the guaranteed delivery procedures set forth above.
     In addition, we reserve the right in our sole discretion:
    to purchase or make offers for any original notes that remain outstanding after the expiration date;
 
    to terminate the exchange offer as described above under “—Expiration Date; Extensions; Amendments; Termination;” and
 
    to purchase original notes in the open market, in privately negotiated transactions or otherwise, to the extent permitted by applicable law.
     The terms of any of these purchases or offers may differ from the terms of the exchange offer.
Withdrawal of Tenders
     Tenders of original notes may be withdrawn at any time prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the expiration date.
     For a withdrawal to be effective you must comply with the appropriate ATOP procedures. Any notice of withdrawal must specify the name and number of the account at DTC to be credited with withdrawn original notes and otherwise comply with the ATOP procedures.
     We will determine all questions as to the validity, form, eligibility and time of receipt of a notice of withdrawal. Our determination shall be final and binding on all parties. We will deem any original notes so withdrawn not to have been validly tendered for exchange for purposes of the exchange offer.

38


Table of Contents

     You may retender properly withdrawn original notes by following the procedures described under “—Procedures for Tendering” above at any time on or prior to the expiration date of the exchange offer.
     Any original notes that have been tendered for exchange but that are not exchanged for any reason will be credited to an account maintained with DTC for the original notes. This return or crediting will take place as soon as practicable after rejection of tender, expiration or termination of the exchange offer.
Conditions of the Exchange Offer
     Notwithstanding any other provisions of the exchange offer, we will not be required to accept for exchange, or to issue exchange notes in exchange for, any original notes and may terminate or amend the exchange offer, if at any time before the acceptance of original notes for exchange or the exchange of the exchange notes for original notes, that acceptance or issuance would violate applicable law or any interpretation of the staff of the SEC.
     That condition is for the sole benefit of the Company and may be asserted by the Company regardless of the circumstances giving rise to that condition. Our failure at any time to exercise the foregoing rights shall not be considered a waiver by us of that right. Our rights described in the prior paragraph are ongoing rights, which we may assert at any time and from time to time.
     In addition, we will not accept for exchange any original notes tendered, and no exchange notes will be issued in exchange for any original notes, if at that time any stop order shall be threatened or in effect with respect to the exchange offer to which this prospectus relates or the qualification of the indenture under the Trust Indenture Act. In any of those events we are required to use every reasonable effort to obtain the withdrawal of any stop order at the earliest possible moment.
Exchange Agent
     All executed letters of transmittal should be directed to the exchange agent at its address provided below. HSBC Bank USA, National Association, the trustee under the indenture, has been appointed as exchange agent for the exchange offer.
     Deliver to:
HSBC Bank USA, National Association
By Regular, Registered or Certified Mail,
By Overnight Courier or By Hand:
         
By Facsimile:
  HSBC Bank USA, National Association   Confirm by Telephone:
(718) 488-4488   Corporate Trust & Loan Agency   (800) 662-9844
    2 Hanson Place, 14th Floor    
    Brooklyn, New York 10217-1409    
Attention: Corporate Trust   Attention: Corporate Trust    
Operations   Operations    

39


Table of Contents

Information Agent
     D.F. King & Co., Inc. has been appointed as the information agent for the exchange offer. Questions and requests for assistance and requests for additional copies of this prospectus or the letter of transmittal should be directed to the information agent.
D.F. King & Co., Inc.
48 Wall Street, 22nd Floor
New York, New York 10005
Banks and Brokers Call (Collect): 212-269-5550
All Others Call (Toll Free): 800-290-6429
Fees and Expenses
     We will bear the expenses of soliciting tenders in the exchange offer. The principal solicitation for tenders in the exchange offer is being made by mail. Additional solicitations may be made by our officers and regular employees in person, by facsimile or by telephone.
     We have not retained any dealer-manager in connection with the exchange offer and will not make any payments to brokers, dealers or other persons soliciting acceptances of the exchange offer. We will, however, pay the exchange agent and information agent reasonable and customary fees for their services and reimburse them for their reasonable and documented out-of-pocket expenses in connection with these services. We may also pay brokerage houses and other custodians, nominees and fiduciaries the reasonable and documented out-of-pocket expenses they incur in forwarding copies of the prospectus, letters of transmittal and related documents to the beneficial owners of the original notes and in handling or forwarding tenders for exchange.
     We will pay the expenses to be incurred in connection with the exchange offer, including fees and expenses of the exchange agent, trustee and information agent and accounting and legal fees.
Resale Registration Statement; Special Interest Premium
     Under the registration rights agreement, if: (i) because of any change in law or in currently prevailing interpretations of the staff of the SEC, we are not permitted to effect the exchange offer, (ii) the exchange offer is not completed by March 23, 2009, (iii) in the case of any holder that participates in the exchange offer in accordance with the terms thereof, such holder does not receive exchange notes on the date of the exchange that may be sold without restriction under state and federal securities laws (other than due solely to the status of such holder as an affiliate of ours within the meaning of the Securities Act or as a broker-dealer), or (iv) we so elect, then in each case we will (1) promptly deliver to the holders written notice thereof and (2) at our sole expense, (a) file, as promptly as practicable (but in no event more than 45 days after so required pursuant to the registration rights agreement (such 45th day, the “Shelf Filing Date”)), a shelf registration statement covering resales of registrable notes, (b) use our reasonable best efforts to cause the shelf registration statement to be declared effective under the Securities Act and (c) use our reasonable best efforts to keep effective the shelf registration statement until May 27, 2010 or such time as all of the applicable registrable notes have been sold thereunder. We will, if a shelf registration statement is filed, provide to each holder of registrable notes copies of the prospectus that is a part of the shelf registration statement, notify each such holder when the shelf registration statement for the registrable notes has become effective and take certain other actions as are required to permit unrestricted resales of the registrable notes. A registrable note means any original note until such time as (i) when an exchange offer registration statement or shelf registration statement with respect to such note has become effective under the Securities Act and such original note has been exchanged or disposed of pursuant to such Registration Statement, (ii) when such original note ceases to be outstanding or (iii) May 27, 2010.
     The registration rights agreement further provides that in the event that:
     (i) the exchange offer is not consummated on or prior to February 21, 2009;
     (ii) the resale shelf registration statement is not filed with the SEC on or prior to the Shelf Filing Date;

40


Table of Contents

     (iii) subject to certain exceptions, the resale registration statement, if required, is not declared effective by the SEC prior to the 210th calendar day following the Shelf Filing Date,
then a special interest premium will accrue in respect of the registrable notes from and including the next calendar day following each of (a) February 21, 2009 in the case of clause (i) above, (b) the Shelf Filing Date in the case of clause (ii) above, and (c) such 210-day period in the case of clause (iii) above, in each case at a rate equal to 0.25% per annum for the first 120 calendar days following the registration default and at a rate equal to 0.50% per annum thereafter; provided that at no time shall the rate of special interest premium payable (including special interest premium payable pursuant to the following paragraph) exceed 0.50% per annum. If we are required to file a shelf registration statement and we request holders of the notes to provide the information called for by the registration rights agreement referred to herein for inclusion in the shelf registration statement, the notes owned by holders who do not deliver such information to us when required pursuant to the registration rights agreement will not be entitled to any such increase in the interest rate for any day after the shelf filing date. Upon (1) the consummation of the exchange offer after February 21, 2009, (2) the filing of a shelf registration statement after the Shelf Filing Date, or (3) the effectiveness of the shelf registration statement after the 210-day period described in clause (iii) above, the interest rate on the registrable notes from the day of such consummation, filing or effectiveness, as the case may be, will be reduced to the original interest rate set for the notes.
     If a shelf registration statement is declared effective pursuant to the foregoing paragraphs, and if we fail to keep such shelf registration statement continuously (x) effective or (y) useable for resales for the period required by the registration rights agreement due to certain circumstances relating to pending corporate developments, public filings with the SEC and similar events, or because the prospectus contains an untrue statement of a material fact or omits to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein not misleading, and such failure continues for more than 120 days (whether or not consecutive) in any twelve-month period (the 121st day being referred to as the “Default Day”), then from the Default Day until the earlier of (i) the date that the shelf registration statement is again deemed effective or is usable, (ii) May 27, 2010, or (iii) the date as of which all of the registrable notes are sold pursuant to the shelf registration statement, the special interest premium in respect of the registrable notes will accrue at a rate equal to 0.25% per annum for the first 90 calendar days following the Default Day and at a rate equal to 0.50% per annum thereafter; provided that at no time shall the rate of Special Interest Premium payable (including Special Interest Premium payable pursuant to the preceding paragraph) exceed 0.50% per annum.
     If we fail to keep the shelf registration statement continuously effective or useable for resales pursuant to the preceding paragraph or we fail to keep the exchange offer registration statement effective in connection with the use of this prospectus by participating broker-dealers as contemplated under “Plan of Distribution,” we will give the holders notice to suspend the sale of the registrable notes or the exchange notes as the case may be and will extend the relevant period referred to above during which we are required to keep effective the shelf registration statement or the period during which participating broker-dealers are entitled to use this prospectus in connection with the resale of exchange notes by the number of days during the period from and including the date of the giving of such notice to and including the earlier of: (i) the date when holders will have received copies of the supplemented or amended prospectus necessary to permit resales of the registrable notes or the exchange notes, as the case may be, and (ii) the date on which we have given notice that the sale of the registrable notes or the exchange notes, as the case may be, may be resumed.
     The registration rights agreement is governed by, and shall be construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of New York. The summary herein of certain provisions of the registration rights agreement does not purport to be complete and is subject to, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, all the provisions of the registration rights agreement, which is attached as an exhibit to the registration statement on Form F-4.
Other
     Participation in this exchange offer is voluntary, and you should carefully consider whether to participate. You are urged to consult your financial and tax advisors in making your own decision as to what action to take.

41


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF EXCHANGE NOTES
     This section of the prospectus summarizes the material terms of the indenture and the exchange notes. It does not, however, describe all of the terms of the indenture and the exchange notes. We refer you to the indenture, which has been filed as an exhibit to the registration statement on Form F-4. Upon request, we will provide you with a copy of the indenture. See “Where You Can Find More Information” for information concerning how to obtain a copy.
     In this section and in the sections entitled “The Exchange Offer” and “Form of Notes, Clearing and Settlement,” references to “we,” “us,” “the Company” and “our” are to ArcelorMittal only and do not include our subsidiaries or affiliates. References to the “notes” include both the exchange notes and the original notes.
     References to “holders” mean those who have notes registered in their names on the books that we or the trustee maintain for this purpose, and not those who own beneficial interests in notes issued in book-entry form through The Depository Trust Company, or DTC, or in notes registered in street name. Owners of beneficial interests in the notes should refer to “Form of Notes, Clearing and Settlement.”
General
     The exchange notes will be identical in all material respects to the original notes, except that the exchange notes are registered under the Securities Act and will therefore not bear legends restricting their transfer.
     We will issue the 2013 exchange notes and the 2018 exchange notes under an indenture dated as of May 27, 2008, between us and HSBC Bank USA, National Association, as trustee. References to the “notes” include both the exchange notes and the original notes. The terms of the notes include those expressly set forth in the indenture and those made part of the indenture by reference to the U.S. Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended. This description of the notes is intended to be a useful overview of the material provisions of the notes and the indenture. Because this description is only a summary, you should refer to the indenture for a complete description of our obligations and your rights.
     The 2013 exchange notes will be issued in an aggregate principal amount of up to $1,500,000,000 and the 2018 exchange notes will be issued in an aggregate principal amount of up to $1,500,000,000, subject to our ability to issue additional notes, which may be of the same series as the 2013 exchange notes or the 2018 exchange notes, as described below under “— Additional Notes.”
     The indenture and the exchange notes do not limit the amount of indebtedness that may be incurred or the amount of securities that may be issued by us, and contain no financial or similar restrictions on us, except as described below under “— Negative Pledge” and “— Consolidation, Merger, Conveyance or Transfer.”
     The notes will be issued in registered, book-entry form only without interest coupons in denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.
Ranking
     The notes will be our unsecured and unsubordinated obligations and will rank equally with all of our existing and future unsecured and unsubordinated debt (including indebtedness and guarantees).
Payments of Principal and Interest
     The 2013 exchange notes will mature on June 1, 2013, and will bear interest at a rate of 5.375% per annum. The 2018 exchange notes will mature on June 1, 2018, and will bear interest at a rate of 6.125% per annum. We will pay interest on the exchange notes semi-annually in arrears on June 1 and December 1 of each year, commencing on December 1, 2008, to the holders in whose names the exchange notes are registered at the close of business on the May 15 and November 15, respectively, immediately preceding the relevant interest payment date. Interest on the

42


Table of Contents

notes will accrue from the issuance date of the notes, or, from the most recent interest payment date on which the interest has been paid to (but excluding) the relevant interest payment date. The period beginning on the issuance date and ending on the first interest payment date and each successive period beginning on an interest payment date and ending on the next succeeding interest payment date is called an “Interest Period.” The amount of interest payable on the exchange notes for any Interest Period will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months.
     Unless previously redeemed or purchased by us and cancelled, we will repay the notes in cash at 100% of their principal amount together with accrued and unpaid interest thereon at maturity. Interest will cease to accrue on the notes on the due date for their redemption, unless, upon such due date, payment of principal is improperly withheld or refused or if default is otherwise made in respect of payment of principal, in which case interest will continue to accrue on the notes at the rates set forth above, as the case may be, until the earlier of (a) the day on which all sums due in respect of such notes up to that day are received by the relevant holder or (b) the day falling seven days after the trustee has notified the holders of receipt of all sums due in respect of the such notes up to that seventh day, except to the extent that there is failure in the subsequent payment to the relevant holders following such notification.
     We will pay principal of and interest on the notes in U.S. dollars. The notes will not be redeemable by us, except as described below under “— Redemption, Exchange and Purchase.”
     If an interest payment date or the maturity date in respect of the notes is not a “Business Day” in the place of payment, we will pay interest or principal, as the case may be, on the next Business Day. Payments postponed to the next Business Day in this situation will be treated under the indenture as if they were made on the original due date. Postponement of this kind will not result in a default under the notes or the indenture, and no interest will accrue on the postponed amount from the original due date to the next day that is a Business Day. The term “Business Day” means any day other than a Saturday or Sunday or a day on which applicable law authorizes or requires banking institutions in The City of New York, New York, Paris or Luxembourg or any place of payment to close.
Additional Notes
     ArcelorMittal reserves the right, without the consent of the holders of the notes, to create and issue additional notes ranking equally with any series of the notes in all respects, so that such additional notes will be consolidated and form a single series with the relevant series of notes and will have the same terms as to status, redemption or otherwise as such series of the notes; provided, that such additional notes will be issued with no more than de minimis original issue discount for U.S. federal income tax purposes or be part of a qualified reopening for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
Additional Amounts
     All payments of principal of, and premium (if any) and interest on the notes will be made without withholding or deduction for, or on account of, any present or future taxes, duties, assessments or governmental charges of whatever nature imposed or levied by or within Luxembourg (or in the case of a successor entity any jurisdiction in which such successor entity is organized or resident for tax purposes (or any political subdivision or taxing authority thereof or therein)) (each, as applicable, a “Relevant Jurisdiction”), unless such withholding or deduction is required by law or by regulation or governmental policy having the force of law. In the event that any such withholding or deduction is so required, we or any successor entity, as the case may be, will make such deduction or withholding, make payment of the amount so withheld to the appropriate governmental authority and will pay such additional amounts (“Additional Amounts”) as will result in receipt by the holders of such amounts as would have been received by the holders had no such withholding or deduction been required by the Relevant Jurisdiction, except that no Additional Amounts will be payable:
          (a) for or on account of:
     (i) any tax, duty, assessment or other governmental charge that would not have been imposed but for:

43


Table of Contents

     (A) the existence of any present or former connection between the holder or beneficial owner of such note, as the case may be, and the Relevant Jurisdiction including, without limitation, such holder or beneficial owner being or having been a citizen or resident of such Relevant Jurisdiction or treated as a resident thereof or being or having been physically present or engaged in a trade or business therein or having or having had a permanent establishment therein, other than merely holding such note or the receipt of payments thereunder;
     (B) the presentation of such note (where presentation is required) more than 30 days after the later of the date on which the payment of the principal of, premium, if any, or interest on, such note became due and payable pursuant to the terms thereof or was made or duly provided for, except to the extent that the holder thereof would have been entitled to such Additional Amounts if it had presented such note for payment on any date within such 30-day period;
     (C) the failure of the holder or beneficial owner to comply with a timely request of us or any successor entity addressed to the holder or beneficial owner, as the case may be, to provide information, documentation and certification concerning such holder’s or beneficial owner’s nationality, residence, identity or connection with any Relevant Jurisdiction, if and to the extent that due and timely compliance with such request would under applicable law, regulation or administrative practice have reduced or eliminated any withholding or deduction as to which Additional Amounts would have otherwise been payable to such holder; or
     (D) the presentation of such note (where presentation is required) for payment in the Relevant Jurisdiction, unless such note could not have been presented for payment elsewhere;
     (ii) any estate, inheritance, gift, sale, transfer, excise or personal property or similar tax, assessment or other governmental charge;
     (iii) any withholding or deduction in respect of any tax, duty, assessment or other governmental charge where such withholding or deduction is imposed or levied on a payment to an individual and is required to be made pursuant to European Council Directive 2003/48/EC or any other Directive implementing the conclusions of the ECOFIN Council meeting of November 26-27, 2000 on the taxation of savings income or any law implementing or complying with, or introduced in order to conform to, such Directives; or
     (iv) any combination of taxes, duties, assessments or other governmental charges referred to in the preceding clauses (i), (ii) and (iii); or
     (b) with respect to any payment of the principal of, or premium, if any, or interest on, such note to a holder who is a fiduciary, partnership or Person other than the sole beneficial owner of any payment to the extent that such payment would be required to be included in the income under the laws of a Relevant Jurisdiction, for tax purposes, of a beneficiary or settlor with respect to the fiduciary, or a member of that partnership or a beneficial owner who would not have been entitled to such Additional Amounts had that beneficiary, settlor, partner, or beneficial owner been the holder thereof.
     Whenever there is mentioned in any context the payment of principal of, and any premium or interest on, any note, such mention will be deemed to include payment of Additional Amounts provided for in the indenture to the extent that, in such context, Additional Amounts are, were or would be payable in respect thereof.
Redemption, Exchange and Purchase
     As explained below, we may redeem the notes before they mature. This means that we may repay them early. You have no right to require us to redeem the notes. Unless we default in payment of the redemption price, on and after the redemption date, interest will cease to accrue on the notes or portions thereof called for redemption.

44


Table of Contents

Redemption at the Option of the Company
     We will have the right to redeem the notes of any series, in whole or in part from time to time, at our option, on at least 30 days’ but no more than 60 days’ prior written notice given to the registered holders of such series of notes to be redeemed. Upon redemption of the notes, we will pay a redemption price equal to the greater of (1) 100% of the principal amount of the notes to be redeemed and (2) the sum of the present values of the Remaining Scheduled Payments (as defined below) of the notes to be redeemed, discounted to the date of redemption on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the Treasury Rate (as defined below) plus 40 basis points, in each case plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the redemption date.
     “Treasury Rate” means, for any redemption date, the rate per annum equal to the semiannual equivalent yield to maturity, of the Comparable Treasury Issue, assuming a price for the Comparable Treasury Issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the Comparable Treasury Price for that redemption date.
     “Comparable Treasury Issue” means the United States Treasury security selected by an Independent Investment Banker as having a maturity comparable to the remaining term of the notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of the notes to be redeemed.
     “Comparable Treasury Price” means, with respect to any redemption date (1) the average of the Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations for such redemption date, after excluding the highest and lowest of the Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations, or (2) if the Independent Investment Banker obtains fewer than four Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations, the average of all of these quotations.
     “Independent Investment Banker” means one of the Reference Treasury Dealers appointed by us, each of BNP Paribas Securities Corp., Goldman, Sachs & Co., J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc. (or their respective affiliates that are primary U.S. Government securities dealers), and their respective successors, or if at any time any of the above is not a primary U.S. Government securities dealer, one other nationally recognized investment banking firm selected by us that is a primary U.S. Government securities dealer.
     “Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations” means, with respect to each Reference Treasury Dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by the Independent Investment Banker, of the bid and asked prices for the Comparable Treasury Issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the Independent Investment Banker by such Reference Treasury Dealer at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the third Business Day preceding such redemption date.
     “Remaining Scheduled Payments” means, with respect to each note to be redeemed, the remaining scheduled payments of the principal thereof and interest thereon that would be due after the related redemption date for such redemption; provided, however, that, if such redemption date is not an interest payment date with respect to such note, the amount of the next succeeding scheduled interest payment thereon will be reduced by the amount of interest accrued thereon to such redemption date.
     The notice of redemption will state any conditions applicable to a redemption and the amount of notes of any series to be redeemed. If less than all the notes of any series are to be redeemed, the notes of such series to be redeemed shall be selected by the trustee by such method as the trustee deems fair and appropriate.
     Except as described under “— Redemption for Taxation Reasons,” the notes will not otherwise be redeemable by us at our option prior to maturity.
Redemption for Taxation Reasons
     The notes may be redeemed, at our option, in whole but not in part, upon giving not less than 30 days’ nor more than 60 days’ notice to the holders (which notice will be irrevocable), at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof, together with accrued and unpaid interest (including any Additional Amounts), if any, to the date fixed by the Company for redemption (the “Tax Redemption Date”) if, as a result of:

45


Table of Contents

     (1) any change in, or amendment to, the laws (or any regulations or rulings promulgated thereunder) of a Relevant Jurisdiction affecting taxation; or
     (2) any change in, or amendment to, an official position regarding the application or interpretation of such laws, regulations or rulings (including a holding, judgment or order by a court of competent jurisdiction),
which change or amendment becomes effective (i) in the case of us, on or after May 27, 2008 or (ii) in the case of any successor entity, on or after the date such successor entity becomes obligated under the notes or the indenture, with respect to any payment due or to become due under the notes or the indenture, we or the successor entity, as the case may be, is, or on the next interest payment date would be, required to pay Additional Amounts, and such requirement cannot be avoided by us or the successor entity, as the case may be, taking reasonable measures available to it; provided that for the avoidance of doubt changing the jurisdiction of us or any successor entity is not a reasonable measure for the purposes of this section; and provided, further that no such notice of redemption will be given earlier than 60 days prior to the earliest date on which we, or any successor entity, as the case may be, would be obligated to pay such Additional Amounts if a payment in respect of the notes were then due.
     Prior to the giving of any notice of redemption of the notes pursuant to the foregoing, we or the successor entity, as the case may be, will deliver to the trustee:
     (1) a certificate signed by a duly authorized officer stating that such change or amendment referred to in the prior paragraph has occurred, and describing the facts related thereto and stating that such requirement cannot be avoided by us or a successor entity, as the case may be, taking reasonable measures available to it; and
     (2) an opinion of legal counsel of recognized standing stating that the requirement to pay such Additional Amounts results from such change or amendment referred to in the prior paragraph.
     The trustee will accept such certificate and opinion as sufficient evidence of the satisfaction of the conditions precedent described above, in which event it will be conclusive and binding on the holders.
     Any notes that are redeemed will be cancelled.
Offer to Purchase upon a Change of Control
     Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, unless we have exercised our right to redeem the notes as described under “— Redemption for Taxation Reasons” or under “— Redemption at the Option of the Company,” or unless the Change of Control Payment Date as described below would fall on or after the maturity date of the notes, the indenture provides that we will make an offer to purchase all or a portion of each holder’s notes pursuant to the offer described below (the “Change of Control Offer”), at a purchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount tendered plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of purchase.
     Within 30 days following the date upon which the Change of Control occurred, or at our option, prior to any Change of Control but after the public announcement of the pending Change of Control, we will be required to send, by first class mail, a notice to each holder of notes, with a copy to the trustee, which notice will govern the terms of the Change of Control Offer. Such notice will state, among other things, the purchase date, which must be no earlier than 30 days nor later than 60 days from the date such notice is mailed, other than as may be required by law (the “Change of Control Payment Date”). The notice, if mailed prior to the date of consummation of the Change of Control, will state that the Change of Control Offer is conditioned on the Change of Control being consummated on or prior to the Change of Control Payment Date. Holders of notes electing to have notes purchased pursuant to a Change of Control Offer will be required to tender the notes in accordance with the terms of the Change of Control Offer prior to the close of business on the third Business Day prior to the Change of Control Payment Date.
     On the Change of Control Payment Date, we will, to the extent lawful:
    accept for payment all notes or portions thereof properly tendered pursuant to the Change of Control Offer;

46


Table of Contents

    deposit with the paying agent and instruct the paying agent in writing to pay an amount equal to the purchase price in respect of all notes or portions thereof so tendered; and
 
    deliver or cause to be delivered to the trustee the notes so accepted together with an officer’s certificate stating the aggregate principal amount of notes or portions thereof being purchased by us.
     Upon receipt of the foregoing, the paying agent will promptly mail or wire to each holder of notes so tendered the purchase price for such notes, and the trustee, upon instruction by the Company and in accordance with the indenture, will promptly authenticate and mail or cause to be transferred by book entry to each holder a new note equal in principal amount to any unpurchased portion of the notes surrendered, if any; provided that each such new note will be in a principal amount of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof. We will publicly announce the results of the Change of Control Offer on or as soon as practicable after the Change of Control Payment Date.
     We shall comply with the requirements of Rule 14e-1 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), and any other securities laws and regulations thereunder to the extent those laws and regulations are applicable in connection with the repurchase of the notes as a result of a Change of Control. To the extent that the provisions of any such securities laws or regulations conflict with the Change of Control Offer provisions of the notes, we shall comply with those securities laws and regulations and shall not be deemed to have breached our obligations under the Change of Control Offer provisions of the notes by virtue of any such conflict.
     The trustee is under no obligation to ascertain whether a Change of Control or any event that could lead to the occurrence of or could constitute a Change of Control has occurred, and until it has actual knowledge or express notice to the contrary, the trustee may assume that no Change of Control or other such event has occurred.
Exchange and Purchase
     We may at any time make offers to the holders to exchange their notes for other bonds or notes issued by us or any other Person. In addition, we and any of our Subsidiaries or affiliates may at any time purchase notes in the open market or otherwise at any price.
Cancellation
     All notes that are exchanged or purchased may either be held or retransferred or resold or be surrendered for cancellation and, if so surrendered, will, together with all notes redeemed by us, be cancelled immediately and accordingly may not be reissued or resold. The trustee will make its record of any such cancellation available for inspection to holders during its normal business hours.
Consolidation, Merger, Conveyance or Transfer
     So long as any of the notes are outstanding, we will not consolidate with or merge into any other Person (excluding Persons controlled by one or more members of the Mittal Family) or convey or transfer substantially all of our properties and assets to any other Person (excluding Persons controlled by one or more members of the Mittal Family) unless thereafter:
     (i) the Person formed by such consolidation or into which we are merged, or the Person which acquired all or substantially all of our properties and assets, expressly assumes pursuant to a supplemental indenture, as provided for in the indenture, the due and punctual payment of the principal of and interest on the notes and the performance or observance of every covenant of the indenture on our part to be performed or observed (including, if such Person is not organized in or a resident of Luxembourg for tax purposes, substituting such Person’s jurisdiction of organization or residence for Luxembourg for tax purposes where applicable, including for the obligation to pay Additional Amounts);
     (ii) immediately after giving effect to such transaction, no event of default has occurred and is continuing; and

47


Table of Contents

     (iii) the Person formed by such consolidation or into which we are merged, or the Person which acquired all or substantially all of our properties and assets delivers to the trustee an officer’s certificate signed by a duly authorized officer and an opinion of legal counsel of recognized standing, each stating that the consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer and, if a supplemental indenture is required in connection with the transaction, the supplemental indenture comply with the indenture and that all conditions precedent in the indenture relating to the transaction have been complied with and, immediately after giving effect to the transaction, no event of default has occurred and is continuing, except that such certificate and opinion shall not be required in the event that any such consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer is made by any court or tribunal having jurisdiction over us, our properties and our assets.
Negative Pledge
     The indenture provides that so long as any of the notes remain outstanding, we will not, and will not permit any Material Subsidiary to, create or permit to subsist any Security upon any of our Assets or their respective Assets, as the case may be, present or future, to secure any Relevant Indebtedness incurred or guaranteed by us or by any such Material Subsidiary (whether before or after the issue of the notes) other than Permitted Security, unless our obligations under the notes are (i) equally and ratably secured so as to rank pari passu with such Relevant Indebtedness or the guarantee thereof or (ii) benefit from any other Security or arrangement as is approved by the holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the notes of the affected series then outstanding.
Events of Default
          Each of the following will be an event of default under the indenture:
     (1) the default in any payment of principal on any note when due, whether on maturity, redemption or otherwise, continues for 15 days;
     (2) the default in any payment of interest, premium (if any) and Additional Amounts (if any), on any note when due, continues for 30 days;
     (3) our failure to comply with our other obligations contained in the indenture and the default or breach continues for a period of 60 days or more after we receive written notice from the trustee as provided for in the indenture;
     (4) our failure, or the failure of any Material Subsidiary, (a) to pay the principal of any indebtedness for borrowed money, including obligations evidenced by any mortgage, indenture, bond, debenture, note, guarantee or other similar instruments on the scheduled or original date due (following the giving of such notice, if any, as required under the document governing such indebtedness and as extended by any applicable cure period or (b) to observe or perform any agreement or condition relating to such indebtedness such that such indebtedness has come due prior to its stated maturity and such acceleration has not been cured, unless (in the case of clauses (a) and (b)) (i) the aggregate amount of such indebtedness is less than €100,000,000 or (ii) the question of whether such indebtedness is due has been disputed in good faith by appropriate proceedings and such dispute has not been finally adjudicated against us or the Material Subsidiary, as the case may be;
     (5) certain events of bankruptcy or insolvency involving our company or a Material Subsidiary.
     Upon the occurrence and continuation of any event of default as provided for in the indenture, then in every such case the trustee or the holders of at least 25% in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding notes of the affected series may declare the principal amount of the outstanding notes of that series to be due and payable immediately, by a notice in writing to the Company (and to the trustee if given by Holders). Upon any such declaration, which we call a declaration of acceleration, the notes of such series shall become due and payable immediately.
     The holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding notes of the affected series may rescind a declaration of acceleration if an amount has been paid to or deposited with the trustee sufficient to pay the

48


Table of Contents

amounts set forth in the applicable provisions of the indenture and all events of default with respect to the notes of such series, other than the failure to pay the principal and other amounts of notes of that series that have become due solely by such declaration of acceleration, have been cured or waived.
     If an event of default occurs or if we breach any covenant or warranty under the indenture or the notes, the trustee may pursue any available remedy to enforce any provision of the notes or the indenture. The trustee may maintain a proceeding even if it does not possess any of the notes or does not produce any of them in the proceeding. A delay or omission by the trustee or any holder of a note in exercising any right or remedy accruing upon an event of default shall not impair the right or remedy or constitute a waiver of or acquiescence in the event of default. All remedies are cumulative to the extent permitted by law.
     Except in cases of default, where the trustee has some special duties, the trustee is not required to take any action under the indenture at the request of any holders unless the holders offer the trustee reasonable protection from expenses and liability. This protection is called an indemnity. If reasonable indemnity is provided, the holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding notes of the relevant series may direct the time, method and place of conducting any lawsuit or other proceeding seeking any remedy available to the trustee. These majority holders may also direct the trustee in performing any other action the trustee may undertake under the indenture.
     Before you bypass the trustee and bring your own lawsuit or other formal legal action or take other steps to enforce your rights or protect your interests relating to the notes you hold, the following must occur:
    You must give the trustee written notice at its Corporate Trust Office that an event of default has occurred and remains uncured.
 
    The holders of 25% in principal amount of all outstanding notes of the relevant series must make a written request that the trustee take action because of the event of default, and must offer reasonable indemnity to the trustee against the cost and other liabilities of taking that action and provide such written request to the Corporate Trust Office of the trustee.
 
    The trustee must have not taken action for 60 days after receipt of the above notice, request and offer of indemnity.
 
    No direction inconsistent with such written request must have been given to the trustee during such 60-day period by holders of a majority in principal amount of all outstanding notes of that series.
     Nothing, however, will prevent an individual holder from bringing suit to enforce payment.
Street name and other indirect holders should consult their banks or brokers for information on how to give notice or direction to or make a request of the trustee and to make or cancel a declaration of acceleration.
     We will furnish to the trustee every year a brief certification of an officer of our Company as to his or her knowledge of our compliance with the conditions and covenants of the indenture.
Amendments and Waivers
     The indenture may be amended or modified without the consent of any holder of notes in order to:
    to cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency;
 
    to provide for the issuance of additional notes in accordance with the limitations set forth in the indenture as of the date thereof;
 
    to comply with any requirements of the SEC in connection with qualifying the indenture under the Trust Indenture Act;

49


Table of Contents

    to provide for the issuance of exchange notes in accordance with the registration rights agreement;
 
    to correct or add any other provisions with respect to matters or questions arising under this indenture, so long as that correction or added provision will not adversely affect the interests of the holders of the notes in any material respect; or
 
    to provide for the assumption by a successor company of our obligations under the notes and the indenture in the case of a merger or consolidation or sale of all or substantially all of our assets.
     Modifications and amendments of the indenture may be made by us and the trustee with the consent of the holders of a majority in principal amount of the notes of the affected series then outstanding under the indenture. In addition, the holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding notes of any series may waive any past default under the indenture, except an uncured default in the payment of principal of or interest on such series of notes or an uncured default relating to a covenant or provision of the indenture that cannot be modified or amended without the consent of each affected holder.
     Notwithstanding the above, without the consent of each holder of an outstanding note affected, no amendment may, among other things:
    modify the stated maturity of the notes or the dates on which interest is payable in respect of the notes;
 
    reduce or cancel the principal amount of, or interest on, the notes;
 
    change the currency of payment of the notes;
 
    impair the right of the holders of notes to institute suit for the enforcement of any payment on or after the date due;
 
    reduce the percentage in principal amount of the outstanding notes, the consent of whose holders is required for any modification of or waiver of compliance with any provision of this indenture or defaults under the indenture and their consequences; and
 
    modify the provisions of the indenture regarding the quorum required at any meeting of holders.
Special Rules for Action by Holders
     When holders take any action under the indenture, such as giving a notice of an event of default, declaring an acceleration, approving any change or waiver or giving the trustee an instruction, the Company will apply the following rules.
Only Outstanding Notes are Eligible
     Only holders of outstanding notes will be eligible to participate in any action by holders. Also, the Company will count only outstanding notes in determining whether the various percentage requirements for taking action have been met. For these purposes, a note will not be “outstanding” if it has been surrendered for cancellation or if the Company has deposited or set aside, in trust for its holder, money for its payment or redemption; provided, however, that, for such purposes, notes held by the Company or its affiliates are not considered outstanding.
Determining Record Dates for Action by Holders
     The Company will generally be entitled to set any day as a record date for the purpose of determining the holders that are entitled to take action under the indenture. In some limited circumstances, only the trustee will be entitled to set a record date for action by holders. If the Company or the trustee set a record date for an approval or other action to be taken by holders, that vote or action may be taken only by persons or entities who are holders on

50


Table of Contents

the record date and must be taken during the period that the Company specifies for this purpose, or that the trustee specifies if it sets the record date. The Company or the trustee, as applicable, may shorten or lengthen this period from time to time, but not beyond 90 days.
Satisfaction and Discharge
     The indenture will be discharged and will cease to be of further effect as to all outstanding notes of any series issued thereunder, when either (i) all notes of that series that have been authenticated, except lost, stolen or destroyed notes that have been replaced or paid and notes for whose payment money has theretofore been deposited in trust and thereafter repaid to us, have been delivered to the trustee for cancellation, or all notes of that series that have not been delivered to the trustee for cancellation have become due and payable by reason of the giving of a notice of redemption or otherwise or will become due and payable within one year and we have irrevocably deposited or caused to be deposited with the trustee as trust funds in trust solely for the benefit of the holders, cash in U.S. dollars, non-callable U.S. government securities, or a combination thereof, in such amounts as will be sufficient, without consideration of any reinvestment of interest, to pay and discharge the entire indebtedness on the notes of such series not delivered to the trustee for cancellation for principal and accrued interest and Additional Amounts, if any, to the date of maturity or redemption; (ii) we have paid or caused to be paid all sums payable by us under the indenture with respect to such series; and (iii) we have delivered irrevocable instructions to the trustee to apply the deposited money toward the payment of the notes of such series at maturity or on the redemption date, as the case may be.
     In addition, we must deliver a certificate signed by a duly authorized officer stating that all conditions precedent to the satisfaction and discharge have been satisfied.
Defeasance and Covenant Defeasance
     The indenture will provide that we may elect either (1) to defease and be discharged from any and all obligations with respect to any series of notes (except for, among other things, certain obligations to register the transfer or exchange of such series of notes, to replace temporary or mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen notes of such series, to maintain an office or agency with respect to the notes of such series and to hold moneys for payment in trust) (“legal defeasance”) or (2) to be released from our obligations to comply with certain covenants under the indenture, and any omission to comply with such obligations will not constitute a default (any event that is, or with the passage of time or the giving of notice or both would be, an event of default) or an event of default with respect to the notes (“covenant defeasance”). Legal defeasance or covenant defeasance, as the case may be, will be conditioned upon, among other things, (A) the irrevocable deposit by us with the trustee, in trust, of an amount in U.S. dollars, or U.S. government securities, or both, applicable to the notes of such series which through the scheduled payment of principal and interest in accordance with their terms will provide money in an amount sufficient to pay the principal or premium, if any, and interest on the notes of such series on the scheduled due dates therefor and (B) no event of default or default with respect to the notes of the series shall have occurred and be continuing on the date of such deposit.
     To effect legal defeasance or covenant defeasance, we will be required to deliver to the trustee an opinion of counsel that the deposit and related defeasance will not cause the holders and beneficial owners of the notes of such series to recognize income, gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes. If we elect legal defeasance, that opinion of counsel must be based upon a ruling from the U.S. Internal Revenue Service or a change in law to that effect.
     We may exercise our legal defeasance option notwithstanding our prior exercise of our covenant defeasance option.
Payment
     Payments in respect of the notes will be made by HSBC Bank USA, National Association, in its capacity as paying agent in New York to the registered holder(s). The paying agent will treat the persons in whose name the

51


Table of Contents

registered global notes representing the notes are registered as the owners thereof for purposes of making such payments and for any other purposes whatsoever.
     Subject to any applicable abandoned property law, the trustee and the paying agent will pay to the Company upon request any money held by them for the payment of principal of, premium or interest on the notes that remains unclaimed for two years, and, thereafter, holders entitled to the money must look to the Company for payment as general creditors.
Governing Law
     The notes will be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York.
Consent to Jurisdiction
     We have irrevocably submitted to the non-exclusive jurisdiction of any New York State court or any U.S. federal court sitting in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York, in respect of any legal action or proceeding arising out of or in relation to the indenture or the notes, and have agreed that all claims in respect of such legal action or proceeding may be heard and determined in such New York State or U.S. federal court and waived, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the defense of an inconvenient forum to the maintenance of any such action or proceeding in any such court.
Notices
     Notices to the holders will be provided to the addresses that appear on the security register of the notes.
Concerning the Trustee
     HSBC Bank USA, National Association, is the trustee under the indenture and has been appointed by us as registrar and paying agent with respect to the notes.
Certain Definitions
     Set forth below is a summary of certain of the defined terms used in the indenture. You should refer to the indenture for the full definition of all such terms, as well as any other terms used in this prospectus for which no definition is provided.
     “Applicable Accounting Standards” means the International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IFRS”), as amended from time to time.
     “Asset(s)” of any Person means, all or any part of its business, undertaking, property, assets, revenues (including any right to receive revenues) and uncalled capital, wherever situated.
     A “Change of Control” shall be deemed to have occurred at each time that a Person (or a group of Persons acting in concert) other than one or more members of the Mittal Family controls or acquires control of us; provided that a Change of Control shall not be deemed to have occurred unless, within the Change of Control Period, (i) if our long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness is rated by any one or more Rating Agencies, a Rating Downgrade in respect of that Change of Control occurs and, in the case only of such Rating Downgrade occurring within the Potential Change of Control Period, the relevant Rating Agency does not, within the Potential Change of Control Period, reverse such Rating Downgrade so that our long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness has the same or a better credit rating attributed by such Rating Agency than before such Rating Downgrade occurred, or (ii) if our long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness is not rated by any one or more Rating Agencies, a Negative Rating Event in respect of that Change of Control occurs; “control” means the power to direct the management and policies of an entity, whether through the ownership of voting capital, by contract or otherwise.

52


Table of Contents

          “Change of Control Period” means the period commencing on the earlier of (i) the date of the first public announcement of the relevant Change of Control having occurred and (ii) the first day of the Potential Change of Control Period, and ending 90 days after the date of the first public announcement of the relevant Change of Control having occurred (the “Initial End Date”), provided that if one or more Rating Agencies has on or prior to the Initial End Date publicly announced that it has placed the rating of our long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness under consideration for rating downgrade (the “Placing on Credit Watch”), the Change of Control Period shall be extended to the earlier of (i) the later of (a) the date which falls 60 days after the date of the Placing on Credit Watch and (b) the Initial End Date or (ii) the date which falls 60 days after the Initial End Date.
          “Consolidated Financial Statements” means our most recently published:
     (a) audited annual consolidated financial statements, as approved by the annual general meeting of our shareholders and certified by an independent auditor; or, as the case may be,
     (b) unaudited (but subject to a “review” from an independent auditor) consolidated half-year financial statements, as approved by our Board of Directors,
in each case prepared in accordance with Applicable Accounting Standards.
          “Corporate Trust Office” means, with respect to the trustee, HSBC Bank USA, National Association, 10 East 40th Street, 14th floor, New York, NY 10016, Attn: Corporate Loan and Agency Group.
          “Existing Security” means any Security granted by any Person over its Assets in respect of any Relevant Indebtedness and which is existing at May 27, 2008 or at the time any such Person becomes a Material Subsidiary or whose business and/or activities, in whole or in part, are assumed by or vested in us or a Material Subsidiary after May 27, 2008 (other than any Security created in contemplation thereof) or any substitute Security created over those Assets (or any part thereof) in connection with the refinancing of the Relevant Indebtedness secured on those Assets provided that the principal, nominal or capital amount secured on any such Security may not be increased.
          “Fitch” means Fitch Inc., and its successors.
          “Group” means our company and its Subsidiaries taken as a whole.
          “Investment Grade Rating” means a rating equal to or higher than Baa3 by Moody’s (or its equivalent under any successor rating category of Moody’s), BBB- by S&P (or its equivalent under any successor rating category of S&P) and BBB- by Fitch (or its equivalent under any successor rating category of Fitch) and the equivalent investment grade credit rating from any replacement rating agency or rating agencies selected by us.
          “Material Subsidiary” means, at any time, a Subsidiary of ours whose gross assets or pre-tax profits (excluding intra-Group items) then equal or exceed 5% of the gross assets or pre-tax profits of the Group.
          For this purpose:
     (a) the gross assets or pre-tax profits of a Subsidiary will be determined from its financial statements (unconsolidated if it has Subsidiaries) upon which the latest audited Consolidated Financial Statements of the Group have been based;
     (b) if a company becomes a member of the Group after the date on which the latest audited Consolidated Financial Statements of the Group have been prepared, the gross assets or pre-tax profits of that Subsidiary will be determined from its latest financial statements;
     (c) the gross assets or pre-tax profits of the Group will be determined from its latest audited Consolidated Financial Statements, adjusted (where appropriate) to reflect the gross assets or pre-tax profits of any company or business subsequently acquired or disposed of; and

53


Table of Contents

     (d) if a Material Subsidiary disposes of all or substantially all of its assets to another Subsidiary of ours, it will immediately cease to be a Material Subsidiary and the other Subsidiary (if it is not already) will immediately become a Material Subsidiary; the subsequent financial statements of those Subsidiaries and the Group will be used to determine whether those Subsidiaries are Material Subsidiaries or not.
     If there is a dispute as to whether or not a company is a Material Subsidiary, a certificate of our auditors will be, in the absence of manifest error, conclusive and binding on us and the holders.
     “Mittal Family” means Mr. and/or Mrs. L.N. Mittal and/or their family (acting directly or indirectly through trusts and/or other entities controlled by any of the foregoing).
     “Moody’s” means Moody’s Investors Service, Inc., and its successors.
     “Negative Rating Event” means we do not within the Change of Control Period obtain an investment grade rating for our long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness from at least one Rating Agency.
 
    “Permitted Security” means:
     (a) any Existing Security;
     (b) any Security granted in respect of or in connection with any Securitization Indebtedness; or
     (c) any Security securing Project Finance Indebtedness, but only to the extent that the Security Interest is created on an asset of the project being financed by the relevant Project Finance Indebtedness (and/or the shares in, and/or shareholder loans to, the company conducting such project where such company has no assets other than those relating to such project).
          “Person” includes any individual, company, corporation, firm, partnership, joint venture, undertaking, association, organization, trust, state or agency of a state (in each case, whether or not having separate legal personality).
          “Potential Change of Control Period” means the period commencing on the date of the first public announcement of a potential Change of Control by us, or by any actual or potential bidder or any adviser thereto, and ending on the date of the first public announcement of the relevant Change of Control.
          “Project Finance Indebtedness” means any indebtedness incurred by a debtor to finance the ownership, acquisition, construction, development and/or operation of an Asset or connected group of Assets in respect of which the Person or Persons to whom such indebtedness is, or may be, owed have no recourse for the repayment of or payment of any sum relating to such indebtedness other than:
     (a) recourse to such debtor or its Subsidiaries for amounts limited to the cash flow from such Asset; and/or
     (b) recourse to such debtor generally, or to a member of the Group, which recourse is limited to a claim for damages (other than liquidated damages and damages required to be calculated in a specific way) for breach of an obligation, representation or warranty (not being a payment obligation, representation or warranty or an obligation, representation or warranty to procure payment by another or an obligation, representation or warranty to comply or to procure compliance by another with any financial ratios or other test of financial condition) by the Person against whom such recourse is available; and/or
     (c) if:
     (i) such debtor has been established specifically for the purpose of constructing, developing, owning and/or operating the relevant Asset or connected group of Assets; and

54


Table of Contents

     (ii) such debtor owns no Assets and carries on no business which is not related to the relevant Asset or connected group of Assets,
     recourse to all the material Assets and undertaking of such debtor and the shares in the capital of such debtor and shareholder loans made to such debtor.
          “Rating Agency” means (1) each of Moody’s, S&P and Fitch; (2) if any of Moody’s, S&P or Fitch ceases to rate the notes or fails to make a rating of the notes publicly available for reasons outside of our control, a “nationally recognized statistical rating organization” within the meaning of Section 3(a)(62) of the Exchange Act selected by us (as certified by a certificate of officers confirming the decision of our Board of Directors) to act as a replacement rating agency for Moody’s, S&P or Fitch or all of them, as the case may be.
          “Rating Downgrade” means the credit rating previously assigned to our long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness by any Rating Agency is (a) withdrawn or (b) is changed from investment grade to non-investment grade (for example, from BBB- to BB+ by S&P, or worse) or (c) if the credit rating previously assigned by the relevant Rating Agency was below investment grade, is lowered one rating notch (for example, from BB+ to BB by S&P), and such Rating Agency shall have publicly announced or confirmed in writing to us that such withdrawal or downgrade is principally the result of any event or circumstance comprised in or arising as a result of, or in respect of, the Change of Control or potential Change of Control.
          “Relevant Indebtedness” means any indebtedness for borrowed money represented by bonds, notes or other debt instruments which are for the time being quoted or listed on any stock exchange or other similar regulated securities market.
          “Securitization Indebtedness” means any Relevant Indebtedness that is incurred in connection with any securitization, asset repackaging, factoring or like arrangement or any combination thereof of any assets, revenues or other receivables where the recourse of the Person making the Relevant Indebtedness available or entering into the relevant arrangement or agreement(s) is limited fully or substantially to such assets or revenues or other receivables.
          “Security” means any mortgage, charge, pledge or other real security interest (sûreté réelle).
          “Subsidiary” means:
     (a) an entity of which a Person has direct or indirect control or owns directly or indirectly more than 50% of the voting capital or similar right of ownership (and control for this purpose means the power to direct the management and the policies of the entity whether through the ownership of voting capital, by contract or otherwise); and
     (b) in relation to our company, an entity that fulfils the definition in paragraph (a) above and which is included in the Consolidated Financial Statements on a fully integrated basis.
          “S&P” means Standard & Poor’s Rating Services, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., and its successors.

55


Table of Contents

FORM OF NOTES, CLEARING AND SETTLEMENT
Global Notes
     The exchange notes will be issued in the form of registered notes in global form, without interest coupons (referred to as Global Notes). Upon issuance, each Global Note will be deposited with the trustee as custodian for The Depository Trust Company (DTC) and registered in the name of Cede & Co., as nominee of DTC. Ownership of beneficial interests in a Global Note will be limited to persons who have accounts with DTC (DTC participants) or persons who hold interests through DTC participants. We expect that under procedures established by DTC ownership of beneficial interests in each Global Note will be shown on, and transfer of ownership of those interests will be effected only through, records maintained by DTC (with respect to interests of DTC participants) and the records of DTC participants (with respect to other owners of beneficial interests in the Global Note). Beneficial interests in a Global Note may be credited within DTC to Euroclear Bank S.A./N.V. (Euroclear) and Clearstream, Luxembourg Banking, société anonyme (Clearstream, Luxembourg) on behalf of the owners of such interests.
     Investors may hold their interests in a Global Note directly through DTC, Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg, if they are participants in those systems, or indirectly through organizations that are participants in those systems. Beneficial interests in a Global Note may not be exchanged for notes in physical, certificated form except in the limited circumstances described below.
Book-Entry Procedures for the Global Notes
     Interests in a Global Note will be subject to the operations and procedures of DTC, Euroclear and Clearstream, Luxembourg. The following description of the operations and procedures of DTC, Euroclear and Clearstream, Luxembourg are provided solely as a matter of convenience. These operations and procedures are solely within the control of the respective settlement systems and are subject to changes by them. We take no responsibility for these operations and procedures and urge investors to contact the systems or their participants directly to discuss these matters.
     DTC is a limited-purpose trust company organized under the New York Banking Law, a “banking organization” within the meaning of the New York State Banking Law, a member of the Federal Reserve System, a “clearing corporation” within the meaning of the New York Uniform Commercial Code, and a “clearing agency” registered pursuant to the provisions of Section 17A of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (“the Exchange Act”). DTC was created to hold securities for its participating organizations (collectively, the “Participants”) and facilitate the clearance and settlement of transactions in those securities between Participants through electronic book-entry changes in accounts of its Participants. The Participants include securities brokers and dealers, banks, trust companies, clearing corporations and certain other organizations. Access to DTC’s system is also available to other entities such as banks, brokers, dealers and trust companies that clear through or maintain a custodial relationship with a Participant, either directly or indirectly (collectively, the “Indirect Participants”). Persons who are not Participants may beneficially own securities held by or on behalf of DTC only through Participants or Indirect Participants. DTC has no knowledge of the identity of beneficial owners of securities held by or on behalf of DTC. DTC’s records reflect only the identity of Participants to whose accounts securities are credited. The ownership interests and transfer of ownership interests of each beneficial owner of each security held by or on behalf of DTC are recorded on the records of the Participants and Indirect Participants.
     Investors in the global notes may hold their interests therein directly through DTC, if they are Participants in such system, or indirectly through organizations that are Participants or Indirect Participants in such system. Euroclear and Clearstream, Luxembourg will hold interests on behalf of their participants through customers’ securities accounts in their respective names on the books of their respective depositaries. The depositaries, in turn, will hold interests in the global notes in customers’ securities accounts in the depositaries’ names on the books of DTC.
     All interests in the global notes, including those held through Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg, will be subject to the procedures and requirements of DTC. Those interests held through Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg will also be subject to the procedures and requirements of these systems. The laws of some

56


Table of Contents

jurisdictions require that certain persons take physical delivery of certificates evidencing securities they own. Consequently, the ability to transfer beneficial interests in a global note to such persons will be limited to that extent. Because DTC can act only on behalf of Participants, which in turn act on behalf of Indirect Participants, the ability of beneficial owners of interests in the global notes to pledge such interests to persons or entities that do not participate in the DTC system, or otherwise take actions in respect of such interests, may be affected by the lack of a physical certificate evidencing such interests. For certain other restrictions on the transferability of the notes, see “— Exchange of Book-Entry Notes for Certificated Notes.”
     Except as described below, owners of interests in the global notes will not have notes registered in their names, will not receive physical delivery of notes in certificated form and will not be considered the registered owners or holders thereof for any purpose.
     Payments in respect of the principal of and premium, if any, and interest on a global note registered in the name of DTC or its nominee will be payable by the trustee to DTC in its capacity as the registered holder under the indenture. We and the trustee will treat the persons in whose names the notes, including the global notes, are registered as the owners thereof for the purpose of receiving such payments and for any and all other purposes whatsoever. Consequently, none of the Company, the trustee or any agent of the Company or the trustee has or will have any responsibility or liability for:
    any aspect of DTC’s records or any Participant’s or Indirect Participant’s records relating to, or payments made on account of beneficial ownership interests in, the global notes, or for maintaining, supervising or reviewing any of DTC’s records or any Participant’s or Indirect Participant’s records relating to the beneficial ownership interests in the global notes, or
 
    any other matter relating to the actions and practices of DTC or any of its Participants or Indirect Participants.
     We understand that DTC’s current practice, upon receipt of any payment in respect of securities such as the notes (including principal and interest), is to credit the accounts of the relevant Participants with the payment on the payment date in amounts proportionate to their respective holdings in the principal amount of the relevant security as shown on the records of DTC, unless DTC has reason to believe it will not receive payment on such payment date. Payments by the Participants and the Indirect Participants to the beneficial owners of notes will be governed by standing instructions and customary practices and will be the responsibility of the Participants or the Indirect Participants and will not be the responsibility of DTC, the trustee or us. Neither we nor the trustee will be liable for any delay by DTC or any of its Participants in identifying the beneficial owners of the notes, and we and the trustee may conclusively rely on and will be protected in relying on instructions from DTC or its nominee for all purposes.
     Except for trades involving only Euroclear and Clearstream, Luxembourg participants, interests in the global notes are expected to be eligible to trade in DTC’s Same-Day Funds Settlement System and secondary market trading activity in such interests will therefore settle in immediately available funds, subject in all cases to the rules and procedures of DTC and its Participants.
     Transfers between Participants in DTC will be effected in accordance with DTC’s procedures, and will be settled in same-day funds, and transfers between participants in Euroclear and Clearstream, Luxembourg will be effected in the ordinary way in accordance with their respective rules and operating procedures.
     Cross-market transfers between Participants in DTC, on the one hand, and Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg participants, on the other hand, will be effected through DTC in accordance with DTC’s rules on behalf of Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg, as the case may be, by their depositaries. Cross-market transactions will require delivery of instructions to Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg, as the case may be, by the counterparty in that system in accordance with the rules and procedures and within the established deadlines (Brussels time) of that system. Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg, as the case may be, will, if the transaction meets its settlement requirements, deliver instructions to its respective depositaries to take action to effect final settlement on its behalf by delivering or receiving interests in the relevant global notes in DTC, and making or receiving payment in accordance with normal procedures for same-day funds settlement applicable to DTC.

57


Table of Contents

Euroclear and Clearstream, Luxembourg participants may not deliver instructions directly to the depositaries for Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg.
     Because of time zone differences, the securities account of a Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg participant purchasing an interest in a global note from a Participant in DTC will be credited and reported to the relevant Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg participant, during the securities settlement processing day (which must be a business day for Euroclear and Clearstream, Luxembourg) immediately following the settlement date of DTC. DTC has advised ArcelorMittal that cash received in Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg as a result of sales of interests in a global note by or through a Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg participant to a Participant in DTC will be received with value on the settlement date of DTC but will be available in the relevant Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg cash account only as of the business day for Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg following DTC’s settlement date.
     We understand that DTC will take any action permitted to be taken by a holder of notes only at the direction of one or more Participants to whose account with DTC interests in a global note are credited and only in respect of such portion of the aggregate principal amount of the notes as to which such Participant or Participants has or have given such direction.
     Although DTC, Euroclear and Clearstream, Luxembourg have agreed to the foregoing procedures to facilitate transfers of interests in global notes among participants in DTC, Euroclear and Clearstream, Luxembourg, they are under no obligation to perform or to continue to perform such procedures, and the procedures may be discontinued at any time. Neither ArcelorMittal nor the trustee will have any responsibility for the performance by DTC, Euroclear or Clearstream, Luxembourg or their respective participants or indirect participants of their respective obligations under the rules and procedures governing their operations.
     The information in this section concerning DTC, Euroclear and Clearstream, Luxembourg and their book-entry systems has been obtained from sources that ArcelorMittal believes to be reliable, but the Issuer takes no responsibility for the accuracy thereof.
Exchange of Book-Entry Notes for Certificated Notes
     The global notes are exchangeable for certificated notes in definitive, fully registered form without interest coupons only in the following limited circumstances:
    DTC notifies us that it is unwilling or unable to continue as depositary for the global notes or DTC ceases to be a clearing agency registered under the Exchange Act at a time when DTC is required to be so registered in order to act as depositary, and in each case we fail to appoint a successor depositary within 90 days of such notice;
 
    we, at our option, notify the trustee in writing that we elect to cause the issuance of notes in definitive form under the indenture subject to the procedures of the depositary;
 
    if there shall have occurred and be continuing an event of default (as defined in the indenture) with respect to the notes (see “Description of Exchange Notes”), and DTC representing a majority in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding notes so advises the trustee in writing.
     In all cases, certificated notes delivered in exchange for any global note or beneficial interests therein will be registered in the names, and issued in any approved denominations, requested by or on behalf of DTC (in accordance with its customary procedures).

58


Table of Contents

TAXATION
     The following summary of certain Luxembourg and U.S. federal income tax considerations is based on the advice of Bonn Schmitt Steichen, with respect to Luxembourg taxes, and on the advice of Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP, with respect to U.S. federal income taxes. This summary contains a description of certain material Luxembourg and U.S. federal income tax consequences of the exchange offer and the ownership and disposition of the exchange notes, but does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all the tax considerations that may be relevant to a decision to participate in the exchange offer. This summary does not describe any tax consequences arising under the laws of any state, locality or taxing jurisdiction other than the United States and Luxembourg.
     This summary is based on the tax laws of Luxembourg and the United States as in effect on the date of this prospectus, as well as on rules and regulations of Luxembourg and regulations, rulings and decisions of the United States available on or before such date and now in effect. All of the foregoing are subject to change, which change could apply retroactively and could affect the continued validity of this summary. Prospective investors participating in the exchange of notes should consult their own tax advisers as to the Luxembourg, United States or other tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of the exchange notes and the exchange of original notes for exchange notes, including, in particular, the application to their particular situations of the tax considerations discussed below, as well as the application of state, local, foreign or other tax laws.
Luxembourg Taxation
     Prospective purchasers of the notes are advised to consult their own tax advisers as to the consequences under the tax laws of the country of which they are residents of the purchase, ownership and disposition of the exchange notes and the exchange of original notes for exchange notes. The following is a general description of certain tax laws relating to the notes as in effect and as applied by the relevant tax authorities on the date hereof and does not purport to be a comprehensive discussion of the tax treatment of the notes.
Exchange of original notes for exchange notes
     No specific Luxembourg tax, such as, for example, registration tax or stamp duty, will be levied on the exchange of the notes. Interest payments made following the exchange of the notes will be taxed as per the descriptions below.
Luxembourg tax residency of the holders of the notes
     A holder of the notes will not become resident, or be deemed to be resident, in Luxembourg by reason only of the holding of the notes, or the execution, performance, delivery and/or enforcement of the notes (holding of the notes includes receipt of interest and repayment of the principal).
Withholding tax
     As a general rule, there is no withholding tax for Luxembourg residents and non resident holders of the notes on payments of interest (including accrued but unpaid interest) in respect of the notes, nor is any Luxembourg withholding tax payable on payments received upon repayment of the principal or upon an exchange of notes except that in certain circumstances a withholding tax may be required to be made upon payments of interest pursuant to European Council Directive 2003/48/EC (the “Tax Savings Directive”) i.e. mainly for payments made to individuals. Under the Tax Savings Directive, each EU Member State (a “Member State”) generally must provide to the tax authorities of another Member State details of interest payments or similar income paid by a Paying Agent within its jurisdiction to a Residual Entity or to or for an individual (the “Beneficial Owner”) resident in the latter Member State, although certain Member States are entitled to apply a withholding tax system during a transitional period. The transitional period commenced July 1, 2005 and will terminate at the end of the first full fiscal year after the EU and certain non-EU states reach an agreement on the exchange of such information. The Tax Savings Directive was implemented into Luxembourg law by a law of June 21, 2005 which is in effect as of July 1, 2005. Due to certain bilateral agreements, relevant dependant and associated territories and certain non-EU States apply similar measures as of the same date.

59


Table of Contents

     According to the law of June 21, 2005 and bilateral agreements with several dependant and associated territories and certain non-EU States, during the transitional period, a Luxembourg Paying Agent may be required to withhold taxes on interest payments to Residual Entities or to Beneficial Owners who reside in an EU Member State or relevant dependant and associated territories at a rate of 15% (the rate will increase to 20% on July 1, 2008 and to 35% on July 1, 2011), unless the Beneficial Owner has opted for an exchange of information or has provided a tax certificate.
     For the purpose of this section, the terms “Paying Agent,” “Interest” and “Beneficial Owner” shall mean respectively “agent payeur,” “intérêt” and “bénéficiaire économique” as these terms are defined in the law of June 21, 2005, and “Residual Entity” shall refer to the entities described in article 4.2 of the same law.
     Another exception has been implemented by a law of December 23, 2005, effective as of January 1, 2006, Luxembourg, which introduced a withholding tax of 10% for interest payments made to Luxembourg individual residents by a Luxembourg paying agent.
Taxation of the holders of the notes
Taxation of Luxembourg non-residents
     Holders of the notes who are non-residents of Luxembourg and who have neither a permanent establishment nor a fixed base of business in Luxembourg with which the holding of the notes is connected are not liable to any Luxembourg income tax, whether they receive payments of principal, payments of interest (including accrued but unpaid interest), payments received upon the redemption of the notes, or realize capital gains on the sale of any notes.
Taxation of Luxembourg residents — General
     Holders of the notes who are residents of Luxembourg, or non-resident holders of the notes who have a permanent establishment or a fixed base of business in Luxembourg with which the holding of the notes is connected, must, for income tax purposes, include any interest received in their taxable income. They will not be liable to any Luxembourg income tax on repayment of principal.
     For individuals resident in Luxembourg, the 10% tax withheld at source constitutes a final taxation.
Luxembourg resident individuals
     Luxembourg resident individuals who are holders of the notes or non-resident individual holders of the notes who have a fixed base of business with which the holding of the notes is connected are not subject to taxation on capital gains upon the disposal of the notes, unless the disposal of the notes precedes the acquisition of the notes or the notes are disposed of within six months of the date of acquisition of these notes. Upon redemption of the notes, individual Luxembourg resident holders of the notes or non-resident holders of the notes who have a fixed base of business with which the holding of the notes is connected must however include the portion of the redemption price corresponding to accrued but unpaid interest in their taxable income.
Luxembourg resident companies
     Luxembourg resident companies (sociétés de capitaux) that are holders of the notes or foreign entities of the same type which have a permanent establishment in Luxembourg with which the holding of the notes is connected, must include in their taxable income the difference between the sale price (including accrued but unpaid interest) and the lower of the cost or book value of the notes sold or converted.
Luxembourg resident companies benefiting from a special tax regime
     Holders of the notes who are holding companies subject to the law of July 31, 1929 or undertakings for collective investment subject to the law of December 20, 2002 are tax exempt entities in Luxembourg, and are thus

60


Table of Contents

not subject to any Luxembourg tax (i.e., corporate income tax, municipal business tax and net wealth tax) other than the subscription tax calculated on their share capital or net asset value.
Net Wealth Tax
     Luxembourg net wealth tax will not be levied on a holder of the notes, unless (i) such holder is a Luxembourg resident company or (ii) the notes are attributable to an enterprise or part thereof which is carried on in Luxembourg through a permanent establishment or (iii) the notes are attributable to a fixed base of business in Luxembourg of their holder.
Other Taxes
     There is no Luxembourg registration tax, stamp duty or any other similar tax or duty payable in Luxembourg by holders of the notes as a consequence of the issuance of the notes, nor will any of these taxes be payable as a consequence of a subsequent transfer, redemption or exchange of the notes.
     There is no Luxembourg value added tax payable in respect of payments in consideration for the issuance of the notes or in respect of the payment of interest or principal under the notes or the transfer of the notes.
     No gift, estate or inheritance tax is levied on the transfer of the notes upon death of a holder in cases where the deceased was not a resident of Luxembourg for inheritance tax purposes.
United States Federal Taxation
     In general, a United States person who holds the exchange notes or owns a beneficial interest in the exchange notes will be subject to United States federal taxation. You are a United States person for U.S. federal income tax purposes if you are:
    a citizen or resident of the United States or its territories, possessions or other areas subject to its jurisdiction,
 
    a corporation or other entity taxable as a corporation organized under the laws of the United States or any political subdivision,
 
    an estate, the income of which is subject to United States federal income taxation regardless of its source or
 
    a trust if (i) a United States court is able to exercise primary supervision over the trust’s administration and (ii) one or more United States persons have the authority to control all of the trust’s substantial decisions.
     Neither the registration of the original notes pursuant to our obligations under the registration rights agreement nor the U.S. holder’s receipt of exchange notes in exchange for original notes will constitute a taxable event for U.S. federal income tax purposes. The exchanging U.S. holder will retain the tax basis in the exchange notes that the holder had in the original notes, and a U.S. holder’s holding period for the exchange notes will include such U.S. holder’s holding period for the original notes before such original notes were registered.
     If you are a United States person, the interest you receive on the exchange notes will generally be subject to United States taxation and will generally be considered ordinary foreign source interest income on which you will be taxed in accordance with the method of accounting that you use for tax purposes. When you sell, exchange or otherwise dispose of the exchange notes, you generally will recognize gain or loss equal to the difference between the amount you realize on the transaction and your tax basis in the exchange notes. Your tax basis in an exchange note generally will equal the cost of the original note to you exchanged for the exchange note. If you are an individual and the exchange note being sold, exchanged or otherwise disposed of is a capital asset held for more than one year (taking into account the holding period of an original note exchanged for an exchange note), you may be eligible for reduced rates of taxation on any capital gain realized. Your ability to deduct capital losses is subject

61


Table of Contents

to limitations. Under current United States federal income tax law, if you are not a United States person, the interest payments that you receive on the exchange notes generally will be exempt from United States federal income taxes, including withholding tax. However, to receive this exemption you may be required to satisfy certain certification requirements (described below) of the United States Internal Revenue Service to establish that you are not a United States person.
     Even if you are not a United States person, you may still be subject to United States federal income taxes on any interest payments you receive if:
    you are an insurance company carrying on a United States insurance business, within the meaning of the United States Internal Revenue Code of 1986, or
 
    you have an office or other fixed place of business in the United States that receives the interest and you (i) earn the interest in the course of operating a banking, financing or similar business in the United States or (ii) are a corporation the principal business of which is trading in stock or securities for its own account, and certain other conditions exist.
     If you are not a United States person, any gain you realize on a sale or exchange of the exchange notes generally will be exempt from United States federal income tax, including withholding tax, unless:
    your gain is effectively connected with your conduct of a trade or business in the United States or
 
    you are an individual holder and are present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of the sale, and either (i) your gain is attributable to an office or other fixed place of business that you maintain in the United States or (ii) you have a tax home in the United States.
     The fiscal agent must file information returns with the United States Internal Revenue Service in connection with exchange note payments made to certain United States persons. If you are a United States person, you generally will not be subject to United States backup withholding tax on such payments if you provide your taxpayer identification number to the fiscal agent. You may also be subject to information reporting and backup withholding tax requirements with respect to the proceeds from a sale of the exchange notes. If you are not a United States person, in order to avoid information reporting and backup withholding tax requirements you may have to comply with certification procedures to establish that you are not a United States person.
     An exchange note held by an individual holder who at the time of death is a non-resident alien will not be subject to United States federal estate tax.

62


Table of Contents

PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION
     The following requirements apply only to broker-dealers. If you are not a broker-dealer as defined in Section 3(a)(4) and Section 3(a)(5) of the Exchange Act, these requirements do not affect you.
     Each broker-dealer that receives exchange notes for its own account pursuant to the exchange offer must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of such exchange notes. This prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, may be used by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of exchange notes received in exchange for original notes where such original notes were acquired as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities. We have agreed that, for a period of up to 45 days from the last date on which original notes are accepted for exchange, we will amend or supplement this prospectus, if requested by any broker-dealer for use in connection with any resale of exchange notes received in exchange for original notes.
We will not receive any proceeds from any sale of exchange notes by broker-dealers.
     Exchange notes received by broker-dealers for their own account pursuant to the exchange offer may be sold from time to time in one or more transactions in the over-the-counter market, in negotiated transactions, through the writing of options on the exchange notes or a combination of such methods of resale, at market prices prevailing at the time of resale, at prices related to such prevailing market prices or at negotiated prices. Any resale may be made directly to purchasers or to or through brokers or dealers who may receive compensation in the form of commissions or concessions from any broker-dealer or the purchasers of any exchange notes.
     Any broker-dealer that resells exchange notes that were received by it for its own account in the exchange offer and any broker or dealer that participates in a distribution of those exchange notes may be deemed to be an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act. Any profit on any resale of exchange notes and any commissions or concessions received by any of those persons may be deemed to be underwriting compensation under the Securities Act. The letter of transmittal states that, by acknowledging that it will deliver and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act.
     For a period of up to 45 days from the last date on which original notes are accepted for exchange, we will promptly send additional copies of this prospectus and any amendment or supplement to the prospectus to any broker-dealer that requests those documents. We have agreed to pay all expenses incident to the exchange offer, other than commissions or concessions of any brokers or dealers, and will indemnify any broker-dealer as a holder of the exchange notes against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act.

63


Table of Contents

VALIDITY OF THE EXCHANGE NOTES
     The validity of the exchange notes offered hereby will be passed upon by Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP, our United States counsel. Certain matters of Luxembourg law relating to the exchange notes will be passed upon by Bonn Schmitt Steichen, our Luxembourg counsel.
EXPERTS
     The 2007 consolidated financial statements and the retrospective adjustments to the 2005 and 2006 financial statement disclosures appearing in our Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008 incorporated by reference herein, and the effectiveness of ArcelorMittal’s internal control over financial reporting included in our 2007 Form 20-F incorporated by reference herein, have been audited by Deloitte S.A., as stated in their reports set forth therein and incorporated by reference herein (which reports (1) expresses an unqualified opinion on the 2007 consolidated financial statements and includes an explanatory paragraph referring to retrospective adjustments to the 2005 and 2006 disclosures for a change in the composition of reportable segments, and (2) expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting). Such consolidated financial statements have been so included in reliance upon the reports of such firm given upon their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.
     The consolidated financial statements of Mittal Steel Company N.V. (predecessor entity of ArcelorMittal) and subsidiaries as of and for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2006 and the retrospective adjustment to the 2006 financial statements related to the acquisition of Arcelor , except for the consolidated financial statements of Arcelor and its subsidiaries (a consolidated subsidiary) (except for Dofasco, Inc., Belgo Siderurgia S.A., Companhia Siderúrgica Tubarão S.A., Sol Coqueria Tubarão S.A., Acindar Industria Argentina de Aceros S.A., Arcelor España S.A., Arcelor Largos Perfiles, and Laminados Velasco S.L., consolidated subsidiaries of Arcelor, whose consolidated financial statements for the period from August 1, 2006 to December 31, 2006, were audited by Deloitte Accountants B.V.), included in our Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008 and incorporated by reference herein, have been audited by Deloitte Accountants B.V. as stated in their report set forth therein and incorporated by reference herein (which report expresses an unqualified opinion on the financial statements and includes an explanatory paragraph referring to the retrospective adjustments to the 2006 financial statements related to the acquisition of Arcelor). Such consolidated financial statements are incorporated herein by reference in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.
     The financial statements of Arcelor, prepared on the basis of IFRS (consolidated with those of the Company and not separately incorporated by reference herein), as of December 31, 2006, and for the period from August 1, 2006 to December 31, 2006, have been audited by KPMG Audit S.à r.l., as stated in their report which is included in our Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K dated September 22, 2008 and is incorporated by reference herein (which report expresses a qualified opinion because the omission of comparative financial information is not in conformity with IFRS and contains an explanatory paragraph stating that the consolidated financial statements are based on historical values of Arcelor’s assets and liabilities prior to its acquisition by Mittal Steel and, accordingly, do not include the purchase price adjustments to such amounts reflected in the consolidated financial statements of Mittal Steel as a result of such acquisition). Such consolidated financial statements are incorporated herein by reference in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.
     All of the foregoing firms are independent registered public accounting firms.

64


Table of Contents

ISSUER
ArcelorMittal
19, Avenue de la Liberté, L-2930 Luxembourg,
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
TRUSTEE, REGISTRAR, PRINCIPAL PAYING AGENT AND TRANSFER AGENT
HSBC Bank USA, National Association
Corporate Trust & Loan Agency
2 Hanson Place, 14th Floor
Brooklyn, New York 10217-1409
United States
LEGAL ADVISORS TO THE ISSUER
     
As to United States Law   As to Luxembourg Law
Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP   Bonn Schmitt Steichen
12 rue de Tilsitt   44 rue de la Vallée
75008 Paris   BP 522, L-2015 Luxembourg
France   Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
 
 
 
   

 


Table of Contents

PART II
INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
Item 20. Indemnification of Directors and Officers.
     The articles of association of ArcelorMittal provide that ArcelorMittal will, to the extent permitted by law, indemnify every director or member of the Group Management Board, as well as every former director or member of the Group Management Board, the fees, costs and expenses reasonably incurred by him or her in the defense or resolution (including a settlement) of all legal actions or proceedings, whether civil, criminal or administrative, he or she has been involved in his or her role as former or current director or member of the Group Management Board of ArcelorMittal.
     The right to indemnification does not exist in the case of gross negligence, fraud, fraudulent inducement, dishonesty or for a criminal offense or if it is ultimately determined that the director or member of the Group Management Board has not acted honestly and in good faith and with the reasonable belief that he or she was acting in the best interests of ArcelorMittal.

II-1


Table of Contents

Item 21. Exhibits.
     
4.1
  Indenture dated as of May 27, 2008 between ArcelorMittal and HSBC Bank USA, National Association.
 
   
4.2
  Form of 2013 Exchange Notes and 2018 Exchange Notes.
 
   
4.3
  Registration Rights Agreement dated as of May 27, 2008 between ArcelorMittal and the Initial Purchasers.
 
   
5.1
  Opinion of Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP as to the validity of the exchange notes.
 
   
5.2
  Opinion of Bonn Schmitt Steichen as to the validity of the exchange notes.
 
   
12
  Calculation of ratios of earnings to fixed charges.
 
   
21
  List of Subsidiaries of ArcelorMittal (incorporated by reference from ArcelorMittal’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2007).
 
   
23.1
  Consent of Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1).
 
   
23.2
  Consent of Bonn Schmitt Steichen (included in Exhibit 5.2).
 
   
23.3
  Consent of Deloitte S.A.
 
   
23.4
  Consent of Deloitte Accountants B.V. (Mittal Steel Company N.V. and subsidiaries).
 
   
23.5
  Consent of KPMG Audit S.à.r.l. (Arcelor S.A. and subsidiaries).
 
   
24
  Powers of attorney (included in the signature pages of this registration statement).
 
   
25
  Form T-1 Statement of Eligibility Under the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 of HSBC Bank USA, National Association.
 
   
99.1
  Form of Letter of Transmittal for Exchange Notes.
 
   
99.2
  Form of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery for Exchange Notes.
 
   
99.3
  Form of Letter to Registered Holders.
 
   
99.4
  Form of Instructions to Registered Holder from Beneficial Owner.
 
   
99.5
  Form of Letter to Clients.
 
   
99.6
  Form of Exchange Agent Agreement.
 
   
Item 22. Undertakings.
(a)   The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes:
  1.   To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being made, a post-effective amendment to this registration statement:
  (i)   To include any prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of the Securities Act of 1933 (the “Securities Act”);
 
 
  (ii)   To reflect in the prospectus any facts arising after the effective date of the registration statement (or the most recent post-effective amendment thereof) which, individually or in the aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information set forth in the registration statement; and
 
  (iii)   To include any material information with respect to the plan of distribution not previously disclosed in the registration statement or any material change to such information set forth in the registration statement.
  2.   That, for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each such post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

II-2


Table of Contents

  3.   To remove from registration by means of a post-effective amendment any of the securities being registered which remain unsold at the termination of the offering.
 
  4.   To file a post-effective amendment to the Registration Statement to include any financial statements required by Item 8.A. of Form 20-F at the start of any delayed offering or throughout a continuous offering.
 
  5.   That, for the purpose of determining liability under the Securities Act to any purchaser, each prospectus filed pursuant to Rule 424(b) as part of a registration statement relating to an offering, other than registration statements relying on Rule 430B or other than prospectuses filed in reliance on Rule 430A, shall be deemed to be part of and included in the registration statement as of the date it is first used after effectiveness. Provided, however, that no statement made in a registration statement or prospectus that is part of the registration statement or made in a document incorporated or deemed incorporated by reference into the registration statement or prospectus that is part of the registration statement will, as to a purchaser with a time of contract of sale prior to such first use, supersede or modify any statement that was made in the registration statement or prospectus that was part of the registration statement or made in any such document immediately prior to such date of first use.
 
  6.   That, for the purpose of determining liability of the registrant under the Securities Act of 1933 to any purchaser in the initial distribution of the securities, the undersigned registrant undertakes that in a primary offering of securities of the undersigned registrant pursuant to this registration statement, regardless of the underwriting method used to sell the securities to the purchaser, if the securities are offered or sold to such purchaser by means of any of the following communications, the undersigned registrant will be a seller to the purchaser and will be considered to offer or sell such securities to such purchaser:
  (i)   Any preliminary prospectus or prospectus of the undersigned registrant relating to the offering required to be filed pursuant to Rule 424;
 
  (ii)   Any free writing prospectus relating to the offering prepared by or on behalf of the undersigned registrant or used or referred to by the undersigned registrant;
 
  (iii)   The portion of any other free writing prospectus relating to the offering containing material information about the undersigned registrant or its securities provided by or on behalf of the undersigned registrant; and
 
  (iv)   Any other communication that is an offer in the offering made by the undersigned registrant to the purchaser.
  7.   That, for purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each filing of the registrant’s annual report pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (and, where applicable, each filing of an employee benefit plan’s annual report pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) that is incorporated by reference in the registration statement shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.
  8.   Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by any registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of any registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of their counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.
  9.   The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes: (i) to respond to requests for information that is incorporated by reference into the prospectus pursuant to Items 4, 10(b), 11 or 13 of this Form, within one business day of such request, and to send the incorporated documents by first class mail or other equally prompt means, and (ii) to arrange or provide for a facility in the United States for the purpose of responding to such requests. The undertaking in subparagraph (i) above includes information contained in documents filed subsequent to the effective date of this registration statement through the date of responding to the request.
  10.   The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to supply by means of a post-effective amendment all information concerning a transaction and the company being acquired involved therein, that was not the subject of and included in the registration statement when it became effective. 

II-3


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES OF ARCELORMITTAL
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the registrant has duly caused this registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in Luxembourg, on September 22, 2008.
         
   

ARCELORMITTAL
 
 
  By:   /s/ H. J. Scheffer  
  Name: H. J. Scheffer  
  Title: Company Secretary  
Power of Attorney
     KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below hereby constitutes and appoints Mr. B.C. Agarwal, Mr. S. Maheshwari, Mr. A. Rinnen and/or Mr. H. Scheffer, severally and individually, and each of them (with full power to each of them to act alone) his/her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him/her and in his/her name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments (including post-effective amendments) to the registration statement on Form F-4, and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto, and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto each said attorneys-in-fact and agents full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done in and about the premises, as fully to all intents and purposes as he/she might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, or any of their or his substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue thereof.
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this registration statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated in respect of ArcelorMittal.
         
Signature   Title   Date
           
/s/ Lakshmi N. Mittal
 
  Lakshmi N. Mittal
  Chief Executive Officer, Director
and Chairman of the Board of
Directors
  September 22, 2008
 
       
/s/ Aditya Mittal
 
  Aditya Mittal
  Chief Financial Officer (Principal
Financial Officer and Principal
Accounting Officer)
  September 22, 2008
 
       

 
  Vanisha Mittal Bhatia
  Director     
 
       
/s/ Narayanan Vaghul
 
  Director    September 22, 2008
  Narayanan Vaghul
       
 
       
/s/ Wilbur L. Ross, Jr.
  Director   September 22, 2008
 
  Wilbur L. Ross, Jr.
       
 
       
/s/ Lewis B. Kaden
  Director   September 22, 2008
 
  Lewis B. Kaden
       
 
       
 
 
  François H. Pinault
  Director     

II-4


Table of Contents

         
Signature   Title   Date
           
/s/ Michel Marti
 
  Michel Marti
  Director    September 22, 2008
 
       
/s/ José Rámon Álvarez Rendueles
 
  José Rámon Álvarez Rendueles
  Director    September 22, 2008
 
       
 
 
  Sergio Silva de Freitas
  Director     
 
       
/s/ Georges Schmit
 
  Georges Schmit
  Director    September 22, 2008
 
       
 
 
  Jean-Pierre Hansen
  Director 
 
       
  
 
  John O. Castegnaro
  Director   
 
       
/s/ Antoine Spillman
 
  Antoine Spillman
  Director    September 22, 2008
 
       
 
 
 HRH Prince Guillaume de Luxembourg
  Director 
 
       
/s/ Ignacio Fernández Toxo
 
  Ignacio Fernández Toxo
  Director    September 22, 2008
 
       
  
 
  Malay Mukherjee
  Director   

II-5


Table of Contents

Signature of Authorized Representative of ArcelorMittal
     Pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, the undersigned, the duly authorized representative in the United States of ArcelorMittal, has signed this registration statement or amendment thereto, as the case may be, in the City of Chicago, State of Illinois, on September 22, 2008.
 
     
Signature   Title
 
   
/s/ Marc R. Jeske
 
 
Marc R. Jeske
  Assistant Secretary
     

II-6


Table of Contents

 
Exhibit Index
 
     
4.1
  Indenture dated as of May 27, 2008 between ArcelorMittal and HSBC Bank USA, National Association.
 
   
4.2
  Form of 2013 Exchange Notes and 2018 Exchange Notes.
 
   
4.3
  Registration Rights Agreement dated as of May 27, 2008 between ArcelorMittal and the Initial Purchasers.
 
   
5.1
  Opinion of Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP as to the validity of the exchange notes.
 
   
5.2
  Opinion of Bonn Schmitt Steichen as to the validity of the exchange notes.
 
   
12
  Calculation of ratios of earnings to fixed charges.
 
   
21
  List of Subsidiaries of ArcelorMittal (incorporated by reference from ArcelorMittal’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2007).
 
   
23.1
  Consent of Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1).
 
   
23.2
  Consent of Bonn Schmitt Steichen (included in Exhibit 5.2).
 
   
23.3
  Consent of Deloitte S.A.
 
   
23.4
  Consent of Deloitte Accountants B.V. (Mittal Steel Company N.V. and subsidiaries).
 
   
23.5
  Consent of KPMG Audit S.à.r.l. (Arcelor S.A. and subsidiaries).
 
   
24
  Powers of attorney (included in the signature pages of this registration statement).
 
   
25
  Form T-1 Statement of Eligibility Under the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 of HSBC Bank USA, National Association.
 
   
99.1
  Form of Letter of Transmittal for Exchange Notes.
 
   
99.2
  Form of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery for Exchange Notes.
 
   
99.3
  Form of Letter to Registered Holders.
 
   
99.4
  Form of Instructions to Registered Holder from Beneficial Owner.
 
   
99.5
  Form of Letter to Clients.
 
   
99.6
  Form of Exchange Agent Agreement.
 
   

II-7 EX-4.1 2 u01974exv4w1.htm EX-4.1: INDENTURE EX-4.1

Exhibit 4.1
 

ARCELORMITTAL
US$1,500,000,000 5.375% NOTES DUE 2013
US$1,500,000,000 6.125% NOTES DUE 2018
 
INDENTURE
Dated as of May 27, 2008
 
HSBC BANK USA, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION
Trustee
 

1


 

CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE
       
  Trust Indenture Act Section   Indenture Section
 
310
(a)(1)
  8.10
 
(a)(2)
  8.10
 
(a)(3)
  N/A
 
(a)(4)
  N/A
 
(a)(5)
  8.10
 
(b)
  8.02(o); 8.03; 8.10
 
(c)
  N/A
311
(a)
  8.02(o); 8.03; 8.11
 
(b)
  8.02(o); 8.03; 8.11
 
(c)
  N/A
312
(a)
  2.05
 
(b)
  12.04
 
(c)
  12.04
313
(a)
  8.05
 
(b)
  8.05
 
(c)
  8.05; 8.06
 
(d)
  8.05
314
(a)(1)
  N/A
 
(a)(2)
  N/A
 
(a)(3)
  N/A
 
(a)(4)
  5.06
 
(b)
  N/A
 
(c)(1)
  12.05(a)
 
(c)(2)
  12.05(b)
 
(c)(3)
  N/A
 
(d)
  N/A
 
(e)
  12.06
 
(f)
  N/A
315
(a)
  8.01(b)
 
(b)
  5.04(b)
 
(c)
  8.01(a)
 
(d)
  8.01(c)
 
(e)
  7.11
316
(a) (last sentence)
  2.08
 
(a)(1)(A)
  7.05
 
(a)(1)(B)
  7.04
 
(a)(2)
  N/A
 
(b)
  7.07
 
(c)
  N/A
317
(a)(1)
  7.08
 
(a)(2)
  7.09
 
(b)
  2.04
318
(a)
  12.01
 
(b)
  N/A
 
(c)
  N/A
 
N/A   means not applicable.

2


 

Note: The Cross-Reference Table shall not for any purpose be deemed to be a part of this Indenture.

3


 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
             
        Page
 
  ARTICLE 1        
 
  DEFINITIONS AND PROVISIONS OF GENERAL APPLICATION        
Section 1.01
  Definitions     1  
Section 1.02
  Other Definitions     9  
Section 1.03
  Rules of Construction     9  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 2        
 
  THE NOTES        
 
           
Section 2.01
  Form and Dating     10  
Section 2.02
  Execution and Authentication     10  
Section 2.03
  Registrar and Paying Agent     11  
Section 2.04
  Paying Agent to Hold Money in Trust     11  
Section 2.05
  Holder Lists     11  
Section 2.06
  Transfer and Exchange     12  
Section 2.07
  Replacement Notes     22  
Section 2.08
  Outstanding Notes     23  
Section 2.09
  Treasury Notes     23  
Section 2.10
  Temporary Notes     23  
Section 2.11
  Cancellation     24  
Section 2.12
  Defaulted Interest     24  
Section 2.13
  Issuance of Additional Notes     24  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 3        
 
  PROVISIONS FOR INTEREST PAYMENTS        
 
           
Section 3.01
  Interest     25  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 4        
 
  REDEMPTION AND PREPAYMENT        
 
           
Section 4.01
  Notices to Trustee     25  
Section 4.02
  Notice of Redemption     26  
Section 4.03
  Effect of Notice of Redemption     26  
Section 4.04
  Deposit of Redemption or Purchase Price     26  
Section 4.05
  Redemption at the Option of the Company     27  
Section 4.06
  Redemption for Taxation Reasons     28  
Section 4.07
  Mandatory Redemption     29  
Section 4.08
  Purchases of Notes by the Company     29  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 5        
 
  COVENANTS        
 
           
Section 5.01
  Payments     29  
Section 5.02
  Maintenance of Office or Agency     29  
Section 5.03
  Appointment to Fill a Vacancy in the Office of the Trustee     30  
Section 5.04
  Notice of Certain Events     30  
Section 5.05
  Reports     30  
Section 5.06
  Compliance Certificate     31  

i


 

             
        Page
Section 5.07
  Further Actions     31  
Section 5.08
  Stay, Extension and Usury Laws     31  
Section 5.09
  Corporate Existence     31  
Section 5.10
  Negative Pledge     32  
Section 5.11
  Payment of Additional Amounts     32  
Section 5.12
  Offer to Purchase Upon a Change of Control     33  
Section 5.13
  Payment of Additional Interest     34  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 6        
 
  SUCCESSORS        
 
           
Section 6.01
  Consolidation, Merger, Conveyance or Transfer     35  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 7        
 
  DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES        
 
           
Section 7.01
  Events of Default     35  
Section 7.02
  Acceleration     37  
Section 7.03
  Other Remedies     37  
Section 7.04
  Waiver of Past Defaults     38  
Section 7.05
  Control by Majority     38  
Section 7.06
  Limitation on Suits     38  
Section 7.07
  Rights of Holders of Notes to Receive Payment     38  
Section 7.08
  Collection Suit by Trustee     39  
Section 7.09
  Trustee May File Proofs of Claim     39  
Section 7.10
  Priorities     39  
Section 7.11
  Restoration of Rights and Remedies     40  
Section 7.12
  Undertaking for Costs     40  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 8        
 
  TRUSTEE        
 
           
Section 8.01
  Duties of Trustee     40  
Section 8.02
  Rights of Trustee     41  
Section 8.03
  Individual Rights of Trustee     43  
Section 8.04
  Trustee’s Disclaimer     43  
Section 8.05
  Reports by Trustee to Holders     43  
Section 8.06
  Notice of Defaults     44  
Section 8.07
  Compensation and Indemnity     44  
Section 8.08
  Replacement of Trustee     45  
Section 8.09
  Successor Trustee by Merger, etc.     46  
Section 8.10
  Eligibility; Disqualification     46  
Section 8.11
  Preferential Collection of Claims Against Issuer     46  
Section 8.12
  Instructions in writing     47  
Section 8.13
  Article applying to Paying Agents     47  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 9        
 
  LEGAL DEFEASANCE AND COVENANT DEFEASANCE        
 
           
Section 9.01
  Option to Effect Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance     47  
Section 9.02
  Legal Defeasance and Discharge     47  
Section 9.03
  Covenant Defeasance     48  
Section 9.04
  Conditions to Legal or Covenant Defeasance     48  

ii


 

             
        Page
Section 9.05
  Deposited Money and Government Securities to be Held in Trust; Other Miscellaneous Provisions     49  
Section 9.06
  Repayment to Company     49  
Section 9.07
  Reinstatement     50  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 10        
 
  AMENDMENT, SUPPLEMENT AND WAIVER        
 
Section 10.01
  Without Consent of Holders of Notes     50  
Section 10.02
  With Consent of Holders of Notes     50  
Section 10.03
  Revocation and Effect of Consents     51  
Section 10.04
  Notation on or Exchange of Notes     51  
Section 10.05
  Trustee to Sign Amendments, etc.     52  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 11        
 
  SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE        
 
Section 11.01
  Satisfaction and Discharge     52  
Section 11.02
  Application of Trust Money     53  
 
           
 
  ARTICLE 12        
 
  MISCELLANEOUS        
 
           
Section 12.01
  Trust Indenture Act Controls     53  
Section 12.02
  Call and Notice of Holders’ Meeting     53  
Section 12.03
  Notices     54  
Section 12.04
  Communication by Holders of Notes with Other Holders of Notes     55  
Section 12.05
  Certificate and Opinion as to Conditions Precedent     55  
Section 12.06
  Statements Required in Certificate or Opinion     56  
Section 12.07
  Rules by Trustee and Agents     56  
Section 12.08
  No Recourse Against Others     56  
Section 12.09
  Governing Law     56  
Section 12.10
  Jurisdiction     56  
Section 12.11
  Waiver of Immunity     57  
Section 12.12
  Process Agent     57  
Section 12.13
  No Adverse Interpretation of Other Agreements     57  
Section 12.14
  Successors     57  
Section 12.15
  Severability     57  
Section 12.16
  Counterpart Originals     57  
Section 12.17
  Currency Indemnity     57  
Section 12.18
  Currency Calculation     58  
Section 12.19
  Table of Contents, Headings, etc.     58  
 
           
 
  EXHIBITS        
 
           
Exhibit A
  FORM OF NOTE        
Exhibit B
  FORM OF CERTIFICATE OF TRANSFER        
Exhibit C
  FORM OF CERTIFICATE OF EXCHANGE        

iii


 

          INDENTURE dated as of May 27, 2008 between ArcelorMittal, a société anonyme incorporated under Luxembourg law, and HSBC Bank USA, National Association, as trustee.
          The Company and the Trustee agree as follows for the benefit of each other and for the equal and ratable benefit of the Holders (as defined below) of the U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes due 2013 (the “2013 Notes”) and the U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes due 2018 (the “2018 Notes” and, together with the 2013 Notes, the “Notes”):
ARTICLE 1
DEFINITIONS AND PROVISIONS OF GENERAL APPLICATION
Section 1.01 Definitions.
          “144A Global Notes” means the Global Notes substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto bearing the Global Note Legend and the Private Placement Legend and deposited with or on behalf of, and registered in the name of, the Depositary or its nominee that will be issued in denominations equal to the respective outstanding principal amounts of the 2013 Notes and 2018 Notes sold in reliance on Rule 144A.
          “2013 Notes” has the meaning assigned to it in the preamble to this Indenture.
          “2018 Notes” has the meaning assigned to it in the preamble to this Indenture.
          “Additional Interest” means additional interest owed to the Holders pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement.
          “Affiliate” of any specified Person means any other Person directly or indirectly controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect common control with such specified Person. For purposes of this definition, “control,” as used with respect to any Person, means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of such Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by agreement or otherwise. For purposes of this definition, the terms “controlling,” “controlled by” and “under common control with” have correlative meanings.
          “Agent” means any Registrar, co-registrar, Paying Agent or additional paying agent.
          “Applicable Accounting Standards” means the International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, as amended from time to time.
          “Applicable Procedures” means, with respect to any transfer or exchange of or for beneficial interests in any Global Note, the rules and procedures of the Depositary, Euroclear and Clearstream that apply to such transfer or exchange.
          “ArcelorMittal” means, ArcelorMittal, a société anonyme incorporated under Luxembourg law, which has its registered office at 19, avenue de la Liberté, L-2930 Luxembourg, Grand Duchy of Luxembourg and is registered with the Registre de Commerce et des Sociétés, Luxembourg under the number B 82.454.
          “Asset(s)” of any Person means, all or any part of its business, undertaking, property, assets, revenues (including any right to receive revenues) and uncalled capital, wherever situated.

1


 

          “Bankruptcy Law” means Title 11, U.S. Code or any similar federal or state law for the relief of debtors.
          “Board of Directors” means:
     (a) with respect to a corporation, the board of directors of the corporation or any committee thereof duly authorized to act on behalf of such board;
     (b) with respect to a partnership, the Board of Directors of the general partner of the partnership;
     (c) with respect to a limited liability company, the managing member or members or any controlling committee of managing members thereof; and
     (d) with respect to any other Person, the board or committee of such Person serving a similar function.
          “Business Day” means any day other than a Legal Holiday.
          “Change of Control” means an event whereby a Person (or a group of Persons acting in concert) other than one or more members of the Mittal Family controls or acquires control of the Company; provided that a Change of Control shall not be deemed to have occurred unless, within the Change of Control Period, (i) if the Company’s long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness is rated by any one or more Rating Agencies, a Rating Downgrade in respect of that Change of Control occurs and, in the case only of such Rating Downgrade occurring within the Potential Change of Control Period, the relevant Rating Agency does not, within the Potential Change of Control Period, reverse such Rating Downgrade so that the Company’s long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness has the same or a better credit rating attributed by such Rating Agency than before such Rating Downgrade occurred, or (ii) if the Company’s long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness is not rated by any one or more Rating Agencies, a Negative Rating Event in respect of that Change of Control occurs. For purposes of this definition, “control” means the power to direct the management and policies of an entity, whether through the ownership of voting capital, by contract or otherwise.
          “Change of Control Period” means the period commencing on the earlier of (i) the date of the first public announcement of the relevant Change of Control having occurred and (ii) the first day of the Potential Change of Control Period, and ending 90 days after the date of the first public announcement of the relevant Change of Control having occurred (the “Initial End Date”), provided that if one or more Rating Agencies has on or prior to the Initial End Date publicly announced that it has placed the rating of the Company’s long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness under consideration for rating downgrade (the “Placing on Credit Watch”), the Change of Control Period shall be extended to the earlier of (i) the later of (a) the date which falls 60 days after the date of the Placing on Credit Watch and (b) the Initial End Date or (ii) the date which falls 60 days after the Initial End Date.
          “Clearstream” means Clearstream Banking, S.A.
          “Closing Date” means the date hereof.
          “Company” means ArcelorMittal, and any and all successors thereto.
          “Consolidated Financial Statements” means the Company’s most recently published:

2


 

     (a) audited annual consolidated financial statements, as approved by the annual general meeting of its shareholders and certified by an independent auditor; or, as the case may be,
     (b) unaudited (but subject to a “review” from an independent auditor) consolidated half-year financial statements, as approved by the Board of Directors,
          in each case prepared in accordance with Applicable Accounting Standards.
          “Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee” will be at the address of the Trustee specified in Section 12.03 hereof or such other address as to which the Trustee may give notice to the Company.
          “Custodian” means the Trustee, as custodian with respect to the Notes in global form, or any successor entity thereto.
          “Default” means any event that is, or with the passage of time or the giving of notice or both would be, an Event of Default.
          “Definitive Note” means a certificated Note registered in the name of the Holder thereof and issued in accordance with Section 2.06 hereof, substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto except that such Note shall not bear the Global Note Legend and shall not have the “Schedule of Exchanges of Interests in the Global Note” attached thereto and shall include the appropriate Private Placement Legend.
          “Depositary” means, with respect to the Notes issuable or issued in whole or in part in global form, the Person specified in Section 2.03 hereof as the Depositary with respect to the Notes, and any and all successors thereto appointed as depositary hereunder and having become such pursuant to the applicable provision of this Indenture.
          “DTC” means The Depository Trust Company.
          “Euroclear” means Euroclear Bank, S.A./N.V., as operator of the Euroclear system.
          “Exchange Act” means the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and the rules and regulations promulgated by the SEC thereunder.
          “Exchange Notes” means debt securities of the Company substantially identical in all material respects to the Notes originally issued pursuant to an exemption from registration under the Securities Act (except that the transfer restrictions pertaining thereto will be modified or eliminated, as appropriate, and that the debt securities will not be subject to the payment of Additional Interest for failure to comply with the Registration Rights Agreement), to be issued under this Indenture pursuant to a Registered Exchange Offer for a like principal amount of Notes originally issued pursuant to an exemption from registration under the Securities Act, and any replacement Notes issued therefor in accordance with this Indenture.
          “Existing Security” means any Security granted by any Person over its Assets in respect of any Relevant Indebtedness and which is existing at the Closing Date or at the time any such Person becomes a Material Subsidiary or whose business and/or activities, in whole or in part, are assumed by or vested in the Company or a Material Subsidiary after the Closing Date (other than any Security created in contemplation thereof) or any substitute Security created over those Assets (or any part thereof) in connection with the refinancing of the Relevant Indebtedness secured on those Assets provided that the principal, nominal or capital amount secured on any such Security may not be increased.

3


 

          “Fitch” means Fitch Inc., and its successors.
          “Global Note Legend” means the legend set forth in Section 2.06(f)(2) hereof, which is required to be placed on all Global Notes issued under this Indenture.
          “Global Notes” means, individually and collectively, each of the Restricted Global Notes and the Unrestricted Global Notes deposited with or on behalf of and registered in the name of the Depository or its nominee, substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto and that bears the Global Note Legend and that has the “Schedule of Exchanges of Interests in the Global Note” attached thereto, issued in accordance with Section 2.01, 2.06(b)(4), 2.06(d)(2) or 2.06(d)(3) hereof or issued in connection with another Global Note pursuant to Section 2.07 or Section 2.10 hereof.
          “Government Securities” means direct obligations of, or obligations guaranteed by, the United States of America, and payment for which the United States pledges its full faith and credit which the full faith and credit.
          “Group” means the Company and its Subsidiaries taken as a whole.
          “Holder” means a Person in whose name a Note is registered on the records of the Registrar.
          “Indenture” means this Indenture, as amended or supplemented from time to time including, for all purposes of this instrument and any other supplemental indenture, the provisions of the Trust Indenture Act that are expressly incorporated by reference and otherwise, herein and in any other supplemental indenture, respectively.
          “Indirect Participant” means a Person who holds a beneficial interest in a Global Note through a Participant.
          “Initial Purchasers” means Goldman, Sachs & Co., J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc. and BNP Paribas Securities Corp.
          “Investment Grade Rating” means a rating equal to or higher than Baa3 by Moody’s (or its equivalent under any successor rating category of Moody’s), BBB- by S&P (or its equivalent under any successor rating category of S&P) and BBB- by Fitch (or its equivalent under any successor rating category of Fitch) and the equivalent investment grade credit rating from any replacement Rating Agency or Rating Agencies selected by the Company.
          “Legal Holiday” means a Saturday, a Sunday or a day on which banking institutions in the City of New York, New York, Paris or Luxembourg or a place of payment (which shall have been notified in writing to the Trustee) are authorized by law, regulation or executive order to close.
          “Material Subsidiary” means, at any time, a Subsidiary of the Company whose gross assets or pre-tax profits (excluding intra-Group items) then equal or exceed 5% of the gross assets or pre-tax profits of the Group.
          For this purpose:
     (a) the gross assets or pre-tax profits of a Subsidiary will be determined from its financial statements (unconsolidated if it has Subsidiaries) upon which the latest audited Consolidated Financial Statements of the Group have been based;

4


 

     (b) if a company becomes a member of the Group after the date on which the latest audited Consolidated Financial Statements of the Group have been prepared, the gross assets or pre-tax profits of that Subsidiary will be determined from its latest financial statements;
     (c) the gross assets or pre-tax profits of the Group will be determined from its latest audited Consolidated Financial Statements, adjusted (where appropriate) to reflect the gross assets or pre-tax profits of any company or business subsequently acquired or disposed of; and
     (d) if a Material Subsidiary disposes of all or substantially all of its assets to another Subsidiary of ours, it will immediately cease to be a Material Subsidiary and the other Subsidiary (if it is not already) will immediately become a Material Subsidiary; the subsequent financial statements of those Subsidiaries and the Group will be used to determine whether those Subsidiaries are Material Subsidiaries or not.
          If there is a dispute as to whether or not a company is a Material Subsidiary, a certificate of the Company’s auditors will be, in the absence of manifest error, conclusive and binding on the Company and the Holders.
          “Mittal Family” means Mr. and/or Mrs. L.N. Mittal and/or their family (acting directly or indirectly through trusts and/or other entities controlled by any of the foregoing).
          “Moody’s” means Moody’s Investors Service, Inc., and its successors.
          “Negative Rating Event” means the Company does not within the Change of Control Period obtain an Investment Grade Rating for the Company’s long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness from at least one Rating Agency.
          “Non-U.S. Person” means a Person who is not a U.S. Person.
          “Notes” has the meaning assigned to it in the preamble to this Indenture.
          “Officer” means, with respect to any Person, the Chairman of the Board, the Chief Executive Officer, the President, the Chief Operating Officer, the Chief Financial Officer, the Treasurer, any Assistant Treasurer, the Controller, the Secretary, any Vice-President, any Finance Special Proxy Holder of such Person or any member of the Group Management Board.
          “Officer’s Certificate” means a certificate signed on behalf of the Company by an Officer (as defined above) of the Company, that meets the requirements of Section 12.05 hereof.
          “Opinion of Counsel” means an opinion from legal counsel that is reasonably acceptable to the Trustee and that meets the requirements of Section 12.05 hereof, it being specified that such counsel may be an employee of or counsel to the Company, any Subsidiary of the Company or the Trustee.
          “Participant” means, with respect to the Depositary, Euroclear or Clearstream, a Person who has an account with the Depositary, Euroclear or Clearstream, respectively (and, with respect to DTC, shall include Euroclear and Clearstream).
          “Permitted Security” means:

5


 

     (a) any Existing Security;
     (b) any Security granted in respect of or in connection with any Securitization Indebtedness; or
     (c) any Security securing Project Finance Indebtedness, but only to the extent that the Security Interest is created on an asset of the project being financed by the relevant Project Finance Indebtedness (and/or the shares in, and/or shareholder loans to, the company conducting such project where such company has no assets other than those relating to such project).
          “Person” includes any individual, company, corporation, firm, partnership, joint venture, undertaking, association, organization, trust, state or agency of a state (in each case, whether or not having separate legal personality).
          “Potential Change of Control Period” means the period commencing on the date of the first public announcement of a potential Change of Control by the Company, or by any actual or potential bidder or any adviser thereto, and ending on the date of the first public announcement of the relevant Change of Control.
          “Private Placement Legend” means the legend set forth in Section 2.06(f)(1) hereof to be placed on all Notes issued under this Indenture except where otherwise permitted by the provisions of this Indenture.
          “Project Finance Indebtedness” means any indebtedness incurred by a debtor to finance the ownership, acquisition, construction, development and/or operation of an Asset or connected group of Assets in respect of which the Person or Persons to whom such indebtedness is, or may be, owed have no recourse for the repayment of or payment of any sum relating to such indebtedness other than:
     (a) recourse to such debtor or its Subsidiaries for amounts limited to the cash flow from such Asset; and/or
     (b) recourse to such debtor generally, or to a member of the Group, which recourse is limited to a claim for damages (other than liquidated damages and damages required to be calculated in a specific way) for breach of an obligation, representation or warranty (not being a payment obligation, representation or warranty or an obligation, representation or warranty to procure payment by another or an obligation, representation or warranty to comply or to procure compliance by another with any financial ratios or other test of financial condition) by the Person against whom such recourse is available; and/or
     (c) if:
  (i)   such debtor has been established specifically for the purpose of constructing, developing, owning and/or operating the relevant Asset or connected group of Assets; and
 
  (ii)   such debtor owns no Assets and carries on no business which is not related to the relevant Asset or connected group of Assets,
recourse to all the material Assets and undertaking of such debtor and the shares in the capital of such debtor and shareholder loans made to such debtor.

6


 

          “QIB” means a “qualified institutional buyer” as defined in Rule 144A.
          “Rating Agency” means (1) each of Moody’s, S&P and Fitch; (2) if any of Moody’s, S&P or Fitch ceases to rate the Notes or fails to make a rating of the Notes publicly available for reasons outside of the Company’s control, a “nationally recognized statistical rating organization” within the meaning of Section 3(a)(62) of the Exchange Act selected by the Company (as certified by a certificate of officers confirming the decision of the Company’s Board of Directors) to act as a replacement rating agency for Moody’s, S&P or Fitch or all of them, as the case may be.
          “Rating Downgrade” means the credit rating previously assigned to the Company’s long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness by any Rating Agency is (a) withdrawn or (b) is changed from investment grade to non-investment grade (for example, from BBB- to BB+ by S&P, or worse) or (c) if the credit rating previously assigned by the relevant Rating Agency was below investment grade, is lowered one rating notch (for example, from BB+ to BB by S&P), and such Rating Agency shall have publicly announced or confirmed in writing to the Company that such withdrawal or downgrade is principally the result of any event or circumstance comprised in or arising as a result of, or in respect of, the Change of Control or potential Change of Control.
          “Registered Exchange Offer” means an exchange offer by the Company registered under the Securities Act pursuant to which Notes originally issued pursuant to an exemption from registration under the Securities Act are exchanged for Notes of like principal amount not bearing the Private Placement Legend and not be subject to the payment of Additional Interest for failure to comply with the Registration Rights Agreement.
          “Registration Rights Agreement” means the Registration Rights Agreement dated as of May 27, 2008, among the Company and the Initial Purchasers.
          “Regulation S” means Regulation S promulgated under the Securities Act.
          “Regulation S Global Notes” means the Global Notes substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto bearing the Global Note Legend and the Private Placement Legend and deposited with or on behalf of and registered in the name of the Depositary or its nominee, issued in denominations equal to the respective outstanding principal amounts of the 2013 Notes and 2018 Notes sold in reliance on Rule 903 of Regulation S.
          “Relevant Indebtedness” means any indebtedness for borrowed money represented by bonds, notes or other debt instruments which are for the time being quoted or listed on any stock exchange or other similar regulated securities market.
          “Relevant Jurisdiction” has the meaning assigned to it in Section 5.11.
          “Responsible Officer,” when used with respect to the Trustee, means any officer assigned to the corporate trust department of the Trustee having direct responsibility for the administration of this Indenture or any other officer of the Trustee customarily performing functions and also means, with respect to a particular corporate trust matter, any other officer to whom such matter is referred because of his knowledge of and familiarity with the particular subject.
          “Restricted Definitive Note” means a Definitive Note bearing the Private Placement Legend.
          “Restricted Global Note” means a Global Note bearing the Private Placement Legend.

7


 

          “Restricted Period” means the 40-day distribution compliance period as defined in Regulation S.
          “Rule 144” means Rule 144 promulgated under the Securities Act.
          “Rule 144A” means Rule 144A promulgated under the Securities Act.
          “Rule 903” means Rule 903 promulgated under the Securities Act.
          “Rule 904” means Rule 904 promulgated under the Securities Act.
          “S&P” means Standard & Poor’s Rating Services, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., and its successors.
          “SEC” means the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.
          “Security” means any mortgage, charge, pledge or other real security interest (sûreté réelle).
          “Securities Act” means the U.S. Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the rules and regulations promulgated by the SEC thereunder.
          “Securitization Indebtedness” means any Relevant Indebtedness that is incurred in connection with any securitization, asset repackaging, factoring or like arrangement or any combination thereof of any assets, revenues or other receivables where the recourse of the Person making the Relevant Indebtedness available or entering into the relevant arrangement or agreement(s) is limited fully or substantially to such assets or revenues or other receivables.
          “Subsidiary” means:
     (a) an entity of which a Person has direct or indirect control or owns directly or indirectly more than 50% of the voting capital or similar right of ownership (and control for this purpose means the power to direct the management and the policies of the entity whether through the ownership of voting capital, by contract or otherwise); and
     (b) in relation to the Company, an entity that fulfils the definition in paragraph (a) above and which is included in the Consolidated Financial Statements on a fully integrated basis.
          “Trust Indenture Act” means the U.S Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended, or any successor statute, and the rules and regulations promulgated by the SEC thereunder.
          “Trustee” means HSBC Bank USA, National Association, until a successor replaces it in accordance with the applicable provisions of this Indenture and thereafter means the successor serving hereunder.
          “Unrestricted Definitive Note” means a Definitive Note that does not bear and is not required to bear the Private Placement Legend.
          “Unrestricted Global Note” means a Global Note that does not bear and is not required to bear the Private Placement Legend.

8


 

          “U.S. Person” means a U.S. Person as defined in Rule 902(k) promulgated under the Securities Act.
Section 1.02 Other Definitions.
     
    Defined
    in
Term   Section
Additional Amounts
  5.11
Authentication Order
  2.02
Change of Control Offer
  5.12
Change of Control Payment Date
  5.12
Covenant Defeasance
  9.03
Event of Default
  7.01
Interest Payment Date
  3.01
Interest Period
  3.01
Legal Defeasance
  9.02
Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event
  7.01
Note Register
  2.03
Paying Agent
  2.03
Process Agent
  12.12
Registrar
  2.03
Relevant Jurisdiction
  5.11
Tax Redemption Date
  4.06
Temporary Notes
  2.10
Section 1.03 Rules of Construction.
          Unless the context otherwise requires:
     (1) a term has the meaning assigned to it;
     (2) an accounting term not otherwise defined has the meaning assigned to it in accordance with Applicable Accounting Standards;
     (3) “or” is not exclusive;
     (4) words in the singular include the plural, and in the plural include the singular;
     (5) “will” shall be interpreted to express a command;
     (6) provisions apply to successive events and transactions; and
     (7) references to sections of or rules under the Securities Act or the Trust Indenture Act will be deemed to include substitute, replacement of successor sections or rules adopted by the SEC from time to time.

9


 

ARTICLE 2
THE NOTES
Section 2.01 Form and Dating.
          (a) General. The Notes and the Trustee’s certificate of authentication will be substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto. The Notes may have notations, legends or endorsements required by law, stock exchange rule or usage, provided that the text of any such notation, legend or endorsement shall be delivered to the Trustee in writing by the Company. Each Note will be dated the date of its authentication. The Notes shall be in a minimum denomination of US$2,000 and integral multiples of US$1,000 in excess thereof.
          The terms and provisions contained in the Notes will constitute, and are hereby expressly made, a part of this Indenture and the Company and the Trustee, by their execution and delivery of this Indenture, expressly agree to such terms and provisions and to be bound thereby. However, to the extent any provision of any Note conflicts with the express provisions of this Indenture, the provisions of this Indenture shall govern and be controlling.
          (b) Global Notes. Notes issued in global form will be substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto (including the Global Note Legend thereon and the “Schedule of Exchanges of Interests in the Global Note” attached thereto) which shall be deposited with the Trustee, as custodian of the Depositary, and registered in the name of the Depositary or a nominee of the Depositary and duly executed by the Company and authenticated by the Trustee as provided herein. Notes issued in definitive form will be substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto (but without the Global Note Legend thereon and without the “Schedule of Exchanges of Interests in the Global Note” attached thereto). Each Global Note will represent such of the outstanding Notes as will be specified therein and each shall provide that it represents the aggregate principal amount of outstanding Notes from time to time endorsed thereon and that the aggregate principal amount of outstanding Notes represented thereby may from time to time be reduced or increased, as appropriate, to reflect exchanges and redemptions. Any endorsement of a Global Note to reflect the amount of any increase or decrease in the aggregate principal amount of outstanding Notes represented thereby will be made by the Trustee or the Custodian, at the direction of the Trustee, in accordance with instructions given by the Holder thereof as required by Section 2.06 hereof.
          Except as set forth in Section 2.06 hereof, the Global Notes may be transferred, in whole or in part, only to another nominee of the Depositary or to a successor of the Depositary or its nominee.
Section 2.02 Execution and Authentication.
          At least one Officer must sign the Notes for the Company by manual or facsimile signature.
          If an Officer whose signature is on a Note no longer holds that office at the time a Note is authenticated, the Note will nevertheless be valid.
          A Note will not be valid until authenticated by the manual signature of the Trustee. The signature will be conclusive evidence that the Note has been authenticated under this Indenture.
          The Trustee will, upon receipt of a written order of the Company signed by an Officer directing the Trustee to authenticate Notes pursuant to instructions contained therein (an “Authentication Order”), authenticate Notes for original issue that may be validly issued under this Indenture. The aggregate principal amount of Notes outstanding at any time may not exceed the aggregate principal amount of

10


 

Notes authorized for issuance by the Company pursuant to one or more Authentication Orders, except as provided in Section 2.07 hereof.
          The Trustee may appoint an authenticating agent acceptable to the Company to authenticate Notes. An authenticating agent may authenticate Notes whenever the Trustee may do so. Each reference in this Indenture to authentication by the Trustee includes authentication by such agent. An authenticating agent has the same rights as an Agent to deal with Holders or an Affiliate of the Company.
Section 2.03 Registrar and Paying Agent.
          The Company will maintain an office or agency where Notes may be presented for registration of transfer or for exchange (“Registrar”) and an office or agency where Notes may be presented for payment (“Paying Agent”). The Registrar will keep a register of the Notes and of their transfer and exchange (the “Note Register”). The Company may appoint one or more co-registrars and one or more additional paying agents. The term “Registrar” includes any co-registrar and the term “Paying Agent” includes any additional paying agent. The Company may change any Paying Agent or Registrar without notice to any Holder. The Company will notify the Trustee in writing of the name and address of any Agent not a party to this Indenture. If the Company fails to appoint or maintain another entity as Registrar or Paying Agent, the Trustee shall act as such. The Company or any of its Subsidiaries may act as Paying Agent or Registrar.
          The Company initially appoints The Depository Trust Company (“DTC”) to act as Depositary with respect to the Global Notes.
          The Company initially appoints the Trustee to act as the Registrar and Paying Agent and to act as Custodian with respect to the Global Notes.
Section 2.04 Paying Agent to Hold Money in Trust.
          The Company will require each Paying Agent other than the Trustee to agree in writing that the Paying Agent will hold in trust for the benefit of Holders or the Trustee all money held by the Paying Agent for the payment of principal, interest or Additional Amounts, if any, on the Notes, and will notify the Trustee of any default by the Company in making any such payment. While any such default continues, the Trustee may require a Paying Agent to pay all money held by it to the Trustee. The Company at any time may require a Paying Agent to pay all money held by it to the Trustee. Upon payment over to the Trustee, the Paying Agent will have no further liability for the money. If the Company or a Subsidiary acts as Paying Agent, it will segregate and hold in a separate trust fund for the benefit of the Holders all money held by it as Paying Agent. Upon any bankruptcy or reorganization proceedings relating to the Company, the Trustee will serve as Paying Agent for the Notes.
Section 2.05 Holder Lists.
          The Registrar will preserve in as current a form as is reasonably practicable the most recent list available to it of the names and addresses of all Holders and shall otherwise comply with Trust Indenture Act Section 312(a). To the extent that the Notes are not held in the form of a Global Note, if the Trustee is not the Registrar, the Company will furnish to the Trustee at least seven Business Days before each interest payment date and at such other times as the Trustee may request in writing, a list in such form and as of such date as the Trustee may reasonably require of the names and addresses of the Holders of Notes and the Company shall comply with Trust Indenture Act Section 312(a).

11


 

Section 2.06 Transfer and Exchange.
          (a) Transfer and Exchange of Global Notes. A Global Note may not be transferred except as a whole by the Depositary to a nominee of the Depositary, by a nominee of the Depositary to the Depositary or to another nominee of the Depositary, or by the Depositary or any such nominee to a successor Depositary or a nominee of such successor Depositary. All Global Notes will be exchanged by the Company for Definitive Notes if:
     (1) the Company delivers to the Trustee notice from the Depositary that it is unwilling or unable to continue to act as Depositary or that it is no longer a clearing agency registered under the Exchange Act at a time when the Depositary is required to be so registered to act as Depositary and, in either case, a successor Depositary is not appointed by the Company within 90 days after the date of such notice from the Depositary;
     (2) the Company in its sole discretion determines that the Global Notes (in whole but not in part) should be exchanged for Definitive Notes and delivers a written notice to such effect to the Trustee; or
     (3) there has occurred and is continuing an Event of Default with respect to the Notes, and DTC representing a majority in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Global Notes so advises the Trustee in writing.
          Upon the occurrence of either of the preceding events in (1), (2) or (3) above, the Company shall deliver a sufficient number of Definitive Notes to the Trustee to permit the exchange of Global Notes for Definitive Notes and such Definitive Notes shall be issued in such names as the Depositary shall instruct the Trustee. Global Notes also may be exchanged or replaced, in whole or in part, as provided in Sections 2.07 and 2.10 hereof. Every Note authenticated and delivered in exchange for, or in lieu of, a Global Note or any portion thereof, pursuant to Section 2.07 or 2.10 hereof, shall be authenticated and delivered in the form of, and shall be, a Global Note. A Global Note may not be exchanged for another Note other than as provided in this Section 2.06(a) or Section 2.06(d), however, beneficial interests in a Global Note may be transferred and exchanged as provided in Section 2.06(b) or (c) hereof. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, the Company will not be obligated to issue Definitive Notes in exchange for beneficial interests in Global Notes except as required under the previous sentence.
          (b) Transfer and Exchange of Beneficial Interests in the Global Notes. The transfer and exchange of beneficial interests in the Global Notes will be effected through the Depositary, in accordance with the provisions of this Indenture and the Applicable Procedures. Beneficial interests in the Restricted Global Notes will be subject to restrictions on transfer comparable to those set forth herein to the extent required by the Securities Act. Transfers of beneficial interests in the Global Notes also will require compliance with either subparagraph (1) or (2) below, as applicable, as well as one or more of the other following subparagraphs, as applicable:
     (1) Transfer of Beneficial Interests in the Same Global Note. Beneficial interests in any Restricted Global Note may be transferred to Persons who take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in the same Restricted Global Note in accordance with the transfer restrictions set forth in the Private Placement Legend; provided, however, that prior to the expiration of the Restricted Period, transfers of beneficial interests in a Regulation S Global Note may not be made to a U.S. Person or for the account or benefit of a U.S. Person (other than an Initial Purchaser). Beneficial interests in any Unrestricted Global Note may be transferred to Persons who take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note. No written

12


 

orders or instructions shall be required to be delivered to the Registrar to effect the transfers described in this Section 2.06(b)(1).
     (2) All Other Transfers and Exchanges of Beneficial Interests in Global Notes. In connection with all transfers and exchanges of beneficial interests that are not subject to Section 2.06(b)(1) above, the transferor of such beneficial interest must deliver to the Registrar either:
(A) both:
     (i) a written order from a Participant or an Indirect Participant given to the Depositary in accordance with the Applicable Procedures directing the Depositary to credit or cause to be credited a beneficial interest in another Global Note of the same series in an amount equal to the beneficial interest to be transferred or exchanged; and
     (ii) instructions given in accordance with the Applicable Procedures containing information regarding the Participant account to be credited with such increase; or
(B) both:
     (i) a written order from a Participant or an Indirect Participant given to the Depositary in accordance with the Applicable Procedures directing the Depositary to cause to be issued a Definitive Note of the same series in an amount equal to the beneficial interest to be transferred or exchanged; and
     (ii) instructions given by the Depositary to the Registrar containing information regarding the Person in whose name such Definitive Note shall be registered to effect the transfer or exchange referred to in (1) above.
Upon satisfaction of all of the requirements for transfer or exchange of beneficial interests in Global Notes contained in this Indenture and the Notes or otherwise applicable under the Securities Act, the Trustee shall adjust the principal amount of the relevant Global Note(s) pursuant to Section 2.06(g) hereof.
     (3) Transfer of Beneficial Interests to Another Restricted Global Note. A beneficial interest in any Restricted Global Note may be transferred to a Person who takes delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in another Restricted Global Note of the same series if the transfer complies with the requirements of Section 2.06(b)(2) above and the Registrar receives the following:
     (A) if the transferee will take delivery in the form of a beneficial interest in a 144A Global Note, then the transferor must deliver a certificate in the form of Exhibit A hereto, including the certifications in item (1) thereof; or

13


 

     (B) if the transferee will take delivery in the form of a beneficial interest in a Regulation S Global Note, then the transferor must deliver a certificate in the form of Exhibit A hereto, including the certifications in item (2) thereof.
     (4) Transfer and Exchange of Beneficial Interests in a Restricted Global Note for Beneficial Interests in an Unrestricted Global Note. A beneficial interest in any Restricted Global Note may be exchanged by any holder thereof for a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note of the same series or transferred to a Person who takes delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note of the same series if the exchange or transfer complies with the requirements of Section 2.06(b)(2) above and:
     (A) the Registrar receives the following:
     (i) if the holder of such beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note proposes to exchange such beneficial interest for a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note, a certificate from such holder in the form of Exhibit C hereto, including the certifications in item (1)(a) thereof; or
     (ii) if the holder of such beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note proposes to transfer such beneficial interest to a Person who shall take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note, a certificate from such holder in the form of Exhibit B hereto, including the certifications in item (3) thereof;
and, in each such case set forth in this subparagraph (A), if the Registrar so requests or if the Applicable Procedures so require, an Opinion of Counsel in form reasonably acceptable to the Registrar to the effect that such exchange or transfer is in compliance with the Securities Act and that the restrictions on transfer contained herein and in the Private Placement Legend are no longer required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act.
          If any such transfer is effected pursuant to subparagraph (A) above at a time when an Unrestricted Global Note has not yet been issued, the Company shall issue and, upon receipt of an Authentication Order in accordance with Section 2.02 hereof, the Trustee shall authenticate one or more Unrestricted Global Notes in an aggregate principal amount equal to the aggregate principal amount of beneficial interests transferred pursuant to subparagraph (A) above.
          Beneficial interests in an Unrestricted Global Note cannot be exchanged for, or transferred to Persons who take delivery thereof in the form of, a beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note.
          (c) Transfer or Exchange of Beneficial Interests for Definitive Notes.
     (1) Beneficial Interests in Restricted Global Notes to Restricted Definitive Notes. If any holder of a beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note proposes to exchange such beneficial interest for a Restricted Definitive Note of the same series or to transfer such beneficial interest to a Person who takes delivery thereof in the form of a Restricted Definitive Note of the same series, then, upon receipt by the Registrar of the following documentation:
     (A) if the holder of such beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note proposes to exchange such beneficial interest for a Restricted Definitive Note, a

14


 

certificate from such holder in the form of Exhibit C hereto, including the certifications in item (2)(a) thereof;
     (B) if such beneficial interest is being transferred to a QIB in accordance with Rule 144A, a certificate to the effect set forth in Exhibit B hereto, including the certifications in item (1) thereof; or
     (C) if such beneficial interest is being transferred to a Non-U.S. Person in an offshore transaction in accordance with Rule 903 or Rule 904, a certificate to the effect set forth in Exhibit B hereto, including the certifications in item (2) thereof,
the Trustee shall cause the aggregate principal amount of the applicable Global Note to be reduced accordingly pursuant to Section 2.06(g) hereof, and the Company shall execute and the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver to the Person designated in the instructions a Definitive Note of the same series in the appropriate principal amount. Any Definitive Note issued in exchange for a beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note pursuant to this Section 2.06(c)(1) shall be registered in such name or names and in such authorized denomination or denominations as the holder of such beneficial interest shall instruct the Registrar through instructions from the Depositary and the Participant or Indirect Participant. The Trustee shall deliver such Definitive Notes to the Persons in whose names such Notes are so registered. Any Definitive Note issued in exchange for a beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note pursuant to this Section 2.06(c)(1) shall bear the Private Placement Legend and shall be subject to all restrictions on transfer contained therein.
     (2) Beneficial Interests in Restricted Global Notes to Unrestricted Definitive Notes. A holder of a beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note may exchange such beneficial interest for an Unrestricted Definitive Note of the same series or may transfer such beneficial interest to a Person who takes delivery thereof in the form of an Unrestricted Definitive Note of the same series only if:
     (A) the Registrar receives the following:
     (i) if the holder of such beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note proposes to exchange such beneficial interest for an Unrestricted Definitive Note, a certificate from such holder in the form of Exhibit C hereto, including the certifications in item (1)(b) thereof; or
     (ii) if the holder of such beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note proposes to transfer such beneficial interest to a Person who shall take delivery thereof in the form of an Unrestricted Definitive Note, a certificate from such holder in the form of Exhibit B hereto, including the certifications in item (3) thereof;
and, in each such case set forth in this subparagraph (A), if the Registrar so requests or if the Applicable Procedures so require, an Opinion of Counsel in form reasonably acceptable to the Registrar to the effect that such exchange or transfer is in compliance with the Securities Act and that the restrictions on transfer contained herein and in the Private Placement Legend are no longer required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act.

15


 

          (3) Beneficial Interests in Unrestricted Global Notes to Unrestricted Definitive Notes. If any holder of a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note proposes to exchange such beneficial interest for a Definitive Note of the same series or to transfer such beneficial interest to a Person who takes delivery thereof in the form of a Definitive Note of the same series, then, upon satisfaction of the conditions set forth in Section 2.06(b)(2) hereof, the Trustee will cause the aggregate principal amount of the applicable Global Note to be reduced accordingly pursuant to Section 2.06(g) hereof, and the Company will execute and the Trustee will authenticate and deliver to the Person designated in the instructions a Definitive Note in the appropriate principal amount. Any Definitive Note issued in exchange for a beneficial interest pursuant to this Section 2.06(c)(3) will be registered in such name or names and in such authorized denomination or denominations as the holder of such beneficial interest requests through instructions to the Registrar from or through the Depositary and the Participant or Indirect Participant. The Trustee will deliver such Definitive Notes to the Persons in whose names such Notes are so registered. Any Definitive Note issued in exchange for a beneficial interest pursuant to this Section 2.06(c)(3) will not bear the Private Placement Legend.
(d) Transfer and Exchange of Definitive Notes for Beneficial Interests.
          (1) Restricted Definitive Notes to Beneficial Interests in Restricted Global Notes. If any Holder of a Restricted Definitive Note proposes to exchange such Note for a beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note of the same series or to transfer such Restricted Definitive Notes to a Person who takes delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note of the same series, then, upon receipt by the Registrar of the following documentation:
     (A) if the Holder of such Restricted Definitive Note proposes to exchange such Note for a beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note, a certificate from such Holder in the form of Exhibit C hereto, including the certifications in item (2)(b) thereof;
     (B) if such Restricted Definitive Note is being transferred to a QIB in accordance with Rule 144A, a certificate to the effect set forth in Exhibit B hereto, including the certifications in item (1) thereof; or
     (C) if such Restricted Definitive Note is being transferred to a Non-U.S. Person in an offshore transaction in accordance with Rule 903 or Rule 904, a certificate to the effect set forth in Exhibit B hereto, including the certifications in item (2) thereof,
the Trustee will cancel the Restricted Definitive Note, increase or cause to be increased the aggregate principal amount of, in the case of clause (A) above, the appropriate Restricted Global Note, in the case of clause (B) above, the appropriate 144A Global Note, and in the case of clause (C) above, the appropriate Regulation S Global Note.
          (2) Restricted Definitive Notes to Beneficial Interests in Unrestricted Global Notes. A Holder of a Restricted Definitive Note may exchange such Note for a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note of the same series or transfer such Restricted Definitive Note to a Person who takes delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note of the same series only if:
     (A) the Registrar receives the following:

16


 

     (i) if the Holder of such Definitive Notes proposes to exchange such Notes for a beneficial interest in the Unrestricted Global Note, a certificate from such Holder in the form of Exhibit C hereto, including the certifications in item (1)(c) thereof; or
     (ii) if the Holder of such Definitive Notes proposes to transfer such Notes to a Person who shall take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in the Unrestricted Global Note, a certificate from such Holder in the form of Exhibit B hereto, including the certifications in item (3) thereof;
and, in each such case set forth in this subparagraph (A), if the Registrar so requests or if the Applicable Procedures so require, an Opinion of Counsel in form reasonably acceptable to the Registrar to the effect that such exchange or transfer is in compliance with the Securities Act and that the restrictions on transfer contained herein and in the Private Placement Legend are no longer required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act.
     Upon satisfaction of the conditions of any of the subparagraphs in this Section 2.06(d)(2), the Trustee will cancel the Definitive Notes and increase or cause to be increased the aggregate principal amount of the Unrestricted Global Note of the same series.
     (3) Unrestricted Definitive Notes to Beneficial Interests in Unrestricted Global Notes. A Holder of an Unrestricted Definitive Note may exchange such Note for a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note of the same series or transfer such Definitive Notes to a Person who takes delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note of the same series at any time. Upon receipt of a request for such an exchange or transfer, the Trustee will cancel the applicable Unrestricted Definitive Note and increase or cause to be increased the aggregate principal amount of one of the Unrestricted Global Notes of the same series.
     If any such exchange or transfer from a Definitive Note to a beneficial interest is effected pursuant to subparagraphs (2)(A) or (3) above at a time when an Unrestricted Global Note has not yet been issued, the Company will issue and, upon receipt of an Authentication Order in accordance with Section 2.02 hereof, the Trustee will authenticate one or more Unrestricted Global Notes in an aggregate principal amount equal to the principal amount of Definitive Notes so transferred.
          (e) Transfer and Exchange of Definitive Notes for Definitive Notes. Upon request by a Holder of Definitive Notes and such Holder’s compliance with the provisions of this Section 2.06(e), the Registrar will register the transfer or exchange of Definitive Notes. Prior to such registration of transfer or exchange, the requesting Holder must present or surrender to the Registrar the Definitive Notes duly endorsed or accompanied by a written instruction of transfer in form satisfactory to the Registrar duly executed by such Holder or by its attorney, duly authorized in writing. In addition, the requesting Holder must provide any additional certifications, documents and information, as applicable, required pursuant to the following provisions of this Section 2.06(e).
     (1) Restricted Definitive Notes to Restricted Definitive Notes. Any Restricted Definitive Note may be transferred to and registered in the name of Persons who take delivery thereof in the form of a Restricted Definitive Note if the Registrar receives the following:

17


 

          (A) if the transfer will be made pursuant to Rule 144A, then the transferor must deliver a certificate in the form of Exhibit B hereto, including the certifications in item (1) thereof; and
          (B) if the transfer will be made pursuant to Rule 903 or Rule 904, then the transferor must deliver a certificate in the form of Exhibit B hereto, including the certifications in item (2) thereof.
          (2) Restricted Definitive Notes to Unrestricted Definitive Notes. Any Restricted Definitive Note may be exchanged by the Holder thereof for an Unrestricted Definitive Note of the same series or transferred to a Person or Persons who take delivery thereof in the form of an Unrestricted Definitive Note of the same series if:
     (A) the Registrar receives the following:
     (i) if the Holder of such Restricted Definitive Notes proposes to exchange such Notes for an Unrestricted Definitive Note, a certificate from such Holder in the form of Exhibit C hereto, including the certifications in item (1)(d) thereof; or
     (ii) if the Holder of such Restricted Definitive Notes proposes to transfer such Notes to a Person who shall take delivery thereof in the form of an Unrestricted Definitive Note, a certificate from such Holder in the form of Exhibit B hereto, including the certifications in item (3) thereof;
and, in each such case set forth in this subparagraph (A), if the Registrar so requests, an Opinion of Counsel in form reasonably acceptable to the Registrar to the effect that such exchange or transfer is in compliance with the Securities Act and that the restrictions on transfer contained herein and in the Private Placement Legend are no longer required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act.
     (3) Unrestricted Definitive Notes to Unrestricted Definitive Notes. A Holder of Unrestricted Definitive Notes may transfer such Notes to a Person who takes delivery thereof in the form of an Unrestricted Definitive Note. Upon receipt of a request to register such a transfer, the Registrar shall register the Unrestricted Definitive Notes pursuant to the instructions from the Holder thereof.
          (f) Legends. The following legends will appear on the face of all Global Notes and Definitive Notes issued under this Indenture unless specifically stated otherwise in the applicable provisions of this Indenture.
     (1) Private Placement Legend.
     (A) Except as permitted by subparagraph (C) below, each Global Note and each Definitive Note (and all Notes issued in exchange therefor or substitution thereof) that is acquired in a sale being made in reliance upon Regulation S shall bear the legend in substantially the following form:
“THIS SECURITY HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE UNITED STATES SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “SECURITIES ACT”), OR THE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY

18


 

STATE OR OTHER JURISDICTION, AND, ACCORDINGLY, MAY NOT BE OFFERED OR SOLD WITHIN THE UNITED STATES OR TO OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OR BENEFIT OF US PERSONS EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN THE FOLLOWING SENTENCE. BY ITS ACQUISITION HEREOF, THE HOLDER (1) REPRESENTS THAT IT IS NOT A US PERSON, IS NOT ACQUIRING THIS SECURITY FOR THE ACCOUNT OR BENEFIT OF A US PERSON AND IS ACQUIRING THIS SECURITY IN AN OFFSHORE TRANSACTION, (2) BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF, AGREES TO OFFER, SELL OR OTHERWISE TRANSFER SUCH SECURITY ONLY (A) TO THE COMPANY OR ANY AFFILIATE THEREOF, (B) PURSUANT TO A REGISTRATION STATEMENT THAT HAS BEEN DECLARED EFFECTIVE UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, (C) FOR SO LONG AS THE NOTES ARE ELIGIBLE FOR RESALE PURSUANT TO RULE 144A UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT (“RULE 144A”), TO A PERSON IT REASONABLY BELIEVES IS A “QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER” AS DEFINED IN RULE 144A THAT PURCHASES FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER TO WHOM NOTICE IS GIVEN THAT THE TRANSFER IS BEING MADE IN RELIANCE ON RULE 144A IN A TRANSACTION MEETING THE REQUIREMENTS OF RULE 144A, (D) PURSUANT TO OFFERS AND SALES THAT OCCUR OUTSIDE THE UNITED STATES IN COMPLIANCE WITH RULE 903 OR 904 UNDER REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OR (E) PURSUANT TO ANOTHER AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT, IN EACH CASE IN ACCORDANCE WITH ALL APPLICABLE SECURITIES LAWS OF THE STATES OF THE UNITED STATES OR ANY OTHER APPLICABLE JURISDICTION AND (3) AGREES THAT IT WILL DELIVER TO EACH PERSON TO WHOM THIS SECURITY IS TRANSFERRED A NOTICE SUBSTANTIALLY TO THE EFFECT OF THIS RESTRICTIVE LEGEND. THIS LEGEND WILL BE REMOVED AFTER 40 CONSECUTIVE DAYS BEGINNING ON AND INCLUDING THE LATER OF (A) THE DAY ON WHICH THE NOTES ARE OFFERED TO PERSONS OTHER THAN DISTRIBUTORS (AS DEFINED IN REGULATION S) AND (B) THE DATE OF THE CLOSING OF THE ORIGINAL OFFERING. AS USED HEREIN, THE TERMS “OFFSHORE TRANSACTION”, “UNITED STATES” AND “US PERSON” HAVE THE MEANINGS GIVEN TO THEM BY REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT.”
     (B) Except as permitted by subparagraph (c) below, each Global Note and each Definitive Note (and all Notes issued in exchange therefor or substitution thereof) that is acquired in a sale being made in reliance upon Rule 144A shall bear the legend in substantially the following form:
“THIS SECURITY HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE UNITED STATES SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “SECURITIES ACT”), OR THE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY STATE OR OTHER JURISDICTION. NEITHER THIS SECURITY NOR ANY INTEREST OR PARTICIPATION HEREIN MAY BE REOFFERED, SOLD, ASSIGNED, TRANSFERRED, PLEDGED, ENCUMBERED OR OTHERWISE DISPOSED OF IN THE ABSENCE OF SUCH REGISTRATION OR UNLESS SUCH TRANSACTION IS EXEMPT FROM, OR NOT SUBJECT TO, SUCH REGISTRATION.
THE HOLDER OF THIS SECURITY BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF (1) REPRESENTS THAT IT IS A “QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER” (AS DEFINED IN RULE 144A UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT) PURCHASING THIS SECURITY FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF ONE OR MORE QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYERS; (2) AGREES TO OFFER, SELL OR OTHERWISE TRANSFER SUCH SECURITY, PRIOR TO THE DATE (THE “RESALE RESTRICTION TERMINATION DATE”) WHICH IS ONE YEAR AFTER THE LATER OF THE ORIGINAL ISSUE DATE HEREOF AND THE LAST DATE ON WHICH THE COMPANY OR ANY AFFILIATE OF THE COMPANY WAS THE OWNER OF THIS SECURITY (OR ANY PREDECESSOR OF SUCH SECURITY), ONLY (A) TO THE COMPANY OR ANY

19


 

AFFILIATE THEREOF, (B) PURSUANT TO A REGISTRATION STATEMENT THAT HAS BEEN DECLARED EFFECTIVE UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, (C) FOR SO LONG AS THE NOTES ARE ELIGIBLE FOR RESALE PURSUANT TO RULE 144A, TO A PERSON IT REASONABLY BELIEVES IS A “QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER”, THAT PURCHASES FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER TO WHOM NOTICE IS GIVEN THAT THE TRANSFER IS BEING MADE IN RELIANCE ON RULE 144A, IN A PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF NOT LESS THAN US$2,000, (D) PURSUANT TO OFFERS AND SALES THAT OCCUR OUTSIDE THE UNITED STATES IN COMPLIANCE WITH RULE 903 OR 904 UNDER REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, (E) PURSUANT TO ANOTHER AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT, IN EACH CASE IN ACCORDANCE WITH ALL APPLICABLE SECURITIES LAWS OF THE STATES OF THE UNITED STATES OR ANY OTHER APPLICABLE JURISDICTION; AND (3) AGREES THAT IT WILL DELIVER TO EACH PERSON TO WHOM THIS SECURITY IS TRANSFERRED A NOTICE SUBSTANTIALLY TO THE EFFECT OF THIS RESTRICTIVE LEGEND. THIS LEGEND WILL BE REMOVED UPON THE REQUEST OF THE HOLDER AFTER THE RESALE RESTRICTION TERMINATION DATE.”
     (C) Notwithstanding the foregoing, any Global Note or Definitive Note issued pursuant to subparagraphs (b)(4), (c)(2), (c)(3), (d)(2), (d)(3), (e)(2) or (e)(3) of this Section 2.06 (and all Notes issued in exchange therefor or substitution thereof) will not bear the Private Placement Legend.
     (2) Global Note Legend. Each Global Note will bear a legend in substantially the following form:
“THIS GLOBAL NOTE IS HELD BY THE DEPOSITARY (AS DEFINED IN THE INDENTURE GOVERNING THIS NOTE) OR ITS NOMINEE IN CUSTODY FOR THE BENEFIT OF THE BENEFICIAL OWNERS HEREOF, AND IS NOT TRANSFERABLE TO ANY PERSON UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES EXCEPT THAT (1) THE TRUSTEE MAY MAKE SUCH NOTATIONS HEREON AS MAY BE REQUIRED PURSUANT TO SECTION 10.04 OF THE INDENTURE, (2) THIS GLOBAL NOTE MAY BE EXCHANGED IN WHOLE BUT NOT IN PART PURSUANT TO SECTION 2.06(a) OF THE INDENTURE, (3) THIS GLOBAL NOTE MAY BE DELIVERED TO THE TRUSTEE FOR CANCELLATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 2.11 OF THE INDENTURE AND (4) THIS GLOBAL NOTE MAY BE TRANSFERRED TO A SUCCESSOR DEPOSITARY WITH THE PRIOR WRITTEN CONSENT OF THE COMPANY.
UNLESS AND UNTIL IT IS EXCHANGED IN WHOLE OR IN PART FOR NOTES IN DEFINITIVE FORM, THIS NOTE MAY NOT BE TRANSFERRED EXCEPT AS A WHOLE BY THE DEPOSITARY TO A NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY OR BY A NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY TO THE DEPOSITARY OR ANOTHER NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY OR BY THE DEPOSITARY OR ANY SUCH NOMINEE TO A SUCCESSOR DEPOSITARY OR A NOMINEE OF SUCH SUCCESSOR DEPOSITARY. UNLESS THIS CERTIFICATE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY (55 WATER STREET, NEW YORK, NEW YORK) (“DTC”), TO THE COMPANY OR ITS AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY CERTIFICATE ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR SUCH OTHER NAME AS MAY BE REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT IS

20


 

MADE TO CEDE & CO. OR SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS MAY BE REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC), ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL INASMUCH AS THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.”
          (g) Cancellation and/or Adjustment of Global Notes. At such time as all beneficial interests in a particular Global Note have been exchanged for Definitive Notes or a particular Global Note has been redeemed, repurchased or canceled in whole and not in part, each such Global Note will be returned to or retained and canceled by the Trustee in accordance with Section 2.11 hereof. At any time prior to such cancellation, if any beneficial interest in a Global Note is exchanged for or transferred to a Person who will take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in another Global Note or for Definitive Notes, the principal amount of Notes represented by such Global Note will be reduced accordingly and an endorsement will be made on such Global Note by the Trustee or by the Depositary at the direction of the Trustee to reflect such reduction; and if the beneficial interest is being exchanged for or transferred to a Person who will take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in another Global Note, such other Global Note will be increased accordingly and an endorsement will be made on such Global Note by the Trustee or by the Depositary at the direction of the Trustee to reflect such increase.
          (h) General Provisions Relating to Transfers and Exchanges.
     (1) To permit registrations of transfers and exchanges, the Company will execute and the Trustee will authenticate Global Notes and Definitive Notes upon receipt of an Authentication Order in accordance with Section 2.02 hereof or at the Registrar’s request.
     (2) No service charge will be made to a Holder of a beneficial interest in a Global Note or to a Holder of a Definitive Note for any registration of transfer or exchange, but the Company may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any transfer tax or similar governmental charge payable in connection therewith.
     (3) The Registrar will not be required to register the transfer of or exchange of any Note selected for redemption.
     (4) All Global Notes and Definitive Notes issued upon any registration of transfer or exchange of Global Notes or Definitive Notes will be the valid obligations of the Company, evidencing the same debt, and entitled to the same benefits under this Indenture, as the Global Notes or Definitive Notes surrendered upon such registration of transfer or exchange.
     (5) Neither the Registrar nor the Company will be required:
     (A) to register the transfer of or to exchange any Notes during a period beginning at the opening of business 15 days before the day of any selection of Notes of such series for redemption under Section 4.02 hereof and ending at the close of business on the day of selection;
     (B) to register the transfer of or to exchange any Note selected for redemption; or
     (C) to register the transfer of or to exchange a Note between a record date and the next succeeding interest payment date.

21


 

     (6) Prior to due presentment for the registration of a transfer of any Note, the Trustee, any Agent and the Company may deem and treat the Person in whose name any Note is registered as the absolute owner of such Note for the purpose of receiving payment of principal of and interest on such Notes and for all other purposes, and none of the Trustee, any Agent or the Company shall be affected by notice to the contrary.
     (7) The Trustee will authenticate Global Notes and Definitive Notes in accordance with the provisions of Section 2.02 hereof.
     (8) All certifications, certificates and Opinions of Counsel required to be submitted to the Registrar pursuant to this Section 2.06 to effect a registration of transfer or exchange may be submitted by facsimile.
     (9) Each Holders agrees to provide reasonable indemnity to the Company and the Trustee against any liability that may result from the transfer, exchange or assignment of such Holder’s Note in violation of any provision of this Indenture and/or applicable United States federal or state securities law.
     (10) The Trustee shall have no obligation or duty to monitor, determine or inquire as to compliance with any restrictions on transfer imposed under this Indenture or any restrictions on transfer imposed under this Indenture or under applicable law with respect to any transfer of any interest in any Note (including any transfers between or among beneficial owners of interests in any Global Note) other than to require delivery of such certificates and other documentation or evidence as are expressly required by, and to do so if and when expressly required by the terms of, this Indenture, and to examine the same to determine substantial compliance as to form with the express requirements hereof.
     (11) Upon consummation of an Exchange Offer (a) beneficial interests in a Restricted Global Note exchanged in the Exchange Offer will be exchanged for beneficial interests in an Unrestricted Global Note and (b) Restricted Definitive Notes exchanged in the Exchange Offer will be exchanged for Unrestricted Definitive Notes and upon consummation of an Exchange Offer, the Trustee will authenticate Exchange Notes upon a Company Order.
     (12) Beneficial interests in a Restricted Global Note or a Regulation S Global Note may be transferred in the form of, exchanged for or replaced with beneficial interests in an Unrestricted Global Note and Restricted Definitive Notes may be exchanged for Unrestricted Definitive Notes if in connection with such transfer, exchange or replacement the Registrar and the Company shall have received an opinion of counsel, certificates and/or such other evidence reasonably required by and satisfactory to them to the effect that neither such Private Placement Legend nor the related restrictions on transfer are required in order to maintain compliance with the provisions of the Securities Act.
Section 2.07 Replacement Notes.
          If any mutilated Note is surrendered to the Trustee or the Company and the Trustee receives evidence to its satisfaction of the destruction, loss or theft of any Note, the Company will issue and the Trustee, upon receipt of an Authentication Order, will authenticate a replacement Note if the Trustee’s requirements are met. If required by the Trustee or the Company, an indemnity bond must be supplied by the Holder that is sufficient in the judgment of the Trustee and the Company to protect the Company, the

22


 

Trustee, any Agent and any authenticating agent from any loss that any of them may suffer if a Note is replaced. The Company may charge for its expenses in replacing a Note.
          Every replacement Note is an additional obligation of the Company and will be entitled to all of the benefits of this Indenture equally and proportionately with all other Notes duly issued hereunder.
Section 2.08 Outstanding Notes.
          The Notes outstanding at any time are all the Notes authenticated by the Trustee except for those canceled by it, those delivered to it for cancellation, those reductions in the interest in a Global Note effected by the Trustee in accordance with the provisions hereof, and those described in this Section 2.08 as not outstanding. Except as set forth in Section 2.09 hereof, a Note does not cease to be outstanding because the Company or an Affiliate of the Company holds the Note.
          If a Note is replaced pursuant to Section 2.07 hereof, it ceases to be outstanding unless the Trustee receives proof satisfactory to it that the replaced Note is held by a protected purchaser.
          If the principal amount of any Note is considered paid under Section 5.01 hereof, it ceases to be outstanding and interest on it ceases to accrue.
          Notes, or portions thereof, for the payment, redemption or, in the case of a Change of Control Offer, purchase of which, money in the necessary amount has been theretofore deposited with the Trustee or any Paying Agent (other than the Company or an Affiliate of the Company) in trust or set aside and segregated in trust by the Company or an Affiliate of the Company (if the Company or such Affiliate is acting as the Paying Agent) for the Holders of such Notes are not considered outstanding; provided that, if Notes (or portions thereof) are to be redeemed or purchased, notice of such redemption or purchase has been duly given pursuant to this Indenture or provision therefor reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee has been made.
Section 2.09 Treasury Notes.
          In determining whether the Holders of the required principal amount of Notes have concurred in any direction, waiver or consent, Notes owned by the Company or by any Person directly or indirectly controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect common control with the Company will be considered as though not outstanding, except that for the purposes of determining whether the Trustee will be protected in relying on any such direction, waiver or consent, only Notes that the Trustee knows are so owned will be so disregarded.
Section 2.10 Temporary Notes.
          Until certificates representing Notes are ready for delivery, the Company may prepare and the Trustee, upon receipt of an Authentication Order, will authenticate temporary Notes (“Temporary Notes”). Temporary Notes will be substantially in the form of certificated Notes but may have variations that the Company considers appropriate for Temporary Notes and as may be reasonably acceptable to the Trustee. Without unreasonable delay, the Company will prepare and the Trustee will authenticate definitive Notes in exchange for Temporary Notes.
          Holders of Temporary Notes will be entitled to all of the benefits of this Indenture.

23


 

Section 2.11 Cancellation.
          All Notes that are exchanged or purchased may either be held or retransferred or resold or be surrendered for cancellation and, if so surrendered, will, together with all Notes redeemed by the Company, be cancelled immediately and accordingly may not be reissued or resold. The Trustee will make its record of any such cancellation available for inspection to Holders during its normal business hours. All cancelled Notes held by the Trustee shall be disposed of in accordance with its customary practices and a certification of their disposal will be provided to the Company.
Section 2.12 Defaulted Interest.
          If the Company defaults in a payment of interest on any of the Notes, it will pay the defaulted interest in any lawful manner plus, to the extent lawful, interest payable on the defaulted interest, to the Persons who are Holders of such Notes on a subsequent special record date, in each case at the rate provided in such Notes and in Section 3.01 hereof. The Company will notify the Trustee in writing of the amount of defaulted interest proposed to be paid on each such Note and the date of the proposed payment. The Company will fix or cause to be fixed each such special record date and payment date; provided that no such special record date may be less than 10 days prior to the related payment date for such defaulted interest. At least 15 days before the special record date, the Company (or, upon the written request of the Company, the Trustee in the name and at the expense of the Company) will mail or cause to be mailed to Holders of such Notes a notice that states the special record date, the related payment date and the amount of such interest to be paid.
Section 2.13 Issuance of Additional Notes.
          The Company shall be entitled, subject to its compliance with the conditions and covenants provided for in this Indenture, to issue additional notes under this Indenture having identical terms as either series of the Notes (other than with respect to the date of issuance, issue price, the amount of the first interest payment, the interest paid on the Notes prior to the issuance of the additional notes, any applicable transfer restrictions, and the benefits of the Registration Rights Agreement and Additional Interest with respect thereto). Any further notes forming a single series with a series of the outstanding Notes shall be treated as a single class with such series for all purposes under this Indenture, including without limitation, waiver, amendments, redemptions and offers to purchase; provided, that such additional notes will be issued with no more than de minimis original issue discount for U.S. federal income tax purposes or be part of a qualified reopening for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
          With respect to any additional notes, the Company shall set forth in an Officer’s Certificate, a copy of which shall be delivered to the Trustee, confirming the due authorization of the Company with respect to the aggregate principal amount of such additional notes to be authenticated and delivered pursuant to this Indenture.

24


 

ARTICLE 3
PROVISIONS FOR INTEREST PAYMENTS
Section 3.01 Interest.
          (a) Interest Payments and Interest Payment Dates.
          The Company will pay interest on the principal amount of the 2013 Notes at 5.375% per annum from the Closing Date until maturity. The Company will pay interest on the principal amount of the 2018 Notes at 6.125% per annum from May 27, 2008 until maturity. The Company will pay interest and Additional Amounts, if any, pursuant to Section 5.14, semi-annually in arrears on June 1 and December 1 of each year (each an “Interest Payment Date”), commencing on December 1, 2008, to the Holders of Notes registered as such as of close of business on May 15 and November 15 (whether or not a Business Day), immediately preceding the relevant Interest Payment Date.
          If an Interest Payment Date or the maturity date in respect of the Notes is not a Business Day in the place of payment, we will pay interest or principal, as the case may be, on the next Business Day. Payments postponed to the next Business Day in this situation will be treated under this Indenture as if they were made on the original due date. Postponement of this kind will not result in a default under the Notes or this Indenture, and no interest will accrue on the postponed amount from the original due date to the next day that is a Business Day.
          (b) Calculation of Interest.
          Interest on the Notes will accrue from the Closing Date or, if interest has already been paid, from the date it was most recently paid (each such period, an “Interest Period”). Interest on the Notes will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months.
ARTICLE 4
REDEMPTION AND PREPAYMENT
Section 4.01 Notices to Trustee.
          If the Company elects to redeem Notes pursuant to the optional redemption provisions of Section 4.06 hereof, it must furnish to the Trustee, at least 30 days but not more than 60 days before a redemption date (the “Redemption Date”), (i) an Opinion of Counsel with respect to matters of the Relevant Jurisdiction to the effect that the change or amendment referred to in Section 4.06 hereof has occurred and (ii) an Officer’s Certificate setting forth:
     (1) the section of the Indenture under which redemption is being effected;
     (2) the principal amount of Notes to be redeemed;
     (3) the Redemption Date;
     (4) the redemption price; and
     (5) a statement that the Company is entitled to effect the optional redemption provisions of Section 4.06 hereof and a statement of facts showing that the conditions precedent to the right of redemption have occurred.

25


 

          The Trustee will accept such Officer’s Certificate and Opinion of Counsel as sufficient evidence of the satisfaction of the conditions precedent described in Section 4.06 hereof, in which event it will be conclusive and binding on the Holders.
          Notwithstanding the foregoing paragraph, no notice of redemption may be given earlier than 60 days prior to the earliest date on which the Company is obligated to pay Additional Amounts if a payment in respect of the Notes was then due.
Section 4.02 Notice of Redemption.
          At least 30 days but not more than 60 days before a Redemption Date, the Company will mail or cause to be mailed, by first class mail, a notice of redemption to each Holder of the series being redeemed at its registered address.
          The notice will state:
     (1) the Redemption Date;
     (2) the redemption price;
     (3) the name and address of the Paying Agent;
     (4) that Notes called for redemption must be surrendered to the Paying Agent to collect the redemption price;
     (5) that, on the Redemption Date, the redemption price shall become due and payable and unless the Company defaults in making such redemption payment, interest on Notes called for redemption ceases to accrue on and after the Redemption Date;
     (6) that no representation is made as to the correctness or accuracy of the CUSIP number, if any, listed in such notice or printed on the Notes.
          At the Company’s request, the Trustee will give the notice of redemption in the Company’s name and at its expense; provided, however, that the Company has delivered to the Trustee, at least 45 days prior to the Redemption Date, an Officer’s Certificate requesting that the Trustee give such notice and setting forth the information to be stated in such notice as provided in the preceding paragraph.
Section 4.03 Effect of Notice of Redemption.
          Once notice of redemption is mailed in accordance with Section 4.02 hereof, Notes called for redemption become irrevocably due and payable on the Redemption Date at the redemption price. A notice of redemption may not be conditional.
Section 4.04 Deposit of Redemption or Purchase Price.
          Prior to 10:00 a.m. Eastern Time on the Redemption Date, the Company will deposit with the Trustee or with the Paying Agent money sufficient to pay the redemption price of and accrued interest and Additional Amounts, if any, on all Notes to be redeemed. The Trustee or the Paying Agent will promptly return to the Company any money deposited with the Trustee or the Paying Agent by the

26


 

Company in excess of the amounts necessary to pay the redemption price of, and accrued interest and Additional Amounts, if any, on, the Notes to be redeemed.
          If the Company complies with the provisions of the preceding paragraph, on and after the Redemption Date, interest will cease to accrue on the Notes. If a Note is redeemed on or after an interest record date but on or prior to the related Interest Payment Date, then any accrued and unpaid interest shall be paid to the Person in whose name such Note was registered at the close of business on such record date. If any Note called for redemption is not so paid upon surrender for redemption because of the failure of the Company to comply with the preceding paragraph, interest shall be paid on the unpaid principal, from the Redemption Date until such principal is paid, and to the extent lawful on any interest not paid on such unpaid principal, in each case at the rate provided in the Notes and in Section 3.01 hereof.
Section 4.05 Redemption at the Option of the Company
          The Company will have the right to redeem the Notes of any series, in whole or in part from time to time, at the Company’s option, on at least 30 days’ but no more than 60 days’ prior written notice mailed to the registered Holders of such series of Notes to be redeemed. Upon redemption of the Notes, the Company will pay a redemption price equal to the greater of (1) 100% of the principal amount of the Notes to be redeemed and (2) the sum of the present values of the Remaining Scheduled Payments (as defined below) of the Notes to be redeemed, discounted to the date of redemption on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the Treasury Rate (as defined below) plus 40 basis points, in each case plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the Redemption Date and certified as to amount to the Trustee in an Officer’s Certificate.
          For the purposes of the foregoing:
          “Treasury Rate” means, for any Redemption Date, the rate per annum equal to the semiannual equivalent yield to maturity, of the Comparable Treasury Issue, assuming a price for the Comparable Treasury Issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the Comparable Treasury Price for that Redemption Date.
          “Comparable Treasury Issue” means the United States Treasury security selected by an Independent Investment Banker as having a maturity comparable to the remaining term of the Notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of the Notes to be redeemed.
          “Comparable Treasury Price” means, with respect to any Redemption Date (1) the average of the Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations for such Redemption Date, after excluding the highest and lowest of the Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations, or (2) if the Independent Investment Banker obtains fewer than four Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations, the average of all of these quotations.
          “Independent Investment Banker” means one of the Reference Treasury Dealers appointed by the Company.
          “Reference Treasury Dealer” means each of BNP Paribas Securities Corp., Goldman, Sachs & Co., J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. and HSBC Securities (USA) Inc. (or their respective affiliates that are primary U.S. Government securities dealers), and their respective successors, or if at any time any of the

27


 

above is not a primary U.S. Government securities dealer, one other nationally recognized investment banking firm selected by the Company that is a primary U.S. Government securities dealer.
          “Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations” means, with respect to each Reference Treasury Dealer and any Redemption Date, the average, as determined by the Independent Investment Banker, of the bid and asked prices for the Comparable Treasury Issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the Independent Investment Banker by such Reference Treasury Dealer at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the third Business Day preceding such Redemption Date.
          “Remaining Scheduled Payments” means, with respect to each Note to be redeemed, the remaining scheduled payments of the principal thereof and interest thereon that would be due after the related Redemption Date for such redemption; provided, however, that, if such Redemption Date is not an Interest Payment Date with respect to such Note, the amount of the next succeeding scheduled interest payment thereon will be reduced by the amount of interest accrued thereon to such Redemption Date.
          The notice of redemption will state any conditions applicable to a redemption and the amount of Notes of any series to be redeemed. If less than all the Notes of any series are to be redeemed, the Notes of such series to be redeemed shall be selected by the Trustee by such method as the Trustee deems fair and appropriate.
          Except as described under Section 4.06, the Notes will not otherwise be redeemable by the Company at the Company’s option prior to maturity.
Section 4.06 Redemption for Taxation Reasons.
          The Notes may be redeemed, at the Company’s option, in whole but not in part, upon giving not less than 30 days’ nor more than 60 days’ notice to the Holders (which notice will be irrevocable), at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof, together with accrued and unpaid interest (including any Additional Amounts), if any, to the date fixed by the Company for redemption (the “Tax Redemption Date”) if, as a result of:
     (1) any change in, or amendment to, the laws (or any regulations or rulings promulgated thereunder) of a Relevant Jurisdiction affecting taxation; or
     (2) any change in, or amendment to, an official position regarding the application or interpretation of such laws, regulations or rulings (including a holding, judgment or order by a court of competent jurisdiction),
which change or amendment becomes effective (i) in the case of the Company, on or after the Closing Date or (ii) in the case of any successor entity, on or after the date such successor entity becomes obligated under the Notes or the Indenture, with respect to any payment due or to become due under the Notes or the Indenture, the Company or its successor entity, as the case may be, is, or on the next Interest Payment Date would be, required to pay Additional Amounts, and such requirement cannot be avoided by the Company or its successor entity, as the case may be, taking reasonable measures available to it; provided that for the avoidance of doubt changing the jurisdiction of the Company or any successor entity is not a reasonable measure for the purposes of this section; and provided, further that no such notice of redemption will be given earlier than 60 days prior to the earliest date on which we, or any successor entity, as the case may be, would be obligated to pay such Additional Amounts if a payment in respect of the Notes were then due.

28


 

          Any Notes that are redeemed will be cancelled.
Section 4.07 Mandatory Redemption.
          The Company is not required to make mandatory redemption or sinking fund payments with respect to the Notes.
Section 4.08 Purchases and Exchanges of Notes by the Company.
          The Company or an Affiliate of the Company may at any time purchase any Notes in the open market or otherwise at any price or exchange the Notes for other bonds or notes issued by the Company or any other Person; provided that the Company will not, and will use its reasonable best efforts to cause its Affiliates not to, re-issue, re-sell, convey, pledge, or otherwise transfer any such Restricted Definitive Notes or such beneficial interests in any Restricted Global Notes purchased by the Company or any of its Affiliates, unless such Restricted Definitive Notes or such beneficial interests in the Restricted Global Notes are registered under the Securities Act or such transfers are in compliance with Regulation S or Rule 144 under the Securities Act.
ARTICLE 5
COVENANTS
Section 5.01 Payments.
          The Company shall pay, or cause to be paid, the principal, interest and Additional Amounts, if any on the dates and in the manner referred to in Section 4.05 hereof.
          Principal, any amounts referred to in Section 4.05, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, will be considered paid on the date due if the Paying Agent, if other than the Company or a Subsidiary thereof, holds as of 10:00 a.m. Eastern Time on the due date money deposited by the Company in immediately available funds and designated for and sufficient to pay all principal and interest and Additional Amounts, if any, then due.
          If a payment date is a Legal Holiday in a place of payment, payment may be made at that place on the next succeeding day that is not a Legal Holiday, and no interest shall accrue or be reduced, as the case may be, on such payment for the intervening period. The Company shall provide in its notice of any such place of payment to the Trustee, notice of the Legal Holidays in such jurisdiction.
          The Company shall pay all Additional Interest, if any, in the same manner on the dates and amounts set forth in the Registration Rights Agreement; provided, however, the Company shall deliver an Officer’s Certificate pursuant to Section 5.13.
Section 5.02 Maintenance of Office or Agency.
          The Company will maintain in the Borough of Manhattan, the City of New York, an office or agency (which may be an office of the Trustee or an affiliate of the Trustee, Registrar or co-registrar) where Notes may be surrendered for registration of transfer or for exchange and will maintain an office in the United States where notices and demands to or upon the Company in respect of the Notes and this Indenture may be served. The Company hereby designates the office for registration of transfer or for exchange of Notes to be at the office of the Trustee at HSBC Bank USA, National Association, Corporate Trust Office, 10 East 40th Street, 14th Floor, New York, NY 10016, United States, and designates the

29


 

office for service of notices and demands to or upon the Company to be at ArcelorMittal USA Inc., 1 South Dearborn, Chicago, Illinois 60603, USA. The Company hereby agrees not to change the designation of either such office without prior written notice to the Trustee and designation of a replacement for such office or agency. If at any time the Company fails to maintain at least one such required office or agency where Notes may be surrendered for registration of transfer or for exchange and where notices and demands to or upon the Company in respect of the Notes and this Indenture may be served or fails to furnish the Trustee with the address thereof, such presentations, surrenders, notices and demands may be made or served at the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee.
          The Company may also from time to time designate one or more other offices or agencies where the Notes may be presented or surrendered for any or all such purposes and may from time to time rescind such designations; provided, however, that no such designation or rescission will in any manner relieve the Company of its obligation to maintain an office or agency in the Borough of Manhattan, the City of New York for such purposes. The Company will give prompt written notice to the Trustee of any such designation or rescission and of any change in the location of any such other office or agency.
          The Company hereby designates the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee as one such office or agency of the Company in accordance with Section 2.03 hereof.
Section 5.03 Appointment to Fill a Vacancy in the Office of the Trustee.
          Whenever necessary to avoid or fill a vacancy in the office of the Trustee, the Company will appoint a successor trustee in accordance with Section 8.08 hereof so that there will at all times be a Trustee with respect to the Notes.
Section 5.04 Notice of Certain Events.
          (a) The Company will give written notice to the Trustee at its Corporate Trust Office, promptly and in any event within fifteen days after it becomes aware of the occurrence of any Event of Default hereunder.
          (b) If the Trustee has received written notice of an Event of Default, the Trustee will give notice of that event to the Holders within 90 days after the Trustee has received written notice thereof. The Trustee may withhold notice to the Holders of such an event (except the non-payment of principal or interest) if a committee of its trust officers determines in good faith that withholding notice is in the interests of the Holders.
Section 5.05 Reports
          The Company shall:
     (1) file with the Trustee copies of the annual reports and of the information, documents and other reports (or copies of such portions of any of the foregoing as the SEC may from time to time by rules and regulations prescribe) which the Company is required to file with the SEC pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act within 15 days of filing with the SEC; or, if the Company is not required to file information, documents or reports pursuant to either of said Sections, then it shall file with the Trustee and the SEC, in accordance with rules and regulations prescribed from time to time by the SEC, such of the supplementary and periodic information, documents and reports (if any) which may be required pursuant to Section 13 of the Exchange Act in respect of a security listed and registered on a national

30


 

securities exchange as may be prescribed from time to time in such rules and regulations, if any, adopted pursuant to Section 314(a)(1) of the Trust Indenture Act;
     (2) file with the Trustee and the SEC, such information, documents and other reports, and such summaries thereof, as may be required pursuant to the Trust Indenture Act at the times and in the manner provided in the Trust Indenture Act; and
          (b) cause the Trustee to transmit by mail to all Holders, as their names and addresses appear in the Security Register, within 30 days after the filing thereof with the Trustee, such summaries of any information, documents and reports required to be filed by the Company pursuant to paragraphs (1) and (2) of this Section as may be required by rules and regulations prescribed from time to time by the SEC. Delivery of such reports, information and documents to the Trustee is for informational purposes only and the Trustee’s receipt of such shall not constitute constructive notice of any information contained therein or determinable from information contained therein, including the Company’s compliance with any of its covenants hereunder (as to which the Trustee is entitled to rely exclusively on Officer’s Certificates).
Section 5.06 Compliance Certificate.
          The Company shall deliver to the Trustee within 120 days after the end of its fiscal year an Officer’s Certificate stating that it has complied with its obligations under the Indenture and that no Event of Default has occurred during such period, or if one or more has occurred, specifying those Events of Default and what actions, if any, have been taken by the Company upon becoming aware of the occurrence of, or what actions, if any, the Company proposes to take with respect to, each such Event of Default.
Section 5.07 Further Actions.
          The Company will execute and deliver such further instruments and do such further acts as may be reasonably necessary or proper or as the Trustee may reasonably request to carry out more effectively the purpose of this Indenture.
Section 5.08 Stay, Extension and Usury Laws.
          The Company covenants (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) that it will not, at any time insist upon, plead, or in any manner whatsoever claim, or to the extent permitted by law, take the benefit or advantage of, any stay, extension or usury law wherever enacted, now or at any time hereafter in force, that may affect the covenants or the performance of this Indenture; and the Company hereby expressly waives (to the extent it may lawfully do so) all benefit or advantage of any such law, and covenants that it will not, by resort to any such law, hinder, delay or impede the execution of any power herein granted to the Trustee, but will, to the extent permitted by law, suffer and permit the execution of every such power as though no such law has been enacted.
Section 5.09 Corporate Existence.
          Subject to Article 6, the Company will preserve and keep in full force and effect its corporate existence.

31


 

Section 5.10 Negative Pledge.
          The Company covenants that so long as any of the Notes remain outstanding, it will not, and will not permit any Material Subsidiary to, create or permit to subsist, any Security upon any of their respective Assets, present or future, to secure any Relevant Indebtedness incurred or guaranteed by it or by any Material Subsidiary (whether before or after the issue of the Notes) other than Permitted Security unless the obligations of the Company under the Notes are (i) equally and rateably secured so as to rank pari passu with such Relevant Indebtedness or the guarantee thereof or (ii) benefit from any other Security or arrangement as shall be approved by the Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Notes of the affected series then outstanding.
Section 5.11 Payment of Additional Amounts.
          (a) The Company will make all payments of principal and interest on the Notes without withholding or deduction for, or on account of, any present or future taxes, duties, assessments or governmental charges of whatever nature imposed or levied by or within Luxembourg (or in the case of a successor entity any jurisdiction in which such successor entity is organized or resident for tax purposes (or any political subdivision or taxing authority thereof or therein)) (each, as applicable, a “Relevant Jurisdiction”), unless such withholding or deduction is required by law or by regulation or governmental policy having the force of law. In the event that any such withholding or deduction is so required, the Company or any successor entity, as the case may be, will make such deduction or withholding, make payment of the amount so withheld to the appropriate governmental authority and will pay such additional amounts (“Additional Amounts”) as will result in receipt by the Holders of such amounts as would have been received by the Holders had no such withholding or deduction been required by the Relevant Jurisdiction, except that no Additional Amounts will be payable:
     (1) for or on account of:
          (a) any tax, duty, assessment or other governmental charge that would not have been imposed but for:
     (A) the existence of any present or former connection between the Holder or beneficial owner of such Note, as the case may be, and the Relevant Jurisdiction including, without limitation, such Holder or beneficial owner being or having been a citizen or resident of such Relevant Jurisdiction or treated as a resident thereof or being or having been physically present or engaged in a trade or business therein or having or having had a permanent establishment therein, other than merely holding such Note or the receipt of payments thereunder;
     (B) the presentation of such Note (where presentation is required) more than 30 days after the later of the date on which the payment of the principal of, premium, if any, or interest on, such Note became due and payable pursuant to the terms thereof or was made or duly provided for, except to the extent that the holder thereof would have been entitled to such Additional Amounts if it had presented such Note for payment on any date within such 30-day period;
     (C) the failure of the Holder or beneficial owner to comply with a timely request of the Company or any successor entity addressed to the holder or beneficial owner, as the case may be, to provide information, documentation and certification concerning such Holder’s or beneficial owner’s nationality, residence, identity or

32


 

connection with any Relevant Jurisdiction, if and to the extent that due and timely compliance with such request would under applicable law, regulation or administrative practice have reduced or eliminated any withholding or deduction as to which Additional Amounts would have otherwise been payable to such Holder or beneficial owner; or
     (D) the presentation of such Note (where presentation is required) for payment in the Relevant Jurisdiction, unless such Note could not have been presented for payment elsewhere;
          (b) any estate, inheritance, gift, sale, transfer, excise or personal property or similar tax, assessment or other governmental charge;
          (c) any withholding or deduction in respect of any tax, duty, assessment or other governmental charge where such withholding or deduction is imposed or levied on a payment to an individual and is required to be made pursuant to European Council Directive 2003/48/EC or any other Directive implementing the conclusions of the ECOFIN Council meeting of November 26-27, 2000 on the taxation of savings income or any law implementing or complying with, or introduced in order to conform to, such Directives; or
          (d) any combination of taxes, duties, assessments or other governmental charges referred to in the preceding clauses (a), (b) and (c); or
     (2) with respect to any payment of the principal of, or premium, if any, or interest on, such Note to a holder who is a fiduciary, partnership or Person other than the sole beneficial owner of any payment to the extent that such payment would be required to be included in the income under the laws of a Relevant Jurisdiction, for tax purposes, of a beneficiary or settlor with respect to the fiduciary, or a member of that partnership or a beneficial owner who would not have been entitled to such Additional Amounts had that beneficiary, settlor, partner, or beneficial owner been the holder thereof.
          (b) Whenever there is mentioned in any context the payment of principal of, and any premium or interest on, any Note, such mention will be deemed to include payment of Additional Amounts provided for in the Indenture to the extent that, in such context, Additional Amounts are, were or would be payable in respect thereof.
Section 5.12 Offer to Purchase Upon a Change of Control
          Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, unless the Company has exercised its right to redeem the Notes under Section 4.05 or under Section 4.06, or unless the Change of Control Payment Date would fall on or after the maturity date of the Notes, the Company will make an offer to purchase all or a portion of each Holder’s Notes pursuant to the offer described below (the “Change of Control Offer”), at a purchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount tendered plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of purchase.
          Within 30 days following the date upon which the Change of Control occurred, or at the Company’s option, prior to any Change of Control but after the public announcement of the pending Change of Control, the Company will be required to send, by first class mail, a notice to each Holder of Notes, with a copy to the Trustee, which notice will govern the terms of the Change of Control Offer. Such notice will state, among other things, the purchase date, which must be no earlier than 30 days nor later than 60 days from the date such notice is mailed, other than as may be required by law (the “Change

33


 

of Control Payment Date”). The notice, if mailed prior to the date of consummation of the Change of Control, will state that the Change of Control Offer is conditioned on the Change of Control being consummated on or prior to the Change of Control Payment Date. Holders of Notes electing to have Notes purchased pursuant to a Change of Control Offer will be required to tender the Notes in accordance with the terms of the Change of Control Offer prior to the close of business on the third Business Day prior to the Change of Control Payment Date.
     On the Change of Control Payment Date, the Company will, to the extent lawful:
     (a) accept for payment all Notes or portions thereof properly tendered pursuant to the Change of Control Offer;
     (b) deposit with the Paying Agent and instruct the Paying Agent in writing to pay an amount equal to the purchase price in respect of all Notes or portions thereof so tendered; and
     (c) deliver or cause to be delivered to the Trustee the Notes so accepted together with an Officer’s Certificate stating the aggregate principal amount of Notes or portions thereof being purchased by the Company.
          Upon receipt of the foregoing, the Paying Agent will promptly mail or wire to each Holder of Notes so tendered the purchase price for such Notes, and the Trustee, upon written instruction by the Company, will promptly authenticate and mail or cause to be transferred by book entry to each holder a new Note equal in principal amount to any unpurchased portion of the Notes surrendered, if any; provided that each such new note will be in a principal amount of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof. The Company will publicly announce the results of the Change of Control Offer on or as soon as practicable after the Change of Control Payment Date.
          The Company shall comply with the requirements of Rule 14e-1 under the Exchange Act, and any other securities laws and regulations thereunder to the extent those laws and regulations are applicable in connection with the repurchase of the Notes as a result of a Change of Control. To the extent that the provisions of any such securities laws or regulations conflict with the Change of Control Offer provisions of the Notes, the Company shall comply with those securities laws and regulations and shall not be deemed to have breached the Company’s obligations under the Change of Control Offer provisions of the Notes by virtue of any such conflict.
          The Trustee is under no obligation to ascertain whether a Change of Control or any event that could lead to the occurrence of or could constitute a Change of Control has occurred, and until it has actual knowledge or express notice to the contrary, the Trustee may assume that no Change of Control or other such event has occurred.
Section 5.13 Payment of Additional Interest
          If Additional Interest is payable by the Company pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, the Company shall deliver to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate to that effect stating (i) the amount of such Additional Interest that is payable, (ii) the reason why such Additional Interest is payable and (iii) the date on which such Additional Interest is payable. Unless and until the Trustee receives such a certificate, the Trustee may assume without inquiry that no such Additional Interest is payable. If the Company has paid Additional Interest directly to the Persons entitled to it, the Company shall deliver to the Trustee a certificate setting forth the particulars of such payment.

34


 

ARTICLE 6
SUCCESSORS
Section 6.01 Consolidation, Merger, Conveyance or Transfer.
          So long as any Notes are outstanding, the Company will not consolidate with or merge into any other Person (excluding Persons controlled by one or more members of the Mittal Family) or convey or transfer substantially all of its properties and assets to any other Person (excluding Persons controlled by one or more members of the Mittal Family) unless thereafter:
     (1) the Person formed by such consolidation or into which it is merged, or the Person which acquired all or substantially all of the Company’s properties and assets, expressly assumes pursuant to a supplemental indenture the due and punctual payment of the principal of and interest on all the Notes and the performance or observance of every covenant herein on the Company’s part to be performed or observed (including, if such Person is not organized in or a resident of Luxembourg for tax purposes, substituting such Person’s jurisdiction of organization or residence for tax purposes for Luxembourg, where applicable, including for the obligation to pay Additional Amounts);
     (2) immediately after giving effect to such transaction, no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing; and
     (3) the Person formed by such consolidation or into which the Company is merged, or the Person which acquired all or substantially all of the properties and assets of the Company delivers to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that the consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer and, if a supplemental indenture is required in connection with the transaction, the supplemental indenture, comply with the terms and conditions herein and that all conditions precedent in the Indenture relating to the transaction have been complied with and, immediately giving effect to such transaction, no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, except that such Officer’s Certificate and Opinion of Counsel shall not be required in the event any such consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer is made by order of any court or tribunal having jurisdiction over the Company, its properties and assets.
ARTICLE 7
DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES
Section 7.01 Events of Default.
          Each of the following is an “Event of Default”:
     (1) default in any payment of principal on any Note when due (at maturity, upon redemption or otherwise), continues for 15 days;
     (2) default in the payment of interest, Additional Interest (if any) and Additional Amounts (if any) on any Note when due, continues for 30 days;
     (3) the Company’s failure to comply with any other obligation contained in this Indenture (other than a covenant default in whose performance or whose breach is elsewhere in

35


 

this Section specifically dealt with), and continuance of such default or breach for a period of 60 days after there has been given to the Company by the Trustee written notice, as provided in accordance with Section 12.03, specifying such default or breach and requiring it to be remedied;
     (4) the Company’s failure, or the failure of any Material Subsidiary, (a) to pay the principal of any indebtedness for borrowed money, including obligations evidenced by any mortgage, indenture, bond, debenture, note, guarantee or other similar instruments on the scheduled or original date due (following the giving of such notice, if any, as required under the document governing such indebtedness and as extended by any applicable cure period) or (b) to observe or perform any agreement or condition relating to such indebtedness such that such indebtedness has come due prior to its stated maturity and such acceleration has not been cured, unless (in the case of clauses (a) and (b)) (i) the aggregate amount of such indebtedness is less than €100,000,000 or (ii) the question of whether such indebtedness is due has been disputed in good faith by appropriate proceedings and such dispute has not been finally adjudicated against the Company or the Material Subsidiary, as the case may be.
     (5) if the Company is (or is deemed by law or a court to be) insolvent or bankrupt or presents a request for controlled management (gestion contrôlée) or is granted a moratorium on payments or is unable to pay its debts, stops, suspends or threatens to stop or suspend payment of all or a material part of (or of a particular type of) its debts within the meaning of any applicable law, proposes or makes any agreement for the deferral, rescheduling or other readjustment of all of (or all of a particular type of) its debts (or of any part which it will or might otherwise be unable to pay when due), proposes or makes a general assignment or any arrangement or composition with or for the benefit of the relevant creditors in respect of any of such debts or a moratorium is agreed or declared in respect of or affecting all or any part of (or of a particular type of) the debts of the Company or any event occurs which under the laws of any relevant jurisdiction has an analogous effect to any of the foregoing events; or
     (6) if any Material Subsidiary is (or is deemed by law or a court to be) insolvent or bankrupt or presents a request for controlled management (gestion contrôlée) or is granted a moratorium on payments or is unable to pay its debts, stops, suspends or threatens to stop or suspend payment of all or a material part of (or of a particular type of) its debts within the meaning of any applicable law, proposes or makes any agreement for the deferral, rescheduling or other readjustment of all of (or all of a particular type of) its debts (or of any part which it will or might otherwise be unable to pay when due), proposes or makes a general assignment or any arrangement or composition with or for the benefit of the relevant creditors in respect of any of such debts or a moratorium is agreed or declared in respect of or affecting all or any part of (or of a particular type of) the debts of any such Material Subsidiary or any event occurs which under the laws of any relevant jurisdiction has an analogous effect to any of the foregoing events (in each case, a “Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event”), provided that no Event of Default under this paragraph (ii) will occur in relation to any such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event unless (x) the credit rating assigned by any Rating Agency to the long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness of the Company within the period of 60 days immediately following such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event is less than the credit rating assigned by such agency to the long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness of the Company immediately prior to or on the effective date of such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event and (y) a Rating Agency making a Rating Downgrade publicly announces or confirms that such Rating Downgrade was the result of any event or circumstance comprised in or arising as a result of, or in respect of, such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event.

36


 

Section 7.02 Acceleration.
          Upon the occurrence and continuation of any Event of Default, then in every such case the Trustee or the Holders of at least 25% in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of the affected series may declare the principal amount of the outstanding Notes of that series to be due and payable immediately, by a notice in writing to the Company (and to the Trustee if given by Holders), in accordance with Section 12.03 hereof. Upon any such declaration, the Notes shall become due and payable immediately.
          At any time after such a declaration of acceleration with respect to outstanding Notes of any series has been made and before a judgment or decree for payment of the money due has been obtained by the Trustee as hereinafter in this Article provided, the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes of that series, by written notice to the Company and the Trustee, may rescind and annul such declaration and its consequences if:
     (1) the Company has paid or deposited with the Trustee a sum sufficient to pay
          (a) all overdue interest on all Notes of that series,
          (b) the principal of (and premium, if any, on) any Notes of that series which have become due otherwise than by such declaration of acceleration and interest thereon at the rate or rates prescribed therefor in such Notes,
          (c) to the extent that payment of such interest is lawful, interest upon overdue interest at the rate or rates prescribed therefor in such Notes, and
          (d) all sums paid or advanced by the Trustee hereunder and the reasonable and documented compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel;
and
     (2) all Events of Default with respect to Notes of that series, other than the non-payment of the principal and other amounts of Notes of that series which have become due solely by such declaration of acceleration, have been cured or waived as provided in Section 7.04.
          No such rescission shall affect any subsequent default or impair any right consequent thereon.
Section 7.03 Other Remedies.
          If an Event of Default occurs or if the Company breaches any covenant or warranty under this Indenture or the Notes, the Trustee may pursue any available remedy to enforce any provision of the Notes or this Indenture.
          The Trustee may maintain a proceeding even if it does not possess any of the Notes or does not produce any of them in the proceeding. A delay or omission by the Trustee or any Holder of a Note in exercising any right or remedy accruing upon an Event of Default shall not impair the right or remedy or constitute a waiver of or acquiescence in the Event of Default. All remedies are cumulative to the extent permitted by law.

37


 

Section 7.04 Waiver of Past Defaults.
          The Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of any series by notice to the Trustee may waive any past default under this Indenture affecting such series, except an uncured default in the payment of principal of or interest on such series of Notes or an uncured default relating to a covenant or provision of the Indenture that cannot be modified or amended without the consent of each affected Holder.
Section 7.05 Control by Majority.
          Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of a series will have the right to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for exercising any remedy available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee, in each case with respect to such series and subject to the limitations specified herein. Subject to Article 8 herein relating to the Trustee’s duties, the Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of its rights and powers under the Indenture unless such Holder has offered an indemnity to its reasonable satisfaction against any loss, costs, expenses and liabilities it may incur.
Section 7.06 Limitation on Suits.
          No Holder of Notes of any series will have any right to institute any proceeding with respect to this Indenture or the Notes of the series or for any remedy thereunder, unless:
     (1) such Holder has previously given written notice to the Trustee at its Corporate Trust Office of a continuing Event of Default under the Notes of the series has occurred;
     (2) Holders of not less than 25% in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of the relevant series have made a written request to the Trustee to institute the proceedings in respect of the Event of Default or breach in its own name as Trustee under this Indenture;
     (3) the Holders of the Notes of the relevant series have offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity against the cost and other liabilities of instituting a proceeding and provided a written request to the Trustee at its Corporate Trust Office;
     (4) the Trustee for 60 days thereafter has failed to institute any such proceeding; and
     (5) during such 60-day period, the Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of the relevant series have not given the Trustee a direction that is inconsistent with such written request.
          it being understood and intended that no one or more Holders shall have any right in any manner whatever by virtue of, or by availing of, any provision of this Indenture to affect, disturb or prejudice the rights of any other Holders, or to obtain or to seek to obtain priority or preference over any other Holders or to enforce any right under this Indenture, except in the manner herein provided and for the equal and ratable benefit of all the Holders.
Section 7.07 Rights of Holders of Notes to Receive Payment.
          Notwithstanding any other provision of this Indenture, the right of any Holder of a Note to receive payment of principal, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, on the Note, on or after the

38


 

respective due dates expressed in the Note (including in connection with a Change of Control Offer), or to institute a suit for the enforcement of any such payment on or after such respective dates, shall not be impaired without the consent of such Holder.
Section 7.08 Collection Suit by Trustee.
          If an Event of Default specified in Section 7.01(1) or (2) hereof occurs and is continuing, the Trustee is authorized to recover judgment in its own name and as trustee of an express trust against the Company for the whole amount of principal of, interest, Additional Interest and Additional Amounts, if any, remaining unpaid on, the Notes and interest on overdue principal and, to the extent lawful, interest and such further amount as shall be sufficient to cover the costs and expenses of collection, including the reasonable and documented compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel.
Section 7.09 Trustee May File Proofs of Claim.
          The Trustee is authorized to file such proofs of claim and other papers or documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the Trustee (including any claim for the compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel) and the Holders of the Notes allowed in any judicial proceedings relative to the Company (or any other obligor upon the Notes), its creditors or its property and shall be entitled and empowered to collect, receive and distribute any money or other property payable or deliverable on any such claims and any custodian in any such judicial proceeding is hereby authorized by each Holder to make such payments to the Trustee, and in the event that the Trustee shall consent to the making of such payments directly to the Holders, to pay to the Trustee any amount due to it for the compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Trustee under Section 8.07 hereof. To the extent that the payment of any such compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Trustee under Section 8.07 hereof out of the estate in any such proceeding, shall be denied for any reason, payment of the same shall be secured by the lien as specified in Section 8.07(d) on, and shall be paid out of, any and all distributions, dividends, money, securities and other properties that the Holders may be entitled to receive in such proceeding whether in liquidation or under any plan of reorganization or arrangement or otherwise. Nothing herein contained shall be deemed to authorize the Trustee to authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Holder any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the Notes or the rights of any Holder, or to authorize the Trustee to vote in respect of the claim of any Holder in any such proceeding.
Section 7.10 Priorities.
          If the Trustee collects any money pursuant to this Article 7, it shall pay out the money in the following order:
     First: to the Trustee, its agents and attorneys in respect of their documented fees and for amounts due under Section 8.07 hereof, including payment of all compensation, expenses and liabilities incurred, and all advances made, by the Trustee and the costs and expenses of collection;
     Second: to Holders of Notes for amounts due and unpaid on the Notes for principal, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, ratably, without preference or priority of any kind,

39


 

according to the amounts due and payable on the Notes for principal, interest, Additional Interest, if any, and Additional Amounts, if any, respectively; and
     Third: to the Company or to such party as a court of competent jurisdiction shall direct.
          The Trustee may fix a record date and payment date for any payment to Holders of Notes pursuant to this Section 7.10.
Section 7.11 Restoration of Rights and Remedies.
          If the Trustee or any Holder has instituted any proceeding to enforce any right or remedy under this Indenture and such proceeding has been discontinued or abandoned for any reason, or has been determined adversely to the Trustee or to such Holder, then and in every such case, subject to any determination in such proceeding, the Company shall be restored to its former position hereunder and thereafter all rights and remedies of the Trustee and the Holders shall continue as though no such proceeding had been instituted.
Section 7.12 Undertaking for Costs.
          In any suit for the enforcement of any right or remedy under this Indenture or in any suit against the Trustee for any action taken or omitted by it as a Trustee, a court in its discretion may require the filing by any party litigant in the suit of an undertaking to pay the costs of the suit, and the court in its discretion may assess reasonable costs, including reasonable attorneys’ fees, against any party litigant in the suit, having due regard to the merits and good faith of the claims or defenses made by the party litigant. This Section 7.12 does not apply to a suit by the Trustee, a suit by a Holder of a Note pursuant to Section 7.07 hereof, or a suit by Holders of more than 10% in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes.
ARTICLE 8
TRUSTEE
Section 8.01 Duties of Trustee.
          (a) If an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Trustee will exercise such of the rights and powers vested in it by this Indenture, and use the same degree of care and skill in its exercise, as a prudent person would exercise or use under the circumstances in the conduct of such person’s own affairs.
          (b) Except during the continuance of an Event of Default:
     (1) the duties of the Trustee will be determined solely by the express provisions of this Indenture and the Trustee need perform only those duties that are specifically set forth in this Indenture and no others, and no implied covenants or obligations shall be read into this Indenture against the Trustee; and
     (2) in the absence of bad faith on its part, the Trustee may conclusively rely, as to the truth of the statements and the correctness of the opinions expressed therein, upon certificates or opinions furnished to the Trustee and conforming to the requirements of this Indenture. However, in the case of certificates or opinions required to be furnished to the Trustee under this

40


 

Indenture, the Trustee will examine the certificates and opinions to determine whether or not they conform to the requirements of this Indenture, but need not confirm or investigate the accuracy of mathematical calculations or other facts stated therein.
          (c) The Trustee may not be relieved from liabilities for its own negligent action, its own negligent failure to act, or its own willful misconduct, except that:
     (1) this paragraph does not limit the effect of paragraph (b) of this Section 8.01;
     (2) the Trustee will not be liable for any error of judgment made in good faith by a Responsible Officer, unless it is proved that the Trustee was negligent in ascertaining the pertinent facts; and
     (3) the Trustee will not be liable with respect to any action it takes or omits to take in good faith in accordance with a direction received by it pursuant to Section 7.05 hereof.
          (d) Whether or not therein expressly so provided, every provision of this Indenture that in any way relates to the Trustee is subject to paragraphs (a), (b), (c) and (e) of this Section 8.01.
          (e) No provision of this Indenture will require the Trustee to expend or risk its own funds or incur any liability. The Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of its rights and powers under this Indenture at the request of any Holders, unless such Holder has offered to the Trustee security and indemnity satisfactory to it against any loss, liability or expense.
          (f) The Trustee will not be liable for interest on any money received by it except as the Trustee may agree in writing with the Company. Money held in trust by the Trustee need not be segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law.
Section 8.02 Rights of Trustee.
          (a) The Trustee may conclusively rely and shall be fully protected in acting or refraining from acting upon any document believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper Person. The Trustee need not investigate any fact or matter stated in the document.
          (b) Before the Trustee acts or refrains from acting, it may require an Officer’s Certificate or an Opinion of Counsel or both. The Trustee will not be liable for any action it takes or omits to take in good faith in reliance on such Officer’s Certificate or Opinion of Counsel. Prior to taking, suffering or admitting an action, the Trustee may consult with counsel (at the Company’s expense) and the advice of such counsel or any Opinion of Counsel will be full and complete authorization and protection from liability in respect of any action taken, suffered or omitted by it hereunder in good faith and in reliance thereon.
          (c) Unless otherwise specifically provided in this Indenture, any demand, request, direction or notice from the Company will be sufficient if signed by at least one Officer of the Company.
          (d) The Trustee may conclusively rely, and shall be protected in acting or refraining from acting, upon any resolution, certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, direction, consent, order, bond, debenture, note, other evidence of indebtedness or other paper or document believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper party or parties.

41


 

          (e) Any request or direction of the Company mentioned herein shall be sufficiently evidenced by an Officer’s Certificate.
          (f) Whenever in the administration of this Indenture the Trustee shall deem it desirable that a matter be proved or established prior to taking, suffering or omitting any action hereunder, the Trustee (unless other evidence be herein specifically prescribed) may, in the absence of bad faith on its part, rely upon an Officer’s Certificate.
          (g) The Trustee may consult with professional advisors and counsel of its selection and the advice of such professional advisors and counsel or any Opinion of Counsel shall be full and complete authorization and protection in respect of any action taken, suffered or omitted by it hereunder in good faith and in reliance thereon.
          (h) The Trustee shall be under no obligation to exercise any of the rights or powers vested in it by this Indenture at the request or direction of any of the Holders of Notes pursuant to this Indenture, unless such Holders shall have offered to the Trustee security or indemnity satisfactory to it against the costs, expenses, losses and liabilities which might be incurred by it in compliance with such request or direction.
          (i) The Trustee shall not be bound to make any investigation into the facts or matters stated in any resolution, certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, direction, consent, order, bond, debenture, note, other evidence of indebtedness or other paper or document, but the Trustee, in its discretion, may make such further inquiry or investigation into such facts or matters as it may see fit, and, if the Trustee shall determine to make such further inquiry or investigation, it may make a reasonable request for information from the Company to the extent the sharing of such information is permitted by law and not subject to any confidentiality restrictions.
          (j) The Trustee may execute any of the trusts or powers hereunder or perform any duties hereunder either directly or by or through agents or attorneys and the Trustee shall not be responsible for any misconduct or negligence on the part of any agent or attorney appointed with due care by it hereunder.
          (k) The Trustee shall have no duty to inquire and no duty to monitor as to the performance of the Company’s covenants in Article 5 hereof. In addition, the Trustee shall not be deemed to have knowledge of any Default or Event of Default except any Default or Event of Default of which a Responsible Officer of the Trustee shall have received written notification from the Company or any Holder at its Corporate Trust Office.
          (l) The Trustee shall not be liable for any action taken, suffered or omitted to be taken by it in good faith and reasonably believed by it to be authorized or within the discretion or rights or powers conferred upon it by this Indenture.
          (m) The Trustee may request that the Company deliver an Officer’s Certificate setting forth the names of individuals and/or titles of officers authorized at such time to take specified actions pursuant to this Indenture, which Officer’s Certificate may be signed by any person authorized to sign an Officer’s Certificate, including any person specified as so authorized in any such certificate previously delivered and not superseded.
          (n) The Trustee may purchase, hold and dispose of Notes and may, subject to Trust Indenture Act Sections 310(b) and 311, enter into any transaction (including, without limitation, any depositary, trust or

42


 

agency transaction) with any Holders of Notes or with any other party hereto in the same manner as if it had not been appointed as Trustee, without being obliged to account for any profits.
          (o) The Trustee may, in the conduct of the trusts of this Indenture, instead of acting personally, employ and pay an agent on any terms, whether or not a lawyer or other professional person, to transact or conduct, or concur in transacting or conducting, any business and to do or concur in doing all acts required to be done by the Trustee (including the receipt and payment of money) and the Trustee shall not be responsible for any loss, liability, expense, demand, cost, claim or proceedings incurred by reason of the misconduct, omission or default on the part of any person appointed by it hereunder or be bound to supervise the proceedings or acts of any such person.
          (p) The Trustee may, in the execution and exercise of all or any of the trusts, powers, authorities and discretions vested in it by this Indenture, act by Responsible Officers or a Responsible Officer for the time being of the Trustee and the Trustee may also whenever it thinks fit, whether by power of attorney or otherwise, delegate to any person or persons or fluctuating body of persons (whether being a joint trustee of this Indenture or not) all or any of the trusts, powers, authorities and discretions vested in it by this Indenture and any such delegation may be made upon such terms and conditions and subject to such regulations (including power to sub-delegate with the consent of the Trustee) as the Trustee may think fit in the interests of the Holders and the Trustee shall not be bound to supervise the proceedings or acts of and shall not in any way or to the extent be responsible for any loss, liability, expense, demand, cost, claim or proceedings incurred by reason of the misconduct, omission, or default on the part of such delegate or sub-delegate.
Section 8.03 Individual Rights of Trustee.
          The Trustee in its individual or any other capacity may become the owner or pledgee of Notes and may, subject to Trust Indenture Act Sections 310(b) and 311, otherwise deal with the Company or any Affiliate of the Company with the same rights it would have if it were not Trustee. However, in the event that the Trustee acquires any conflicting interest, it must eliminate such conflict within 90 days, or resign. Any Agent may do the same with like rights and duties. The Trustee is also subject to Sections 8.10 and 8.11 hereof.
Section 8.04 Trustee’s Disclaimer.
          The Trustee will not be responsible for and makes no representation as to the validity or adequacy of this Indenture or the Notes, the Offering Memorandum related thereto or the Registration Rights Agreement; it shall not be accountable for the Company’s use of the proceeds from the Notes or any money paid to the Company or upon the Company’s direction under any provision of this Indenture, it will not be responsible for the use or application of any money received by any Paying Agent other than the Trustee, and it will not be responsible for any statement or recital herein or any statement in the Notes or any other document in connection with the sale of the Notes, the Offering Memorandum related thereto or the Registration Rights Agreement or pursuant to this Indenture other than its certificate of authentication.
Section 8.05 Reports by Trustee to Holders.
          Within 60 days after June 15 of each year commencing with the first June 15 after the Closing Date, the Trustee shall transmit to the Holders, in the manner and to the extent provided in Trust Indenture Act Section 313(c), a brief report dated as of such June 15, if required by Trust Indenture Act Section 313(a). The Trustee also shall comply with Trust Indenture Act Sections 313(b) and (c).

43


 

          The Company shall promptly notify the Trustee whenever the Notes become listed on any securities exchange and of any delisting thereof and the Trustee shall file the above described report with each stock exchange upon which the Notes are listed.
Section 8.06 Notice of Defaults.
          Within 90 days after a Responsible Officer of the Trustee becoming aware of the occurrence of any Default hereunder with respect to Notes, the Trustee shall give notice to all Holders of Notes, unless such Default shall have been cured or waived; provided, however, that except in the case of a Default in the payment of the principal, interest or Additional Amounts with respect to the Notes of a series, the Trustee shall be protected in withholding such notice if and so long as a trust committee of directors or Responsible Officers of the Trustee in good faith determine that the withholding of such notice is in the interest of the Holders of Notes of such series.
          Notice given pursuant to this Section 8.05 shall be transmitted by mail:
          (a) To all registered Holders, at the names and addresses of the registered Holders appear in the Note Register.
          (b) To each Holder of a Note whose name and address appear in the information preserved at the time by the Trustee in accordance with Section 8.06(a) of this Indenture.
Section 8.07 Compensation and Indemnity.
          (a) The Company will pay to the Trustee from time to time compensation for its acceptance of this Indenture and services hereunder. After consultation with the Company, an additional fee may be payable after the occurrence of a Default or for the performance of exceptional duties. The Trustee’s compensation will not be limited by any law on compensation of a trustee of an express trust. The Company will reimburse the Trustee promptly upon receipt of a written request detailing all disbursements, advances and expenses properly incurred or made by it in addition to the compensation for its services. Such expenses will include the reasonable compensation, disbursements and expenses of the Trustee’s agents and counsel.
          (b) The Company will indemnify the Trustee (which, for the purposes of this Section 8.07(b), shall include its officers, directors, employees and agents), acting in any capacity hereunder, against any and all duly documented actual and direct losses, liabilities or reasonable and documented expenses incurred by it arising out of or in connection with the acceptance or administration of its duties under this Indenture, including the costs and expenses of enforcing this Indenture against the Company (including this Section 8.07) and defending itself against any claim (whether asserted by the Company, any Holder or any other Person) or liability in connection with the exercise or performance of any of its powers or duties hereunder, except to the extent any such loss, liability or expense may be attributable to its negligence or bad faith. The Trustee will promptly notify the Company in writing of any claim for which it may seek indemnity. Failure by the Trustee to so notify the Company will not relieve the Company of its obligations hereunder. The Trustee may have separate counsel and the Company will pay the reasonable and documented fees and expenses of such counsel. The Company need not pay for any settlement made without its consent, which consent will not be unreasonably withheld. Under no circumstances shall the Trustee be liable for any consequential or punitive damages.

44


 

          (c) The obligations of the Company under this Section 8.07 will survive the redemption or maturity of the Notes, the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture and the resignation or removal of the Trustee.
          (d) With respect to payment obligations in this Section 8.07, the Trustee will have a lien prior to the Notes on all money or property held or collected by the Trustee for the benefit of itself, except that held in trust to pay principal and interest on particular Notes. Such lien will survive the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture and the resignation or removal of the Trustee, including termination under any bankruptcy law.
          (e) When the Trustee incurs expenses or renders services after an Event of Default specified in Section 7.01(4), (5) or (6) hereof occurs, the expenses and the compensation for the services (including the fees and expenses of its agents and counsel) are intended to constitute expenses of administration under any bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or other similar law.
Section 8.08 Replacement of Trustee.
          (a) A resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a successor Trustee will become effective only upon the successor Trustee’s acceptance of appointment as provided in this Section 8.08.
          (b) The Trustee may resign in writing at any time and be discharged from the trust hereby created by so notifying the Company. The Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes of any series may remove the Trustee by so notifying the Trustee and the Company in writing. The Company may remove the Trustee if:
     (1) the Trustee fails to comply with Section 8.10 hereof;
     (2) the Trustee is adjudged bankrupt or insolvent or an order for relief is entered with respect to the Trustee under any Bankruptcy Law;
     (3) a custodian or public officer takes charge of the Trustee or its property; or
     (4) the Trustee becomes incapable of acting.
          (c) If the Trustee resigns or is removed or if a vacancy exists in the office of Trustee for any reason, the Company will promptly appoint a successor Trustee. Within one year after the successor Trustee takes office, the Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes may appoint a successor Trustee to replace the successor Trustee appointed by the Company.
          (d) If a successor Trustee does not take office within 60 days after the retiring Trustee resigns or is removed, the retiring Trustee, the Company, or the Holders of at least 10% in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes of any series may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor Trustee.
          (e) If the Trustee, after written request by any Holder who has been a Holder for at least six months, fails to comply with Section 8.10 hereof, such Holder may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the removal of the Trustee and the appointment of a successor Trustee.

45


 

          (f) A successor Trustee will deliver a written acceptance of its appointment to the retiring Trustee and to the Company. Thereupon, the resignation or removal of the retiring Trustee will become effective, and the successor Trustee will have all the rights, powers and duties of the Trustee under this Indenture. The successor Trustee will mail a notice of its succession to Holders. The retiring Trustee will promptly transfer all property held by it as Trustee to the successor Trustee; provided all sums owing to the Trustee hereunder have been paid and subject to the lien provided for in Section 8.07 hereof. Notwithstanding replacement of the Trustee pursuant to this Section 8.08, the Company’s obligations under Section 8.06 hereof will continue for the benefit of the retiring Trustee.
          (g) In no event shall the Trustee be liable for any indirect, special, punitive or consequential loss or damage of any kind whatsoever, including, but not limited to, lost profits, even if the Trustee has been advised of the likelihood of such loss or damage and regardless of the form of action.
          (h) In no event shall the Trustee be liable for any failure or delay in the performance of its obligations hereunder because of circumstances beyond its control, including, but not limited to, acts of God, flood, war (whether declared or undeclared), terrorism, fire, riot, embargo, government action, including any laws, ordinances, regulations, governmental action or the like which delay, restrict or prohibit the providing of the services contemplated by this Indenture.
Section 8.09 Successor Trustee by Merger, etc.
          If the Trustee consolidates, merges or converts into, or transfers all or substantially all of its corporate trust business to, another corporation, the successor corporation without any further act will be the successor Trustee.
Section 8.10 Eligibility; Disqualification.
          There will at all times be a Trustee that satisfies the requirements of Trust Indenture Act Section 310(a)(1) and (5). The Trustee shall be a corporation organized and doing business under the laws of the United States of America or of any state thereof that is authorized under such laws to exercise corporate trustee power, that is subject to supervision or examination by federal or state authorities and that has a combined capital and surplus of at least $50.0 million as set forth in its most recent published annual report of condition.
          The Trustee shall comply with Trust Indenture Act Section 310(b); provided, that there shall be excluded from the operation of Trust Indenture Act Section 310(b)(1) any indenture or indentures under which other securities or certificates of interest or participation in other notes of the Company are outstanding if the requirements for such exclusion set forth in Trust Indenture Act Section 310(b)(1) are met.
Section 8.11 Preferential Collection of Claims Against Issuer.
          The Trustee shall comply with Trust Indenture Act Section 311(a), excluding any creditor relationship listed in Trust Indenture Act Section 311(b). A Trustee who has resigned or been removed shall be subject to Trust Indenture Act Section 311(a) to the extent indicated therein.

46


 

Section 8.12 Instructions in writing.
          Notwithstanding any provisions of this Indenture to the contrary, the Trustee shall not be obliged to act or omit to act in accordance with any instruction, direction or request delivered to it unless such instruction, direction or request is delivered to the Trustee in writing.
Section 8.13 Article applying to Paying Agents.
          At all times when a paying agent other than the Trustee shall have been appointed by the Company and be then acting hereunder, the term “Trustee” as used in this Article shall in such case (unless the context otherwise requires) be construed as extending to and including such paying agent within its meaning as fully for all intents and purposes as if such paying agent were named in this Article in addition to or in place of the Trustee; provided, however, that Section 8.12 shall not apply to the Company or any affiliate of the Company if it or such affiliate acts as paying agent.
ARTICLE 9
LEGAL DEFEASANCE AND COVENANT DEFEASANCE
Section 9.01 Option to Effect Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance.
          The Company may at any time, at the option of its Board of Directors as evidenced by an Officer’s Certificate confirming the due authorization by the Company, elect to have either Section 9.02 or 9.03 hereof be applied to all outstanding Notes of any series upon compliance with the conditions set forth below in this Article 9.
Section 9.02 Legal Defeasance and Discharge.
          Upon the Company’s exercise under Section 9.01 hereof of the option applicable to this Section 9.02, the Company will, subject to the satisfaction of the conditions set forth in Section 9.04 hereof, be deemed to have been discharged from its obligations with respect to all outstanding Notes of the series on the date the conditions set forth below are satisfied (hereinafter, “Legal Defeasance”). For this purpose, Legal Defeasance means that the Company will be deemed to have paid and discharged the entire indebtedness represented by the outstanding Notes of the series, which will thereafter be deemed to be “outstanding” only for the purposes of Section 9.05 hereof and the other Sections of this Indenture referred to in clauses (1) and (2) below, and to have satisfied all its other obligations under such Notes of the series and this Indenture (and the Trustee, on demand of and at the expense of the Company (such expense being documented), shall execute proper instruments acknowledging the same), except for the following provisions which will survive until otherwise terminated or discharged hereunder:
          (1) the rights of Holders of outstanding Notes of the series to receive payments in respect of the principal of, or interest or Additional Amounts, if any, on, such Notes when such payments are due from the trust referred to in Section 9.04 hereof;
          (2) the Company’s obligations with respect to such Notes under Article 2 and Section 5.02 hereof;
          (3) the rights, powers, trusts, duties and immunities of the Trustee hereunder and the Company’s obligations in connection therewith; and
          (4) this Article 9.

47


 

          Subject to compliance with this Article 9, the Company may exercise its option under this Section 9.02 notwithstanding the prior exercise of its option under Section 9.03 hereof.
Section 9.03 Covenant Defeasance.
          Upon the Company’s exercise under Section 9.01 hereof of the option applicable to this Section 9.03, the Company will, subject to the satisfaction of the conditions set forth in Section 9.04 hereof, be released from each of its obligations under the covenants contained in Sections 5.10, 5.12 and 6.01 hereof with respect to the outstanding Notes of the series on and after the date the conditions set forth in Section 9.04 hereof are satisfied (hereinafter, “Covenant Defeasance”), and the Notes will thereafter be deemed not “outstanding” for the purposes of any direction, waiver, consent or declaration or act of Holders (and the consequences of any thereof) in connection with such covenants, but will continue to be deemed “outstanding” for all other purposes hereunder (it being understood that such Notes will not be deemed outstanding for accounting purposes). For this purpose, Covenant Defeasance means that, with respect to the outstanding Notes of the series, the Company may omit to comply with and will have no liability in respect of any term, condition or limitation set forth in any such covenant, whether directly or indirectly, by reason of any reference elsewhere herein to any such covenant or by reason of any reference in any such covenant to any other provision herein or in any other document and such omission to comply will not constitute an Event of Default under Section 7.01 hereof, but, except as specified above, the remainder of this Indenture and such Notes will be unaffected thereby. In addition, upon the Company’s exercise under Section 9.01 hereof of the option applicable to this Section 9.03, subject to the satisfaction of the conditions set forth in Section 9.04 hereof, Sections 7.01(4), (5), and (6) hereof will not constitute Events of Default. The Company’s obligations under Section 8.07 shall survive an exercise under Section 9.01.
Section 9.04 Conditions to Legal or Covenant Defeasance.
          In order to exercise either Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance under either Section 9.02 or 9.03 hereof:
     (1) the Company must irrevocably deposit with the Trustee, in trust, for the benefit of the Holders, cash in U.S. dollars, non-callable Government Securities, or a combination thereof, in such amounts as will be sufficient, in the opinion of an internationally recognized firm of independent public accountants as appointed by the Company, to pay the principal of, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, on, the outstanding Notes of the relevant series on the stated date for payment thereof or on the applicable Redemption Date, as the case may be, and the Company must specify whether the Notes are being defeased to such stated date for payment or to a particular Redemption Date;
     (2) the Company must deliver to the Trustee an opinion of counsel of recognized standing with respect to U.S. federal income tax matters confirming that the Holders and beneficial owners of the outstanding Notes of the relevant series will not recognize income, gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes as a result of such Legal Defeasance or Legal or Covenant Defeasance; with respect to a Legal Defeasance, such opinion of counsel must be based upon a ruling from the U.S. Internal Revenue Service or a change in law to that effect;
     (3) no Default or Event of Default with respect to the Notes of such series shall have occurred and be continuing on the date of such deposit;

48


 

     (4) such legal defeasance or covenant defeasance shall not cause the Trustee to have a conflicting interest for purposes of the Trust Indenture Act with respect to any of the Company’s securities; and
     (5) the Company must deliver to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that all conditions precedent relating to the Legal Defeasance or the Covenant Defeasance have been complied with.
Section 9.05 Deposited Money and Government Securities to be Held in Trust; Other Miscellaneous Provisions.
          Subject to Section 9.06 hereof, all money and non-callable Government Securities (including the proceeds thereof) deposited with the Trustee (or other qualifying trustee, collectively for purposes of this Section 9.05, the “Trustee”) pursuant to Section 9.04 hereof in respect of the outstanding Notes will be held in trust and applied by the Trustee, in accordance with the provisions of such Notes and this Indenture, to the payment, either directly or through any Paying Agent (including the Company acting as Paying Agent) as the Trustee may determine, to the Holders of such Notes of all sums due and to become due thereon in respect of principal, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, but such money need not be segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law.
          The Company will pay and indemnify the Trustee against any duly documented tax, fee or other charge imposed on or assessed against the cash or non-callable Government Securities deposited pursuant to Section 9.04 hereof or the principal, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, received in respect thereof other than any such tax, fee or other charge which by law is for the account of the Holders of the outstanding Notes.
          Notwithstanding anything in this Article 9 to the contrary, the Trustee will deliver or pay to the Company from time to time upon the request of the Company any money or non-callable Government Securities held by it as provided in Section 9.04 hereof which, in the opinion of a nationally recognized firm of independent public accountants as appointed by the Company expressed in a written certification thereof delivered to the Trustee (which may be the opinion delivered under Section 9.04(1) hereof), are in excess of the amount thereof that would then be required to be deposited to effect an equivalent Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance.
Section 9.06 Repayment to Company.
          Any money deposited with the Trustee or any Paying Agent, or then held by the Company, in trust for the payment of the principal of, interest, Additional Interest or Additional Amounts, if any, on, any Note and remaining unclaimed for two years after such principal, interest, Additional Interest or Additional Amounts, if any, has become due and payable shall be paid to the Company on its request or (if then held by the Company) will be discharged from such trust; and the Holder of such Note will thereafter be permitted to look only to the Company for payment thereof, and all liability of the Trustee or such Paying Agent with respect to such trust money, and all liability of the Company as trustee thereof, will thereupon cease; provided, however, that the Trustee or such Paying Agent, before being required to make any such repayment, may at the expense of the Company (such expense being documented) cause to be published once, in The New York Times and The Wall Street Journal (national edition), notice that such money remains unclaimed and that, after a date specified therein, which will not be less than 30 days from the date of such notification or publication, any unclaimed balance of such money then remaining will be repaid to the Company.

49


 

Section 9.07 Reinstatement.
     If the Trustee or Paying Agent is unable to apply any U.S. dollars or non-callable Government Securities in accordance with Section 9.02 or 9.03 hereof, as the case may be, by reason of any order or judgment of any court or governmental authority enjoining, restraining or otherwise prohibiting such application, then the Company’s obligations under this Indenture and the Notes will be revived and reinstated as though no deposit had occurred pursuant to Section 9.02 or 9.03 hereof until such time as the Trustee or Paying Agent is permitted to apply all such money in accordance with Section 9.02 or 9.03 hereof, as the case may be; provided, however, that, if the Company makes any payment of principal of, interest, Additional Interest or Additional Amounts, if any, on, any Note following the reinstatement of its obligations, the Company will be subrogated to the rights of the Holders of such Notes to receive such payment from the money held by the Trustee or Paying Agent.
ARTICLE 10
AMENDMENT, SUPPLEMENT AND WAIVER
Section 10.01 Without Consent of Holders of Notes.
     Notwithstanding Section 10.02 of this Indenture, the Company and the Trustee may modify this Indenture without the consent of any Holder of Notes:
     (1) to cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency;
     (2) to provide for the issuance of additional notes in accordance with the limitations set forth in this Indenture as of the date hereof;
     (3) to comply with Article Six in respect of the assumption by a Person of the obligations of the Company under the Notes and this Indenture;
     (4) to comply with any requirements of the SEC in connection with qualifying this Indenture under the Trust Indenture Act;
     (5) to provide for the issuance of Exchange Notes; and
     (6) to correct or add any other provisions with respect to matters or questions arising under this Indenture, so long as that correction or added provision will not adversely affect the interests of the Holders of the Notes in any material respect.
     Upon the request of the Company accompanied by an Officer’s Certificate confirming the due authorization by the Company of the execution of any such amended or supplemental indenture, and upon receipt by the Trustee of the documents described in Section 8.02 hereof, the Trustee will join with the Company in the execution of any amended or supplemental indenture authorized or permitted by the terms of this Indenture and to make any further appropriate agreements and stipulations that may be therein contained, but the Trustee will not be obligated to enter into such amended or supplemental indenture that affects its own rights, duties or immunities under this Indenture or otherwise.
Section 10.02 With Consent of Holders of Notes.
     Except as provided below in this Section 10.02, the Company and the Trustee may modify and amend this Indenture with the consent of the Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the

50


 

Notes (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any) of the relevant series then outstanding. However, no modification or amendment may, without the consent of the Holders of outstanding Notes of a series affected thereby (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any): (i) change the maturity of any payment of principal of or any installment of interest on the Notes; (ii) reduce the principal amount or the rate of interest, or change the method of computing the amount of principal or interest payable on any date, with respect to the Notes; (iii) change the coin or currency in which the principal of or interest on the Notes are payable; (iv) impair the right of the Holders of Notes to institute suit for the enforcement of any payment on or after the date due; (v) reduce the percentage in principal amount of the outstanding Notes, the consent of whose Holders is required for any modification of or waiver of compliance with any provision of this Indenture or defaults under the Indenture and their consequences; or (vi) modify the provisions summarized in this paragraph or the provisions of this Indenture regarding the quorum required at any meeting of Holders.
     After an amendment described in the preceding paragraph, the Company is required to mail through the Trustee, to the Holders of the Notes affected by such amendment (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any) a notice briefly describing the amendment. However, the failure to give that notice to all the Holders of the Notes affected by such amendment (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any), or any defect in the notice, will not affect the validity of the amendment.
     It is not necessary for the Holders to approve the particular form of any proposed modification of the Indenture, but it is sufficient if that consent approves the substance of the proposed modification.
Section 10.03 Revocation and Effect of Consents.
     Until an amendment, supplement or waiver becomes effective, a consent to it by a Holder of a Note is a continuing consent by the Holder of a Note and every subsequent Holder of a Note or portion of a Note that evidences the same debt as the consenting Holder’s Note, even if notation of the consent is not made on any Note. However, any such Holder of a Note or subsequent Holder of a Note may revoke the consent as to its Note if the Trustee receives written notice of revocation before the date the amendment, supplement or waiver becomes effective. An amendment, supplement or waiver becomes effective in accordance with its terms and thereafter binds every Holder.
     The Company may, but shall not be obligated to, fix a record date, which need not be the date provided in Trust Indenture Act § 316(c) to the extent it would otherwise be applicable, for the purpose of determining the Holders entitled to give their consent or take any other action described above or required or permitted to be taken pursuant to this Indenture. If a record date is fixed, then notwithstanding the immediately preceding paragraph, those Persons who were Holders at such record date (or their duly designated proxies), and only those Persons, shall be entitled to give such consent or to revoke any consent previously given or to take any such action, whether or not such Persons continue to be Holders after such record date. No such consent shall be valid or effective for more than 90 days after such record date.
Section 10.04 Notation on or Exchange of Notes.
     The Trustee may place an appropriate notation about an amendment, supplement or waiver on any Note thereafter authenticated. The Company in exchange for all Notes may issue and the Trustee shall, upon receipt of an Authentication Order, authenticate new Notes that reflect the amendment, supplement or waiver.

51


 

     Failure to make the appropriate notation or issue a new Note will not affect the validity and effect of such amendment, supplement or waiver.
Section 10.05 Trustee to Sign Amendments, etc.
     The Trustee will sign any amended or supplemental indenture authorized pursuant to this Article 10 if the amendment or supplement does not adversely affect the rights, duties, liabilities or immunities of the Trustee. The Company may not sign an amended or supplemental indenture without due authorization. In executing any amended or supplemental indenture, the Trustee will be entitled to receive and (subject to Section 8.01 hereof) will be fully protected in relying upon, in addition to the documents required by Section 12.05 hereof, an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel stating that the execution of such amended or supplemental indenture is authorized or permitted by this Indenture.
ARTICLE 11
SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE
Section 11.01 Satisfaction and Discharge.
     This Indenture will be discharged and will cease to be of further effect as to all Notes of any series issued hereunder, when:
     (1) either:
          (a) all Notes that have been authenticated, except lost, stolen or destroyed Notes that have been replaced or paid and Notes for whose payment money has theretofore been deposited in trust and thereafter repaid to the Company, have been delivered to the Trustee for cancellation; or
          (b) all Notes of such series that have not been delivered to the Trustee for cancellation have become due and payable by reason of the mailing of a notice of redemption or otherwise or will become due and payable within one year and the Company has irrevocably deposited or caused to be deposited with the Trustee as trust funds in trust solely for the benefit of the Holders, cash in U.S. dollars, non-callable Government Securities, or a combination thereof, in such amounts as will be sufficient, without consideration of any reinvestment of interest, to pay and discharge the entire indebtedness on the Notes of such series not delivered to the Trustee for cancellation for principal and accrued interest and Additional Amounts, if any, to the date of maturity or redemption;
     (2) the Company has paid or caused to be paid all sums payable by it under this Indenture with respect to the series; and
     (3) the Company has delivered irrevocable instructions to the Trustee under this Indenture to apply the deposited money toward the payment of the Notes of such series at maturity or on the Redemption Date, as the case may be.
In addition, the Company must deliver an Officer’s Certificate stating that all conditions precedent to the satisfaction and discharge have been satisfied.

52


 

     Notwithstanding the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture, if money has been deposited with the Trustee pursuant to subclause (b) of clause (1) of this Section 11.01, the provisions of Sections 11.02 and 9.06 hereof will survive. In addition, nothing in this Section 11.01 will be deemed to discharge those provisions of Section 8.07 hereof, that, by their terms, survive the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture.
Section 11.02 Application of Trust Money.
     Subject to the provisions of Section 9.06 hereof, all money deposited with the Trustee pursuant to Section 11.01 hereof shall be held in trust and applied by it, in accordance with the provisions of the Notes and this Indenture, to the payment, either directly or through any Paying Agent (including the Company acting as its own Paying Agent) as the Trustee may determine, to the Persons entitled thereto, of the principal and interest and Additional Amounts, if any, for whose payment such money has been deposited with the Trustee; but such money need not be segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law.
     If the Trustee or Paying Agent is unable to apply any money or Government Securities in accordance with Section 11.01 hereof by reason of any legal proceeding or by reason of any order or judgment of any court or governmental authority enjoining, restraining or otherwise prohibiting such application, the Company’s obligations under this Indenture and the Notes shall be revived and reinstated as though no deposit had occurred pursuant to Section 11.01 hereof; provided that if the Company has made any payment of principal of, interest or Additional Amounts, if any, on, any Notes because of the reinstatement of its obligations, the Company shall be subrogated to the rights of the Holders of such Notes to receive such payment from the money or Government Securities held by the Trustee or Paying Agent.
ARTICLE 12
MISCELLANEOUS
Section 12.01 Trust Indenture Act Controls.
     If and to the extent that any provision of this Indenture limits, qualifies or conflicts with the duties that would be imposed by the Trust Indenture Act or with another provision (an “incorporated provision”) of the Trust Indenture Act expressly incorporated herein, by reference or otherwise, such duties or incorporated provision shall control.
Section 12.02 Call and Notice of Holders’ Meeting.
     A meeting of Holders of any series may be called by the Trustee at any time. The Company or the Holders of at least 10% in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes of any series may call a meeting if the Company or the Holders have requested the Trustee in writing to call such a meeting and the Trustee has not given notice of such meeting within 20 days of receiving the request. Notices of meetings must include the time and place of the meeting and a general description of the action proposed to be taken at the meeting and must be given not less than 30 days nor more than 60 days before the date of the meeting, except that notices of meetings reconvened after adjournment must be given not less than 10 days nor more than 60 days before the date of the meeting. At any meeting, the presence of Holders holding Notes in an aggregate principal amount sufficient to take the action for which the meeting was called will constitute a quorum. Any modifications to or waivers of the Indenture or the Notes will be conclusive and binding on all Holders of Notes of such series, whether or not they have given their consent (unless required under this Indenture) or were present at any duly held meeting.

53


 

Section 12.03 Notices.
     (a) Any notice or communication by the Company or the Trustee to the other is duly given if made, given, furnished or filed, in writing, with:
     If to the Company:
     ArcelorMittal
             
 
  Address:   24-26 boulevard d’Avranches    
 
      L-1160, Luxembourg    
 
  Fax number:   +352-4792-2189    
 
  Attention:   Funding Department    
 
           
 
  and        
 
           
 
  Address:   1 à 5 rue Luigi Cherubini    
 
      93200 St Denis, France    
 
  Fax number:   +33-1-71-92-10-05    
 
  Attention:   Funding Department    
     With a copy to:
Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP
12, rue de Tilsitt
75008 Paris
France
Facsimile No.: +33-1-40-74-69-30
Attention: Gamal M. Abouali
     If to the Trustee:
HSBC Bank USA, National Association
10 East 40th Street, 14th Floor
New York, NY 10016
USA
Facsimile No.: +1-212-525-1300
Attention: Corporate Trust and Loan Services
     The Company or the Trustee, by notice to the others, may designate additional or different addresses for subsequent notices or communications.
     All notices and communications (other than those sent to Holders) will be deemed to have been duly given: at the time delivered by hand, if personally delivered; five Business Days after being deposited in the mail, postage prepaid, if mailed; when receipt acknowledged, if transmitted by facsimile and in legible form; and the next Business Day after timely delivery to the courier, if sent by overnight air courier guaranteeing next day delivery.
     Any notice or communication to a Holder will be given by the Trustee at the expense of the Company as follows:

54


 

     (1) first class mail, postage prepaid, to the address of each Holder on the register kept by the Registrar; and
     (2) publication in English on a Business Day in a leading newspaper having general circulation in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York.
     Notice to the Holders will be deemed to have been validly given on the date of mailing or first publication in the required newspaper, as the case may be. If the publication as provided above is not practicable, notice will be given in such other manner, and shall be deemed to have been given on such date, as the Trustee may approve.
     Failure to mail a notice or communication to a Holder or any defect in it will not affect its sufficiency with respect to other Holders.
     If a notice or communication is mailed in the manner provided above within the time prescribed, it is duly given, whether or not the addressee receives it.
     If the Company mails a notice or communication to Holders, it will mail a copy to the Trustee and each Agent at the same time.
     (b) Where this Indenture provides for notice in any manner, such notice may be waived in writing by any Person entitled to receive such notice, either before or after the event, and such waiver shall be the equivalent of such notice. Waivers of notice by Holders shall be filed with the Trustee but such filing shall not be a condition precedent to the validity of any action taken in reliance upon such a waiver.
Section 12.04 Communication by Holders of Notes with Other Holders of Notes.
     Holders may communicate pursuant to Trust Indenture Act Section 312(b) with other Holders with respect to their rights under this Indenture or the Notes. The Company, any guarantor, the Trustee, the Registrar and anyone else shall have the protection of Trust Indenture Act Section 312(c).
     Holders may communicate with other Holders with respect to their rights under this Indenture or the Notes.
Section 12.05 Certificate and Opinion as to Conditions Precedent.
     Upon any request or application by the Company to the Trustee to take any action under this Indenture, the Company shall furnish to the Trustee:
     (1) an Officer’s Certificate in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee (which must include the statements set forth in Section 12.06 hereof) stating that, in the opinion of the signer(s), all conditions precedent and covenants, if any, provided for in this Indenture relating to the proposed action have been complied with; and
     (2) an Opinion of Counsel in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee (which must include the statements set forth in Section 12.06 hereof) stating that, in the opinion of such counsel, all such conditions precedent and covenants have been complied with.

55


 

Section 12.06 Statements Required in Certificate or Opinion.
     Each certificate or opinion with respect to compliance with a condition or covenant provided for in this Indenture must include:
     (1) a statement that the Person making such certificate or opinion has read such covenant or condition;
     (2) a brief statement as to the nature and scope of the examination or investigation upon which the statements or opinions contained in such certificate or opinion are based;
     (3) a statement that, in the opinion of such Person, he or she has made such examination or investigation as is necessary to enable him or her to express an informed opinion as to whether or not such covenant or condition has been complied with; and
     (4) a statement as to whether or not, in the opinion of such Person, such condition or covenant has been complied with.
Section 12.07 Rules by Trustee and Agents.
     The Trustee may make reasonable rules for action by or at a meeting of Holders. The Registrar or Paying Agent may make reasonable rules and set reasonable requirements for its functions.
Section 12.08 No Recourse Against Others.
     No past, present or future director, officer, employee, incorporator or stockholder of the Company, as such, will have any liability for any obligations of the Company under the Notes or this Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of, or by reason of, such obligations or their creation. Each Holder of Notes by accepting a Note waives and releases all such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for issuance of the Notes. The waiver may not be effective to waive liabilities under the federal securities laws.
Section 12.09 Governing Law.
     THE INDENTURE AND THE NOTES SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.
Section 12.10 Jurisdiction.
     TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY LAW AS APPLICABLE, THE COMPANY IRREVOCABLY AGREES THAT ANY LEGAL SUIT, ACTION OR PROCEEDING BROUGHT BY ANY HOLDER OR BY ANY PERSON WHO CONTROLS SUCH HOLDER OR THE TRUSTEE ON BEHALF OF SUCH HOLDER ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS INDENTURE OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY MAY BE INSTITUTED IN ANY FEDERAL OR STATE COURT IN THE BOROUGH OF MANHATTAN, THE CITY OF NEW YORK, NEW YORK, AND IRREVOCABLY WAIVES ANY OBJECTION WHICH IT MAY NOW OR HEREAFTER HAVE TO THE LAYING OF THE VENUE OF ANY SUCH SUIT, ACTION OR PROCEEDING AND ANY CLAIM THAT ANY SUCH PROCEEDING BROUGHT IN SUCH A COURT HAS BEEN BROUGHT IN AN INCONVENIENT FORUM, AND IRREVOCABLY SUBMITS TO THE NON-EXCLUSIVE JURISDICTION OF ANY SUCH COURT IN ANY SUCH SUIT, ACTION OR PROCEEDING.

56


 

Section 12.11 Waiver of Immunity.
     To the extent that the Company has or hereafter may acquire any immunity (sovereign or otherwise) from any legal action, suit or proceeding, from jurisdiction of any court or from set-off or any legal process (whether service or notice, attachment in aid or otherwise) with respect to itself or any of its property, the Company hereby irrevocably waives, to the fullest extent permitted by law, such immunity in respect of its obligations under this Indenture or the Notes.
Section 12.12 Process Agent.
     The Company has appointed ArcelorMittal USA Inc. (the “Process Agent”), at 1 South Dearborn, Chicago, Illinois 60603, USA, as its agent to receive on its behalf service of copies of the summons and complaints and any other process which may be served in any suit, action or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Indenture, the Notes or the transactions contemplated hereby brought in such New York State or federal court sitting in The City of New York. The Company further agrees to take any and all action as may be necessary to maintain such designation and appointment of such agent in full force and effect for a period of five years from the date of this Indenture. Such service may be made by delivering a copy of such process to the Company in care of the Process Agent at the address for the Process Agent and obtaining a receipt therefor, and the Company hereby irrevocably authorizes and directs such Process Agent to accept such service on its behalf. The Company represents and warrants that the Process Agent has agreed to act as said agent for service of process, and agrees that service of process in such manner upon the Process Agent shall be deemed, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, in every respect effective service of process upon the Company in any such suit, action or proceeding.
Section 12.13 No Adverse Interpretation of Other Agreements.
     This Indenture may not be used to interpret any other indenture, loan or debt agreement of the Company or its Subsidiaries or of any other Person. Any such indenture, loan or debt agreement may not be used to interpret this Indenture.
Section 12.14 Successors.
     All agreements of the Company in this Indenture and the Notes will bind its successors. All agreements of the Trustee in this Indenture will bind its successors.
Section 12.15 Severability.
     In case any provision in this Indenture or in the Notes is invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions will not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.
Section 12.16 Counterpart Originals.
     The parties may sign any number of copies of this Indenture. Each signed copy will be an original, but all of them together represent the same agreement.
Section 12.17 Currency Indemnity.
     The U.S. dollar is the sole currency of account and payment for all sums payable by the Company in connection with the Notes. Any amount received or recovered in a currency other than the U.S. dollar

57


 

in respect of the Notes (whether as a result of, or for the enforcement of, a judgment or order of a court of any jurisdiction, in the winding-up or dissolution of the Company or otherwise) by the Trustee or any Holder with respect to any sum due to it from the Company will constitute a discharge to the Company only to the extent of the amount in U.S. dollars that the recipient is able to purchase with the amount so received or recovered in that other currency on the date of that receipt or recovery (or, if it is not practicable to make that purchase on that date, on the first date on which it is practicable to do so). If the amount in U.S. dollars is less than the U.S. dollar amount expressed to be due to the recipient under any Note, the Company will indemnify the recipient against any loss sustained by it as a result. In any event the Company will indemnify the recipient against the reasonable and documented cost of making any such purchase.
     For the purposes of this Section 12.17, it will be sufficient for a Holder or the Trustee to certify in a satisfactory manner (indicating sources of information used) that it would have suffered a loss had an actual purchase of U.S. dollars been made with the amount so received in that other currency on the date of receipt or recovery (or, if a purchase of U.S. dollars on such date had not been practicable, on the first date on which it would have been practicable so long as the Holder or the Trustee certifies the need for the change of date). These indemnities, to the extent permitted by law, (i) constitute a separate and independent obligation from the other obligations of the Company, (ii) will give rise to a separate and independent cause of action, (iii) will apply irrespective of any waiver or extension granted by any Holder or the Trustee, and (iv) will continue in full force and effect despite any other judgment, order or the filing of any proof of, claim in the winding-up of the Company for a liquidated sum.
Section 12.18 Currency Calculation.
     Except as otherwise expressly set forth herein, for purposes of determining compliance with any U.S. dollar-denominated restriction herein, the U.S. dollar-equivalent amount for purposes hereof that is denominated in a non-U.S. dollar currency shall be calculated based on the relevant currency exchange rate in effect on the date such non-U.S. dollar amount is incurred or made, as the case may be.
Section 12.19 Table of Contents, Headings, etc.
     The Table of Contents, Cross-Reference Table and Headings of the Articles and Sections of this Indenture have been inserted for convenience of reference only, are not to be considered a part of this Indenture and will in no way modify or restrict any of the terms or provisions hereof.
[Signatures on following page]

58


 

SIGNATURES
Dated as of May 27, 2008
             
    ARCELORMITTAL    
 
           
 
  By:        /s/ E.S. de Vries    
 
           
 
      Name: E.S. de Vries    
 
      Title:    
 
           
 
  By:        /s/ Armand Gobber    
 
           
 
      Name: Armand Gobber    
 
      Title:    
[Indenture Signature Page]

 


 

             
    HSBC BANK USA, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
     as Trustee
 
           
 
           
 
  By:        /s/ Anthony A. Bocchino    
 
           
 
      Name: Anthony A. Bocchino    
 
      Title: Vice President    
[Indenture Signature Page]

 


 

[Face of 2013 Note]
[Insert the Global Note Legend, if applicable, pursuant to the provisions of the Indenture]
[Insert the Private Placement Legend, if applicable, pursuant to the provisions of the Indenture]
 
CUSIP:            03938LAA2
L0302DAM5
ISIN:        US03938LAA26
USL0302DAM58
Common Code:           036162554
036162422
5.375% Notes due 2013
No.                        $                                        
ARCELORMITTAL
promises to pay to Cede & Co. or registered assigns,
the principal sum of                                                                                                       DOLLARS on June 1, 2013.
Interest Payment Dates: June 1 and December 1 of each year, commencing on December 1, 2008
Record Dates: May 15 and November 15 of each year, commencing on November 15, 2008
Reference is hereby made to the further provisions of the Note evidenced hereby set forth on the reverse hereof, which further provisions shall have the same effect as if set forth at this place.
Unless the Certificate of Authentication has been duly executed by the Trustee by manual signature, this Note shall not be entitled to any benefits under the Indenture, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.
Dated: May 27, 2008
             
    ARCELORMITTAL    
 
           
 
  By:        
 
           
 
      Name:    
 
      Title:    
 
           
 
  By:        
 
           
 
      Name:    
 
      Title:    

A-1


 

This is one of the Notes referred to
in the within-mentioned Indenture:
HSBC BANK USA, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
     as Trustee
         
By:
       
 
       
 
  Authorized Signatory    

A-2


 

[Face of 2018 Note]
[Insert the Global Note Legend, if applicable, pursuant to the provisions of the Indenture]
[Insert the Private Placement Legend, if applicable, pursuant to the provisions of the Indenture]
 
CUSIP:           03938LAD6
L0302DAN3
ISIN:        US03938LAD64
USL0302DAN32
Common Code:           036162481
036162520
6.125% Notes due 2018
No.                        $                                        
ARCELORMITTAL
promises to pay to Cede & Co. or registered assigns,
the principal sum of                                                                                                       DOLLARS on June 1, 2018.
Interest Payment Dates: June 1 and December 1 of each year, commencing on December 1, 2008
Record Dates: May 15 and November 15 of each year, commencing on November 15, 2008
Reference is hereby made to the further provisions of the Note evidenced hereby set forth on the reverse hereof, which further provisions shall have the same effect as if set forth at this place.
Unless the Certificate of Authentication has been duly executed by the Trustee by manual signature, this Note shall not be entitled to any benefits under the Indenture, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.
Dated: May 27, 2008
             
    ARCELORMITTAL    
 
           
 
  By:        
 
           
 
      Name:    
 
      Title:    
 
           
 
  By:        
 
           
 
      Name:    
 
      Title:    
This is one of the Notes referred to
in the within-mentioned Indenture:
Dated:
HSBC BANK USA, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
     as Trustee
         
By:
       
 
       
 
  Authorized Signatory    

A-3


 

[Back of Note]
[5.375% Notes due 2013][6.125% Notes due 2018]1
     Capitalized terms used herein have the meanings assigned to them in the Indenture referred to below unless otherwise indicated.
     (1) Interest. [ArcelorMittal, a société anonyme organized under Luxembourg law will pay interest on the principal amount of the 2013 Notes at 5.375% per annum from May 27, 2008 until maturity.][ArcelorMittal, a société anonyme organized under Luxembourg law will pay interest on the principal amount of the 2018 Notes at 6.125% per annum from May 27, 2008 until maturity.]2 The Company will pay interest and Additional Amounts, if any, pursuant to Section 5.11, semi-annually in arrears on June 1 and December 1 of each year (each an Interest Payment Date) commencing on December 1, 2008, to the Holders of Notes registered as such as of close of business on May 15 and November 15, immediately preceding the relevant Interest Payment Date.
     If an Interest Payment Date or the maturity date in respect of the Notes is not a Business Day in the place of payment, we will pay interest or principal, as the case may be, on the next Business Day. Payments postponed to the next Business Day in this situation will be treated under this Indenture as if they were made on the original due date. Postponement of this kind will not result in a default under the Notes or this Indenture, and no interest will accrue on the postponed amount from the original due date to the next day that is a Business Day.
     Interest on the Notes will accrue from the Closing Date or, if interest has already been paid, from the date it was most recently paid (each such period, an Interest Period). Interest on the Notes will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months.
     (2) Additional Interest. If Additional Interest is payable by the Company pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, the Company shall deliver to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate to that effect stating (i) the amount of such Additional Interest that is payable, (ii) the reason why such Additional Interest is payable and (iii) the date on which such Additional Interest is payable. Unless and until the Trustee receives such a certificate, the Trustee may assume without inquiry that no such Additional Interest is payable. If the Company has paid Additional Interest directly to the Persons entitled to it, the Company shall deliver to the Trustee a certificate setting forth the particulars of such payment.
     (3) Defaulted Interest. If the Company defaults in a payment of interest on any of the Notes, it will pay the defaulted interest in any lawful manner plus, to the extent lawful, interest payable on the defaulted interest, to the Persons who are Holders of such Notes on a subsequent special record date, in each case at the rate provided in such Notes and in Section 3.01 hereof. The Company will notify the Trustee in writing of the amount of defaulted interest proposed to be paid on each such Note and the date of the proposed payment. The Company will fix or cause to be fixed each such special record date and payment date; provided that no such special record date may be less than 10 days prior to the related payment date for such defaulted interest. At
 
1   Delete as appropriate
 
2   Delete as appropriate

A-4


 

least 15 days before the special record date, the Company (or, upon the written request of the Company, the Trustee in the name and at the expense of the Company) will mail or cause to be mailed to Holders of such Notes a notice that states the special record date, the related payment date and the amount of such interest to be paid.
     (4) Method of Payment. The Company will pay interest on the Notes (except defaulted interest) and Additional Amounts, if any, to the Persons who are registered Holders of Notes at the close of business in New York City on May 15 or November 15 (whether or not a Business Day) immediately preceding the Interest Payment Date, except as provided in Section 2.12 of the Indenture with respect to defaulted interest. The Notes will be payable as to principal, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, at the office or agency of the Company maintained for such purpose within or without the City and State of New York, or, at the option of the Company, payment of interest and Additional Amounts, if any, may be made by check mailed to the Holders at their addresses set forth in the register of Holders; provided that payment by wire transfer of immediately available funds will be required with respect to principal of, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, on, all Global Notes and all other Notes the Holders of which will have provided wire transfer instructions to the Company or the Paying Agent. Such payment will be in such coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment is legal tender for payment of public and private debts.
     (5) Paying Agent and Registrar. Initially, HSBC Bank USA, National Association, the Trustee under the Indenture, will act as Paying Agent and Registrar. The Company may appoint one or more Co-Registrars and one or more additional Paying Agents. The Company may change any Paying Agent or Registrar without notice to any Holder. The Company or any of its Subsidiaries may act in any such capacity.
     (6) Indenture. The Company issued the Notes under an Indenture dated as of May 27, 2008 between the Company and the Trustee. The terms of the Notes include those stated in the Indenture and those expressly made part of the Indenture by reference to the Trust Indenture Act as in effect on the date of the Indenture and, to the extent required by any amendment after such date, as so amended. The Notes are subject to all such terms, and Holders are referred to the Indenture and the U.S. Trust Indenture Act for a statement of such terms. To the extent any provision of this Note conflicts with the express provisions of the Indenture, the provisions of the Indenture shall govern and be controlling.
     (7) Redemption for Taxation Reasons. The Notes may be redeemed, at the Company’s option, in whole but not in part, upon giving not less than 30 days’ nor more than 60 days’ notice to the Holders (which notice will be irrevocable), at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof, together with accrued and unpaid interest (including any Additional Amounts), if any, to the Tax Redemption Date if, as a result of:
     (a) any change in, or amendment to, the laws (or any regulations or rulings promulgated thereunder) of a Relevant Jurisdiction affecting taxation; or
     (b) any change in, or amendment to, an official position regarding the application or interpretation of such laws, regulations or rulings (including a holding, judgment or order by a court of competent jurisdiction),

A-5


 

which change or amendment becomes effective (i) in the case of the Company, on or after the Closing Date or (ii) in the case of any successor entity, on or after the date such successor entity becomes obligated under the Notes or the Indenture, with respect to any payment due or to become due under the Notes or the Indenture, the Company or its successor entity, as the case may be, is, or on the next Interest Payment Date would be, required to pay Additional Amounts, and such requirement cannot be avoided by the Company or its successor entity, as the case may be, taking reasonable measures available to it; provided that for the avoidance of doubt changing the jurisdiction of the Company or any successor entity is not a reasonable measure for the purposes of this section; and provided, further that no such notice of redemption will be given earlier than 60 days prior to the earliest date on which we, or any successor entity, as the case may be, would be obligated to pay such Additional Amounts if a payment in respect of the Notes were then due.
     Any Notes that are redeemed will be cancelled.
     (8) Redemption at the Option of the Company. The Company will have the right to redeem the Notes of any series, in whole or in part from time to time, at the Company’s option, on at least 30 days’ but no more than 60 days’ prior written notice mailed to the registered Holders of such series of Notes to be redeemed. Upon redemption of the Notes, the Company will pay a redemption price equal to the greater of (1) 100% of the principal amount of the Notes to be redeemed and (2) the sum of the present values of the Remaining Scheduled Payments of the Notes to be redeemed, discounted to the date of redemption on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the Treasury Rate plus 40 basis points, in each case plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the Redemption Date and certified as to amount to the Trustee in an Officer’s Certificate.
     (9) Mandatory Redemption. The Company is not be required to make mandatory redemption or sinking fund payments with respect to the Notes.
     (10) Notice of Redemption. Notice of redemption will be mailed at least 30 days but not more than 60 days before the Redemption Date to each Holder at its registered address.
     (11) Offer To Purchase Upon a Change of Control. Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, unless the Company has exercised its right to redeem the Notes under Section 4.05 or under Section 4.06 of the Indenture, or unless the Change of Control Payment Date would fall on or after the maturity date of the Notes, the Company will make an offer to purchase all or a portion of each Holder’s Notes pursuant to the Change of Control Offer, at a purchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount tendered plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of purchase.
     (12) Denominations, Transfer, Exchange. The Notes are in registered form without coupons in a minimum denomination of US$2,000 and integral multiples of US$1,000 in excess thereof. The transfer of Notes may be registered and Notes may be exchanged as provided in the Indenture. The Registrar and the Trustee may require a Holder, among other things, to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents and the Company may require a Holder to pay any taxes and fees required by law or permitted by the Indenture. The Company need not exchange or register the transfer of any Note or portion of a Note selected for redemption. Also, the Company need not exchange or register the transfer of any Notes for a period of 15 days

A-6


 

before a selection of Notes of such series to be redeemed or selected for redemption or during the period between a record date and the corresponding Interest Payment Date.
     (13) Persons Deemed Owners. The registered Holder of a Note may be treated as its owner for all purposes.
     (14) Amendment, Supplement and Waiver. Subject to certain exceptions, the Company and the Trustee may modify this Indenture without the consent of any Holder of Notes: (i) to cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency; (ii) to provide for the issuance of additional notes in accordance with the limitations set forth in the Indenture as of the date hereof; (iii) to provide for the assumption by a successor company of the Company’s obligations under the Notes and the Indenture in the case of a merger or consolidation or sale of all or substantially all of the Company’s assets; (iv) to comply with any requirements of the SEC in connection with qualifying the Indenture under the Trust Indenture Act; (v) to provide for the issuance of Exchange Notes; or (vi) to correct any other provisions with respect to matters or questions arising under the Indenture, so long as that correction or added provision will not adversely affect the interests of the Holders of the Notes in any material respect.
     Upon the request of the Company, as evidenced by an Officer’s Certificate confirming the due authorization by the Company of the execution of any such amended or supplemental indenture, and upon receipt by the Trustee of the documents described in Section 8.02 of the Indenture, the Trustee will join with the Company in the execution of any amended or supplemental indenture authorized or permitted by the terms of this Indenture and to make any further appropriate agreements and stipulations that may be therein contained, but the Trustee will not be obligated to enter into such amended or supplemental indenture that affects its own rights, duties or immunities under this Indenture or otherwise.
     Subject to the exceptions set out below, the Company and the Trustee may modify and amend this Indenture with the consent of the Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Notes (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any) of the relevant series then outstanding. However, no modification or amendment may, without the consent of the Holders of outstanding Notes of a series affected thereby (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any): (i) change the maturity of any payment of principal of or any installment of interest on the Notes; (ii) reduce the principal amount or the rate of interest, or change the method of computing the amount of principal or interest payable on any date, with respect to the Notes; (iii) change the coin or currency in which the principal of or interest on the Notes are payable; (iv) impair the right of the Holders of Notes to institute suit for the enforcement of any payment on or after the date due; (v) reduce the percentage in principal amount of the outstanding Notes, the consent of whose Holders is required for any modification of or waiver of compliance with any provision of this Indenture or defaults under the Indenture and their consequences; or (vi) modify the provisions summarized in paragraph 10.02 of the Indenture or the provisions of this Indenture regarding the quorum required at any meeting of Holders.
     After an amendment described in the preceding paragraph, the Company is required to mail through the Trustee, to the Holders of the Notes affected by such amendment (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any) a notice briefly describing the amendment. However, the failure to give that notice to all the Holders of the Notes affected by such amendment (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any), or any defect in the notice, will not affect the validity of the amendment.

A-7


 

     It is not necessary for the Holders to approve the particular form of any proposed modification of the Indenture, but it is sufficient if that consent approves the substance of the proposed modification.
     (15) Defaults and Remedies.
     Each of the following is an “Event of Default”:
     (1) default in any payment of principal on any Note when due (at maturity, upon redemption or otherwise), continues for 15 days;
     (2) default in the payment of interest, Additional Interest (if any) and Additional Amounts (if any) on any Note when due, continues for 30 days;
     (3) the Company’s failure to comply with any other obligation contained in the Indenture (other than a covenant default in whose performance or whose breach is elsewhere in Section 7.01 of the Indenture specifically dealt with), and continuance of such default or breach for a period of 60 days after there has been given to the Company by the Trustee written notice, as provided in accordance with Section 12.03 of the Indenture, specifying such default or breach and requiring it to be remedied;
     (4) the Company’s failure, or the failure of any Material Subsidiary, (a) to pay the principal of any indebtedness for borrowed money, including obligations evidenced by any mortgage, indenture, bond, debenture, note, guarantee or other similar instruments on the scheduled or original date due (following the giving of such notice, if any, as required under the document governing such indebtedness and as extended by any applicable cure period) or (b) to observe or perform any agreement or condition relating to such indebtedness such that such indebtedness has come due prior to its stated maturity and such acceleration has not been cured, unless (in the case of clauses (a) and (b)) (i) the aggregate amount of such indebtedness is less than €100,000,000 or (ii) the question of whether such indebtedness is due has been disputed in good faith by appropriate proceedings and such dispute has not been finally adjudicated against the Company or the Material Subsidiary, as the case may be;
     (5) if the Company is (or is deemed by law or a court to be) insolvent or bankrupt or presents a request for controlled management (gestion contrôlée) or is granted a moratorium on payments or is unable to pay its debts, stops, suspends or threatens to stop or suspend payment of all or a material part of (or of a particular type of) its debts within the meaning of any applicable law, proposes or makes any agreement for the deferral, rescheduling or other readjustment of all of (or all of a particular type of) its debts (or of any part which it will or might otherwise be unable to pay when due), proposes or makes a general assignment or any arrangement or composition with or for the benefit of the relevant creditors in respect of any of such debts or a moratorium is agreed or declared in respect of or affecting all or any part of (or of a particular type of) the debts of the Company or any event occurs which under the laws of any relevant jurisdiction has an analogous effect to any of the foregoing events; or
     (6) if any Material Subsidiary is (or is deemed by law or a court to be) insolvent or bankrupt or presents a request for controlled management (gestion contrôlée) or is granted a moratorium on payments or is unable to pay its debts, stops, suspends or threatens to stop or suspend payment of all or a material part of (or of a particular type of) its debts within the

A-8


 

meaning of any applicable law, proposes or makes any agreement for the deferral, rescheduling or other readjustment of all of (or all of a particular type of) its debts (or of any part which it will or might otherwise be unable to pay when due), proposes or makes a general assignment or any arrangement or composition with or for the benefit of the relevant creditors in respect of any of such debts or a moratorium is agreed or declared in respect of or affecting all or any part of (or of a particular type of) the debts of any such Material Subsidiary or any event occurs which under the laws of any relevant jurisdiction has an analogous effect to any of the foregoing events (in each case, a “Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event”), provided that no Event of Default under this paragraph (ii) will occur in relation to any such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event unless (x) the credit rating assigned by any Rating Agency to the long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness of the Company within the period of 60 days immediately following such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event is less than the credit rating assigned by such agency to the long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness of the Company immediately prior to or on the effective date of such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event and (y) a Rating Agency making a Rating Downgrade publicly announces or confirms that such Rating Downgrade was the result of any event or circumstance comprised in or arising as a result of, or in respect of, such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event.
     Upon the occurrence and continuation of any Event of Default, then in every such case the Trustee or the Holders of at least 25% in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of the affected series may declare the principal amount of the outstanding Notes of that series to be due and payable immediately, by a notice in writing to the Company (and to the Trustee if given by Holders), in accordance with Section 12.03 of the Indenture. Upon any such declaration, the Notes shall become due and payable immediately.
     At any time after such a declaration of acceleration with respect to outstanding Notes of any series has been made and before a judgment or decree for payment of the money due has been obtained by the Trustee as hereinafter in this Article provided, the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes of that series, by written notice to the Company and the Trustee, may rescind and annul such declaration and its consequences if:
  (1)   the Company has paid or deposited with the Trustee a sum sufficient to pay
                 (a) all overdue interest on all Notes of that series,
               (b) the principal of (and premium, if any, on) any Notes of that series which have become due otherwise than by such declaration of acceleration and interest thereon at the rate or rates prescribed therefor in such Notes,
               (c) to the extent that payment of such interest is lawful, interest upon overdue interest at the rate or rates prescribed therefor in such Notes, and
               (d) all sums paid or advanced by the Trustee hereunder and the reasonable and documented compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel;
and

A-9


 

     (2) all Events of Default with respect to Notes of that series, other than the non-payment of the principal and other amounts of Notes of that series which have become due solely by such declaration of acceleration, have been cured or waived as provided in Section 7.04 of the Indenture.
No such rescission shall affect any subsequent default or impair any right consequent thereon.
     The Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of any series by notice to the Trustee may waive any past default under the Indenture affecting such series, except an uncured default in the payment of principal of or interest on such series of Notes or an uncured default relating to a covenant or provision of the Indenture that cannot be modified or amended without the consent of each affected Holder.
     Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of a series will have the right to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for exercising any remedy available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee, in each case with respect to such series and subject to the limitations specified herein. Subject to Article 8 of the Indenture relating to the Trustee’s duties, the Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of its rights and powers under the Indenture unless such Holder has offered an indemnity to its reasonable satisfaction against any loss, costs, expenses and liabilities it may incur.
     No Holder of Notes of any series will have any right to institute any proceeding with respect to the Indenture or the Notes of the series or for any remedy thereunder, unless:
     (1) such Holder has previously given written notice to the Trustee at its Corporate Trust Office of a continuing Event of Default under the Notes of the series has occurred;
     (2) Holders of not less than 25% in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of the relevant series have made a written request to the Trustee to institute the proceedings in respect of the Event of Default or breach in its own name as Trustee under the Indenture;
     (3) the Holders of the Notes of the relevant series have offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity against the cost and other liabilities of instituting a proceeding and provided a written request to the Trustee at its Corporate Trust Office;
     (4) the Trustee for 60 days thereafter has failed to institute any such proceeding; and
     (5) during such 60-day period, the Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of the relevant series have not given the Trustee a direction that is inconsistent with such written request,
it being understood and intended that no one or more Holders shall have any right in any manner whatever by virtue of, or by availing of, any provision of the Indenture to affect, disturb or prejudice the rights of any other Holders, or to obtain or to seek to obtain priority or preference over any other Holders or to enforce any right under the Indenture, except in the manner herein provided and for the equal and ratable benefit of all the Holders.
     Notwithstanding any other provision of the Indenture, the right of any Holder of a Note to receive payment of principal, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, on the Note, on or after the respective due

A-10


 

dates expressed in the Note (including in connection with a Change of Control Offer), or to institute a suit for the enforcement of any such payment on or after such respective dates, shall not be impaired without the consent of such Holder.
     (16) Trustee Dealings with Company. The Trustee, in its individual or any other capacity, may become the owner or pledgee of Notes and may otherwise deal with the Company or any Affiliate of the Company with the same rights it would have if it were not Trustee. However, in the event that the Trustee acquires any conflicting interest, it must eliminate such conflict within 90 days, or resign.
     (17) No Recourse Against Others. No past, present or future director, officer, employee, incorporator or stockholder of the Company, as such, will have any liability for any obligations of the Company under the Notes or the Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of, or by reason of, such obligations or their creation. Each Holder by accepting a Note waives and releases all such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for the issuance of the Notes.
     (18) Authentication. This Note will not be valid until authenticated by the manual signature of the Trustee or an authenticating agent.
     (19) Abbreviations. Customary abbreviations may be used in the name of a Holder or an assignee, such as: TEN COM (= tenants in common), TEN ENT (= tenants by the entireties), JT TEN (= joint tenants with right of survivorship and not as tenants in common), CUST (= Custodian), and U/G/M/A (= Uniform Gifts to Minors Act).
     (20) CUSIP Numbers. Pursuant to a recommendation promulgated by the Committee on Uniform Security Identification Procedures, the Company has caused CUSIP numbers to be printed on the Notes, and the Trustee may use CUSIP numbers in notices of redemption as a convenience to Holders. No representation is made as to the accuracy of such numbers either as printed on the Notes or as contained in any notice of redemption, and reliance may be placed only on the other identification numbers placed thereon.
     (21) Governing Law. THE INDENTURE AND THE NOTES SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.
     The Company will furnish to any Holder upon written request and without charge a copy of the Indenture. Requests may be made to:
     
 
  ArcelorMittal
 
  19, avenue de la Liberté
 
  L-2930 Luxembourg
 
  Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
 
  Facsimile: +352 4792 2189
 
  Attention: Funding Department

A-11


 

Assignment Form
     To assign this Note, fill in the form below:
     
(I) or (we) assign and transfer this Note to:
   
 
   
 
  (Insert assignee’s legal name)
     
 
(Insert assignee’s soc. sec. or tax I.D. no.)
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
(Print or type assignee’s name, address and zip code)
     
and irrevocably appoint
   
 
   
to transfer this Note on the books of the Company. The agent may substitute another to act for him.
Date:                     
Your Signature:                                                                                         
(Sign exactly as your name appears on the face of this Note)
Signature Guarantee*:                                         
 
*   Participant in a recognized Signature Guarantee Medallion Program (or other signature guarantor acceptable to the Trustee).

A-12


 

Schedule of Exchanges of Interests in the Global Note *
     The following exchanges of a part of this Global Note for an interest in another Global Note or for a Definitive Note, or exchanges of a part of another Global Note or Definitive Note for an interest in this Global Note, have been made:
                                 
                        Principal Amount of    
                        this Global Note    
        Amount of decrease in   Amount of increase in   following such   Signature of authorized
        Principal Amount of   Principal Amount of   decrease   officer of Trustee or
Date of Exchange   this Global Note   this Global Note   (or increase)   Custodian
 
*   This schedule should be included only if the Note is issued in global form

A-13


 

EXHIBIT B
FORM OF CERTIFICATE OF TRANSFER
ArcelorMittal
19, avenue de la Liberté
L-2930 Luxembourg
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
Facsimile: +352 4792 2189
Attention: Funding Department
HSBC Bank USA, National Association
10 East 40th Street, 14th Floor
New York, NY 10016
USA
Facsimile No.: +1-212-525-1111
Attention: Anthony Bocchino
     Re: [5.375% 2013][6.125% 2018] Notes of ArcelorMittal
     Reference is hereby made to the Indenture, dated as of May 27, 2008 (the “Indenture”), between ArcelorMittal, as issuer (the “Company”), and HSBC Bank USA, National Association, as trustee. Capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the meanings given to them in the Indenture.
                         , (the “Transferor”) owns and proposes to transfer the Note[s] or interest in such Note[s] specified in Annex A hereto, in the principal amount of $                     in such Note[s] or interests (the “Transfer”), to                                          (the “Transferee”), as further specified in Annex A hereto. In connection with the Transfer, the Transferor hereby certifies that:
[CHECK ALL THAT APPLY]
     1. ¨ Check if Transferee will take delivery of a beneficial interest in the 144A Global Note or a Restricted Definitive Note pursuant to Rule 144A. The Transfer is being effected pursuant to and in accordance with Rule 144A under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), and, accordingly, the Transferor hereby further certifies that the beneficial interest or Definitive Note is being transferred to a Person that the Transferor reasonably believes is purchasing the beneficial interest or Definitive Note for its own account, or for one or more accounts with respect to which such Person exercises sole investment discretion, and such Person and each such account is a “qualified institutional buyer” within the meaning of Rule 144A in a transaction meeting the requirements of Rule 144A, and such Transfer is in compliance with any applicable blue sky securities laws of any state of the United States. Upon consummation of the proposed Transfer in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, the transferred beneficial interest or Definitive Note will be subject to the restrictions on transfer enumerated in the Private Placement Legend printed on the 144A Global Note and/or the Restricted Definitive Note and in the Indenture and the Securities Act.
     2. ¨ Check if Transferee will take delivery of a beneficial interest in the Regulation S Global Note or a Restricted Definitive Note pursuant to Regulation S. The Transfer is being effected pursuant to and in accordance with Rule 903 or Rule 904 under the Securities Act and, accordingly, the Transferor hereby further certifies that (i) the Transfer is not being made to a Person in the United States and (x) at the time the buy order was originated, the Transferee was outside the United States or such Transferor and any Person acting on its behalf reasonably believed and believes that the Transferee was outside the United States or (y) the transaction was executed in, on or through the facilities of a designated offshore securities market and neither such Transferor nor any Person acting on its behalf knows that the transaction was prearranged with a

B-1


 

buyer in the United States, (ii) no directed selling efforts have been made in contravention of the requirements of Rule 903(b) or Rule 904(b) of Regulation S under the Securities Act, (iii) the transaction is not part of a plan or scheme to evade the registration requirements of the Securities Act and (iv) if the proposed transfer is being made prior to the expiration of the Restricted Period, the transfer is not being made to a U.S. Person or for the account or benefit of a U.S. Person (other than an Initial Purchaser). Upon consummation of the proposed transfer in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, the transferred beneficial interest or Definitive Note will be subject to the restrictions on Transfer enumerated in the Private Placement Legend printed on the Regulation S Global Note and/or the Restricted Definitive Note and in the Indenture and the Securities Act.
     3. ¨ Check if Transferee will take delivery of a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note or of an Unrestricted Definitive Note.
     (a) ¨ Check if Transfer is pursuant to Rule 144. (i) The Transfer is being effected pursuant to and in accordance with Rule 144 under the Securities Act and in compliance with the transfer restrictions contained in the Indenture and any applicable blue sky securities laws of any state of the United States and (ii) the restrictions on transfer contained in the Indenture and the Private Placement Legend are not required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act. Upon consummation of the proposed Transfer in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, the transferred beneficial interest or Definitive Note will no longer be subject to the restrictions on transfer enumerated in the Private Placement Legend printed on the Restricted Global Notes, on Restricted Definitive Notes and in the Indenture.
     (b) ¨ Check if Transfer is Pursuant to Regulation S. (i) The Transfer is being effected pursuant to and in accordance with Rule 903 or Rule 904 under the Securities Act and in compliance with the transfer restrictions contained in the Indenture and any applicable blue sky securities laws of any state of the United States and (ii) the restrictions on transfer contained in the Indenture and the Private Placement Legend are not required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act. Upon consummation of the proposed Transfer in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, the transferred beneficial interest or Definitive Note will no longer be subject to the restrictions on transfer enumerated in the Private Placement Legend printed on the Restricted Global Notes, on Restricted Definitive Notes and in the Indenture.
     (c) ¨ Check if Transfer is Pursuant to Other Exemption. (i) The Transfer is being effected pursuant to and in compliance with an exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act other than Rule 144, Rule 903 or Rule 904 and in compliance with the transfer restrictions contained in the Indenture and any applicable blue sky securities laws of any State of the United States and (ii) the restrictions on transfer contained in the Indenture and the Private Placement Legend are not required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act. Upon consummation of the proposed Transfer in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, the transferred beneficial interest or Definitive Note will not be subject to the restrictions on transfer enumerated in the Private Placement Legend printed on the Restricted Global Notes or Restricted Definitive Notes and in the Indenture.
     (d) ¨ Check if Transfer is Pursuant to an Effective Registration Statement. (i) The Transfer is being effected pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Securities Act and in compliance with the transfer restrictions contained in the Indenture and any applicable blue sky securities laws of any State of the United States and (ii) the restrictions on transfer contained in the Indenture and the Private Placement Legend are not required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act. Upon consummation of the proposed Transfer in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, the transferred beneficial interest or Definitive Note will not be subject to the restrictions on transfer enumerated in the Private Placement Legend printed on the Restricted Global Notes or Restricted Definitive Notes and in the Indenture.

B-2


 

     This certificate and the statements contained herein are made for your benefit and the benefit of the Company.
             
 
     
 
      [Insert Name of Transferor]
   
 
           
 
  By:        
 
     
 
Name:
   
 
      Title:    
     Dated:                                         

B-3


 

ANNEX A TO CERTIFICATE OF TRANSFER
1.   The Transferor owns and proposes to transfer the following:
[CHECK ONE OF (a) OR (b)]
  (a)   ¨       a beneficial interest in the:
  (i)   ¨    144A Global Note (CUSIP                     ), or
 
  (ii)   ¨    Regulation S Global Note (CUSIP                     ); or
  (b)   ¨      a Restricted Definitive Note.
2.   After the Transfer the Transferee will hold:
[CHECK ONE]
  (a)   ¨       a beneficial interest in the:
  (i)   ¨    144A Global Note (CUSIP                     ), or
 
  (ii)   ¨    Regulation S Global Note (CUSIP                     ); or
 
  (iii)   ¨    Unrestricted Global Note (CUSIP                     ); or
  (b)   ¨       a Restricted Definitive Note; or
 
  (c)   ¨       an Unrestricted Definitive Note,
in accordance with the terms of the Indenture.

B-4


 

EXHIBIT C
FORM OF CERTIFICATE OF EXCHANGE
ArcelorMittal
19, avenue de la Liberté
L-2930 Luxembourg
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
Facsimile: +352 4792 2189
Attention: Funding Department
HSBC Bank USA, National Association
10 East 40th Street, 14th Floor
New York, NY 10016
USA
Facsimile No.: +1-212-525-1300
Attention: Anthony A. Bocchino, Jr.
     Re: [5.375% 2013][6.125% 2018] Notes of ArcelorMittal
(CUSIP                     )
     Reference is hereby made to the Indenture, dated as of May 27, 2008 (the “Indenture”), between ArcelorMittal, as issuer (the “Company”), and HSBC Bank USA, National Association, as trustee. Capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the meanings given to them in the Indenture.
                                             , (the “Owner”) owns and proposes to exchange the Note[s] or interest in such Note[s] specified herein, in the principal amount of $                     in such Note[s] or interests (the “Exchange”). In connection with the Exchange, the Owner hereby certifies that:
     1. Exchange of Restricted Definitive Notes or Beneficial Interests in a Restricted Global Note for Unrestricted Definitive Notes or Beneficial Interests in an Unrestricted Global Note
     (a) ¨ Check if Exchange is from beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note to beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note. In connection with the Exchange of the Owner’s beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note for a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note in an equal principal amount, the Owner hereby certifies (i) the beneficial interest is being acquired for the Owner’s own account without transfer, (ii) such Exchange has been effected in compliance with the transfer restrictions applicable to the Global Notes and pursuant to and in accordance with the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), (iii) the restrictions on transfer contained in the Indenture and the Private Placement Legend are not required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act and (iv) the beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note is being acquired in compliance with any applicable blue sky securities laws of any state of the United States.
     (b) ¨ Check if Exchange is from beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note to Unrestricted Definitive Note. In connection with the Exchange of the Owner’s beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note for an Unrestricted Definitive Note, the Owner hereby certifies (i) the Definitive Note is being acquired for the Owner’s own account without transfer, (ii) such Exchange has been effected in compliance with the transfer restrictions applicable to the Restricted Global Notes and pursuant to and in accordance with the Securities Act, (iii) the restrictions on transfer contained in the

C-1


 

EXHIBIT C
Indenture and the Private Placement Legend are not required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act and (iv) the Definitive Note is being acquired in compliance with any applicable blue sky securities laws of any state of the United States.
     (c) ¨ Check if Exchange is from Restricted Definitive Note to beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note. In connection with the Owner’s Exchange of a Restricted Definitive Note for a beneficial interest in an Unrestricted Global Note, the Owner hereby certifies (i) the beneficial interest is being acquired for the Owner’s own account without transfer, (ii) such Exchange has been effected in compliance with the transfer restrictions applicable to Restricted Definitive Notes and pursuant to and in accordance with the Securities Act, (iii) the restrictions on transfer contained in the Indenture and the Private Placement Legend are not required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act and (iv) the beneficial interest is being acquired in compliance with any applicable blue sky securities laws of any state of the United States.
     (d) ¨ Check if Exchange is from Restricted Definitive Note to Unrestricted Definitive Note. In connection with the Owner’s Exchange of a Restricted Definitive Note for an Unrestricted Definitive Note, the Owner hereby certifies (i) the Unrestricted Definitive Note is being acquired for the Owner’s own account without transfer, (ii) such Exchange has been effected in compliance with the transfer restrictions applicable to Restricted Definitive Notes and pursuant to and in accordance with the Securities Act, (iii) the restrictions on transfer contained in the Indenture and the Private Placement Legend are not required in order to maintain compliance with the Securities Act and (iv) the Unrestricted Definitive Note is being acquired in compliance with any applicable blue sky securities laws of any state of the United States.
     2. Exchange of Restricted Definitive Notes or Beneficial Interests in Restricted Global Notes for Restricted Definitive Notes or Beneficial Interests in Restricted Global Notes
     (a) ¨ Check if Exchange is from beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note to Restricted Definitive Note. In connection with the Exchange of the Owner’s beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note for a Restricted Definitive Note with an equal principal amount, the Owner hereby certifies that the Restricted Definitive Note is being acquired for the Owner’s own account without transfer. Upon consummation of the proposed Exchange in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, the Restricted Definitive Note issued will continue to be subject to the restrictions on transfer enumerated in the Private Placement Legend printed on the Restricted Definitive Note and in the Indenture and the Securities Act.
     (b) ¨ Check if Exchange is from Restricted Definitive Note to beneficial interest in a Restricted Global Note. In connection with the Exchange of the Owner’s Restricted Definitive Note for a beneficial interest in the [CHECK ONE] ¨ 144A Global Note, ¨ Regulation S Global Note, the Owner hereby certifies (i) the beneficial interest is being acquired for the Owner’s own account without transfer and (ii) such Exchange has been effected in compliance with the transfer restrictions applicable to the Restricted Global Notes and pursuant to and in accordance with the Securities Act, and in compliance with any applicable blue sky securities laws of any state of the United States. Upon consummation of the proposed Exchange in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, the beneficial interest issued will be subject to the restrictions on transfer enumerated in the Private Placement Legend printed on the relevant Restricted Global Note and in the Indenture and the Securities Act.

C-2


 

EXHIBIT C
     This certificate and the statements contained herein are made for your benefit and the benefit of the Company.
         
 
       
 
      [Insert Name of Transferor]
 
       
 
  By:    
 
       
 
      Name:
 
      Title:
Dated:                                         

C-3

EX-4.2 3 u01974exv4w2.htm EX-4.2: FORM OF 2013 AND 2018 EXCHANGE NOTES EX-4.2
Exhibit 4.2
[Face of 2013 Note]
 
THIS GLOBAL NOTE IS HELD BY THE DEPOSITARY (AS DEFINED IN THE INDENTURE GOVERNING THIS NOTE) OR ITS NOMINEE IN CUSTODY FOR THE BENEFIT OF THE BENEFICIAL OWNERS HEREOF, AND IS NOT TRANSFERABLE TO ANY PERSON UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES EXCEPT THAT (1) THE TRUSTEE MAY MAKE SUCH NOTATIONS HEREON AS MAY BE REQUIRED PURSUANT TO SECTION 10.04 OF THE INDENTURE, (2) THIS GLOBAL NOTE MAY BE EXCHANGED IN WHOLE BUT NOT IN PART PURSUANT TO SECTION 2.06(a) OF THE INDENTURE, (3) THIS GLOBAL NOTE MAY BE DELIVERED TO THE TRUSTEE FOR CANCELLATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 2.11 OF THE INDENTURE AND (4) THIS GLOBAL NOTE MAY BE TRANSFERRED TO A SUCCESSOR DEPOSITARY WITH THE PRIOR WRITTEN CONSENT OF THE COMPANY.
UNLESS AND UNTIL IT IS EXCHANGED IN WHOLE OR IN PART FOR NOTES IN DEFINITIVE FORM, THIS NOTE MAY NOT BE TRANSFERRED EXCEPT AS A WHOLE BY THE DEPOSITARY TO A NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY OR BY A NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY TO THE DEPOSITARY OR ANOTHER NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY OR BY THE DEPOSITARY OR ANY SUCH NOMINEE TO A SUCCESSOR DEPOSITARY OR A NOMINEE OF SUCH SUCCESSOR DEPOSITARY. UNLESS THIS CERTIFICATE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY (55 WATER STREET, NEW YORK, NEW YORK) (“DTC”), TO THE COMPANY OR ITS AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY CERTIFICATE ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR SUCH OTHER NAME AS MAY BE REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT IS MADE TO CEDE & CO. OR SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS MAY BE REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC), ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL INASMUCH AS THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.
 

 


 

CUSIP:         03938LAC8
ISIN:     US03938LAC81
5.375% Notes due 2013
No.             $                    
ARCELORMITTAL
promises to pay to Cede & Co. or registered assigns,
the principal sum of                                          DOLLARS on June 1, 2013.
Interest Payment Dates: June 1 and December 1 of each year, commencing on December 1, 2008
Record Dates: May 15 and November 15 of each year, commencing on November 15, 2008
Reference is hereby made to the further provisions of the Note evidenced hereby set forth on the reverse hereof, which further provisions shall have the same effect as if set forth at this place.
Unless the Certificate of Authentication has been duly executed by the Trustee by manual signature, this Note shall not be entitled to any benefits under the Indenture, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.
Dated:                     , 2008
         
  ARCELORMITTAL
 
 
  By:      
    Name:      
    Title:      
 
     
  By:      
    Name:      
    Title:      
 

 


 

This is one of the Notes referred to
in the within-mentioned Indenture:
HSBC BANK USA, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
 as Trustee
         
By:
       
 
 
 
Authorized Signatory
   

 


 

[Face of 2018 Note]
 
THIS GLOBAL NOTE IS HELD BY THE DEPOSITARY (AS DEFINED IN THE INDENTURE GOVERNING THIS NOTE) OR ITS NOMINEE IN CUSTODY FOR THE BENEFIT OF THE BENEFICIAL OWNERS HEREOF, AND IS NOT TRANSFERABLE TO ANY PERSON UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES EXCEPT THAT (1) THE TRUSTEE MAY MAKE SUCH NOTATIONS HEREON AS MAY BE REQUIRED PURSUANT TO SECTION 10.04 OF THE INDENTURE, (2) THIS GLOBAL NOTE MAY BE EXCHANGED IN WHOLE BUT NOT IN PART PURSUANT TO SECTION 2.06(a) OF THE INDENTURE, (3) THIS GLOBAL NOTE MAY BE DELIVERED TO THE TRUSTEE FOR CANCELLATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 2.11 OF THE INDENTURE AND (4) THIS GLOBAL NOTE MAY BE TRANSFERRED TO A SUCCESSOR DEPOSITARY WITH THE PRIOR WRITTEN CONSENT OF THE COMPANY.
UNLESS AND UNTIL IT IS EXCHANGED IN WHOLE OR IN PART FOR NOTES IN DEFINITIVE FORM, THIS NOTE MAY NOT BE TRANSFERRED EXCEPT AS A WHOLE BY THE DEPOSITARY TO A NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY OR BY A NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY TO THE DEPOSITARY OR ANOTHER NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY OR BY THE DEPOSITARY OR ANY SUCH NOMINEE TO A SUCCESSOR DEPOSITARY OR A NOMINEE OF SUCH SUCCESSOR DEPOSITARY. UNLESS THIS CERTIFICATE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY (55 WATER STREET, NEW YORK, NEW YORK) (“DTC”), TO THE COMPANY OR ITS AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY CERTIFICATE ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR SUCH OTHER NAME AS MAY BE REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT IS MADE TO CEDE & CO. OR SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS MAY BE REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC), ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL INASMUCH AS THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.
 

 


 

CUSIP:         03938LAF1
ISIN:     US03938LAF13
6.125% Notes due 2018
No.            $                    
ARCELORMITTAL
promises to pay to Cede & Co. or registered assigns,
the principal sum of                                          DOLLARS on June 1, 2018.
Interest Payment Dates: June 1 and December 1 of each year, commencing on December 1, 2008
Record Dates: May 15 and November 15 of each year, commencing on November 15, 2008
Reference is hereby made to the further provisions of the Note evidenced hereby set forth on the reverse hereof, which further provisions shall have the same effect as if set forth at this place.
Unless the Certificate of Authentication has been duly executed by the Trustee by manual signature, this Note shall not be entitled to any benefits under the Indenture, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.
Dated:                     , 2008
         
  ARCELORMITTAL
 
 
  By:      
    Name:      
    Title:      
 
     
  By:      
    Name:      
    Title:      
 
This is one of the Notes referred to
in the within-mentioned Indenture:
Dated:

 


 

HSBC BANK USA, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
 as Trustee
         
By:
       
 
 
 
Authorized Signatory
   

 


 

[Back of Note]
[5.375% Notes due 2013][6.125% Notes due 2018]1
     Capitalized terms used herein have the meanings assigned to them in the Indenture referred to below unless otherwise indicated.
     (1) Interest. [ArcelorMittal, a société anonyme organized under Luxembourg law will pay interest on the principal amount of the 2013 Notes at 5.375% per annum from [issuance date] until maturity.][ArcelorMittal, a société anonyme organized under Luxembourg law will pay interest on the principal amount of the 2018 Notes at 6.125% per annum from [issuance date] until maturity.]2 The Company will pay interest and Additional Amounts, if any, pursuant to Section 5.11, semi-annually in arrears on June 1 and December 1 of each year (each an Interest Payment Date) commencing on [December 1], 2008, to the Holders of Notes registered as such as of close of business on May 15 and November 15, immediately preceding the relevant Interest Payment Date.
     If an Interest Payment Date or the maturity date in respect of the Notes is not a Business Day in the place of payment, we will pay interest or principal, as the case may be, on the next Business Day. Payments postponed to the next Business Day in this situation will be treated under this Indenture as if they were made on the original due date. Postponement of this kind will not result in a default under the Notes or this Indenture, and no interest will accrue on the postponed amount from the original due date to the next day that is a Business Day.
     Interest on the Notes will accrue from [issuance date] or, if interest has already been paid, from the date it was most recently paid (each such period, an Interest Period). Interest on the Notes will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months.
     (2) Defaulted Interest. If the Company defaults in a payment of interest on any of the Notes, it will pay the defaulted interest in any lawful manner plus, to the extent lawful, interest payable on the defaulted interest, to the Persons who are Holders of such Notes on a subsequent special record date, in each case at the rate provided in such Notes and in Section 3.01 hereof. The Company will notify the Trustee in writing of the amount of defaulted interest proposed to be paid on each such Note and the date of the proposed payment. The Company will fix or cause to be fixed each such special record date and payment date; provided that no such special record date may be less than 10 days prior to the related payment date for such defaulted interest. At least 15 days before the special record date, the Company (or, upon the written request of the Company, the Trustee in the name and at the expense of the Company) will mail or cause to be mailed to Holders of such Notes a notice that states the special record date, the related payment date and the amount of such interest to be paid.
     (3) Method of Payment. The Company will pay interest on the Notes (except defaulted interest) and Additional Amounts, if any, to the Persons who are registered Holders of Notes at the close of business in New York City on May 15 or November 15 (whether or not a
 
1   Delete as appropriate
 
2   Delete as appropriate

 


 

Business Day) immediately preceding the Interest Payment Date, except as provided in Section 2.12 of the Indenture with respect to defaulted interest. The Notes will be payable as to principal, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, at the office or agency of the Company maintained for such purpose within or without the City and State of New York, or, at the option of the Company, payment of interest and Additional Amounts, if any, may be made by check mailed to the Holders at their addresses set forth in the register of Holders; provided that payment by wire transfer of immediately available funds will be required with respect to principal of, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, on, all Global Notes and all other Notes the Holders of which will have provided wire transfer instructions to the Company or the Paying Agent. Such payment will be in such coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment is legal tender for payment of public and private debts.
     (4) Paying Agent and Registrar. Initially, HSBC Bank USA, National Association, the Trustee under the Indenture, will act as Paying Agent and Registrar. The Company may appoint one or more Co-Registrars and one or more additional Paying Agents. The Company may change any Paying Agent or Registrar without notice to any Holder. The Company or any of its Subsidiaries may act in any such capacity.
     (5) Indenture. The Company issued the Notes under an Indenture dated as of May 27, 2008 between the Company and the Trustee. The terms of the Notes include those stated in the Indenture and those expressly made part of the Indenture by reference to the Trust Indenture Act as in effect on the date of the Indenture and, to the extent required by any amendment after such date, as so amended. The Notes are subject to all such terms, and Holders are referred to the Indenture and the U.S. Trust Indenture Act for a statement of such terms. To the extent any provision of this Note conflicts with the express provisions of the Indenture, the provisions of the Indenture shall govern and be controlling.
     (6) Redemption for Taxation Reasons. The Notes may be redeemed, at the Company’s option, in whole but not in part, upon giving not less than 30 days’ nor more than 60 days’ notice to the Holders (which notice will be irrevocable), at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof, together with accrued and unpaid interest (including any Additional Amounts), if any, to the Tax Redemption Date if, as a result of:
     (a) any change in, or amendment to, the laws (or any regulations or rulings promulgated thereunder) of a Relevant Jurisdiction affecting taxation; or
     (b) any change in, or amendment to, an official position regarding the application or interpretation of such laws, regulations or rulings (including a holding, judgment or order by a court of competent jurisdiction),
which change or amendment becomes effective (i) in the case of the Company, on or after the Closing Date or (ii) in the case of any successor entity, on or after the date such successor entity becomes obligated under the Notes or the Indenture, with respect to any payment due or to become due under the Notes or the Indenture, the Company or its successor entity, as the case may be, is, or on the next Interest Payment Date would be, required to pay Additional Amounts, and such requirement cannot be avoided by the Company or its successor entity, as the case may be, taking reasonable measures available to it; provided that for the avoidance of doubt changing the jurisdiction of the Company or any successor entity is not a reasonable measure for the purposes of this section; and provided, further that no such notice of redemption will be given earlier than 60 days prior to the earliest date on which we, or any successor entity, as the case

 


 

may be, would be obligated to pay such Additional Amounts if a payment in respect of the Notes were then due.
     Any Notes that are redeemed will be cancelled.
     (7) Redemption at the Option of the Company. The Company will have the right to redeem the Notes of any series, in whole or in part from time to time, at the Company’s option, on at least 30 days’ but no more than 60 days’ prior written notice mailed to the registered Holders of such series of Notes to be redeemed. Upon redemption of the Notes, the Company will pay a redemption price equal to the greater of (1) 100% of the principal amount of the Notes to be redeemed and (2) the sum of the present values of the Remaining Scheduled Payments of the Notes to be redeemed, discounted to the date of redemption on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the Treasury Rate plus 40 basis points, in each case plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the Redemption Date and certified as to amount to the Trustee in an Officer’s Certificate.
     (8) Mandatory Redemption. The Company is not be required to make mandatory redemption or sinking fund payments with respect to the Notes.
     (9) Notice of Redemption. Notice of redemption will be mailed at least 30 days but not more than 60 days before the Redemption Date to each Holder at its registered address.
     (10) Offer To Purchase Upon a Change of Control. Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, unless the Company has exercised its right to redeem the Notes under Section 4.05 or under Section 4.06 of the Indenture, or unless the Change of Control Payment Date would fall on or after the maturity date of the Notes, the Company will make an offer to purchase all or a portion of each Holder’s Notes pursuant to the Change of Control Offer, at a purchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount tendered plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of purchase.
     (11) Denominations, Transfer, Exchange. The Notes are in registered form without coupons in a minimum denomination of US$2,000 and integral multiples of US$1,000 in excess thereof. The transfer of Notes may be registered and Notes may be exchanged as provided in the Indenture. The Registrar and the Trustee may require a Holder, among other things, to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents and the Company may require a Holder to pay any taxes and fees required by law or permitted by the Indenture. The Company need not exchange or register the transfer of any Note or portion of a Note selected for redemption. Also, the Company need not exchange or register the transfer of any Notes for a period of 15 days before a selection of Notes of such series to be redeemed or selected for redemption or during the period between a record date and the corresponding Interest Payment Date.
     (12) Persons Deemed Owners. The registered Holder of a Note may be treated as its owner for all purposes.
     (13) Amendment, Supplement and Waiver. Subject to certain exceptions, the Company and the Trustee may modify this Indenture without the consent of any Holder of Notes: (i) to cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency; (ii) to provide for the issuance of additional notes in accordance with the limitations set forth in the Indenture as of the date hereof; (iii) to provide for the assumption by a successor company of the Company’s obligations under the Notes and the Indenture in the case of a merger or consolidation or sale of all or substantially all

 


 

of the Company’s assets; (iv) to comply with any requirements of the SEC in connection with qualifying the Indenture under the Trust Indenture Act; (v) to provide for the issuance of Exchange Notes; or (vi) to correct any other provisions with respect to matters or questions arising under the Indenture, so long as that correction or added provision will not adversely affect the interests of the Holders of the Notes in any material respect.
     Upon the request of the Company, as evidenced by an Officer’s Certificate confirming the due authorization by the Company of the execution of any such amended or supplemental indenture, and upon receipt by the Trustee of the documents described in Section 8.02 of the Indenture, the Trustee will join with the Company in the execution of any amended or supplemental indenture authorized or permitted by the terms of this Indenture and to make any further appropriate agreements and stipulations that may be therein contained, but the Trustee will not be obligated to enter into such amended or supplemental indenture that affects its own rights, duties or immunities under this Indenture or otherwise.
     Subject to the exceptions set out below, the Company and the Trustee may modify and amend this Indenture with the consent of the Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Notes (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any) of the relevant series then outstanding. However, no modification or amendment may, without the consent of the Holders of outstanding Notes of a series affected thereby (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any): (i) change the maturity of any payment of principal of or any installment of interest on the Notes; (ii) reduce the principal amount or the rate of interest, or change the method of computing the amount of principal or interest payable on any date, with respect to the Notes; (iii) change the coin or currency in which the principal of or interest on the Notes are payable; (iv) impair the right of the Holders of Notes to institute suit for the enforcement of any payment on or after the date due; (v) reduce the percentage in principal amount of the outstanding Notes, the consent of whose Holders is required for any modification of or waiver of compliance with any provision of this Indenture or defaults under the Indenture and their consequences; or (vi) modify the provisions summarized in paragraph 10.02 of the Indenture or the provisions of this Indenture regarding the quorum required at any meeting of Holders.
     After an amendment described in the preceding paragraph, the Company is required to mail through the Trustee, to the Holders of the Notes affected by such amendment (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any) a notice briefly describing the amendment. However, the failure to give that notice to all the Holders of the Notes affected by such amendment (including, without limitation, additional notes, if any), or any defect in the notice, will not affect the validity of the amendment.
     It is not necessary for the Holders to approve the particular form of any proposed modification of the Indenture, but it is sufficient if that consent approves the substance of the proposed modification.
     (14) Defaults and Remedies.
     Each of the following is an “Event of Default”:
     (1) default in any payment of principal on any Note when due (at maturity, upon redemption or otherwise), continues for 15 days;

 


 

     (2) default in the payment of interest and Additional Amounts (if any) on any Note when due, continues for 30 days;
     (3) the Company’s failure to comply with any other obligation contained in the Indenture (other than a covenant default in whose performance or whose breach is elsewhere in Section 7.01 of the Indenture specifically dealt with), and continuance of such default or breach for a period of 60 days after there has been given to the Company by the Trustee written notice, as provided in accordance with Section 12.03 of the Indenture, specifying such default or breach and requiring it to be remedied;
     (4) the Company’s failure, or the failure of any Material Subsidiary, (a) to pay the principal of any indebtedness for borrowed money, including obligations evidenced by any mortgage, indenture, bond, debenture, note, guarantee or other similar instruments on the scheduled or original date due (following the giving of such notice, if any, as required under the document governing such indebtedness and as extended by any applicable cure period) or (b) to observe or perform any agreement or condition relating to such indebtedness such that such indebtedness has come due prior to its stated maturity and such acceleration has not been cured, unless (in the case of clauses (a) and (b)) (i) the aggregate amount of such indebtedness is less than €100,000,000 or (ii) the question of whether such indebtedness is due has been disputed in good faith by appropriate proceedings and such dispute has not been finally adjudicated against the Company or the Material Subsidiary, as the case may be;
     (5) if the Company is (or is deemed by law or a court to be) insolvent or bankrupt or presents a request for controlled management (gestion contrôlée) or is granted a moratorium on payments or is unable to pay its debts, stops, suspends or threatens to stop or suspend payment of all or a material part of (or of a particular type of) its debts within the meaning of any applicable law, proposes or makes any agreement for the deferral, rescheduling or other readjustment of all of (or all of a particular type of) its debts (or of any part which it will or might otherwise be unable to pay when due), proposes or makes a general assignment or any arrangement or composition with or for the benefit of the relevant creditors in respect of any of such debts or a moratorium is agreed or declared in respect of or affecting all or any part of (or of a particular type of) the debts of the Company or any event occurs which under the laws of any relevant jurisdiction has an analogous effect to any of the foregoing events; or
     (6) if any Material Subsidiary is (or is deemed by law or a court to be) insolvent or bankrupt or presents a request for controlled management (gestion contrôlée) or is granted a moratorium on payments or is unable to pay its debts, stops, suspends or threatens to stop or suspend payment of all or a material part of (or of a particular type of) its debts within the meaning of any applicable law, proposes or makes any agreement for the deferral, rescheduling or other readjustment of all of (or all of a particular type of) its debts (or of any part which it will or might otherwise be unable to pay when due), proposes or makes a general assignment or any arrangement or composition with or for the benefit of the relevant creditors in respect of any of such debts or a moratorium is agreed or declared in respect of or affecting all or any part of (or of a particular type of) the debts of any such Material Subsidiary or any event occurs which under the laws of any relevant jurisdiction has an analogous effect to any of the foregoing events (in each case, a “Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event”), provided that no Event of Default under this paragraph (ii) will occur in relation to any such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event unless (x) the credit rating assigned by any Rating Agency to the long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness of the Company within the period of 60 days immediately following

 


 

such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event is less than the credit rating assigned by such agency to the long-term, unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness of the Company immediately prior to or on the effective date of such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event and (y) a Rating Agency making a Rating Downgrade publicly announces or confirms that such Rating Downgrade was the result of any event or circumstance comprised in or arising as a result of, or in respect of, such Material Subsidiary Insolvency Event.
     Upon the occurrence and continuation of any Event of Default, then in every such case the Trustee or the Holders of at least 25% in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of the affected series may declare the principal amount of the outstanding Notes of that series to be due and payable immediately, by a notice in writing to the Company (and to the Trustee if given by Holders), in accordance with Section 12.03 of the Indenture. Upon any such declaration, the Notes shall become due and payable immediately.
     At any time after such a declaration of acceleration with respect to outstanding Notes of any series has been made and before a judgment or decree for payment of the money due has been obtained by the Trustee as hereinafter in this Article provided, the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes of that series, by written notice to the Company and the Trustee, may rescind and annul such declaration and its consequences if:
     (1) the Company has paid or deposited with the Trustee a sum sufficient to pay
          (a) all overdue interest on all Notes of that series,
          (b) the principal of (and premium, if any, on) any Notes of that series which have become due otherwise than by such declaration of acceleration and interest thereon at the rate or rates prescribed therefor in such Notes,
          (c) to the extent that payment of such interest is lawful, interest upon overdue interest at the rate or rates prescribed therefor in such Notes, and
          (d) all sums paid or advanced by the Trustee hereunder and the reasonable and documented compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel;
and
     (2) all Events of Default with respect to Notes of that series, other than the non-payment of the principal and other amounts of Notes of that series which have become due solely by such declaration of acceleration, have been cured or waived as provided in Section 7.04 of the Indenture.
     No such rescission shall affect any subsequent default or impair any right consequent thereon.
     The Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of any series by notice to the Trustee may waive any past default under the Indenture affecting such series, except an uncured default in the payment of principal of or interest on such series of Notes or an uncured default relating to a covenant or provision of the Indenture that cannot be modified or amended without the consent of each affected Holder.

 


 

     Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of a series will have the right to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for exercising any remedy available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee, in each case with respect to such series and subject to the limitations specified herein. Subject to Article 8 of the Indenture relating to the Trustee’s duties, the Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of its rights and powers under the Indenture unless such Holder has offered an indemnity to its reasonable satisfaction against any loss, costs, expenses and liabilities it may incur.
     No Holder of Notes of any series will have any right to institute any proceeding with respect to the Indenture or the Notes of the series or for any remedy thereunder, unless:
     (1) such Holder has previously given written notice to the Trustee at its Corporate Trust Office of a continuing Event of Default under the Notes of the series has occurred;
     (2) Holders of not less than 25% in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of the relevant series have made a written request to the Trustee to institute the proceedings in respect of the Event of Default or breach in its own name as Trustee under the Indenture;
     (3) the Holders of the Notes of the relevant series have offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity against the cost and other liabilities of instituting a proceeding and provided a written request to the Trustee at its Corporate Trust Office;
     (4) the Trustee for 60 days thereafter has failed to institute any such proceeding; and
     (5) during such 60-day period, the Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Notes of the relevant series have not given the Trustee a direction that is inconsistent with such written request,
it being understood and intended that no one or more Holders shall have any right in any manner whatever by virtue of, or by availing of, any provision of the Indenture to affect, disturb or prejudice the rights of any other Holders, or to obtain or to seek to obtain priority or preference over any other Holders or to enforce any right under the Indenture, except in the manner herein provided and for the equal and ratable benefit of all the Holders.
     Notwithstanding any other provision of the Indenture, the right of any Holder of a Note to receive payment of principal, interest and Additional Amounts, if any, on the Note, on or after the respective due dates expressed in the Note (including in connection with a Change of Control Offer), or to institute a suit for the enforcement of any such payment on or after such respective dates, shall not be impaired without the consent of such Holder.
     (16) Trustee Dealings with Company. The Trustee, in its individual or any other capacity, may become the owner or pledgee of Notes and may otherwise deal with the Company or any Affiliate of the Company with the same rights it would have if it were not Trustee. However, in the event that the Trustee acquires any conflicting interest, it must eliminate such conflict within 90 days, or resign.
     (17) No Recourse Against Others. No past, present or future director, officer, employee, incorporator or stockholder of the Company, as such, will have any liability for any obligations of the Company under the Notes or the Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of, or by reason of, such obligations or their creation. Each Holder by accepting a Note waives and releases all such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for the issuance of the Notes.

 


 

     (18) Authentication. This Note will not be valid until authenticated by the manual signature of the Trustee or an authenticating agent.
     (19) Abbreviations. Customary abbreviations may be used in the name of a Holder or an assignee, such as: TEN COM (= tenants in common), TEN ENT (= tenants by the entireties), JT TEN (= joint tenants with right of survivorship and not as tenants in common), CUST (= Custodian), and U/G/M/A (= Uniform Gifts to Minors Act).
     (20) CUSIP Numbers. Pursuant to a recommendation promulgated by the Committee on Uniform Security Identification Procedures, the Company has caused CUSIP numbers to be printed on the Notes, and the Trustee may use CUSIP numbers in notices of redemption as a convenience to Holders. No representation is made as to the accuracy of such numbers either as printed on the Notes or as contained in any notice of redemption, and reliance may be placed only on the other identification numbers placed thereon.
     (21) Governing Law. THE INDENTURE AND THE NOTES SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.
     The Company will furnish to any Holder upon written request and without charge a copy of the Indenture. Requests may be made to:
ArcelorMittal
19, avenue de la Liberté
L-2930 Luxembourg
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
Facsimile: +352 4792 2189
Attention: Funding Department

 

EX-4.3 4 u01974exv4w3.htm EX-4.3: REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT EX-4.3
Exhibit 4.3
REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT
     This REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT dated May 27, 2008 (the “Agreement”) is entered into by and among ArcelorMittal, a Luxembourg société anonyme (the “Company”), and Goldman, Sachs & Co., J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., HSBC Securities (USA) Inc. and BNP Paribas Securities Corp. (the “Initial Purchasers”).
     The Company and the Initial Purchasers are parties to the Purchase Agreement dated as of May 19, 2008 (the “Purchase Agreement”), which provides for the sale by the Company to the Initial Purchasers of $1,500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of its 5.375% Notes due 2013 (the “2013 Notes”) and $1,500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of its 6.125% Notes due 2018 (the “2018 Notes” and, together with the 2013 Notes, the “Securities”). As an inducement to the Initial Purchasers to enter into the Purchase Agreement, the Company has agreed to provide to the Initial Purchasers and their direct and indirect transferees the registration rights set forth in this Agreement. The execution and delivery of this Agreement is a condition to the closing under the Purchase Agreement.
     In consideration of the foregoing, the parties hereto agree as follows:
     1. Definitions. As used in this Agreement, the following terms shall have the following meanings:
     “Business Day” shall mean any day that is not a Saturday, Sunday or other day on which commercial banks in New York City, Paris and Luxembourg are authorized or required by law to remain closed.
     “Company” shall have the meaning set forth in the Preamble and shall also include the Company’s successors.
     “Default Day” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2(d) hereof.
     “Exchange Act” shall mean the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended from time to time.
     “Exchange Date” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2(a)(ii) hereof.
     “Exchange Offer” shall mean the exchange offer by the Company of Exchange Securities for Registrable Securities pursuant to Section 2(a) hereof.
     “Exchange Offer Registration” shall mean a registration under the Securities Act effected pursuant to Section 2(a) hereof.
     “Exchange Offer Registration Statement” shall mean an exchange offer registration statement on Form F-4 (or, if applicable, on another appropriate form) and all amendments and supplements to such registration statement, in each case including the Prospectus contained therein or deemed a part thereof, all exhibits thereto and any document incorporated by reference therein.

 


 

     “Exchange Securities” shall mean notes issued by the Company under the Indenture containing terms identical to the Securities (except that the Exchange Securities will not be subject to restrictions on transfer or to any increase in annual interest rate for failure to comply with this Agreement) and to be offered to Holders of Registrable Securities in exchange for Exchange Securities pursuant to the Exchange Offer.
     “FINRA” means the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc.
     “Free Writing Prospectus” means each free writing prospectus (as defined in Rule 405 under the Securities Act) prepared by or on behalf of the Company or used or referred to by the Company, in each case in connection with the sale of the Securities or Exchange Securities pursuant to this Agreement.
     “Holders” shall mean the Initial Purchasers, and each of their successors, assigns and direct and indirect transferees who become owners of Registrable Securities under the Indenture, in each case for so long as they hold any Registrable Securities; provided that for purposes of Sections 4 and 5 of this Agreement, the term “Holders” shall include Participating Broker-Dealers.
     “Indemnified Person” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5(c) hereof.
     “Indemnifying Person” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5(c) hereof.
     “Indenture” shall mean the Indenture relating to the Securities and Exchange Securities dated as of May 27, 2008 between the Company and HSBC Bank USA, National Association, as trustee, and as the same may be amended from time to time in accordance with the terms thereof.
     “Initial Purchasers” shall have the meaning set forth in the preamble.
     “Issuer Information” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5(a) hereof.
     “Majority Holders” shall mean the Holders of a majority of the aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Registrable Securities; provided that whenever the consent or approval of Holders of a specified percentage of Registrable Securities is required hereunder, any Registrable Securities owned directly or indirectly by the Company or any of its affiliates shall not be counted in determining whether such consent or approval was given by the Holders of such required percentage or amount; and provided, further, that if the Company shall issue any additional Securities under the Indenture prior to consummation of the Exchange Offer or, if applicable, the effectiveness of any Shelf Registration Statement, such additional Securities and the Registrable Securities to which this Agreement relates shall be treated together as one class for purposes of determining whether the consent or approval of Holders of a specified percentage of Registrable Securities has been obtained.
     “Participating Broker-Dealers” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4(a) hereof.
     “Person” includes any individual, company, corporation, firm, partnership, joint venture, undertaking, association, organization, trust, state or agency of a state (in each case, whether or not having separate legal personality).

2


 

     “Prospectus” shall mean the prospectus included in, or, pursuant to the rules and regulations of the Securities Act, deemed a part of, a Registration Statement, including any preliminary prospectus, and any such prospectus as amended or supplemented by any prospectus supplement, including a prospectus supplement with respect to the terms of the offering of any portion of the Registrable Securities covered by a Shelf Registration Statement, and by all other amendments and supplements to such prospectus, and in each case including any document incorporated by reference therein.
     “Purchase Agreement” shall have the meaning set forth in the preamble.
     “Registrable Securities” shall mean the Securities; provided that the Securities shall cease to be Registrable Securities (i) when a Registration Statement with respect to such Securities has become effective under the Securities Act and such Securities have been exchanged or disposed of pursuant to such Registration Statement, (ii) when such Securities cease to be outstanding or (iii) after a period of two years from the date of this Agreement.
     “Registration Expenses” shall mean any and all expenses incident to performance of or compliance by the Company with this Agreement, including without limitation: (i) all SEC, stock exchange or FINRA registration and filing fees, (ii) all fees and expenses incurred in connection with compliance with state securities or blue sky laws (including reasonable and documented fees and disbursements of one counsel for any Underwriters or Holders in connection with blue sky qualification of any Exchange Securities or Registrable Securities), (iii) all expenses of any Persons in preparing or assisting in preparing, word processing, printing and distributing any Registration Statement, any Prospectus, any Free Writing Prospectus and any amendments or supplements thereto, any underwriting agreements, securities sales agreements or other similar agreements and any other documents relating to the performance of and compliance with this Agreement, provided that such Persons have been appointed by the Company or with the prior approval of the Company, (iv) all rating agency fees, (v) all fees and disbursements relating to the qualification of the Indenture under applicable securities laws, (vi) the reasonable and documented fees and disbursements of the Trustee and its counsel in accordance with the terms of the Indenture, (vii) the reasonable and documented fees and disbursements of counsel for the Company and, in the case of a Shelf Registration Statement, the reasonable and documented fees and disbursements of one counsel for the Holders (which counsel shall be selected by the Holders of a majority of the principal amount of the Registrable Securities to be covered by the Shelf Registration Statement and which counsel may also be counsel for the Initial Purchasers) and (viii) the fees and disbursements of the independent public accountants of the Company including the expenses of any special audits or “comfort” letters required by or incident to the performance of and compliance with this Agreement, but excluding fees and expenses of counsel to the Underwriters (other than fees and expenses set forth in clause (ii) above) or the Holders and underwriting discounts and commissions, brokerage commissions and transfer taxes, if any, relating to the sale or disposition of Registrable Securities by a Holder.
     “Registration Statement” shall mean any registration statement of the Company that covers any of the Exchange Securities or Registrable Securities pursuant to the provisions of this Agreement and all amendments and supplements to any such registration statement, including post-effective amendments, in each case including the Prospectus contained therein or deemed a part thereof, all exhibits thereto and any document incorporated by reference therein.
     “SEC” shall mean the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.

3


 

     “Securities” shall have the meaning set forth in the Preamble.
     “Securities Act” shall mean the Securities Act of 1933, as amended from time to time.
     “Shelf Effectiveness Period” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2(b) hereof.
     “Shelf Registration” shall mean a registration effected pursuant to Section 2(b) hereof.
     “Shelf Registration Statement” shall mean a “shelf” registration statement of the Company that covers all or a portion of the Registrable Securities (but no other securities unless approved by the Holders of a majority of the principal amount of the Registrable Securities to be covered by such Shelf Registration Statement) on an appropriate form under Rule 415 under the Securities Act, or any similar rule that may be adopted by the SEC, and all amendments and supplements to such registration statement, including post-effective amendments, in each case including the Prospectus contained therein or deemed a part thereof, all exhibits thereto and any document incorporated by reference therein.
     “Staff” shall mean the staff of the SEC.
     “Trust Indenture Act” shall mean the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended from time to time.
     “Trustee” shall mean the trustee with respect to the Securities under the Indenture.
     “Underwriter” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 3(e) hereof.
     “Underwritten Offering” shall mean an offering in which Registrable Securities are sold to an Underwriter for reoffering to the public.
     2. Registration Under the Securities Act. (a) To the extent not prohibited by any applicable law or applicable interpretations of the Staff, the Company shall (x) cause to be filed within 120 days after the date hereof an Exchange Offer Registration Statement covering an offer to the Holders to exchange all the Registrable Securities for Exchange Securities and (y) use its reasonable best efforts to cause such Registration Statement to be declared effective within 210 days after the date hereof. The Company shall commence the Exchange Offer promptly after the Exchange Offer Registration Statement is declared effective by the SEC and use their reasonable best efforts to complete the Exchange Offer not later than 270 days after the date hereof.
     The Company shall commence the Exchange Offer by mailing the related Prospectus, appropriate letters of transmittal and other accompanying documents to each Holder stating, in addition to such other disclosures as are required by applicable law, substantially the following:
(i)   that the Exchange Offer is being made pursuant to this Agreement and that all Registrable Securities validly tendered and not properly withdrawn will be accepted for exchange;
 
(ii)   the date of acceptance for exchange (which shall be a period of at least 20 business days (as defined in Rule 14d-1 under the Exchange Act) from the date such notice is mailed) (the “Exchange Date”);

4


 

(iii)   that any Registrable Security not tendered will remain outstanding and continue to accrue interest but will not retain any rights under this Agreement, except as otherwise specified herein;
 
(iv)   that any Holder electing to have a Registrable Security exchanged pursuant to the Exchange Offer will be required to (A) surrender such Registrable Security, together with the appropriate letters of transmittal, to the institution and at the address and in the manner specified in the notice, or (B) effect such exchange otherwise in compliance with the applicable procedures of the depositary for such Registrable Security, in each case prior to the close of business on the Exchange Date; and
 
(v)   that any Holder will be entitled to withdraw its election, not later than the close of business on the Exchange Date, by (A) sending to the institution and at the address specified in the notice, a telex, facsimile transmission or letter setting forth the name of such Holder, the principal amount of Registrable Securities delivered for exchange and a statement that such Holder is withdrawing its election to have such Securities exchanged or (B) effecting such withdrawal in compliance with the applicable procedures of the depositary for the Registrable Securities.
     As a condition to participating in the Exchange Offer, a Holder will be required to represent to the Company that (i) any Exchange Securities to be received by it will be acquired in the ordinary course of its business, (ii) at the time of the Exchange Offer it has no arrangement or understanding with any Person to participate in, is not engaged in and does not intend to engage in, the distribution (within the meaning of the Securities Act) of the Exchange Securities in violation of the provisions of the Securities Act, (iii) it is not an “affiliate” (within the meaning of Rule 405 under the Securities Act) of the Company and (iv) if such Holder is a broker-dealer that will receive Exchange Securities for its own account in exchange for Registrable Securities that were acquired as a result of market-making or other trading activities, then such Holder will deliver a Prospectus (or, to the extent permitted by law, make available a Prospectus to purchasers) in connection with any resale of such Exchange Securities.
     As soon as practicable after the Exchange Date, the Company shall:
(i)   accept for exchange Registrable Securities or portions thereof validly tendered and not properly withdrawn pursuant to the Exchange Offer; and
 
(ii)   deliver, or cause to be delivered, to the Trustee for cancellation all Registrable Securities or portions thereof so accepted for exchange by the Company and issue, and cause the Trustee to promptly authenticate and deliver to each Holder, Exchange Securities equal in principal amount to the principal amount of the Registrable Securities tendered by such Holder.
     The Company shall use its reasonable best efforts to complete the Exchange Offer as provided above and shall comply in all material respects with the applicable requirements of the Securities Act, the Exchange Act and other applicable laws and regulations in connection with the Exchange Offer. The Exchange Offer shall not be subject to any conditions, other than that the Exchange Offer does not violate any applicable law or applicable interpretations of the Staff.
     (b) In the event that (i) the Company determines that the Exchange Offer Registration provided for in Section 2(a) above is not available or may not be completed as soon

5


 

as practicable after the Exchange Date because it would violate any applicable law or applicable interpretations of the Staff, (ii) the Exchange Offer is not for any other reason completed by March 23, 2009, (iii) in the case of any Holder that participates in the Exchange Offer in accordance with the terms thereof, such holder does not receive Exchange Securities on the date of the exchange that may be sold without restriction under state and federal securities laws (other than due solely to the status of such Holder as an affiliate of the Company within the meaning of the Securities Act or as a broker-dealer) or (iv) the Company so elects, the Company shall (1) promptly deliver to the Holders written notice thereof and (2) at the Company’s sole expense, (a) file, as promptly as practicable (but in no event more than 45 days after so required hereby, such 45th day, the “Shelf Filing Date”), a Shelf Registration Statement providing for the sale of all the Registrable Securities by the Holders thereof and (b) use the Company’s reasonable best efforts to cause the Shelf Registration Statement to be declared effective under the Securities Act.
     The Company agrees to use its reasonable best efforts to keep the Shelf Registration Statement continuously effective until the expiration of the period ending two years from the date of this Agreement with respect to the Registrable Securities or such shorter period that will terminate when all the Registrable Securities covered by the Shelf Registration Statement have been sold pursuant to the Shelf Registration Statement (the “Shelf Effectiveness Period”). The Company further agrees to supplement or amend the Shelf Registration Statement, the related Prospectus and any Free Writing Prospectus if required by the rules, regulations or instructions applicable to the registration form used by the Company for such Shelf Registration Statement or by the Securities Act or by any other rules and regulations thereunder or if reasonably requested by a Holder of Registrable Securities with respect to information relating to such Holder, and to use their reasonable best efforts to cause any such amendment to become effective, if required, and such Shelf Registration Statement, Prospectus or Free Writing Prospectus, as the case may be, to become usable as soon as thereafter practicable. The Company agrees to furnish to the Holders of Registrable Securities copies of any such supplement or amendment promptly after its being used or filed with the SEC.
     (c) The Company shall pay all Registration Expenses in connection with any registration pursuant to Section 2(a) or Section 2(b) hereof. Each Holder shall pay all underwriting discounts and commissions, brokerage commissions and transfer taxes, if any, relating to the sale or disposition of such Holder’s Registrable Securities pursuant to the Shelf Registration Statement.
     (d) An Exchange Offer Registration Statement pursuant to Section 2(a) hereof will not be deemed to have become effective unless it has been declared effective by the SEC. A Shelf Registration Statement pursuant to Section 2(b) hereof will not be deemed to have become effective unless it has been declared effective by the SEC or is automatically effective upon filing with the SEC as provided in Rule 462 under the Securities Act.
     If: (i) the Exchange Offer Registration Statement is not filed with the SEC on or prior to September 24, 2008, (ii) the Shelf Registration Statement is not filed with the SEC on or prior to the Shelf Filing Date, (iii) the Exchange Offer Registration Statement is not declared effective on or prior to December 23, 2008 or the Shelf Registration Statement is not declared effective on or prior to the 210th day following the Shelf Filing Date, or (iv) the Exchange Offer is not consummated on or prior to February 21, 2009, (each such event, a “Registration Default”), then a special interest premium (the “Special Interest Premium”) will accrue in respect of the Registrable Securities from and including the next calendar day following each of (a) September 24, 2008 in the case of clause (i) above, (b) the Shelf Filing Date in the case of clause (ii) above,

6


 

(c) such 210-day period in the case of clause (iii) above, and (d) such 270-day period in the case of clause (iv) above, in each case at a rate equal to 0.25% per annum for the first 90 calendar days following the Registration Default and at a rate equal to 0.50% per annum thereafter; provided that at no time shall the rate of Special Interest Premium payable (including Special Interest Premium payable pursuant to the following paragraph) exceed 0.50% per annum. If the Company is required to file a Shelf Registration Statement and the Company requests Holders of the Registrable Securities to provide the information called for hereby for inclusion in the Shelf Registration Statement, the Registrable Securities owned by Holders who do not deliver such information to the Company when required hereby will not be entitled to any such increase in the interest rate for any day after the Shelf Filing Date. Upon (1) the filing of an Exchange Offer Registration Statement after September 24, 2008, (2) the filing of a Shelf Registration Statement after the Shelf Filing Date, (3) the effectiveness of the Exchange Offer Registration Statement or the Shelf Registration Statement after the 210-day period referred to in clause (iii) above or (4) the consummation of the Exchange Offer after the 270-day period referred to in clause (iii) above, the interest rate on the Registrable Securities from the day of such filing, effectiveness or consummation, as the case may be, will be reduced to the original interest rate for the Registrable Securities.
     If a Shelf Registration Statement is declared effective pursuant to the foregoing paragraphs, and if the Company fails to keep such Shelf Registration Statement continuously (x) effective or (y) useable for resales for the period required by the Registration Rights Agreement due to certain circumstances relating to pending corporate developments, public filings with the SEC and similar events, or because the Prospectus related to such Shelf Registration Statement contains an untrue statement of a material fact or omits to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein not misleading, and such failure continues for more than 120 days (whether or not consecutive) in any twelve-month period (the 121st day being referred to as the “Default Day”), then from the Default Day until the earlier of (i) the date that the Shelf Registration Statement is again deemed effective or is usable, (ii) the date that is the second anniversary of the Closing Date, or (iii) the date as of which all of the Registrable Securities are sold pursuant to the Shelf Registration Statement, the Special Interest Premium in respect of the Registrable Securities will accrue at a rate equal to 0.25% per annum for the first 90 calendar days following the Default Day and at a rate equal to 0.50% per annum thereafter; provided that at no time shall the rate of Special Interest Premium payable (including Special Interest Premium payable pursuant to the preceding paragraph) exceed 0.50% per annum.
     If the Company fails to keep the Shelf Registration Statement continuously effective or useable for resales pursuant to the preceding paragraph or the Company fails to keep the Exchange Offer Registration Statement effective in connection with the use of the Prospectus contained in that Registration Statement by Participating Broker-Dealers as contemplated above, it will give the Holders notice to suspend the sale of the Registrable Securities or the Exchange Notes as the case may be and will extend the relevant period referred to above during which it is required to keep effective the Shelf Registration Statement or the period during which Participating Broker-Dealers are entitled to use the Prospectus included in an Exchange Offer Registration Statement in connection with the resale of Exchange Securities by the number of days during the period from and including the date of the giving of such notice to and including the earlier of: (i) the date when Holders will have received copies of the supplemented or amended Prospectus necessary to permit resales of the Registrable Securities or the Exchange Securities, as the case may be, and (ii) the date on which the Company has given notice that the sale of the Registrable Securities or the Exchange Securities, as the case may be, may be resumed.

7


 

     (e) The parties hereto agree that the additional interest provided for in this Section 2 constitutes a reasonable estimate of and is intended to constitute the sole damages that will be suffered by Holders of Registrable Securities by reason of the failure of (i) the Shelf Registration Statement or the Exchange Offer Registration Statement to be filed, (ii) the Shelf Registration Statement to remain effective or (iii) the Exchange Offer Registration Statement to be declared effective and the Registered Exchange Offer to be consummated, in each case to the extent required by this Agreement.
     3. Registration Procedures. (a) In connection with their obligations pursuant to Section 2(a) and Section 2(b) hereof, the Company shall:
     (i) prepare and file with the SEC a Registration Statement on the appropriate form under the Securities Act, which form (x) shall be selected by the Company, (y) shall, in the case of a Shelf Registration, be available for the sale of the Registrable Securities by the Holders thereof and (z) shall comply as to form in all material respects with the requirements of the applicable form and include all financial statements required by the SEC to be filed therewith; and use their reasonable best efforts to cause such Registration Statement to become effective and remain effective for the applicable period in accordance with Section 2 hereof;
     (ii) prepare and file with the SEC such amendments and post-effective amendments to each Registration Statement as may be necessary to keep such Registration Statement effective for the applicable period in accordance with Section 2 hereof and cause each Prospectus to be supplemented by any required prospectus supplement and, as so supplemented, to be filed pursuant to Rule 424 under the Securities Act; and keep each Prospectus current during the period described in Section 4(3) of and Rule 174 under the Securities Act that is applicable to transactions by brokers or dealers with respect to the Registrable Securities or Exchange Securities;
     (iii) to the extent any Free Writing Prospectus is used, file with the SEC any Free Writing Prospectus that is required to be filed by the Company with the SEC in accordance with the Securities Act and retain in accordance with the Securities Act any Free Writing Prospectus not required to be filed;
     (iv) in the case of a Shelf Registration, furnish to each Holder of Registrable Securities, to counsel for the Initial Purchasers, to counsel for such Holders and to each Underwriter of an Underwritten Offering of Registrable Securities, if any, without charge, as many copies of each Prospectus, preliminary prospectus or Free Writing Prospectus, and any amendment or supplement thereto, in each case relating to the Shelf Registration Statement, as such Holder, Underwriter or counsel of such Holder, Underwriter or Initial Purchaser may reasonably request in order to facilitate the sale or other disposition of the Registrable Securities thereunder; and the Company consents to the use of such Prospectus, preliminary prospectus or such Free Writing Prospectus and any amendment or supplement thereto in accordance with applicable law by each of the Holders of Registrable Securities and any such Underwriters in connection with the offering and sale of the Registrable Securities covered by and in the manner described in such Prospectus, preliminary prospectus or such Free Writing Prospectus or any amendment or supplement thereto in accordance with applicable law;
     (v) use its reasonable best efforts to register or qualify the Registrable Securities under all applicable state securities or blue sky laws of such jurisdictions as any Holder of

8


 

Registrable Securities covered by a Registration Statement shall reasonably request in writing by the time the applicable Registration Statement becomes effective; cooperate with such Holders in connection with any filings required to be made with FINRA; and do any and all other acts and things that may be reasonably necessary or advisable to enable each Holder to complete the disposition in each such jurisdiction of the Registrable Securities owned by such Holder; provided that the Company shall not be required to (1) qualify as a foreign corporation or other entity or as a dealer in securities in any such jurisdiction where it would not otherwise be required to so qualify, (2) file any general consent to service of process in any such jurisdiction or (3) subject itself to taxation in any such jurisdiction if it is not so subject;
     (vi) notify counsel for the Initial Purchasers and, in the case of a Shelf Registration, notify each Holder of Registrable Securities and counsel for such Holders promptly and, if requested by any such Holder or counsel, confirm such advice in writing (1) when a Registration Statement has become effective, when any post-effective amendment thereto has been filed and becomes effective, when any Free Writing Prospectus has been filed or any amendment or supplement to the Prospectus or any Free Writing Prospectus has been filed, (2) of any request by the SEC or any state securities authority for amendments and supplements to a Registration Statement, Prospectus or any Free Writing Prospectus or for additional information relating to the Registration Statement after the Registration Statement has become effective, (3) of the issuance by the SEC or any state securities authority of any stop order suspending the effectiveness of a Registration Statement or the initiation of any proceedings for that purpose, including the receipt by the Company of any notice of objection of the SEC to the use of a Shelf Registration Statement or any post-effective amendment thereto pursuant to Rule 401(g)(2) under the Securities Act, (4) if, between the applicable effective date of a Shelf Registration Statement and the closing of any sale of Registrable Securities covered thereby, the representations and warranties of the Company contained in any underwriting agreement, securities sales agreement or other similar agreement, if any, relating to an offering of such Registrable Securities cease to be true and correct in all material respects or if the Company receives any notification with respect to the suspension of the qualification of the Registrable Securities for sale in any jurisdiction or the initiation of any proceeding for such purpose, (5) of the happening of any event during the period a Registration Statement is effective that makes any statement made in such Registration Statement or the related Prospectus or any Free Writing Prospectus untrue in any material respect or that requires the making of any changes in such Registration Statement or Prospectus or any Free Writing Prospectus in order to make the statements therein not misleading and (6) of any determination by the Company that a post-effective amendment to a Registration Statement or any amendment or supplement to the Prospectus or any Free Writing Prospectus would be appropriate;
     (vii) use its reasonable best efforts to obtain the withdrawal of any order suspending the effectiveness of a Registration Statement or, in the case of a Shelf Registration, the resolution of any objection of the SEC pursuant to Rule 401(g)(2), including by filing an amendment to such Shelf Registration Statement on the proper form, at the earliest possible moment and provide prompt notice to each Holder of the withdrawal of any such order or such resolution;
     (viii) in the case of a Shelf Registration, furnish to each Holder of Registrable Securities upon request, without charge, at least one conformed copy (to be signed by authorized signatories of the Company) of each Registration Statement and any post-effective amendment thereto (without any documents incorporated therein by reference or exhibits thereto, unless requested);

9


 

     (ix) in the case of a Shelf Registration, cooperate with the Holders of Registrable Securities to facilitate the timely preparation and delivery of certificates representing Registrable Securities to be sold and not bearing any restrictive legends and enable such Registrable Securities to be issued in such denominations and registered in such names (consistent with the provisions of the Indenture) as such Holders may reasonably request at least one Business Day prior to the closing of any sale of Registrable Securities;
     (x) in the case of a Shelf Registration, upon the occurrence of any event contemplated by Section 3(a)(vi)(5) hereof, use its reasonable best efforts to prepare and file with the SEC a supplement or post-effective amendment to such Shelf Registration Statement or the related Prospectus or any Free Writing Prospectus or any document incorporated therein by reference or file any other required document so that, as thereafter delivered (or, to the extent permitted by law, made available) to purchasers of the Registrable Securities, such Prospectus or Free Writing Prospectus, as the case may be, will not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading; and the Company shall notify the Holders of Registrable Securities to suspend use of the Prospectus or any Free Writing Prospectus as promptly as practicable after the occurrence of such an event, and such Holders hereby agree to suspend use of the Prospectus or any Free Writing Prospectus, as the case may be, until the Company has amended or supplemented the Prospectus or the Free Writing Prospectus, as the case may be, to correct such misstatement or omission;
     (xi) a reasonable time prior to the filing of any Registration Statement, any Prospectus, any Free Writing Prospectus, any amendment to a Registration Statement or amendment or supplement to a Prospectus or a Free Writing Prospectus after initial filing of a Registration Statement, provide copies of such document to the Initial Purchasers and their counsel and make such of the representatives of the Company as shall be reasonably requested by the Initial Purchasers or their counsel available for discussion of such document; and the Company shall not, at any time after initial filing of a Registration Statement, use or file any Prospectus, any Free Writing Prospectus, any amendment of or supplement to a Registration Statement, a Prospectus or a Free Writing Prospectus of which the Initial Purchasers and their counsel shall not have previously been advised and furnished a copy or to which the Initial Purchasers or their counsel shall reasonably object;
     (xii) obtain a CUSIP number for all Exchange Securities or Registrable Securities, as the case may be, not later than the initial effective date of a Registration Statement;
     (xiii) cause the Indenture to be qualified under the Trust Indenture Act in connection with the registration of the Exchange Securities or Registrable Securities, as the case may be; cooperate with the Trustee and the Holders to effect such changes to the Indenture as may be required for the Indenture to be so qualified in accordance with the terms of the Trust Indenture Act; and execute, and use their reasonable best efforts to cause the Trustee to execute, all documents as may be required to effect such changes and all other forms and documents required to be filed with the SEC to enable the Indenture to be so qualified in a timely manner;
     (xiv) in the case of a Shelf Registration, make available for inspection by any Underwriter participating in any disposition pursuant to such Shelf Registration Statement, any attorneys and accountants designated by Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Registrable Securities to be included in such Shelf Registration and any attorneys and accountants designated by such Underwriter, at reasonable times and in a reasonable manner, all

10


 

pertinent financial and other records, documents and properties of the Company and its subsidiaries, and cause the respective officers, directors and employees of the Company to supply all information reasonably requested by any such Underwriter, attorney or accountant in connection with a Shelf Registration Statement; in each case, as shall be reasonably necessary to enable such persons to conduct a reasonable investigation within the meaning of Section 11 of the Securities Act; provided that if any such information is identified by the Company as being confidential or proprietary, each Person receiving such information shall take such actions as are reasonably necessary to protect the confidentiality of such information to the extent such action is otherwise not inconsistent with, an impairment of or in derogation of the rights and interests of any Holder or Underwriter hereunder (which actions shall include the execution of a confidentiality agreement with the Company); provided, further, that the foregoing inspection and information gathering shall be coordinated on behalf of the Holders by one counsel designated by and on behalf of such other parties as described in the definition of Registration Expenses;
     (xv) if reasonably requested by any Holder of Registrable Securities covered by a Shelf Registration Statement, promptly include in a Prospectus supplement or post-effective amendment such information with respect to such Holder as such Holder reasonably requests to be included therein and make all required filings of such Prospectus supplement or such post-effective amendment reasonably promptly thereafter; and
     (xvi) in the case of a Shelf Registration, enter into such necessary agreements and take all such other actions in connection therewith (including those reasonably requested by the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Registrable Securities covered by the Shelf Registration Statement) in order to expedite or facilitate the disposition of such Registrable Securities including, but not limited to, an Underwritten Offering and in such connection, (1) to the extent possible, make such representations and warranties to the Holders and any Underwriters of such Registrable Securities with respect to the business of the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole, and the Registration Statement, Prospectus, any Free Writing Prospectus and documents incorporated by reference or deemed incorporated by reference, if any, in each case, in form, substance and scope as are customarily made by issuers to underwriters in underwritten offerings and confirm the same if and when requested, (2) obtain opinions of counsel to the Company (which counsel and opinions, in form, scope and substance, shall be reasonably satisfactory to the Holders and such Underwriters and their respective counsel) addressed to each selling Holder and Underwriter of Registrable Securities, covering the matters customarily covered in opinions requested in underwritten offerings, (3) obtain “comfort” letters from the independent certified public accountants of the Company (and, if necessary, any other certified public accountant of any subsidiary of the Company or of any business acquired by the Company for which financial statements and financial data are or are required to be included in the Registration Statement) addressed to each selling Holder (to the extent permitted by applicable professional standards) and Underwriter of Registrable Securities, such letters to be in customary form and covering matters of the type customarily covered in “comfort” letters in connection with underwritten offerings, including but not limited to financial information contained in any preliminary prospectus, Prospectus or Free Writing Prospectus and (4) deliver such documents and certificates as may be reasonably requested by the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Registrable Securities being sold or the Underwriters, and which are customarily delivered in underwritten offerings, to evidence the continued validity of the representations and warranties of the Company made pursuant to clause (1) above and to evidence compliance with any customary conditions contained in an underwriting agreement.

11


 

     (b) In the case of a Shelf Registration Statement, the Company may require each Holder of Registrable Securities to furnish to the Company such information regarding such Holder and the proposed disposition by such Holder of such Registrable Securities as the Company may from time to time reasonably request in writing and may impose reasonable deadlines in connection with the furnishing of such information, which deadlines shall (if reasonable) be binding on such Holders.
     (c) In the case of a Shelf Registration Statement, each Holder of Registrable Securities covered in such Shelf Registration Statement agrees that, upon receipt of any notice from the Company of the happening of any event of the kind described in Section 3(a)(vi)(3) or 3(a)(vi)(5) hereof, such Holder will forthwith discontinue disposition of Registrable Securities pursuant to the Shelf Registration Statement until such Holder’s receipt of the copies of the supplemented or amended Prospectus and any Free Writing Prospectus contemplated by Section 3(a)(x) hereof and, if so directed by the Company such Holder will deliver to the Company all copies in its possession, other than permanent file copies then in such Holder’s possession, of the Prospectus and any Free Writing Prospectus covering such Registrable Securities that is current at the time of receipt of such notice.
     (d) If the Company shall give any notice to suspend the disposition of Registrable Securities pursuant to a Registration Statement, the Company shall extend the period during which such Registration Statement shall be maintained effective pursuant to this Agreement by the number of days during the period from and including the date of the giving of such notice to and including the date when the Holders of such Registrable Securities shall have received copies of the supplemented or amended Prospectus or any Free Writing Prospectus necessary to resume such dispositions. The Company may give any such notice only four times during any 365-day period and any such suspensions shall not exceed an aggregate of 120 days during any 365-day period.
     (e) The Holders of Registrable Securities covered by a Shelf Registration Statement who desire to do so may sell such Registrable Securities in an Underwritten Offering. In any such Underwritten Offering, the investment bank or investment banks and manager or managers (each an “Underwriter”) that will administer the offering will be selected by the Holders in consultation with the Company of a majority of the principal amount of the Registrable Securities included in such offering.
     4. Participation of Broker-Dealers in Exchange Offer. (a) Certain broker-dealers may receive Exchange Securities for their own account in the Exchange Offer in exchange for Securities that were acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of market-making or other trading activities (a “Participating Broker-Dealer”) and may be deemed to be an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act and may be required to deliver a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale of such Exchange Securities.
     The Company understands that it is the Staff’s position that if the Prospectus contained in the Exchange Offer Registration Statement includes a plan of distribution containing a statement to the above effect and the means by which Participating Broker-Dealers may resell the Exchange Securities, without naming the Participating Broker-Dealers or specifying the amount of Exchange Securities owned by them, such Prospectus may be delivered by Participating Broker-Dealers (or, to the extent permitted by law, made available to purchasers) to satisfy their prospectus delivery obligation under the Securities Act in connection with resales of Exchange

12


 

Securities for their own accounts, so long as the Prospectus otherwise meets the requirements of the Securities Act.
     (b) In light of the above, and notwithstanding the other provisions of this Agreement, to the extent required by the applicable rules of the SEC and if requested by a Participating Broker-Dealer, the Company agrees to amend or supplement the Prospectus contained in the Exchange Offer Registration Statement for a period of not less than 45 days after the Exchange Date (as such period may be extended pursuant to Section 3(d) of this Agreement), in order to expedite or facilitate the disposition of any Exchange Securities by Participating Broker-Dealers consistent with the positions of the Staff recited in Section 4(a) above. The Company further agrees that Participating Broker-Dealers shall be authorized to deliver such Prospectus (or, to the extent permitted by law, make available) during such period in connection with the resales contemplated by this Section 4.
     5. Indemnification and Contribution. (a) The Company agrees to indemnify and hold harmless each Initial Purchaser and each Holder, their respective affiliates, directors and officers and each Person, if any, who controls any Initial Purchaser or any Holder within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act or Section 20 of the Exchange Act, from and against any and all duly documented losses, claims, damages and liabilities (including, without limitation, legal fees and other reasonable expenses incurred in connection with any suit, action or proceeding or any claim asserted, as such fees and expenses are incurred), joint or several, that arise out of, or are based upon, (1) any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any Registration Statement or any omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein not misleading, or (2) any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any Prospectus, any Free Writing Prospectus or any “issuer information” (“Issuer Information”) filed or required to be filed pursuant to Rule 433(d) under the Securities Act, or any omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading, in each case except insofar as such losses, claims, damages or liabilities arise out of, or are based upon, any untrue statement or omission or alleged untrue statement or omission made in reliance upon and in conformity with any information relating to any Initial Purchaser or information relating to any Holder furnished to the Company in writing through any Initial Purchaser or any selling Holder, respectively, expressly for use therein. In connection with any Underwritten Offering permitted by Section 3, the Company will also indemnify the Underwriters, if any, participating in the distribution, their respective affiliates and each Person who controls such Persons (within the meaning of the Securities Act and the Exchange Act) to the same extent as provided above with respect to the indemnification of the Holders, if requested in connection with any Registration Statement, any Prospectus, any Free Writing Prospectus or any Issuer Information.
     (b) Each Holder agrees, severally and not jointly, to indemnify and hold harmless the Company, the Initial Purchasers and the other selling Holders, the directors of the Company, each officer of the Company who signed the Registration Statement and each Person, if any, who controls the Company, any Initial Purchaser and any other selling Holder within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act or Section 20 of the Exchange Act to the same extent as the indemnity set forth in paragraph (a) above, but only with respect to any duly documented losses, claims, damages or liabilities that arise out of, or are based upon, any untrue statement or omission or alleged untrue statement or omission made in reliance upon and in conformity with

13


 

any information relating to such Holder furnished to the Company in writing by such Holder expressly for use in any Registration Statement, any Prospectus and any Free Writing Prospectus.
     (c) If any suit, action, proceeding (including any governmental or regulatory investigation), claim or demand shall be brought or asserted against any Person in respect of which indemnification may be sought pursuant to either paragraph (a) or (b) above, such Person (the “Indemnified Person”) shall promptly notify the Person against whom such indemnification may be sought (the “Indemnifying Person”) in writing; provided that the failure to notify the Indemnifying Person shall not relieve it from any liability that it may have under this Section 5 except to the extent that it has been materially prejudiced (through the forfeiture of substantive rights or defenses) by such failure; and provided, further, that the failure to notify the Indemnifying Person shall not relieve it from any liability that it may have to an Indemnified Person otherwise than under this Section 5. If any such proceeding shall be brought or asserted against an Indemnified Person and it shall have notified the Indemnifying Person thereof, the Indemnifying Person shall retain counsel reasonably satisfactory to the Indemnified Person to represent the Indemnified Person and any others entitled to indemnification pursuant to this Section 5 in such proceeding that the Indemnifying Person may designate and shall pay the fees and expenses of such proceeding and shall pay the fees and expenses of such counsel related to such proceeding, as incurred. In any such proceeding, any Indemnified Person shall have the right to retain its own counsel, but the fees and reasonable and documented expenses of such counsel shall be at the expense of such Indemnified Person unless (i) the Indemnifying Person and the Indemnified Person shall have mutually agreed to the contrary; (ii) the Indemnifying Person has failed within a reasonable time to retain counsel reasonably satisfactory to the Indemnified Person; (iii) the Indemnified Person shall have reasonably concluded that there may be legal defenses available to it that are different from or in addition to those available to the Indemnifying Person; or (iv) the named parties in any such proceeding (including any impleaded parties) include both the Indemnifying Person and the Indemnified Person and representation of both parties by the same counsel would be inappropriate due to actual or potential differing interests between them. It is understood and agreed that the Indemnifying Person shall not, in connection with any proceeding or related proceeding in the same jurisdiction, be liable for the fees and expenses of more than one separate firm (in addition to any local counsel) for all Indemnified Persons, and that all such fees and expenses shall be reimbursed as they are incurred. Any such separate firm (x) for any Initial Purchaser, its affiliates, directors and officers and any control Persons of such Initial Purchaser shall be designated in writing by the Initial Purchasers, (y) for any Holder, its directors and officers and any control Persons of such Holder shall be designated in writing by the Majority Holders and (z) in all other cases shall be designated in writing by the Company. The Indemnifying Person shall not be liable for any settlement of any proceeding effected without its written consent, but if settled with such consent or if there be a final judgment for the plaintiff, the Indemnifying Person agrees to indemnify each Indemnified Person from and against any loss or liability by reason of such settlement or judgment. Notwithstanding the foregoing sentence, if at any time an Indemnified Person shall have requested that an Indemnifying Person reimburse the Indemnified Person for fees and expenses of counsel as contemplated by this paragraph, the Indemnifying Person shall be liable for any settlement of any proceeding effected without its written consent if (i) such settlement is entered into more than 90 days after receipt by the Indemnifying Person of such request and (ii) (A) the Indemnifying Person shall not have reimbursed the Indemnified Person in accordance with such request prior to the date of such settlement or (B) the Indemnifying Person shall not have, on or before the 90th day after the receipt by the Indemnifying Person of such request, disputed in good faith that the fees and expenses claimed by the Indemnified Party are payable by the Indemnifying Person hereunder. No Indemnifying Person shall, without the written consent of the Indemnified Person, effect any

14


 

settlement of any pending or threatened proceeding in respect of which any Indemnified Person is or was threatened to be made a party and indemnification could have been sought hereunder by such Indemnified Person, unless such settlement (A) includes an unconditional release of such Indemnified Person, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to such Indemnified Person, from all liability on claims that are the subject matter of such proceeding and (B) does not include any statement as to or any admission of fault, culpability or a failure to act by or on behalf of any Indemnified Person.
     (d) If the indemnification provided for in paragraphs (a) and (b) above is unavailable to an Indemnified Person or insufficient in respect of any losses, claims, damages or liabilities referred to therein, then each Indemnifying Person under such paragraph, in lieu of indemnifying such Indemnified Person thereunder, shall contribute to the amount paid or payable by such Indemnified Person as a result of such losses, claims, damages or liabilities (i) in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect the relative benefits received by the Company from the offering of the Securities and the Exchange Securities, on the one hand, and by the Holders from receiving Securities or Exchange Securities registered under the Securities Act, on the other hand, or (ii) if the allocation provided by clause (i) is not permitted by applicable law, in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect not only the relative benefits referred to in clause (i) but also the relative fault of the Company on the one hand and the Holders on the other in connection with the statements or omissions that resulted in such losses, claims, damages or liabilities, as well as any other relevant equitable considerations. The relative fault of the Company on the one hand and the Holders on the other shall be determined by reference to, among other things, whether the untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact or the omission or alleged omission to state a material fact relates to information supplied by the Company or by the Holders and the parties’ relative intent, knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent such statement or omission.
     (e) The Company and the Holders agree that it would not be just and equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 5 were determined by pro rata allocation (even if the Holders were treated as one entity for such purpose) or by any other method of allocation that does not take account of the equitable considerations referred to in paragraph (d) above. The amount paid or payable by an Indemnified Person as a result of the losses, claims, damages and liabilities referred to in paragraph (d) above shall be deemed to include, subject to the limitations set forth above, any legal or other expenses incurred by such Indemnified Person in connection with any such action or claim. Notwithstanding the provisions of this Section 5, in no event shall a Holder be required to contribute any amount in excess of the amount by which the total price at which the Securities or Exchange Securities sold by such Holder exceeds the amount of any damages that such Holder has otherwise been required to pay by reason of such untrue or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission. No Person guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Securities Act) shall be entitled to contribution from any Person who was not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation. The Holders’ obligations to contribute pursuant to this Section (5) are several and not joint.
     (f) The remedies provided for in this Section 5 are not exclusive and shall not limit any rights or remedies that may otherwise be available to any Indemnified Person at law or in equity.
     (g) The indemnity and contribution provisions contained in this Section 5 shall remain operative and in full force and effect regardless of (i) any termination of this Agreement, (ii) any investigation made by or on behalf of the Initial Purchasers or any Holder or any Person

15


 

controlling any Initial Purchaser or any Holder, or by or on behalf of the Company or the officers or directors of or any Person controlling the Company, (iii) acceptance of any of the Exchange Securities and (iv) any sale of Registrable Securities pursuant to a Shelf Registration Statement.
     6. General.
     (a) No Inconsistent Agreements. The Company represents, warrants and agrees that (i) the rights granted to the Holders hereunder do not in any way conflict with and are not inconsistent with the rights granted to the holders of any other outstanding securities issued or guaranteed by the Company under any other agreement and (ii) the Company has not entered into, or on or after the date of this Agreement will not enter into, any agreement that is inconsistent with the rights granted to the Holders of Registrable Securities in this Agreement or otherwise conflicts with the provisions hereof.
     (b) Amendments and Waivers. The provisions of this Agreement, including the provisions of this sentence, may not be amended, modified or supplemented, and waivers or consents to departures from the provisions hereof may not be given unless the Company has obtained the written consent of Holders of at least a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Registrable Securities affected by such amendment, modification, supplement, waiver or consent; provided that no amendment, modification, supplement, waiver or consent to any departure from the provisions of Section 5 hereof shall be effective as against any Holder of Registrable Securities unless consented to in writing by such Holder. Any amendments, modifications, supplements, waivers or consents pursuant to this Section 6(b) shall be by a writing executed by each of the parties hereto.
     (c) Notices. All notices and other communications provided for or permitted hereunder shall be made in writing by hand-delivery, registered first-class mail, telecopier, or any courier guaranteeing overnight delivery (i) if to a Holder, at the most current address given by such Holder to the Company by means of a notice given in accordance with the provisions of this Section 6(c), which address initially is, with respect to the Initial Purchasers, the address set forth in the Purchase Agreement; (ii) if to the Company initially at the Company’s address set forth in the Purchase Agreement and thereafter at such other address, notice of which is given in accordance with the provisions of this Section (6)(c); and (iii) to such other persons at their respective addresses as provided in the Purchase Agreement and thereafter at such other address, notice of which is given in accordance with the provisions of this Section 6(c). All such notices and communications shall be deemed to have been duly given: at the time delivered by hand, if personally delivered; five Business Days after being deposited in the mail, postage prepaid, if mailed; when answered back, if telexed; when receipt is acknowledged, if telecopied; and on the next Business Day if timely delivered to an air courier guaranteeing overnight delivery. Copies of all such notices, demands or other communications shall be concurrently delivered by the Person giving the same to the Trustee, at the address specified in the Indenture.
     (d) Successors and Assigns. This Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and be binding upon the successors, assigns and transferees of each of the parties, including, without limitation and without the need for an express assignment, subsequent Holders; provided that nothing herein shall be deemed to permit any assignment, transfer or other disposition of Registrable Securities in violation of the terms of the Purchase Agreement or the Indenture. If any transferee of any Holder shall acquire Registrable Securities in any manner, whether by operation of law or otherwise, such Registrable Securities shall be held subject to all the terms of this Agreement, and by taking and holding such Registrable Securities such Person shall be

16


 

conclusively deemed to have agreed to be bound by and to perform all of the terms and provisions of this Agreement and such Person shall be entitled to receive the benefits hereof. The Initial Purchasers (in their capacity as Initial Purchasers) shall have no liability or obligation to the Company with respect to any failure by a Holder to comply with, or any breach by any Holder of, any of the obligations of such Holder under this Agreement.
     (e) Third Party Beneficiaries. Each Holder shall be a third party beneficiary to the agreements made hereunder between the Company on the one hand, and the Initial Purchasers, on the other hand, and shall have the right to enforce such agreements directly to the extent it deems such enforcement necessary or advisable to protect its rights or the rights of other Holders hereunder.
     (f) Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original and all of which taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.
     (g) Headings. The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of reference only, are not a part of this Agreement and shall not limit or otherwise affect the meaning hereof.
     (h) Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York.
     (i) Entire Agreement; Severability. This Agreement contains the entire agreement between the parties relating to the subject matter hereof and supersedes all oral statements and prior writings with respect thereto. If any term, provision, covenant or restriction contained in this Agreement is held by a court of competent jurisdiction to be invalid, void or unenforceable or against public policy, the remainder of the terms, provisions, covenants and restrictions contained herein shall remain in full force and effect and shall in no way be affected, impaired or invalidated. The Company and the Initial Purchasers shall endeavor in good faith negotiations to replace the invalid, void or unenforceable provisions with valid provisions the economic effect of which comes as close as possible to that of the invalid, void or unenforceable provisions.

17


 

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Agreement as of the date first written above.
         
    ARCELORMITTAL
 
       
 
  By:      /s/ E.S. de Vries
 
       
 
      Name: E.S. de Vries
 
      Title:
 
       
 
  By:      /s/ Armand Gobber
 
       
 
      Name: Armand Gobber
 
      Title:

18


 

Confirmed and accepted as of the date first above written:
GOLDMAN, SACHS & CO.
         
By:
    /s/ Goldman Sachs & Co.    
 
 
 
     Authorized Signatory
   
 
       
J.P. MORGAN SECURITIES INC.    
 
       
By:
    /s/ Maria Sramek    
 
       
 
       Name: Maria Sramek    
 
       Title: Executive Director    
 
       
HSBC SECURITIES (USA) INC.    
 
       
By:
    /s/ Maureen K. Sweeny    
 
       
 
       Authorized Signatory    
 
       Maureen K. Sweeny    
 
       Vice President    
 
       
BNP PARIBAS SECURITIES CORP.    
 
       
By:
    /s/ Hugo Sueiro    
 
       
 
       Authorized Signatory    
 
       Hugo Sueiro    
 
       Authorized Signatory    

19

EX-5.1 5 u01974exv5w1.htm EX-5.1: OPINION OF CLEARY GOTTLIEB STEEN & HAMILTON LLP EX-5.1
Exhibit 5.1
September 22, 2008
ArcelorMittal
19, avenue de la Liberté
L-2930 Luxembourg
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
Ladies and Gentlemen:
          We have acted as United States counsel to ArcelorMittal, a société anonyme organized under the laws of Luxembourg (the “Company”), in connection with the Company’s filing of a registration statement on Form F-4 (the “Registration Statement”) filed today with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “Commission”) pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”) in respect of up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 principal amount of its 5.375% Notes due 2013 (the “2013 Exchange Notes”) and up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 principal amount of its 6.125% Notes due 2018 (the “2018 Exchange Notes” and, together with the 2013 Exchange Notes, the “Exchange Notes”) to be offered in exchange for, respectively, up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 principal amount of its 5.375% Notes due 2013 (the “Original 2013 Notes”) and up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 principal amount of its 6.125% Notes due 2018 (the “Original 2018 Notes” and, together with the Original 2013 Notes, the “Original Notes”). The Exchange Notes will be issued under the indenture dated as of May 27, 2008 (the “Indenture”), between the Company and HSBC Bank USA, National Association, as trustee (the “Trustee”).
          In arriving at the opinions expressed below, we have reviewed the following documents:
  (a)   the Registration Statement;
 
  (b)   the forms of the Exchange Notes included in Exhibit 4.2 to the Registration Statement; and

 


 

ArcelorMittal, p.2
          (c) an executed copy of the Indenture.
In addition, we have reviewed the originals or copies certified or otherwise identified to our satisfaction of all such corporate records of the Company and such other instruments and other certificates of public officials, officers and representatives of the Company and such other persons, and we have made such investigations of law, as we have deemed appropriate as a basis for the opinions expressed below.
          In rendering the opinions expressed below, we have assumed the authenticity of all documents submitted to us as originals and the conformity to the originals of all documents submitted to us as copies. In addition, we have assumed and have not verified (i) the accuracy as to factual matters of each document we have reviewed, and (ii) that the Exchange Notes will conform to the forms thereof that we have reviewed and will be duly authenticated in accordance with the terms of the Indenture.
          Based on the foregoing, and subject to the further assumptions and qualifications set forth below, it is our opinion that when the Exchange Notes, in the forms included in Exhibit 4.2 to the Registration Statement, have been duly executed and authenticated in accordance with the Indenture, and duly issued and delivered by the Company in exchange for an equal principal amount of Original Notes, the Exchange Notes will be the valid, binding and enforceable obligations of the Company, entitled to the benefits of the Indenture.
          Insofar as the foregoing opinions relate to the validity, binding effect or enforceability of any agreement or obligation of the Company, (a) we have assumed that the Company and each other party to such agreement or obligation has satisfied those legal requirements that are applicable to it to the extent necessary to make such agreement or obligation enforceable against it (except that no such assumption is made as to the Company regarding matters of the federal law of the United States of America or the law of the State of New York that in our experience normally would be applicable to general business entities with respect to such agreement or obligation), (b) such opinions are subject to applicable bankruptcy, insolvency and similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and to general principles of equity and (c) such opinions are subject to the effect of judicial application of foreign laws or foreign governmental actions affecting creditors’ rights.
          We express no opinion as to the enforceability of Section 12.17 of the Indenture relating to currency indemnity. With respect to the third sentence of Section 12.12 of the Indenture, we express no opinion except as follows: Under the law of the State of New York relating to submission to jurisdiction, the Company, pursuant to the first sentence of Section 12.12 of the Indenture, has validly appointed ArcelorMittal USA Inc. as its initial authorized agent for the purpose described in the third sentence of Section 12.12 of the Indenture.
          In addition, we note that the designation in Section 12.10 of the Indenture of the U.S. federal courts sitting in New York City as the venue for actions or proceedings relating to the Indenture (notwithstanding the waiver in Section 12.10) is subject to the power of such courts to transfer actions pursuant to 28 U.S.C. §1404(a) or to dismiss such actions or proceedings on the grounds that such a federal court is an inconvenient forum for such an action or proceeding.

 


 

ArcelorMittal, p.3
          We note that the enforceability of the waiver of immunities by the Company set forth in Section 12.11 of the Indenture is subject to the limitations imposed by the Foreign Sovereign Immunities Act of 1976.
          The foregoing opinions are limited to the federal law of the United States of America and the law of the State of New York.
          We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion as Exhibit 5.1 to the Registration Statement and to the use of our name in the Registration Statement and the related prospectus under the heading “Validity of the Exchange Notes.” In giving this consent, we do not thereby admit that we are experts with respect to any part of the Registration Statement, including this Exhibit, within the meaning of the term “expert” as used in the Securities Act or the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder. The opinions expressed herein are rendered on and as of the date hereof, and we assume no obligation to advise you or any other person, or to make any investigations, as to any legal developments or factual matters arising subsequent to the date hereof that might affect the opinion expressed herein.
         
  Very truly yours,

CLEARY GOTTLIEB STEEN & HAMILTON LLP
 
 
  By:   /s/ Gamal M. Abouali    
    Gamal M. Abouali, a Partner   
       

 

EX-5.2 6 u01974exv5w2.htm EX-5.2: OPINION OF BONN SCHMITT STEICHEN EX-5.2
Exhibit 5.2
ArcelorMittal
19 Avenue de la Liberté,
L-2930 Luxembourg
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
Luxembourg, September 22, 2008
Ladies and Gentlemen,
  1.   We have acted as your counsel in connection with the filing by ArcelorMittal (the “Company”, a corporation (societé anonyme) incorporated and existing under the laws of the Grand Duchy of Luxembourg (“Luxembourg”) of a registration statement on Form F-4 (the “Registration Statement”) with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “Commission”) in respect of up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 principal amount of its 5.375% Notes due 2013 (the “2013 Exchange Notes”) and up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 principal amount of its 6.125% Notes due 2018 (the “2018 Exchange Notes” and, together with the 2013 Exchange Notes, the “Exchange Notes”) to be offered in exchange for, respectively, up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 principal amount of its 5.375% Notes due 2013 (the “Original 2013 Notes”) and up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 principal amount of its 6.125% Notes due 2018 (the “Original 2018 Notes” and, together with the Original 2013 Notes, the “Original Notes”). The Exchange Notes will be issued under the indenture dated as of May 27, 2008 (the “Indenture”), between the Company and HSBC Bank USA, National Association, as trustee (the “Trustee”). This opinion letter is rendered to you in order to be filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement.
 
  2.   In rendering this opinion we have examined the following documents:
  i.   the articles of association of the Company dated May 15, 2008 (the “Articles”);
 
  ii.   a certificate issued by the Company Secretary together with another authorised representative of the Company certifying, inter alia, that, based on the corporate records of the Company, on February 12, 2008 the board of directors of the Company has authorised an envelope of USD 5 billion (five billion US dollars) or its equivalent in

 


 

      order to raise funds in the debt capital markets, via public and/or private issuances, in various markets: Europe, North America (Canada and US), Brazil and consequently the signature by the Company of any agreements or documents as necessary for the proper implementation of the above mentioned envelope (the “Officers’ Certificate”);

  iii.   a certificate (the “Certificate”) issued by the court of judicial district of Luxembourg (Tribunal d’Arrondissement de et à Luxembourg) on September 22, 2008 stating that the Company is not subject to any of the following procedures: bankruptcy (faillite), insolvency (liquidation judiciaire), moratorium (concordat préventif de faillite), controlled management (gestion contrôlée) or suspension of payments (sursis de paiement);
 
  iv.   an extract (the “Extract”) issued by the Luxembourg Register of Commerce and Companies on September 22, 2008; and
 
  v.   the Registration Statement.
We have also examined the originals or copies, certified or otherwise identified to our satisfaction, of such public and corporate records, certificates, instruments and other documents and have considered such questions of law as we have deemed necessary as a basis for the opinions hereinafter expressed.
We have assumed that all copies of documents that we have reviewed conform to the originals, that all originals are genuine and complete and that each signature is the genuine signature of the individual concerned. In addition, we have assumed and have not verified (i) the accuracy as to factual matters of each document we have reviewed, and (ii) that the Exchange Notes will conform to the forms thereof that we have reviewed and will be duly authenticated in accordance with the terms of the Indenture. We have also assumed that the statements made in the Officers’ Certificate are a true record of the proceedings described in them in duly convened and constituted meetings and the resolutions set out in those minutes and any written resolutions were validly passed and remain in full force and effect without modification.
  3.   Based on the above and subject to the qualifications set forth below, we are of the opinion that
  i.   the Company is duly incorporated in Luxembourg as a public limited liability company (société anonyme) with power to carry on its business and validly in existence under Luxembourg law and its Articles. The Company possesses the capacity (a) to be sued and (b) to sue;
 
  ii.   the Company has all the necessary corporate power and authority to issue and deliver the Exchange Notes and the Company has taken all necessary corporate action, and no other

2


 

      action is required to be taken, to authorise the issuance and delivery of the Exchange Notes.
This opinion is subject to any limitations arising from bankruptcy, insolvency, liquidation, moratorium, reorganisation and other laws of general application relating to or affecting the rights of creditors. Insofar as the foregoing opinions relate to the valid existence and good standing of the Company, they are based solely on the Certificate and the Extract. A search at the Luxembourg Register of Commerce and Companies and/or at the court clerk’s office of the Tribunal d’Arrondissement de et à Luxembourg (sitting in commercial matters) is not capable of conclusively revealing whether or not any bankruptcy (faillite), insolvency (liquidation judiciaire), re-organization, reconstruction or reprieve from payment (sursis de paiement) proceedings on the one hand and dissolution and liquidation proceedings on the other hand have been initiated and the relevant corporate documents (including, but not limited to, the notice of a winding-up order or resolution, notice of the appointment of a receiver, manager, administrator or administrative receiver) may not be held at the Luxembourg Register of Commerce and Companies and/or at the court clerk’s office of the Tribunal d’Arrondissement de et à Luxembourg immediately and there may be a delay in the relevant notice appearing on the files of the relevant party.
  4.   This opinion is confined to matters of Luxembourg law (as defined below). Accordingly, we express no opinion with regard to any system of law other than the laws of Luxembourg as they stand as of the date hereof and as such laws as of the date hereof have been interpreted in published case law of the courts of Luxembourg (“Luxembourg law”).
 
  5.   This opinion speaks as of the date hereof. No obligation is assumed to update this opinion or to inform any person of any changes of law or other matters coming to our knowledge and occurring after the date hereof, which may affect this opinion letter in any respect.
 
  6.   We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to the Registration Statement and further consent to the reference to our firm in the Registration Statement under the captions “Taxation” and “Validity of the Exchange Notes”.
 
  7.   This opinion is strictly limited to the matters stated herein and does not extend to, and is not to be read as extending by implication to, any other matters.

3


 

  8.   This opinion is governed by Luxembourg law and the Luxembourg courts shall have exclusive jurisdiction thereon.
         
  Yours faithfully,

Bonn Schmitt Steichen

 
 
  By:   /s/ Alex Schmitt    
    Alex Schmitt
 
 
       
 
     
  By:   /s/ Pierre-Alexandre Degehet    
    Pierre-Alexandre Degehet   
       
 

4

EX-12 7 u01974exv12.htm EX-12: CALCULATION OF RATIOS OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES EX-12
Ratio Based on IFRS
(Amounts in $ millions except ratios)
         
Exhibit 12
                                         
    Six months ended   Years ended December 31,  
    June 30, 2008   2007     2006*     2005     2004  
Earnings
                                       
Consolidated net income
    8,802     $ 11,850     $ 6,106     $ 3,795     $ 5,625  
Income allocable to minority interest in consolidated entities that incurred fixed charges
    (592     (1,482 )     (859 )     (494 )     (415 )
Consolidated provision for income taxes
    1,529       3,038       1,122       881       967  
Fixed charges less interest capitalized
    985       1,920       1,134       513       267  
 
                             
Subtotal
    10,724       15,326       7,503       4,695       6,444  
Undistributed earnings of less-than-50% owned affiliates
    (21     (19 )     (127 )     (73 )     (165 )
 
                             
Total earnings
    10,703       15,307       7,376       4,622       6,279  
 
                             
Fixed charges
                                       
Interest expensed and capitalized
    946       1,839       1,124       503       259  
Interest portion of rental obligations
    39       81       10       10       8  
 
                             
Total fixed charges
    985       1,920       1,134       513       267  
 
                             
Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges
    10.9 x     8.0 x     6.5 x     9.0 x     23.5 x
 
                             
 
*   A required by IFRS, the 2006 information has been adjusted for the finalization of the allocation of the purchase price of Arcelor (see Note 3 to the ArcelorMittal Consolidated Financial Statements).

 

EX-23.3 8 u01974exv23w3.htm EX-23.3: CONSENT OF DELOITTE S.A. EX-23.3
Exhibit 23.3
CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
We consent to the incorporation by reference in this Registration Statement on Form F-4 of (1) our report dated March 19, 2008 (September 19, 2008 as to Note 24, insomuch as it relates to the change in the composition of reportable segments) related to the 2007 financial statements and the retrospective adjustments to the 2005 and 2006 financial statement disclosures of ArcelorMittal (successor entity of Mittal Steel Company N.V.) (which report expresses an unqualified opinion and includes an explanatory paragraph regarding the change in the composition of reportable segments) as of and for the year ended December 31, 2007 appearing in the Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K of ArcelorMittal dated on or about September 19, 2008, (2) our report dated March 19, 2008 relating to the effectiveness of ArcelorMittal’s internal control over financial reporting appearing in the Annual Report on Form 20-F of ArcelorMittal for the year ended December 31, 2007, and (3) to the reference to us under the heading “Experts” in the Prospectus, which is part of this Registration Statement.
/s/ Deloitte S.A.

Luxembourg, Grand-Duchy of Luxembourg
September 19, 2008

  EX-23.4 9 u01974exv23w4.htm EX-23.4: CONSENT OF DELOITTE ACCOUNTANTS B.V EX-23.4

Exhibit 23.4
CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
We consent to the incorporation by reference in this Registration Statement on Form F-4 of our report dated April 16, 2007 (March 19, 2008 as to note 3 insomuch as it relates to the acquisition of Arcelor) relating to the 2006 consolidated financial statements of ArcelorMittal (successor entity of Mittal Steel Company N.V.) and subsidiaries, incorporated by reference in the Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K of ArcelorMittal dated on or about September 19, 2008, and to the reference to us under the heading “Experts” in the Prospectus, which is part of this Registration Statement.
/s/ Deloitte Accountants B.V.
Rotterdam, The Netherlands
September 19, 2008

  EX-23.5 10 u01974exv23w5.htm EX-23.5: CONSENT OF KPMG AUDIT S.A.R.L. EX-23.5

Exhibit 23.5
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
We consent to the incorporation by reference into this Registration Statement of our report dated April 16, 2007, with respect to the consolidated balance sheet of Arcelor S.A. and subsidiaries (“the Company”) as of December 31, 2006, and the related consolidated income statement, statement of cash flows, and statement of changes in shareholders’ equity for the five months ended December 31, 2006, prepared in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, which report appears in the Report of Foreign Private Issuer on Form 6-K of ArcelorMittal dated on or about September 19, 2008, and to the reference to our firm under the heading “Experts” in this Registration Statement.
Our qualified report dated April 16, 2007 contains an explanatory paragraph that states the following:
IAS 34 requires that interim financial statements be represented with comparative financial information. These consolidated interim financial statements have been prepared solely for the purposes of consolidating the Company into the consolidated financial statements of Mittal Steel Company N.V. (“Mittal Steel”) as of and for the five months ended December 31, 2006. Accordingly, no comparative financial information is presented.
Our report dated April 16, 2007 also contains the following explanatory paragraph:
The consolidated financial statements are based on the historical values of Arcelor S.A.’s assets and liabilities prior to its acquisition by Mittal Steel and, accordingly, do not include the purchase price adjustments to such amounts reflected in the consolidated financial statements of Mittal Steel as a result of such acquisition.
/s/ KPMG Audit S.à r.l.
City of Luxembourg
Luxembourg
September 19, 2008
 
EX-25 11 u01974exv25.htm EX-25: FORM T-1 EX-25
Table of Contents

Exhibit 25
CONFORMED COPY
 
 
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
FORM T-1
STATEMENT OF ELIGIBILITY UNDER THE TRUST
INDENTURE ACT OF 1939 OF A CORPORATION
DESIGNATED TO ACT AS TRUSTEE
CHECK IF AN APPLICATION TO DETERMINE
ELIGIBILITY OF A TRUSTEE PURSUANT TO
SECTION 305(b)(2)
HSBC Bank USA, National Association
(Exact name of trustee as specified in its charter)
     
N/A
  20-1177241
(Jurisdiction of incorporation   (I.R.S. Employer
or organization if not a U.S.
national bank)
  Identification No.)
     
1201 Market Street, Ste 1001    
Wilmington, Delaware   19801
(Address of principal executive offices)   (Zip Code)
Kevin T. O’Brien, SVP
HSBC Bank USA, National Association
452 Fifth Avenue
New York, New York 10018-2706
Tel: (212) 525-1311
(Name, address and telephone number of agent for service)
ArcelorMittal
(Exact name of obligor as specified in its charter)
     
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg   [Not Applicable]
(State or other jurisdiction   (I.R.S. Employer
of incorporation or organization)   Identification No.)
     
19, Avenue de la Liberte    
L-2930 Luxembourg    
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg   [Not Applicable]
(Address of principal executive offices)   (Zip Code)
5.375% Notes due 2013
6.125% Notes due 2018

(Title of Indenture Securities)
 
 

 


TABLE OF CONTENTS

Item 1. General Information
Item 2. Affiliations with Obligor
Items 3-15. Not Applicable
Item 16. List of Exhibits
SIGNATURE


Table of Contents

General
Item 1. General Information.
Furnish the following information as to the trustee:
(a) Name and address of each examining or supervisory
authority to which it is subject.
Comptroller of the Currency, New York, NY.
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, Washington, D.C.
Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System,
Washington, D.C.
(b) Whether it is authorized to exercise corporate trust powers.
                         Yes.
Item 2. Affiliations with Obligor.
If the obligor is an affiliate of the trustee, describe each such affiliation.
                         None
     Items 3-15. Not Applicable

 


Table of Contents

Item 16. List of Exhibits
Exhibit
     
 
   
T1A(i)
(1)  Copy of the Articles of Association of HSBC Bank USA, National Association.
 
   
T1A(ii)
(1)  Certificate of the Comptroller of the Currency dated July 1, 2004 as to the authority of HSBC Bank USA, National Association to commence business.
 
   
T1A(iii)
(2)  Certificate of Fiduciary Powers dated August 18, 2004 for HSBC Bank USA, National Association.
 
   
T1A(iv)
(1)  Copy of the existing By-Laws of HSBC Bank USA, National Association.
 
   
T1A(v)
  Not applicable.
 
   
T1A(vi)
(2)  Consent of HSBC Bank USA, National Association required by Section 321(b) of the Trust Indenture Act of 1939.
 
   
T1A(vii)
  Copy of the latest report of condition of the trustee (June 30, 2008), published pursuant to law or the requirement of its supervisory or examining authority.
 
   
T1A(viii)
  Not applicable.
 
   
T1A(ix)
  Not applicable.
 
(1)   Exhibits previously filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission with Registration No. 333-118523 and incorporated herein by reference thereto.
 
(2)   Exhibits previously filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission with Registration No. 333-125197 and incorporated herein by reference thereto.

 


Table of Contents

SIGNATURE
Pursuant to the requirements of the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, the Trustee, HSBC Bank USA, National Association, a national banking association organized and existing under the laws of the United States of America, has duly caused this statement of eligibility to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, all in the City of New York and State of New York on the 27th day of August, 2008.
         
  HSBC BANK USA, NATIONAL
ASSOCIATION
 
 
  By:   /s/ Anthony A. Bocchino  
    Anthony A. Bocchino  
    Vice President   
 

 


Table of Contents

Exhibit T1A (vii)
       
 
  Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System  
 
  OMB Number: 7100-0036  
 
  Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation  
 
  OMB Number: 3064-0052  
 
  Office of the Comptroller of the Currency  
 
  OMB Number: 1557-0081  
Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council
  Expires March 31, 2009  
 
 
  Please refer to page i,  
 
  Table of Contents, for
the required disclosure
of estimated burden.
1
 
         
Consolidated Reports of Condition and Income for
       
A Bank With Domestic and Foreign Offices—FFIEC 031
       
 
       
Report at the close of business June 30, 2008
    (20040630)
 
(RCRI 9999)
 

This report is required by law; 12 U.S.C. §324 (State member banks); 12 U.S.C. § 1817 (State nonmember banks); and 12 U.S.C. §161 (National banks).
This report form is to be filed by banks with branches and consolidated subsidiaries in U.S. territories and possessions, Edge or Agreement subsidiaries, foreign branches, consolidated foreign subsidiaries, or International Banking Facilities.


NOTE: The Reports of Condition and Income must be signed by an authorized officer and the Report of Condition must be attested to by not less than two directors (trustees) for State nonmember banks and three directors for State member and National Banks.
I, Clive Bucknall, Controller                    
   Name and Title of Officer Authorized to Sign Report
 
Of the named bank do hereby declare that these Reports of Condition and Income (including the supporting schedules) have been prepared in conformance with the instructions issued by the appropriate Federal regulatory authority and are true to the best of my knowledge and believe.
     /s/ Joseph R. Simpson
Signature of Officer Authorized to Sign Report
05/12/2008
Date of Signature
 
 
 
 
 
The Reports of Condition and Income are to be prepared in accordance with Federal regulatory authority instructions.
We, the undersigned directors (trustees), attest to the correctness of this Report of Condition (including the supporting schedules) and declare that it has been examined by us and to the best of our knowledge and belief has been prepared in conformance with the instructions issued by the appropriate Federal regulatory authority and is true and correct.
/s/ Sal H. Alfieri
Director (Trustee)
/s/ Bernard J. Kennedy
Director (Trustee)
/s/ Martin Glynn
Director (Trustee)


 

 


Table of Contents

Submission of Reports
Each Bank must prepare its Reports of Condition and Income either:
(a)   in electronic form and then file the computer data file directly with the banking agencies’ collection agent, Electronic Data System Corporation (EDS), by modem or computer diskette; or
 
b)   in hard-copy (paper) form and arrange for another party to convert the paper report to automated for. That party (if other than EDS) must transmit the bank’s computer data file to EDS.
                                         
FDIC Certificate Number
    5       7       8       9       0  
    (RCRI 9030)
http://WWW.BANKING.US.HSBC.COM
     Primary Internet Web Address of Bank (Home Page), if any (TEXT 4087)
     (Example: www.examplebank.com) 
For electronic filing assistance, contact EDS Call report Services, 2150 N. Prospect Ave., Milwaukee, WI 53202, telephone (800) 255-1571.
To fulfill the signature and attestation requirement for the Reports of Condition and Income for this report date, attach this signature page to the hard-copy f the completed report that the bank places in its files.
HSBC Bank USA, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION
 
Legal Title of Bank (TEXT 9010)
 
Wilmington
 
City (TEXT 9130)
         
DE
    19801  
 
State Abbrev. (TEXT 9200)
  ZIP Code (TEXT 9220)


Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, Office of the Comptroller of the Currency
REPORT OF CONDITION
Consolidated domestic subsidiaries
     
HSBC Bank USA, National Association
  of Buffalo
 
Name of Bank
  City
in the state of New York, at the close of business June 30, 2008
                 
            Thousands of dollars
ASSETS
               
 
Cash and balances due from depository institutions:
               
a. Non-interest-bearing balances currency and coin
            3,746,575  
b. Interest-bearing balances
            4,269,852  
Held-to-maturity securities
            2,776,907  
Available-for-sale securities
            21,761,840  
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell:
               
a. Federal funds sold in domestic offices
            4,620,000  
b. Securities purchased under agreements to resell
            7,715,576  
Loans and lease financing receivables:
               
Loans and leases held for sale
            4,410,114  
Loans and leases net of unearned income
    84,525,017          
LESS: Allowance for loan and lease losses
    1,795,053          
Loans and lease, net of unearned income, allowance, and reserve
            82,729,964  
Trading assets
            32,699,558  
Premises and fixed assets
            545,573  
Other real estate owned
            72,547  
Investments in unconsolidated subsidiaries
            313,902  
Customers’ liability to this bank on acceptances outstanding
            NA  
Intangible assets: Goodwill
            2,111,113  
Intangible assets: Other intangible assets
            589,485  
Other assets
            9,103,240  
Total assets
            177,466,246  
 
               

 


Table of Contents

                 
            Thousands of dollars
LIABILITIES
               
 
               
Deposits:
               
In domestic offices
            82,747,882  
Non-interest-bearing
    12,897,851          
Interest-bearing
    69,850,031          
In foreign offices
            36,698,708  
Non-interest-bearing
    963,333          
Interest-bearing
    35,735,375          
 
               
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase:
               
a. Federal funds purchased in domestic offices
            115,564  
b. Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
            944,566  
 
               
Trading Liabilities
            14,021,445  
Other borrowed money
            19,553,170  
Bank’s liability on acceptances
            NA  
Subordinated notes and debentures
            4,614,032  
Other liabilities
            6,349,027  
Total liabilities
            165,044,394  
Minority Interests in consolidated Subsidiaries
            349  
EQUITY CAPITAL
               
 
               
Perpetual preferred stock and related surplus
            0  
Common Stock
            2,001  
Surplus
            11,593,143  
Retained earnings
            1,472,086  
Accumulated other comprehensive income
            -645,727  
Other equity capital components
            0  
Total equity capital
            12,421,503  
Total liabilities, minority interests and equity capital
            177,466,246  

 

EX-99.1 12 u01974exv99w1.htm EX-99.1: FORM OF LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL EX-99.1
Exhibit 99.1
LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL
To Tender
U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 (CUSIP: 03938LAC8) and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (CUSIP: 03938LAF1)
which have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933,
for any and all outstanding unregistered U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and
U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018
of
ArcelorMittal
pursuant to the prospectus dated            , 2008
THE EXCHANGE OFFER WILL EXPIRE AT 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON       , 2008 UNLESS THE OFFER IS EXTENDED (THE “EXPIRATION DATE”). TENDERS OF ORIGINAL NOTES MAY BE WITHDRAWN AT ANY TIME PRIOR TO 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON THE EXPIRATION DATE.
Delivery to the Exchange Agent, HSBC Bank USA, National Association:
By Regular, Registered or Certified Mail,
By Overnight Courier or By Hand:
         
By Facsimile:   HSBC Bank USA, National Association   Confirm by Telephone:
(718) 488-4488   Corporate Trust & Loan Agency   (800) 662-9844
    2 Hanson Place, 14th Floor    
Attention: Corporate Trust   Brooklyn, New York 10217-1409    
Operations   Attention: Corporate Trust    
    Operations    
     Delivery of this Letter of Transmittal to an address, or transmission via telegram, telex or facsimile, other than as set forth above will not constitute a valid delivery. The instructions contained herein should be read carefully before this Letter of Transmittal is completed.
     HOLDERS WHO WISH TO BE ELIGIBLE TO RECEIVE EXCHANGE NOTES FOR THEIR ORIGINAL NOTES PURSUANT TO THE EXCHANGE OFFER MUST VALIDLY TENDER (AND NOT WITHDRAW) THEIR ORIGINAL NOTES TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT PRIOR TO THE EXPIRATION DATE.
     By execution hereof, the undersigned acknowledges receipt of the prospectus (the “Prospectus”), dated            , 2008, of ArcelorMittal (the “Company”), which, together with this Letter of Transmittal and the instructions hereto (the “Letter of Transmittal”), constitutes the Company’s offer to exchange (the “Exchange Offer”) up to an aggregate principal amount of U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (respectively, the “2013 Exchange Notes” and the “2018 Exchange Notes” and, together, the “Exchange Notes”) that have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), pursuant to a registration statement of which the Prospectus constitutes a part, for a like principal amount of its outstanding unregistered U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (respectively, the “2013 Original Notes” and the “2018 Original Notes” and, together, the “Original Notes”), upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in the Prospectus.
     This Letter of Transmittal is to be used by Holders if: (i) certificates representing Original Notes are to be physically delivered to the Exchange Agent herewith by Holders or (ii) tender of Original Notes is to be made according to the guaranteed delivery procedures set forth in the Prospectus under “The Exchange Offer—Terms of the Exchange Offer—Guaranteed Delivery Procedures.” Delivery of documents to DTC does not constitute delivery to the Exchange Agent.

 


 

     If delivery of the Original Notes is to be made by book-entry transfer to the account maintained by the Exchange Agent at DTC, this Letter of Transmittal need not be manually executed; provided, however, that tenders of Original Notes must be effected in accordance with the procedures mandated by DTC’s Automated Tender Offer Program (“ATOP”).
     The term “Holder” with respect to the Exchange Offer means: (i) any person in whose name Original Notes are registered on the books of the Company or the trustee or any other person who has obtained a properly completed bond power from the registered Holder or (ii) any participant in DTC whose Original Notes are held of record by DTC who desires to deliver such Original Notes by book-entry transfer at DTC.
     The undersigned has completed, executed and delivered this Letter of Transmittal to indicate the action the undersigned desires to take with respect to the Exchange Offer. Holders who wish to tender their Original Notes must complete this letter in its entirety.
     The instructions included with this Letter of Transmittal must be followed. Questions and requests for assistance or for additional copies of the Prospectus, this Letter of Transmittal and the Notice of Guaranteed Delivery may be directed to the Information Agent. See Instruction 8 herein.
     HOLDERS WHO WISH TO ACCEPT THE EXCHANGE OFFER AND TENDER THEIR ORIGINAL NOTES MUST COMPLETE THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL IN ITS ENTIRETY.
     List below the Original Notes to which this Letter of Transmittal relates. If the space provided below is inadequate, list the certificate numbers and principal amounts on a separately executed schedule and affix the schedule to this Letter of Transmittal. Tenders of Original Notes will be accepted only in authorized denominations.
 
DESCRIPTION OF 2013 ORIGINAL NOTES
             
    Certificate Number(s)*       Aggregate Principal Amount
Name(s) and Address(es) of   (attach signed list   Aggregate Principal Amount   Tendered
Holder(s)   if necessary)   of 2013 Original Note(s)   (if less than all)**
 
(Please fill in if blank)
           
 
TOTAL PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF 2013 ORIGINAL NOTES TENDERED
 
*   Need not be completed by Holders tendering by book-entry transfer.
 
**   Need not be completed by Holders who wish to tender with respect to all 2013 Original Notes listed. See Instruction 2. 2013 Original Notes tendered hereby must be in denominations of principal amount of $2,000 and any integral multiple of $1,000 in excess thereof.
 
DESCRIPTION OF 2018 ORIGINAL NOTES
             
    Certificate Number(s)*       Aggregate Principal Amount
Name(s) and Address(es) of   (attach signed list   Aggregate Principal Amount   Tendered
Holder(s)   if necessary)   of 2018 Original Note(s)   (if less than all)**
 
(Please fill in if blank)
           
 
TOTAL PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF 2018 ORIGINAL NOTES TENDERED
 
*   Need not be completed by Holders tendering by book-entry transfer.
 
**   Need not be completed by Holders who wish to tender with respect to all 2018 Original Notes listed. See Instruction 2. 2018 Original Notes tendered hereby must be in denominations of principal amount of $2,000 and any integral multiple of $1,000 in excess thereof.

2


 

o   CHECK HERE IF TENDERED ORIGINAL NOTES ARE BEING DELIVERED BY DTC TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT’S ACCOUNT AT DTC AND COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING:
Name of Tendering Institution:
DTC Book-Entry Account:
Transaction Code No.:
     If Holders desire to tender Original Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer and (i) certificates representing such Original Notes are not lost but are not immediately available, (ii) time will not permit this Letter of Transmittal, certificates representing such Original Notes or other required documents to reach the Exchange Agent prior to the Expiration Date or (iii) the procedures for book-entry transfer cannot be completed prior to the Expiration Date, such Holders may effect a tender of such Original Notes in accordance with the guaranteed delivery procedures set forth in the Prospectus under “The Exchange Offer—Terms of the Exchange Offer—Guaranteed Delivery Procedures.”
o   CHECK HERE IF TENDERED ORIGINAL NOTES ARE BEING DELIVERED PURSUANT TO A NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY PREVIOUSLY DELIVERED TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT AND COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING:
Name(s) of Holder(s) of Original Notes:
Window Ticket No. (if any):
Date of Execution of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery:
Name of Eligible Institution that Guaranteed Delivery:
DTC Book-Entry Account No.:
If Delivered by Book-Entry Transfer:
Name of Tendering Institution:
Transaction Code No.:
o   CHECK HERE IF TENDERED BY BOOK-ENTRY TRANSFER AND NON-EXCHANGED ORIGINAL NOTES ARE TO BE RETURNED BY CREDITING THE DTC ACCOUNT SET FORTH ABOVE.
o   CHECK HERE IF YOU ARE A BROKER-DEALER WHO ACQUIRED THE ORIGINAL NOTES FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT AS A RESULT OF MARKET MAKING OR OTHER TRADING ACTIVITIES AND WISH TO RECEIVE 10 ADDITIONAL COPIES OF THE PROSPECTUS AND 10 COPIES OF ANY AMENDMENTS OR SUPPLEMENTS THERETO.
Name:
Address:

3


 

Ladies and Gentlemen:
     Subject to the terms of the Exchange Offer, the undersigned hereby tenders to the Company the principal amount of Original Notes indicated above. Subject to and effective upon the acceptance for exchange of the principal amount of Original Notes tendered in accordance with this Letter of Transmittal, the undersigned sells, assigns and transfers to, or upon the order of, the Company all right, title and interest in and to the Original Notes tendered hereby. The undersigned hereby irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Exchange Agent its agent and attorney-in-fact (with full knowledge that the Exchange Agent also acts as the agent of the Company and as trustee under the indentures for the Original Notes and the Exchange Notes) with respect to the tendered Original Notes with full power of substitution to (i) deliver certificates for such Original Notes to the Company, or transfer ownership of such Original Notes on the account books maintained by DTC, together, in either such case, with all accompanying evidences of transfer and authenticity to, or upon the order of, the Company and (ii) present such Original Notes for transfer on the books of the Company and (iii) receive all benefits and otherwise exercise all rights of beneficial ownership of such Original Notes, all in accordance with the terms of the Exchange Offer. The power of attorney granted in this paragraph shall be deemed irrevocable and coupled with an interest.
     The undersigned hereby represents and warrants that he or she has full power and authority to tender, sell, assign and transfer the Original Notes tendered hereby and that the Company will acquire good and unencumbered title thereto, free and clear of all liens, restrictions, charges and encumbrances and not subject to any adverse claim, when the same are acquired by the Company. The undersigned also acknowledges that this Exchange Offer is being made in reliance upon existing interpretations by the staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) set forth in interpretive letters issued to parties unrelated to the Company that the Exchange Notes issued in exchange for the Original Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer may be offered for sale, resold and otherwise transferred by holders thereof (other than a broker-dealer who acquires such Original Notes directly from the Company for resale pursuant to Rule 144A under the Securities Act or any other available exemption under the Securities Act or any such holder that is an “affiliate” of the Company within the meaning of Rule 405 under the Securities Act) without compliance with the registration and prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act, provided that such Exchange Notes are acquired in the ordinary course of such holder’s business and such holder is not engaged in, and does not intend to engage in, and has no arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in, the distribution of such Exchange Notes in violation of the provisions of the Securities Act. If a holder of Original Notes is engaged in or intends to engage in a distribution of the Exchange Notes or has any arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in the distribution of the Exchange Notes to be acquired pursuant to the Exchange Offer, such holder may not rely on the applicable interpretations of the staff of the SEC described above and must comply with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any secondary resale transaction.
     The undersigned represents that (i) any Exchange Notes acquired in exchange for Original Notes tendered hereby will be acquired in the ordinary course of business of the person receiving such Exchange Notes, whether or not such person is the undersigned, (ii) neither the holder of such Original Notes nor any such other person has any arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in, is engaged in or intends to engage in, the distribution (within the meaning of the Securities Act) of the Exchange Notes in violation of the provisions of the Securities Act and (iii) neither the holder of such Original Notes nor any such other person is an “affiliate,” as defined under Rule 405 of the Securities Act, of the Company. If the undersigned is a broker-dealer receiving Exchange Notes for its own account, it represents that it acquired the Original Notes to be exchanged for the Exchange Notes as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities and that it will deliver a prospectus (or, to the extent permitted by law, make available a prospectus to purchasers) in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes to the extent required by applicable law or regulation or SEC pronouncement. By acknowledging that it will deliver and by delivering a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes, the undersigned is not deemed to admit that it is an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act.
     The undersigned will, upon request, execute and deliver any additional documents deemed by the Exchange Agent or the Company to be necessary or desirable to complete the assignment and transfer of the Original Notes tendered hereby.

4


 

     For purposes of the Exchange Offer, the Company shall be deemed to have accepted validly tendered Original Notes when, as and if the Company has given oral or written notice thereof to the Exchange Agent. If any tendered Original Notes are not accepted for exchange pursuant to the Exchange Offer for any reason, certificates for any such unaccepted Original Notes will be returned (except as noted below with respect to tenders through DTC), without expense, to the undersigned at the address shown below or at a different address as may be indicated under “Special Issuance Instructions” as promptly as practicable after the Expiration Date.
     All authority conferred or agreed to be conferred by this Letter of Transmittal shall survive the death, incapacity or dissolution of the undersigned and every obligation under this Letter of Transmittal shall be binding upon the undersigned’s heirs, personal representatives, successors and assigns.
     The undersigned understands that tenders of Original Notes pursuant to the procedures described under the caption “The Exchange Offer—Terms of the Exchange Offer—Procedures for Tendering” in the Prospectus and in the instructions hereto will constitute a binding agreement between the undersigned and the Company upon the terms and subject to the conditions of the Exchange Offer.
     Unless otherwise indicated under “Special Issuance Instructions,” please issue the certificates representing the Exchange Notes issued in exchange for the Original Notes accepted for exchange and return any Original Notes not tendered or not exchanged, in the name(s) of the undersigned (or in either such event in the case of Original Notes tendered by DTC, by credit to the account at DTC). Similarly, unless otherwise indicated under “Special Delivery Instructions,” please send the certificates representing the Exchange Notes issued in exchange for the Original Notes accepted for exchange and any certificates for Original Notes not tendered or not exchanged (and accompanying documents, as appropriate) to the undersigned at the address shown below the undersigned’s signatures, unless, in either event, tender is being made through DTC. In the event that both “Special Issuance Instructions” and “Special Delivery Instructions” are completed, please issue the certificates representing the Exchange Notes issued in exchange for the Original Notes accepted for exchange and return any Original Notes not tendered or not exchanged in the name(s) of, and send said certificates to, the person(s) so indicated. The undersigned recognizes that the Company has no obligation pursuant to the “Special Issuance Instructions” and “Special Delivery Instructions” to transfer any Original Notes from the name of the registered holder(s) thereof if the Company does not accept for exchange any of the Original Notes so tendered.

5


 

PLEASE SIGN HERE
(To Be Completed by All Tendering Holders of Original Notes Regardless
of Whether Original Notes Are Being Physically Delivered Herewith)
     This Letter of Transmittal must be signed by the Holder(s) of Original Notes exactly as their name(s) appear(s) on certificate(s) for Original Notes or, if tendered by a participant in DTC, exactly as such participant’s name appears on a security position listing as the owner of Original Notes, or by person(s) authorized to become registered Holder(s) by endorsements and documents transmitted with this Letter of Transmittal. If signature is by a trustee, executor, administrator, guardian, attorney-in-fact, officer or other person acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, such person must set forth his or her full title below under “Capacity” and submit evidence satisfactory to the Company of such person’s authority to so act. See Instruction 3 herein.
     If the signature appearing below is not of the registered Holder(s) of the Original Notes, then the registered Holder(s) must sign a valid proxy.
                         
 
  x           Date:        
 
     
 
         
 
   
 
                       
 
  x           Date:        
 
     
 
Signature(s) of Holder(s) or
         
 
   
 
      Authorized Signatory                
                         
 
  Name(s):           Address:        
 
     
 
         
 
   
 
                       
 
     
 
(Please Print)
         
 
(including zip code)
   
                         
 
  Capacity(ies):            Area Code and Telephone No.:        
 
     
 
         
 
   
     Social Security No.(s):                                                            
SIGNATURE GUARANTEE (See Instruction 3 herein)
Certain Signatures Must Be Guaranteed by an Eligible Institution
 
(Name of Eligible Institution Guaranteeing Signatures)
 
(Address (including zip code) and Telephone Number (including area code) of Firm)
 
(Authorized Signature)
 
(Printed Name)
 
(Title)
Date:                                         

 


 

SPECIAL ISSUANCE INSTRUCTIONS
(See Instruction 4 herein)
To be completed ONLY if certificates for Original Notes in a principal amount not tendered are to be issued in the name of, or the Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer are to be issued to the order of, someone other than the person or persons whose signature(s) appear(s) within this Letter of Transmittal or issued to an address different from that shown in the box entitled “Description of Original Notes” within this Letter of Transmittal, or if Original Notes tendered by book-entry transfer that are not accepted for purchase are to be credited to an account maintained at DTC other than the account at DTC indicated above.
     
Name:
   
 
   
 
  (Please Print)
     
Address:
   
 
   
 
  (Please Print)
 
   
 
   
 
  Zip Code
 
   
 
Taxpayer Identification or Social Security Number
o Credit unexchanged Original Notes delivered by book- entry transfer to the Book-Entry Transfer Facility account set forth below.
Book-Entry Transfer Facility
Account Number, if applicable)
SPECIAL DELIVERY INSTRUCTIONS
(See Instruction 4 herein)
To be completed ONLY if certificates for Original Notes in a principal amount not tendered or not accepted for purchase or the Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer are to be sent to someone other than the person or persons whose signature(s) appear(s) within this Letter of Transmittal or to an address different from that shown in the box entitled “Description of Original Notes” within this Letter of Transmittal or to be credited to an account maintained at DTC other than the account at DTC indicated above.
     
 
   
Name:
   
 
   
 
  (Please Print)
     
Address:
   
 
   
 
  (Please Print)
 
   
 
   
 
  Zip Code
 
   
 
Taxpayer Identification or Social Security Number


 


 

INSTRUCTIONS
Forming Part of the Terms and Conditions
of the Exchange Offer and the Solicitation
     1. Delivery of this Letter of Transmittal and Original Notes. The certificates for the tendered Original Notes (or a confirmation of a book-entry into the Exchange Agent’s account at DTC of all Original Notes delivered electronically), as well as a properly completed and duly executed copy of this Letter of Transmittal or facsimile hereof and any other documents required by this Letter of Transmittal must be received by the Exchange Agent at its address set forth herein prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration Date. The method of delivery of the tendered Original Notes, this Letter of Transmittal and all other required documents to the Exchange Agent are at the election and risk of the Holder and, except as otherwise provided below, the delivery will be deemed made only when actually received by the Exchange Agent. Instead of delivery by mail, it is recommended that the Holder use an overnight or hand delivery service. In all cases, sufficient time should be allowed to assure timely delivery. No Letter of Transmittal or Original Notes should be sent to the Company. Original Notes may be tendered in whole or in part in the principal amount of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.
     Holders who wish to tender their Original Notes and (i) whose Original Notes are not immediately available or (ii) who cannot deliver their Original Notes, this Letter of Transmittal or any other documents required hereby to the Exchange Agent prior to the Expiration Date, or who cannot complete the procedure for book-entry transfer on a timely basis must tender their Original Notes and follow the guaranteed delivery procedures set forth in the Prospectus. Pursuant to such procedures: (i) such tender must be made by or through an eligible institution (as defined below); (ii) prior to the Expiration Date, the Exchange Agent must have received from the eligible institution a properly completed and duly executed Notice of Guaranteed Delivery (by facsimile transmission, mail or hand delivery) setting forth the name and address of the Holder of the Original Notes, the certificate number or numbers of such Original Notes and the principal amount of Original Notes tendered, stating that the tender is being made thereby and guaranteeing that within three business days from the date of the Notice of Guaranteed Delivery, this Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile thereof) together with the certificate(s) representing the Original Notes (or a confirmation of electronic mail delivery of book-entry delivery into the Exchange Agent’s account at DTC) and any of the required documents will be deposited by the eligible institution with the Exchange Agent; and (iii) such properly completed and executed Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile hereof), as well as all other documents required by this Letter of Transmittal and the certificate(s) representing all tendered Original Notes in proper form for transfer (or a confirmation of electronic mail delivery of book-entry delivery into the Exchange Agent’s account at DTC), must be received by the Exchange Agent within three business days from the date of the Notice of Guaranteed Delivery, all as provided in the Prospectus under the caption “The Exchange Offer—Terms of the Exchange Offer—Guaranteed Delivery Procedures.” Any Holder of Original Notes who wishes to tender his Original Notes pursuant to the guaranteed delivery procedures described above must ensure that the Exchange Agent receives the Notice of Guaranteed Delivery prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration Date.
     As used herein in and in the Prospectus, “Eligible Institution” means a firm which is a member of a registered national securities exchange or a member of the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. or a commercial bank or trust company having an office or correspondent in the United States.
     All questions as to the validity, form, eligibility (including time of receipt), acceptance and withdrawal of tendered Original Notes will be determined by the Company in its sole discretion, which determination will be final and binding. The Company reserves the absolute right to reject any and all Original Notes not properly tendered or any Original Notes the Company’s acceptance of which would, in the opinion of counsel for the Company, be unlawful. The Company also reserves the right to waive any irregularities or conditions of tender as to particular Original Notes. The Company’s interpretation of the terms and conditions of the Exchange Offer (including the instructions in this Letter of Transmittal) will be final and binding on all parties. Unless waived, any defects or irregularities in connection with tenders of Original Notes must be cured within such time as the Company shall determine. Neither the Company, the Exchange Agent nor any other person shall be under any duty to give notification of defects or irregularities with respect to tenders of Original Notes, nor shall any of them incur any liability for failure to give such notification. Tenders of Original Notes will not be deemed to have been made until such defects or irregularities have been cured or waived. Any Original Notes received by the Exchange Agent that are not properly tendered and as to which the defects or irregularities have not been cured or waived will be returned

8


 

without cost by the Exchange Agent to the tendering Holders of Original Notes, unless otherwise provided in this Letter of Transmittal, as soon as practicable following the Expiration Date.
     2. Partial Tenders. Tenders of Original Notes will be accepted only in the principal amount of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof. If less than the entire principal amount of any Original Notes is tendered, the tendering Holder should fill in the principal amount tendered in the third column of the chart entitled “Description of Original Notes.” The entire principal amount of Original Notes delivered to the Exchange Agent will be deemed to have been tendered unless otherwise indicated. If the entire principal amount of all Original Notes is not tendered, Original Notes for the principal amount of Original Notes delivered to the Exchange Agent will be deemed to have been tendered unless otherwise indicated. If the entire principal amount of all Original Notes is not tendered, Original Notes for the principal amount of Original Notes not tendered and a certificate or certificates representing Exchange Notes issued in exchange of any Original Notes accepted will be sent to the Holder at his or her registered address, unless a different address is provided in the appropriate box on this Letter of Transmittal or unless tender is made through DTC, promptly after the Original Notes are accepted for exchange.
     3. Signatures on the Letter of Transmittal; Bond Powers and Endorsements; Guarantee of Signatures. If this Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile hereof) is signed by the registered Holder(s) of the Original Notes tendered hereby, the signature must correspond with the name(s) as written on the face of the Original Notes without alteration, enlargement or any change whatsoever.
     If this Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile hereof) is signed by the registered Holder(s) of Original Notes tendered and the certificate(s) for Exchange Notes issued in exchange therefor is to be issued (or any untendered principal amount of Original Notes is to be reissued) to the registered Holder, such Holder need not and should not endorse any tendered Original Note, nor provide a separate bond power. In any other case, such holder must either properly endorse the Original Notes tendered or transmit a properly completed separate bond power with this Letter of Transmittal, with the signatures on the endorsement or bond power guaranteed by an Eligible Institution.
     If this Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile hereof) is signed by a person other than the registered Holder(s) of any Original Notes listed, such Original Notes must be endorsed or accompanied by appropriate bond powers signed as the name(s) of the registered Holder(s) appear(s) on the Original Notes.
     If this Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile hereof) or any Original Notes or bond powers are signed by trustees, executors, administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact, or officers of corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, such persons should so indicate when signing, and unless waived by the Company, evidence satisfactory to the Company of their authority so to act must be submitted with this Letter of Transmittal.
     Endorsements on Original Notes or signatures on bond powers required by this Instruction 3 must be guaranteed by an Eligible Institution.
     Signatures on this Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile hereof) must be guaranteed by an Eligible Institution unless the Original Notes tendered pursuant thereto are tendered (i) by a registered Holder (including any participant in DTC whose name appears on a security position listing as the owner of Original Notes) who has not completed the box set forth herein entitled “Special Issuance Instructions” or the box entitled “Special Delivery Instructions” or (ii) for the account of an eligible institution.
     4. Special Issuance and Delivery Instructions. Tendering Holders should indicate, in the applicable spaces, the name and address to which Exchange Notes or substitute Original Notes for principal amounts not tendered or not accepted for exchange are to be issued or sent, if different from the name and address of the person signing this Letter of Transmittal (or in the case of tender of the Original Notes through DTC, if different from the account maintained at DTC indicated above). In the case of issuance in a different name, the taxpayer identification or social security number of the person named must also be indicated.
     5. Transfer Taxes. The Company will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the exchange of Original Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer. If, however, certificates representing Exchange Notes or Original Notes for principal amounts not tendered or accepted for exchange are to be delivered to, or are to be registered or issued in the name of, any person other than the registered Holder of the Original Notes tendered hereby, or if tendered

9


 

Original Notes are registered in the name of any person other than the person signing this Letter of Transmittal, or if a transfer tax is imposed for any reason other than the exchange of Original Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, then the amount of any such transfer taxes (whether imposed on the registered Holder or any other person) will be payable by the tendering Holder. If satisfactory evidence of payment of such taxes or exemption therefrom is not submitted with this Letter of Transmittal, the amount of such transfer taxes will be billed directly to such tendering Holder.
     Except as provided in this Instruction 5, it will not be necessary for transfer tax stamps to be affixed to the Original Notes listed in this Letter of Transmittal.
     6. Waiver of Conditions. The Company reserves the absolute right to amend, waive or modify specified conditions in the Exchange Offer in the case of any Original Notes tendered.
     7. Mutilated, Lost, Stolen or Destroyed Original Notes. Any tendering Holder whose Original Notes have been mutilated, lost, stolen or destroyed should contact the Information Agent at the address indicated herein for further instruction.
     8. Requests for Assistance or Additional Copies. Questions and requests for assistance and requests for the Prospectus, Letter of Transmittal and the related documents may be directed to the Exchange Agent set forth above. Holders may also contact their broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee for assistance concerning the Exchange Offer.
IMPORTANT: THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL (OR FACSIMILE THEREOF), OR AN
AGENT’S MESSAGE IN LIEU THEREOF, AND ALL OTHER REQUIRED DOCUMENTS MUST BE
RECEIVED BY THE EXCHANGE AGENT ON OR PRIOR TO THE EXPIRATION DATE.
 
(DO NOT WRITE IN SPACE BELOW)
         
Certificate Surrendered   Original Notes Tendered   Original Notes Accepted
 
       
 
       
 
       
 
       
Delivery Prepared by                     
  Checked by                                            Date                                         

10


 

By Regular, Registered or Certified Mail,
By Overnight Courier or By Hand:
         
By Facsimile:   HSBC Bank USA, National Association   Confirm by Telephone:
(718) 488-4488   Corporate Trust & Loan Agency   (800) 662-9844
    2 Hanson Place, 14th Floor    
Attention: Corporate Trust   Brooklyn, New York 10217-1409    
Operations   Attention: Corporate Trust    
    Operations    
Information Agent, D.F. King & Co., Inc.:
48 Wall Street, 22nd Floor
New York, New York 10005
Banks and Brokers Call (Collect): 212-269-5550
All Others Call (Toll Free): 800-290-6429

11

EX-99.2 13 u01974exv99w2.htm EX-99.2: FORM OF NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY EX-99.2
Exhibit 99.2
NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY
U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 (CUSIP: 03938LAC8) and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (CUSIP: 03938LAF1)
which have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933,
for any and all outstanding unregistered U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and
U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018
of
ArcelorMittal
pursuant to the prospectus dated            , 2008
     As set forth in the prospectus, dated            , 2008 (the “Prospectus”), of ArcelorMittal (the “Company”), in the accompanying Letter of Transmittal and instructions thereto (the “Letter of Transmittal”), this form or one substantially equivalent hereto must be used to accept the Company’s offer to exchange (the “Exchange Offer”) up to an aggregate principal amount of U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (respectively, the “2013 Exchange Notes” and the “2018 Exchange Notes” and, together, the “Exchange Notes”), for a like principal amount of its U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (respectively, the “2013 Original Notes” and the “2018 Original Notes” and, together, the “Original Notes”), if (i) certificates representing the Original Notes to be tendered for purchase and payment are not lost but are not immediately available, (ii) time will not permit the Letter of Transmittal, certificates representing such Original Notes or other required documents to reach HSBC Bank USA, National Association (the “Exchange Agent”) prior to the Expiration Date (as defined below) or (iii) the procedures for book-entry transfer cannot be completed prior to the Expiration Date. This form may be delivered by an eligible institution by mail or hand delivery or transmitted, via telegram, telex or facsimile, to the Exchange Agent as set forth below.
For information, contact:
     THE EXCHANGE OFFER WILL EXPIRE AT 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON       , 2008 UNLESS THE OFFER IS EXTENDED (THE “EXPIRATION DATE”). TENDERS OF ORIGINAL NOTES MAY BE WITHDRAWN AT ANY TIME PRIOR TO 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON THE EXPIRATION DATE.
Delivery to the Exchange Agent, HSBC Bank USA, National Association:
By Regular, Registered or Certified Mail,
By Overnight Courier or By Hand:
         
By Facsimile:   HSBC Bank USA, National Association   Confirm by Telephone:
(718) 488-4488   Corporate Trust & Loan Agency   (800) 662-9844
    2 Hanson Place, 14th Floor    
Attention: Corporate Trust   Brooklyn, New York 10217-1409    
Operations   Attention: Corporate Trust    
    Operations    

 


 

Information Agent, D.F. King & Co., Inc.:
48 Wall Street, 22nd Floor
New York, New York 10005
Banks and Brokers Call (Collect): 212-269-5550
All Others Call (Toll Free): 800-290-6429
     Delivery of this instrument other than as set forth above will not constitute a valid delivery.

2


 

Ladies and Gentlemen:
     Upon the terms and conditions set forth in the Prospectus and the accompanying Letter of Transmittal, the undersigned hereby tenders to the Company the principal amount of Original Notes set forth below, pursuant to the guaranteed delivery procedure described in “The Exchange Offer—Terms of the Exchange Offer—Guaranteed Delivery Procedures” section of the Prospectus. The undersigned confirms all provisions of this Letter of Transmittal (including all representations and warranties) on behalf of itself and any beneficial owners of such principal amount of Original Notes as fully as if it had executed and transmitted the Letter of Transmittal to the Exchange Agent.
                     
Principal Amount of Original 2013 Notes Tendered:       Address(es):        
 
             
 
   
 
                   
$
                   
                 
 
                   
Principal Amount of Original 2018 Notes Tendered:                
                 
             
$                
     
 
   
 
           
 
      Area Code and Telephone Number(s):    
 
           
 
     
 
   
 
           
The Depository Trust Company account number.
       
 
   
                 
Account Number
               
 
 
 
           
 
               
             
 
          Signature(s):    
 
               
             
 
               
Name(s) of Holders(s):            
 
         
 
   
             
 
               
             
THE ACCOMPANYING GUARANTEE MUST BE COMPLETED.
 

3


 

GUARANTEE
(Not to be used for signature guarantee)
     The undersigned, an “eligible guarantor institution” within the meaning of Rule 17Ad-15 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, hereby guarantees to deliver to the Depository Trust Company the tendered Original Notes, in proper form for a Book-Entry Confirmation, with any required signature guarantees, within three New York Stock Exchange trading days after the Expiration Date.
                 
Name of Firm:
   
 
       
 
   
 
          (Authorized Signature)    
                     
Address:
          Title:        
 
 
 
         
 
   
 
                   
 
          Name:        
 
         
 
   
 
                   
 
          Date:        
 
             
 
   
Area Code and
Telephone Number:                                                            

4

EX-99.3 14 u01974exv99w3.htm EX-99.3: FORM OF LETTER TO REGISTERED HOLDERS EX-99.3
Exhibit 99.3
LETTER TO REGISTERED HOLDERS
U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 (CUSIP: 03938LAC8) and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (CUSIP: 03938LAF1)
which have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933,
for any and all outstanding unregistered U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and
U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018
of
ArcelorMittal
pursuant to the prospectus dated      , 2008
To Registered Holders:
     We are enclosing herewith the material listed below relating to the offer to exchange (the “Exchange Offer”) by ArcelorMittal (the “Company”) up to an aggregate principal amount of U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (the “Exchange Notes”) that have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), for a like principal amount of its outstanding unregistered U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (the “Original Notes”), upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in the prospectus (the “Prospectus”) dated         , 2008, and the accompanying Letter of Transmittal and instructions thereto (the “Letter of Transmittal”).
     Enclosed herewith are copies of the following documents:
  1.   Prospectus;
 
  2.   Letter of Transmittal;
 
  3.   Notice of Guaranteed Delivery;
 
  4.   Instruction to Registered Holder and/or Book-Entry Transfer Participant from Beneficial Owner; and
 
  5.   Letter which may be sent to your clients for whose account you hold Original Notes in your name or in the name of your nominee, to accompany the instruction form referred to above, for obtaining such client’s instruction with regard to the Exchange Offer.
We urge you to contact your clients promptly. Please note that the Exchange Offer will expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on                     , 2008 unless it is extended.
     The Exchange Offer is not conditioned upon any minimum number of Original Notes being tendered.
     Pursuant to the Letter of Transmittal, each holder of Original Notes (a “Holder”) will represent to the Company that (i) any Exchange Notes acquired in exchange for Original Notes tendered pursuant to the Letter of Transmittal will be acquired in the ordinary course of business of the person receiving such Exchange Notes, (ii) neither such Holder nor any person who will receive such Exchange Notes has any arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in, is engaged in or intends to engage in, the distribution (within the meaning of the Securities Act) of such Exchange Notes in violation of the provisions of the Securities Act and (iii) neither such Holder nor any person who will receive such Exchange Notes is an “affiliate,” as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act, of the Company. If such Holder is a broker-dealer receiving Exchange Notes for its own account, it will represent that it acquired the Original Notes to be exchanged for the Exchange Notes as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities and that it will deliver a prospectus (or, to the extent permitted by law, make available a prospectus to purchasers) in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes to the extent required by applicable law or regulation or SEC pronouncement. By acknowledging that it will deliver and by

 


 

delivering a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes, the Holder will not be deemed to admit that it is an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act.
     The enclosed Instruction to Registered Holder and/or Book-Entry Transfer Participant from Beneficial Owner contains an authorization by the beneficial owners of the Original Notes for you to make the foregoing representations.
     The Company will not pay any fee or commission to any broker or dealer or to any other persons (other than the Exchange and Information Agents for the Exchange Offer) in connection with the solicitation of tenders of Original Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer. The Company will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the Exchange of Original Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, on the transfer of Original Notes to it, except as otherwise provided in Instruction 5 of the enclosed Letter of Transmittal.
Delivery to the Exchange Agent, HSBC Bank USA, National Association:
By Regular, Registered or Certified Mail,
By Overnight Courier or By Hand:
         
By Facsimile:
  HSBC Bank USA, National Association   Confirm by Telephone:
(718) 488-4488
  Corporate Trust & Loan Agency   (800) 662-9844
 
  2 Hanson Place, 14th Floor    
Attention: Corporate Trust
  Brooklyn, New York 10217-1409    
Operations
  Attention:  Corporate Trust    
 
  Operations    
Information Agent, D.F. King & Co., Inc.:
48 Wall Street, 22nd Floor
New York, New York 10005
Banks and Brokers Call (Collect): 212-269-5550
All Others Call (Toll Free): 800-290-6429
Very truly yours,
ArcelorMittal
NOTHING CONTAINED HEREIN OR IN THE ENCLOSED DOCUMENTS SHALL CONSTITUTE YOU THE AGENT OF THE COMPANY, THE EXCHANGE AGENT OR ANY OTHER PERSON, OR AUTHORIZE YOU OR ANY OTHER PERSON TO USE ANY DOCUMENT OR MAKE ANY STATEMENT ON BEHALF OF THE COMPANY IN CONNECTION WITH THE EXCHANGE OFFER OTHER THAN THE DOCUMENTS ENCLOSED HEREWITH AND THE STATEMENTS CONTAINED THEREIN.

2

EX-99.4 15 u01974exv99w4.htm EX-99.4: FORM OF INSTRUCTIONS TO REGISTERED HOLDER EX-99.4
Exhibit 99.4
INSTRUCTION TO REGISTERED HOLDER AND/OR BOOK-ENTRY TRANSFER PARTICIPANT
FROM BENEFICIAL OWNER
U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 (CUSIP: 03938LAC8) and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (CUSIP: 03938LAF1)
which have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933,
for any and all outstanding unregistered U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and
U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018
of
ArcelorMittal
pursuant to the prospectus dated            , 2008
To Registered Holder:
     The undersigned hereby acknowledges receipt of the prospectus dated            , 2008 (the “Prospectus”) of ArcelorMittal (the “Company”), which, together with the accompanying Letter of Transmittal and the instructions thereto (the “Letter of Transmittal”), constitutes the Company’s offer to exchange (the “Exchange Offer”) up to an aggregate principal amount of U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (respectively, the “2013 Exchange Notes” and the “2018 Exchange Notes” and, together, the “Exchange Notes”) that have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), for a like principal amount of its outstanding unregistered U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (respectively, the “2013 Original Notes” and the “2018 Original Notes” and, together, the “Original Notes”).
     This will instruct you, the registered holder and/or book-entry transfer participant, as to the action to be taken by you relating to the Exchange Offer with respect to the Original Notes held by you for the account of the undersigned.
     The aggregate face amount of the Original Notes held by you for the account of the undersigned is (fill in amount(s)):
     
U.S.$
  of 2013 Original Notes.
 
   
U.S.$
  of 2018 Original Notes.
With respect to the Exchange Offer, the undersigned hereby instructs you (check appropriate box):
o   To TENDER the following Original Notes held by you for the account of the undersigned (insert principal amount of Original Notes to be tendered (if any)):
     
U.S.$
  of 2013 Original Notes.
 
   
U.S.$
  of 2018 Original Notes.
o   NOT to TENDER any Original Notes held by you for the account of the undersigned.
     If the undersigned instructs you to tender Original Notes held by you for the account of the undersigned, it is understood that you are authorized to make, on behalf of the undersigned (and the undersigned, by its signature below, hereby makes to you), the representations and warranties contained in the Letter of Transmittal that are to be made with respect to the undersigned as a beneficial owner, including but not limited to the representations, that (i) any Exchange Notes acquired in exchange for Original Notes tendered pursuant to the Letter of Transmittal will be acquired in the ordinary course of business of the person receiving such Exchange Notes, (ii) neither the undersigned nor any person who will receive such Exchange Notes has any arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in, is engaged in or intends to engage in, the distribution (within the meaning of the Securities

 


 

Act) of such Exchange Notes in violation of the provisions of the Securities Act, (iii) neither the undersigned nor any person who will receive such Exchange Notes is an “affiliate,” as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act, of the Company and (iv) if the undersigned is a broker-dealer receiving Exchange Notes for its own account, it acquired the Original Notes to be exchanged for such Exchange Notes as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities and it will deliver a prospectus (or, to the extent permitted by law, make available a prospectus to purchasers) in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes to the extent required by applicable law or regulation or SEC pronouncement. By so acknowledging that it will deliver and by delivering a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes, the undersigned is not deemed to admit that it is an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act.
SIGN HERE
 
Name of beneficial owner(s) (please print):
 
 
Signature(s):
 
 
Address:
 
 
Telephone Number:
 
 
Taxpayer identification or Social Security Number:
 
 
Date:
 

2

EX-99.5 16 u01974exv99w5.htm EX-99.5: FORM OF LETTER TO CLIENTS EX-99.5
Exhibit 99.5
LETTER TO CLIENTS
U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 (CUSIP: 03938LAC8) and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (CUSIP: 03938LAF1)
which have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933,
for any and all outstanding unregistered U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and
U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018
of
ArcelorMittal
pursuant to the prospectus dated           , 2008
To Our Clients:
     We are enclosing herewith the prospectus dated            , 2008 of ArcelorMittal (the “Company”), which, together with the accompanying Letter of Transmittal and the instructions thereto (the “Letter of Transmittal”), constitutes the Company’s offer to exchange (the “Exchange Offer”) up to an aggregate principal amount of U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (the “Exchange Notes”) that have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), for a like principal amount of its outstanding unregistered U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (the “Original Notes”), upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in the Exchange Offer.
Please note that the Exchange Offer will expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on           , 2008 unless it is extended.
The Exchange Offer is not conditioned upon any minimum number of Original Notes being tendered.
     We are the holder of record and/or participant in the book-entry transfer facility of Original Notes held by us for your account. A tender of such Original Notes can be made only by us as the record holder and pursuant to your instructions. The Letter of Transmittal is furnished to you for your information only and cannot be used by you to tender Original Notes held by us for your account.
     We request instructions as to whether you wish to tender any or all of the Original Notes held by us for your account pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Exchange Offer. We also request that you confirm that we may on your behalf make the representations contained in the Letter of Transmittal.
     Pursuant to the Letter of Transmittal, each holder of Original Notes will represent to the Company that (i) any Exchange Notes acquired in exchange for Original Notes tendered pursuant to the Letter of Transmittal will be acquired in the ordinary course of business of the person receiving such Exchange Notes, (ii) neither such holder nor any person who will receive such Exchange Notes has any arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in, is engaged in or intends to engage in, the distribution (within the meaning of the Securities Act) of such Exchange Notes in violation of the provisions of the Securities Act and (iii) neither such holder nor any person who will receive such Exchange Notes is an “affiliate,” as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act, of the Company. If such holder is a broker-dealer receiving Exchange Notes for its own account, it will represent that it acquired the Original Notes to be exchanged for the Exchange Notes as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities and that it will deliver a prospectus (or, to the extent permitted by law, make available a prospectus to purchasers) in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes to the extent required by applicable law or regulation or SEC pronouncement. By acknowledging that it will deliver and by delivering a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes, the holder will not be deemed to admit that it is an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act.
Very truly yours,

EX-99.6 17 u01974exv99w6.htm EX-99.6: FORM OF EXCHANGE AGENT AGREEMENT EX-99.6
Exhibit 99.6
EXCHANGE AGENT AGREEMENT
HBSC BANK, USA, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION
452 Fifth Avenue
New York, New York
Ladies and Gentlemen,
     ArcelorMittal, a company organized under the laws of the Grand Duchy of Luxembourg (“the Company”), proposes to make an offer (the “Exchange Offer”) to exchange up to U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (the “Exchange Notes”), which have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Act”), for a like principal amount of its outstanding U.S.$1,500,000,000 5.375% Notes Due 2013 and U.S.$1,500,000,000 6.125% Notes Due 2018 (the “Original Notes”). The terms and conditions of the Exchange Offer as currently contemplated are set forth in a prospectus (the “Prospectus”) included in the Company’s registration statement on Form F-4 (File No. 333- ) (the “Registration Statement”) filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”), and proposed to be distributed to all record holders of the Original Notes. The Original Notes and the Exchange Notes are collectively referred to herein as the “Notes”. Capitalized terms used herein and not defined shall have the respective meanings ascribed to them in the Prospectus or the accompanying Letter of Transmittal.
     The Company hereby appoints HSBC Bank USA, National Association, to act as exchange agent (the “Exchange Agent”) in connection with the Exchange Offer. References hereinafter to “you” shall refer to HSBC Bank USA, National Association.
     The Exchange Offer is expected to be commenced by the Company on or about      , 2008. The Letter of Transmittal accompanying the Prospectus is to be used by the holders of the Original Notes to accept the Exchange Offer, and contains instructions with respect to the delivery of Original Notes tendered. The Exchange Agent’s obligations with respect to receipt and inspection of the Letter of Transmittal in connection with the Exchange Offer shall be satisfied for all purposes hereof by inspection of the electronic message transmitted to the Exchange Agent by Exchange Offer participants in accordance with the Automated Tender Exchange Offer Program (“ATOP”) of the Depository Trust Company (“DTC”), and by otherwise observing and complying with all procedures established by DTC in connection with ATOP, to the extent that ATOP is utilized by Exchange Offer participants.
     The Exchange Offer shall expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on or about      , 2008, or on such later date or time to which the Company may extend the Exchange Offer (the “Expiration Date”). Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the Prospectus, the Company expressly reserves the right to extend the Exchange Offer from time to time and may extend the Exchange Offer by giving written notice to you at any time before 9:00 a.m., New York City time, on the business day following the previously scheduled Expiration Date, and in such case the term “Expiration Date” shall mean the time and date on which such Exchange Offer as so extended shall expire.

1


 

     The Company expressly reserves the right, in its sole discretion, to delay, amend or terminate the Exchange Offer, and not to accept for exchange any Original Notes not theretofore accepted for exchange, in among other cases upon the occurrence of any of the events specified in the Prospectus under the caption “The Exchange Offer – Terms of the Exchange Offer – Expiration Date; Extensions; Amendments; Termination.” The Company will give to you as promptly as practicable written notice of any delay, amendment, termination or non-acceptance.
     In carrying out your duties as Exchange Agent, you are to act in accordance with the following instructions:
     1. You will perform such duties and only such duties as are specifically set forth herein, in the section of the Prospectus captioned “The Exchange Offer,” or in the Letter of Transmittal accompanying the Prospectus and such duties which are necessarily incidental thereto.
     2. You will establish a book-entry account with respect to the Original Notes at The Depository Trust Company (the “Book-Entry Transfer Facility”) for purposes of the Exchange Offer within two business days after the date of the Prospectus, and any financial institution that is a participant in the Book-Entry Transfer Facility’s systems may make book-entry delivery of the Original Notes by causing the Book-Entry Transfer Facility to transfer such Original Notes into your account in accordance with the Book-Entry Transfer Facility’s procedure for such transfer.
     3. You are to examine each of the Letters of Transmittal and certificates for Original Notes (or confirmation of book-entry transfer into your account at the Book-Entry Transfer Facility) and any other documents delivered or mailed to you by or for holders of the Original Notes to ascertain whether: (i) the Letters of Transmittal, certificates and any such other documents are duly executed and properly completed in accordance with instructions set forth therein and in the Prospectus and that such book-entry confirmations are in due and proper form and contain the information required to be set forth therein, and (ii) the Original Notes have otherwise been properly tendered. In each case where the Letter of Transmittal or any other document has been improperly completed or executed or where book-entry confirmations are not in due and proper form or omit certain information or any of the certificates for Original Notes are not in proper form for transfer or some other irregularity in connection with the acceptance of the Exchange Offer exists, you will endeavor to inform the presenters of the need for fulfillment of all requirements and to take any other action as may be necessary or advisable to cause such irregularity to be corrected. In order to conduct such examination, the Company shall provide you with the list of the authorized signatories of ArcelorMittal deposited at the Luxembourg Register of Commerce and Companies and the booklet containing the signature specimens of such authorized signatories.
     4. With the approval of two Finance Special Proxy Holders of the Company, or any other party designated by such Finance Special Proxy Holders in writing, you are authorized to waive any defects, irregularities or conditions of tender in connection with any tender of Original Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer.
     5. Tenders of Original Notes may be made only as set forth in the Letter of Transmittal and in the section of the Prospectus captioned “The Exchange Offer – Terms of the

2


 

Exchange Offer – Procedures for Tendering” and Original Notes shall be considered properly tendered to you only when tendered in accordance with the procedures set forth therein.
          Notwithstanding the provisions of this paragraph 5, Original Notes which two Finance Special Proxy Holders of the Company or any other party designated by any such Finance Special Proxy Holders in writing shall approve as having been properly tendered shall be considered to be properly tendered.
     6. You shall promptly advise the Company with respect to any Original Notes delivered subsequent to the Expiration Date and accept its instructions with respect to disposition of such Original Notes.
7. You shall accept tenders:
     (a) in cases where the Original Notes are registered in two or more names only if signed by all named holders;
     (b) in cases where the signing person (as indicated on the Letter of Transmittal) is acting in a fiduciary or a representative capacity only when proper evidence of his or her authority so to act is submitted; and
     (c) from persons other than the registered holder of Original Notes, provided that customary transfer requirements, including any endorsement of the Original Note or delivery of a properly completed bond power, in either case, duly executed by each registered holder, and payment of applicable transfer taxes, are fulfilled.
          You shall accept partial tenders of Original Notes where so indicated and as permitted in the Letter of Transmittal and deliver certificates for Original Notes to the transfer agent for split-up and return any untendered Original Notes to the holder (or such other person as may be designated in the Letter of Transmittal) as promptly as practicable after expiration or termination of the Exchange Offer.
     8. Upon satisfaction or waiver of all of the conditions to the Exchange Offer, the Company will notify you of its acceptance, promptly after the Expiration Date, of all Original Notes properly tendered and you, on behalf of the Company, will exchange such Original Notes for Exchange Notes and cause such Original Notes to be canceled. Delivery of Exchange Notes will be made on behalf of the Company by you at the rate of $1,000 principal amount of Exchange Notes (with a minimum principal amount of $2,000) for each $1,000 principal amount of the Original Notes tendered promptly after notice of acceptance of such Original Notes by the Company; provided, however, that in all cases, Original Notes tendered pursuant to the Exchange Offer will be exchanged only after timely receipt by you of certificates for such Original Notes (or confirmation of book-entry transfer into your account at the Book-Entry Transfer Facility), a properly completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile thereof or an Agent’s Message in lieu thereof) with any required signature guarantees and any other required document. Unless otherwise instructed in writing by the Company, you shall issue Exchange Notes only in denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.

3


 

     9. Tenders pursuant to the Exchange Offer are irrevocable after the Expiration Date. Subject to the terms and upon the conditions set forth in the Prospectus and the Letter of Transmittal, Original Notes tendered pursuant to the Exchange Offer may be withdrawn at any time on or prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration Date in accordance with the terms of the Exchange Offer.
     10. The Company shall not be required to exchange any Original Notes tendered if any of the conditions set forth in the Exchange Offer are not met. Notice of any decision by the Company not to exchange any Original Notes tendered shall be given by the Company to you.
     11. If, pursuant to the Exchange Offer, the Company does not accept for exchange all or part of the Original Notes tendered because of an invalid tender, the occurrence of certain other events set forth in the Prospectus or otherwise, you shall as soon as practicable after the expiration or termination of the Exchange Offer return those certificates for unaccepted Original Notes (or effect appropriate book-entry transfer), together with any related required documents and the Letters of Transmittal relating thereto that are in your possession, to the persons who deposited them (or effected such book-entry transfer).
     12. All certificates for reissued Original Notes, unaccepted Original Notes or Exchange Notes (other than those effected by book-entry transfer) shall be forwarded by (a) first-class mail, postage pre-paid under a blanket surety bond protecting you and the Company from loss or liability arising out of the non-receipt or non-delivery of such certificates or (b) by registered mail insured separately for the replacement value of each of such certificates.
     13. You are not authorized to pay or offer to pay any concessions, commissions or solicitation fees to any broker, dealer, bank or other persons or to engage or utilize any person to solicit tenders.
     14. As Exchange Agent hereunder you:
          (a) will be regarded as making no representations and having no responsibilities as to the validity, sufficiency, value or genuineness of any of the Original Notes deposited with you pursuant to the Exchange Offer, and will not be required to and will make no representation as to the validity, value or genuineness of the Exchange Offer;
          (b) shall not take any legal action hereunder against any third party other than the Company, without the prior written consent of the Company, and shall not be obligated to take any legal action hereunder which might in your reasonable judgment involve any expense or liability, unless you shall have been furnished with reasonable indemnity;
          (c) shall not be liable to the Company for any action taken or omitted by you, or any action suffered by you to be taken or omitted, without negligence, willful misconduct or bad faith on your part, by reason of or as a result of the administration of your duties hereunder in accordance with the terms and conditions of this agreement or by reason of your compliance with the instructions set forth herein or with any written or oral instructions delivered to you pursuant hereto, and may reasonably rely on and shall be protected in acting in good faith in reliance upon any certificate, instrument, opinion, notice, letter, facsimile, or other document or

4


 

security delivered to you and reasonably believed by you to be genuine and to have been signed by the proper party or parties;
          (d) may reasonably rely upon any tender, statement, request, document, certificate, agreement or other instrument whatsoever not only as to its due execution and validity and effectiveness of its provisions, but also as to the truth and accuracy of any information contained therein, which you in good faith reasonably believe to be genuine or to have been signed or represented by the proper person or persons;
          (e) may rely on and shall be protected in acting upon written notice or oral instructions from any officer of the Company with respect to the Exchange Offer;
          (f) shall not advise any person tendering Original Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer as to whether to tender or refrain from tendering all or any portion of Original Notes or as to the market value, decline or appreciation in market value of any Original Notes that may or may not occur as a result of the Exchange Offer or as to the market value of the Exchange Notes; and
          (g) may consult with counsel, after notifying the Company, with respect to any questions relating to your duties and responsibilities, and the written advice or opinion of such counsel shall be full and complete authorization and protection in respect of any action taken, suffered or omitted by you hereunder in good faith and in reliance thereon.
     15. While it is the function of the Information Agent to distribute these materials, you shall take such reasonable action on a case-by-case basis as may from time to time be requested by the Company or its counsel (and such other action as you may reasonably deem appropriate, in which case you shall promptly inform the Company) to furnish copies of the Prospectus, Letter of Transmittal, the Notice of Guaranteed Delivery (as defined in the Prospectus) and such other documents (collectively, the “Exchange Offer Documents”) or such other forms as may be approved from time to time by the Company, to all holders of Original Notes and to all persons requesting such documents and to accept and comply with telephone requests for information relating to the Exchange Offer, provided that such information shall relate only to the procedures for accepting (or withdrawing from) the Exchange Offer. All other requests for information relating to the Exchange Offer shall be directed to the Information Agent, D.F. King & Co., Inc., attention: Tom Long, telephone number (212) 269-5550, at 48 Wall Street, 22nd Floor, New York, New York 10005.
     16. You shall advise by electronic mail or facsimile transmission, and promptly thereafter confirm in writing to Gamal M. Abouali, counsel for the Company (at gabouali@cgsh.com), D.F. King & Co., Inc., Information Agent (at tlong@dfking.com) and such other person or persons as the Company may request in writing, daily on each business day, and more frequently during the week immediately preceding the Expiration Date and if otherwise requested, up to and including the Expiration Date, as to the aggregate principal amount of Original Notes which have been tendered pursuant to the Exchange Offer and the items received by you pursuant to the Exchange Offer and this agreement, separately reporting and giving cumulative totals as to items properly received and items improperly received. In addition, you will also inform, and cooperate in making available to, the Company or any such other person or persons as the Company requests in writing from time to time prior to the Expiration Date of

5


 

such other information as it or he or she may reasonably request. Such cooperation shall include, without limitation, the granting by you to the Company and such person as the Company may request of access to a designated person on your staff who is responsible for receiving tenders, in order to ensure that immediately prior to the Expiration Date and each other Expiration Date, if any, the Company shall have received information in sufficient detail to enable it to decide whether to extend the Exchange Offer. You shall prepare a final list of all persons whose tenders were accepted, the aggregate principal amount of Original Notes tendered, the aggregate principal amount of Original Notes accepted and the identity of any Participating Broker-Dealers and the aggregate principal amount of Exchange Notes delivered to each, and deliver said list promptly to the Company.
     17. Letters of Transmittal and Notices of Guaranteed Delivery shall be stamped by you as to the date and the time of receipt thereof and shall, except as provided in paragraph 11, be preserved by you for a period of time at least equal to the period of time you customarily preserve other records pertaining to the transfer of securities or as required by applicable law, or one year, whichever is longer, and thereafter shall be delivered by you to the Company. You shall dispose of unused Letters of Transmittal and other surplus materials by returning them to the Company.
     18. It is understood and agreed that the securities, money or property to be deposited with or received by you as Exchange Agent (the “Property”) constitute a special, segregated account held solely for the benefit of the Company and the tendering holders of Original Notes, as their interests may appear, and the Property shall not be commingled with the money, assets or properties of you or of any other person, firm or corporation. You hereby expressly waive any and all rights of lien, attachment, encumbrance or right of set-off whatsoever against the Property so deposited, whether such rights arise by reason of applicable law, contract or otherwise.
     19. For services rendered as Exchange Agent hereunder, you shall be entitled to a fee as has been separately agreed by you and the Company in writing and reimbursement of your reasonable and documented out-of-pocket expenses.
     20. You hereby acknowledge receipt of the Prospectus, the Letter of Transmittal and other documents associated with the Exchange Offer attached hereto and further acknowledge that you have examined each of them. Any inconsistency between this agreement, on the one hand, and the Prospectus, the Letter of Transmittal and such other forms (as they may be amended from time to time), on the other hand, shall be resolved in favor of the Prospectus, the Letter of Transmittal and such other forms, except with respect to the duties, liabilities and indemnification of you as Exchange Agent which shall be controlled by this agreement.
     21. The Company agrees to indemnify and hold you harmless in your capacity as Exchange Agent hereunder against any duly documented liability, reasonable and documented cost or expense, including reasonable attorneys’ fees, arising out of or in connection with your appointment as Exchange Agent and the performance of your duties hereunder, including, without limitation, any act, omission, delay or refusal made by you in reasonable reliance upon any signature, endorsement, assignment, certificate, order, request, notice, instruction or other instrument or document reasonably believed by you to be valid, genuine and sufficient and in accepting any tender or effecting any transfer of Original Notes reasonably believed by you in

6


 

good faith to be authorized, and in delaying or refusing in good faith to accept any tenders or effect any transfer of Original Notes; provided, however, that the Company shall not be liable for indemnification or otherwise for any loss, liability, cost or expense to the extent arising out of your negligence, willful misconduct or bad faith. In no case shall the Company be liable under this indemnity with respect to any claim against you unless the Company shall be notified by you, by letter or cable or by facsimile confirmed by letter, of the written assertion of a claim against you or of any other action commenced against you, promptly after you shall have received any such written assertion or written notice of the commencement of any such action. The Company shall be entitled to participate at its own expense in the defense of any such claim or other action, and, if the Company so elects, the Company shall assume the defense of any suit brought to enforce any such claim. In the event that the Company shall assume the defense of any such suit, the Company shall not be liable for the fees and expenses of any additional counsel thereafter retained by you so long as the Company shall retain counsel reasonably satisfactory to you to defend such suit.
     22. You shall arrange to comply with all requirements under the tax laws of the United States, including those relating to missing Tax Identification Numbers, and shall file any appropriate reports with the Internal Revenue Service.
     23. You shall notify the Company of the amount of any transfer taxes payable in respect of the exchange of Original Notes and shall deliver or cause to be delivered, in a timely manner, to each governmental authority to which any transfer taxes are payable in respect of the exchange of Original Notes, your check in the amount of all transfer taxes so payable, and, subject to the provisions of Section 7(c) of this agreement, the Company shall reimburse you for the amount of any and all transfer taxes payable in respect of the exchange of Original Notes; provided, however, that you shall reimburse the Company for amounts refunded to you in respect of your payment of any such transfer taxes, at such time as such refund is received by you.
     24. This agreement and your appointment as Exchange Agent hereunder shall be construed and enforced in accordance with the laws of the State of New York applicable to agreements made and to be performed entirely within such state, and without regard to conflicts of laws principles, and shall inure to the benefit of, and the obligations created hereby shall be binding upon, the successors and assigns of each of the parties hereto, and nothing in this agreement, express or implied, is intended to or shall confer upon any other person any right, benefit or remedy of any nature whatsoever under or by reason of this agreement. Without limitation of the foregoing, the parties hereto expressly agree that no holder of Original Notes or Exchange Notes shall have any right, benefit or remedy of any nature whatsoever under or by reason of this agreement.
     25. This agreement may be executed in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original and all of which taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.
     26. In case any provision of this agreement shall be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.

7


 

     27. This agreement shall not be deemed or construed to be modified, amended, rescinded, cancelled or waived, in whole or in part, except by a written instrument signed by a duly authorized representative of each party.
     28. Unless otherwise provided herein, all notices, requests and other communications to any party hereunder shall be in writing (including facsimile) and shall be given to such party, addressed to it, at its address or telecopy number set forth below:
          If to the Company:
ArcelorMittal
19 Avenue de la Liberté
L-2930 Luxembourg
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
Telephone: (352) 4792-2414
Facsimile: (352) 4792-2189
Attention: Funding Department
and
Facsimile: (33) 1 71 92 10 05
Attention: Corporate Funding
With a copy to:
Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP
12, rue de Tilsitt
75008 Paris
France
Telephone: +33 1 40 74 68 00
Facsimile: +33 1 40 74 68 88
Attention: Gamal M. Abouali
          If to the Exchange Agent:
HSBC Bank USA, National Association
Corporate Trust & Loan Agency
2 Hanson Place, 14th Floor
Brooklyn, New York 10217-1409
United States
Telephone: + 1 800 662-9844
Facsimile: +1 718 488-4488
     29. Unless terminated earlier by the parties hereto, this agreement shall terminate 90 days following the Expiration Date. Notwithstanding the foregoing, Paragraphs 17, 18, 19, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28 and 29 shall survive the termination of this agreement. Upon any

8


 

termination of this agreement, you shall promptly deliver to the Company any certificates for Notes, funds or property (including, without limitation, any documents relating to the Exchange Offer) then held by you as Exchange Agent under this agreement.
     30. This agreement shall be binding and effective as of the date hereof.

9


 

          Please acknowledge receipt of this agreement and confirm the arrangements herein provided by signing and returning the enclosed copy.
         
     
  By:      
    Name:      
    Title:      
 
     
  By:      
    Name:      
    Title:      
 
Accepted as of the date first above written:
HSBC BANK USA, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
as exchange agent
         
By:
       
 
 
 
Name:
   
 
  Title:    
[Signature Page to Exchange Agent Agreement]

10

GRAPHIC 18 u01974u0197400.gif GRAPHIC begin 644 u01974u0197400.gif M1TE&.#EAZ@`[`.8``(F'A/+U\_Z)=YF7D_[%N7IX=O[QZ_[CV:JII?[IX?[5 MR3DT,_V5A2HD)4M&1?XE#/W^_OVGF/VWJ>/EXK6TL?U\:-/4TI22D%E65/XU M&FEF8]O[O[?UB3/[Y]?TZ(-+1SL'" MOO[\^B\I*4`[.OV_L]K9U_[[^/\<`'1R;["MJW]]>__^^[JYMH2"?R M!#AW_[\_?V@C_VTG^GJZ,"^N_VMGV!<6K_!O/7W]OO]_??Y^8Z, MBN[Q[L3(PNCIYOG\_/[]_DY+29^=FOXA"=[?W-;7U5113V1A7K>WM/W^_2(= M'BPF)V]L:?X:`N;JYT9!/\_/S?X;!/[[^S4P+^OMZQ\:&_X9`B4@(/[^_O[^ M__[______O_^_OS]_BTH*/#R\,?'Q?XO$OU/+_[V]?X_)?___R'Y!``````` M+`````#J`#L```?_@'^"@X2%AH>(B8J+C(V.CY"1?UI*=FP)*`0[$D]/$CL$ M!"@=!G9UA:>2JJNLK:ZOL+&(=4()2R$N#RJ[O+L?1C4D(14,$B@'-*>G=G:R MSL_0T=*P!@P9'Q\>VMO5,#I4@,&$R&(E"`< M2;*D(@DQ\#7\T!#8BV$58(1XX8)#C3U=)';#J,U(#!("=B3`0="DT:,CEQAQ M2,](A`,B:/3`T8.&"`,&#J!XPD!`"!)^'NC$B+&+BPH14(B@@[2M6W9,_QY8 MW,:'&201"G8(>%'#B`J6V"Q&5-&%@P"UD^K8?G*T"AH%6RGI@8A`B!NAM$;>M MR3!CR1\E;%*[7OZ:384:?OB$$,"`P9,$-`PD.-"A@X+OX!5T/Y#```TYB303 M8###C^S9VX#->-*AQRSF^-DU$W@(\G<4*.P0@0`5Q#0#6!GLH6`,#\00PQX9 MU,`!"3/`1-T3HB@`U3JI:?9$!1QT`9]#V:Q10P4[&*"8$*FT>%E^,+*BA6J" M""&"5A((``-??NURSX_W8+.+#QD(0PP!&O;1C/]>N0#'C0I`(4.08C%6"8L= M!G1`0&<9O*?22OG,!:23X&`$)CA=9,`!B@IDM40N?W$3D5E/E,*?E7A&TH=> MN.RQQF\ZA38;3V..:$^93!F:D1%JSD!=CAG$^8T'&82P0Q\O_G%GGLLUPXQJ M-^;X0@9B25KHH`T%Y\$9#ZC)`072)QRAR+=>"00`>\A06?KKU^DPU##T#X@)P.P4$"`0F4:ZZY M!Z3KW0Y/+-%5!3-PD.`#N1**3UD.BIAM?!PPT$%R@M#H;&N7Z%6#+^#R]`%H MX<20`1\P"+`$"I5$L`;_2[,U=`8)"6BZB@@=+$$@"3<9$>A*/H@Y*#XJQ,"` M`C0,[%H/!RSAQ\77[DL/JVON0$JF0BCPK6`79:``:ZW80;,"3+1'+#Z%6O0+ M'P3(;-(R2JS#A@("Y!+HB-NJ8(0+'BG0L::9!BP'`1QL.U<7.Z"7-BNZ=<%0.N41=-K<@_)V2P`PX/Y1- M%Q4<($M1=PH$_)7K12K&?*($(MTM2AP@"F`SU M_S8QH"`'Y.TH(0&(8C'$D@I[//$\]`+1H`#O)S>5000=X!"P*-.O3@"2Y8BL[N903#]`]IFY*%'5#`!T!Q MXPS-0Q_T_B`':"FA#R(02?U(YE&`+<)H2*V8\S**&%!%0@ M5W+:F`3\9Q`A)#"$-'R%""K0!=`(!C1GB$$()'``#I$$?"FIAP]B$`'-1?%Y M!_"%JJ[GL@001(4%J<,!KD&FB"C@C/,3`0RJ%QH7,,%_64/;C(QR`!B<(2(, M\<`>.H#'YWTO`B^@%0=@L`./&6*&[ZC##D@@FSV$H/\#Z&DD!;6#J>5P[@\X MR,0Y<,`B45(P@8U9!N0$TDI7VI(QRD`%)F_)RU[Z\I?`#*8PATG,8AKSF,A, MIC*7:4LY0&`.>>!"`8*``/1`P)EM8\,Y1]D$(0B%,$,=YB``V[:@HP:`@)?N``U(6`%)WR3"!-P*A5X,(0J!.'! M1+B`_Q@V,((1.',*$,#"#09`A'E&.`IQ+:=1Z5"`!I1AMV9%*`20``(.3S,( M5:#`%RQ\!YG.80HR<#`"H*F';P)@`J%D@0:".X`4%&$%4)`"(1`Z`2@4UP1A M*`,>B$!7%A[5#2T(P@6:``$JJ.$"`!AO`\(0X2\$@`)5*,`*UON#*K0`#0<] M*@MX@&8B%*```!!#$L;@A0Y#=Q`4""X82D#.[Z)G"(MM0Q)BF@(RE"$-%I"K M(.XP@-/JX`@:P$,.CGR$F%K@!SHH`D@7H%3[;B$*FIT"$K@`AMCF@-2+;8`# MJN`&;"*TQ"<.@%FGRX4MA+0,;5C`6K,:A"]T%:`L.,)IV__@!3.T@;LK4$,H M\S!>/$P@"0M':+XE4W<` M`LJU`&*@3RPT!>'&?6#0!!GW!QP';"D@5Q,P9"M0`%(@7TLF"!H@4AK0!(:6 M>@T8!$%%_P0&]0Z]P=AJ&Z%4(9G6`AIN(:"D`=VUP*;98ERH%(-4/]Y@#:!T<`6 M(^!M9;`"&%``/^"./_`#+M=A!<9%!6BI`$H09O-T60 M]W9O\G93/R`#MV9B+/4';E``;!91AX!HK64#[;1]^I8("/!U21",`7`!<5`$ M4/`'>;`%Q84`=^!,='`"_N@%"3>-8S@(UHB&I:>-\]5:#3`$WS@(7,4%N>4` M"7>'%)B'+!;="`%[K8"K[A-[X54]H4'A/4' M2M@&B``!09!858!USR0'-G!99)`$0)#_E!@@`W3U3L-H7Y0%AI=%C6286-=( M"-G(`X/`C0V0`P-0@+HG4_IDA`A7CIA7E,[`568@@QL@`[(YFS+@!K*I!FM6 M!$VE>R5XE=JT32EH7S_0@D554O$%5440!A-P31C6=@@E!UD@3N@%='F@3R80 M6VF0`@EW!UG`31/`A[+657]P`S8%F(?PG<"FA73P4G(P`EP`5#]07PT0=]PD M"%(@DDM%"#)9C9IIDVKHF8(P`M:'!VD`C>LGG6,@`V\@;VE@A^88#1?P;#IP M`I4HBX+``LT8E\:&'KT9`&PA73>0!O+V`X3%4[\Y!W?@!D]8!E#@!ACV3W1U M3F[&`O]D?<%FF MQU;8M5$L)`:*]0:A)PC[F9EFZ)\X^0=JL`5%T`90L)P7UE$6X`!K1:`.NIK1 M``+HAP<_P`*]50@Q-72A:0972(*Y=95Z]09%XNM4`5'.*2*@/]4XZ4# M)G!-`\!=.I`%]B=]=Z`&0>``S[8"2QE5"P`%E)@%,3<`4*!\4 M4TW`!41P`YO5M*R@65D@4Q6ZBUP54STZLM)G8^LIB^V4NCRU4"4%`1@64YKU M3@F%ES'55==K4-8$MBZ(7MPDGD<5O(^(EXE+!]W9I[E'5=";4`HU3DNF4<^$ MEP5HH!UF'2UDN!'550%O+P:"S$*P(V`O5GIOHEK91L5C<'86Q]: M?])'5^S+@/Z;8A(UM>MJ:-_5"@\\LC+%;3V:P>\KBP78M*$44/5W4"\(O-,7 )7^S+P,X0"``[ ` end
-----END PRIVACY-ENHANCED MESSAGE-----